Hempelbook PDF
Hempelbook PDF
Hempelbook PDF
Product Data
Manual
Product Name
Date
HEMPEL'S MARINE VARNISH.................................................... .November 2003
HEMPADUR SEALER ................................................................ .December 2007
HEMPEL'S HI-VEE LACQUER ...................................................... December 2007
HEMPEL'S THINNERS. .............................................................. November 2003
HEMPINOL .............................................................................. December 2007
HEMPELS BALLAST COAT SH ...................................................... October 2007
HEMPALIN PRIMER .................................................................. December 2007
HEMPEL'S UNI-PRIMER ........................................................... December 2007
HEMPALIN PRIMER HI-BUILD ..................................................... December 2007
HEMPAQUICK PRIMER ............................................................ . December 2007
HEMPEL'S SHOPPRIMER E........................................................ December 2007
HEMPADUR PRIMER ................................................................ December 2007
HEMPADUR ZINC ..................................................................... December 2007
APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS ............................................... December 2007
HEMPADUR ............................................................................. December 2007
APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS ............................................... December 2007
HEMPADUR ............................................................................. December 2007
APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS ............................................... December 2007
HEMPADUR ............................................................................. December 2007
HEMPADUR FAST DRY .............................................................. December 2007
HEMPADUR ............................................................................. December 2007
APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS ............................................... December 2007
HEMPADUR ............................................................................. December 2007
HEMPEL'S GALVOSIL ............................................................... December 2007
APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS ............................................... December 2007
HEMPEL'S GALVOSIL ............................................................... December 2007
APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS ............................................... December 2007
HEMPEL'S GALVOSIL .................................................................. October 2006
APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS .................................................. October 2007
HEMPEL'S SHOPPRIMER ZS ....................................................September 2007
APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS ............................................... December 2007
HEMPEL'S ZINC PRIMER .............................................................. October 2007
HEMPEL'S SILICONE ZINC ........................................................... October 2007
HEMPADUR ZINC ..................................................................... December 2007
HEMPADUR ZINC...................................................................... December 2007
HEMPADUR ............................................................................. December 2007
APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS ............................................... December 2007
APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS BALLAST TANKS............................ December 2007
HEMUCRYL PRIMER HI-BUILD ................................................... December 2007
APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS ............................................... December 2007
HEMUCRYL TI-COAT .................................................................. December 2007
APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS ............................................... December 2007
HEMUDUR .............................................................................. December 2007
HEMUDUR ZINC ....................................................................... December 2007
HEMPATEX E.V. PRIMER ........................................................... December 2007
HEMPASIL NEXUS ................................................................... December 2007
HEMPADUR FILLER ................................................................... December 2007
HEMPADUR SPRAY-GUARD ....................................................... December 2007
APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS ............................................... December 2007
INSTRUCTIONS FOR MANUAL APPLICATION ........................... December 2007
HEMPADUR MULTI-STRENGTH .................................................. December 2007
APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS ............................................... December 2007
HEMPADUR ............................................................................. December 2007
APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS ............................................... December 2007
HEMPADUR GLASS FLAKE......................................................... December 2007
HEMPADUR MULTI-STRENGTH GF. ............................................. December 2007
HEMPEL'S VINYL ESTER GF.....................................................September 2007
APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS ..............................................September 2007
HEMPEL'S POLYESTER GF. ............................................................August 2006
APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS ............................................... November 2003
HEMPALIN UNDERCOAT ............................................................ December 2007
Page 1 of 3
Product No.
45080/45083
45141/45143
45182
45200
45540
45601/45603
45751/45753
45753
45880/45881
46330
46370
46410
46820
47140
47200
47601/47603
47741/47743
47741
48130
51570
52140
52220
52360
53240
53840
55000
55030
55100
55210
55850
55910
56360
56540
56900
56910
56940
58030
58040
58230
67420
67500
77000
77100
77500
8190M
8190N
8195M
8195N
81970
8490K
8495K
85442
85531
Product Name
Date
HEMPADUR ............................................................................. December 2007
HEMPADUR ............................................................................. December 2007
APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS ............................................... December 2007
HEMPADUR ............................................................................. December 2007
HEMPADUR HI-BUILD. ............................................................... December 2007
HEMPADUR MULTI-STRENGTH .................................................. December 2007
HEMPADUR PRO....................................................................... December 2007
APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS ............................................... December 2007
APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS BALLAST TANKS....................... December 2007
HEMPADUR MULTI-STRENGTH .................................................. December 2007
APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS ............................................... December 2007
APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS BALLAST TANKS....................... December 2007
HEMPADUR MASTIC ................................................................ December 2007
APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS ............................................... December 2007
HEMPATEX HI-BUILD ................................................................. December 2007
HEMPATEX HI-BUILD ................................................................. December 2007
HEMPATEX HI-BUILD ................................................................. December 2007
HEMPATEX HI-BUILD. ................................................................ December 2003
HEMPADUR ............................................................................. December 2007
HEMPADUR ............................................................................. December 2007
HEMPADUR FIBRE ................................................................... December 2007
APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS ............................................... December 2007
APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS BALLAST TANKS....................... December 2007
HEMPADUR UNIQ .................................................................... December 2007
APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS ............................................... December 2007
APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS BALLAST TANKS....................... December 2007
HEMUCRYL . ............................................................................ December 2007
APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS ............................................... December 2007
HEMPEL'S SILVIUM ................................................................. December 2007
HEMPALIN ENAMEL .................................................................. December 2007
HEMPALIN ENAMEL HI-BUILD .................................................... December 2007
HEMPALIN DANREX ................................................................. December 2005
HEMPALIN DECKPAINT.............................................................. December 2005
HEMPAQUICK ENAMEL.............................................................. December 2007
HEMPAXANE .......................................................................... December 2007
APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS ............................................... December 2007
HEMPAXANE LIGHT.................................................................. December 2007
HEMPATHANE ENAMEL ............................................................. December 2007
HEMPATHANE TOPCOAT............................................................ December 2007
HEMPEL'S OXIDUR . ................................................................. December 2007
HEMPATHANE TOPCOAT............................................................ December 2007
HEMPATEX ENAMEL.................................................................. December 2003
HEMPEL'S HI-VEE . ................................................................... December 2003
HEMPEL'S SILICONE TOPCOAT ..................................................... October 2007
HEMPEL'S SILICONE ALUMINIUM. ............................................. December 2007
HEMPELS SILICONE ACRYLIC ................................................... December 2007
HEMUCRYL ENAMEL HI-BUILD ................................................... December 2007
APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS ............................................... December 2007
HEMUCRYL ENAMEL. ............................................................... December 2007
APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS ............................................... December 2007
HEMUCRYL TOPCOAT HI-BUILD................................................. December 2007
APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS ............................................... December 2007
HEMPEL'S ANTI-SLIP BEADS ..................................................... November 2003
HEMPEL'S ANTI-SLINT .............................................................. December 2007
HEMPASIL HELIX ..................................................................... December 2007
HEMPASIL .............................................................................. December 2007
HEMPASIL .............................................................................. December 2007
HEMPELS ANTIFOULING GLOBIC NCT ........................................ December 2007
HEMPELS ANTIFOULING GLOBIC NCT ........................................ December 2007
HEMPELS ANTIFOULING GLOBIC NCT .......................................... February 2007
HEMPELS ANTIFOULING GLOBIC NCT ........................................ December 2007
HEMPELS ANTIFOULING GLOBIC SAP ........................................ December 2007
HEMPELS ANTIFOULING OCEANIC ............................................ December 2007
HEMPELS ANTIFOULING OCEANIC ............................................ December 2007
HEMPELS GAS PIPE COATING................................................... November 2003
HEMPADUR ............................................................................. December 2007
Page 2 of 3
Product No.
85671
86900
86950
87540
87633
99610
99800
99810
99850
Product Name
Date
HEMPADUR ............................................................................. December 2007
APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS ............................................... December 2007
HEMPELS ANTIFOULING OLYMPIC ............................................ December 2007
HEMPELS ANTIFOULING OLYMPIC ............................................ December 2007
HEMPADUR ............................................................................. December 2007
APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS ............................................... December 2007
HEMPEL'S HS GAS PIPE COATING ............................................. November 2007
HEMPEL'S TOOL CLEANER ........................................................ December 2007
HEMUCRYL THINNER ................................................................ December 2007
HEMUCRYL BRUSH AGENT........................................................ December 2007
HEMPELS SILICONE CLEANER .......................................................... June 2005
Page 3 of 3
Generally the proprietary name of a Hempel paint is a collective name denoting the
group and the generic type to which it belongs, thus:
Physically drying:
HEMPATEX
HEMPANYL
HEMUCRYL
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
Chemically curing:
HEMPALIN
HEMPADUR
HEMUDUR
HEMPATHANE
GALVOSIL
Note: Where a proprietary name is not used the product name is preceded by
HEMPEL'S.
QUALITY NUMBERS:
Each Hempel product is identified by a 5-digit quality number. The first two digits relate
to the principal function and the generic type. The third and fourth digits are serial
numbers. The fifth digit identifies specific formulas with the same product, e.g. high
temperature curing/low, medium temperature curing, conformity to local legislation.
Therefore, the first four digits define the end-user performance, ie the dried, cured paint
material. The fifth digit usually relates to the conditions of application, however, may
also be used purely for logistic reasons.
First digit
Function
0----
1----
2----
3----
4----
5----
Finishing coat
6----
Miscellaneous
7----
Antifouling paint
8----
Miscellaneous
9----
Miscellaneous
Second digit
Generic type
-0---
-1---
-2---
Page 1A of 10
SHADE NUMBERS:
-3---
-4---
Miscellaneous
-5---
-6---
-7---
Miscellaneous
-8---
-9---
Miscellaneous
Example:
HEMPADUR 15570:
1----5--- - 57 - - - - 0 (or 1)
Hempel paints are supplied in colours identified by a 5-digit, standard shade number as
follows:
White
Whitish, grey
Black
Yellow, cream, buff
Blue, violet
Green
Red, orange, pink
Brown
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
:
Example:
HEMPALIN PRIMER 12050-50410:
10000
10010-19980
19990
20010-29990
30010-39990
40010-49990
50010-59990
60010-69990
50410 = red shade
Hempels standard shade numbers do not directly correlate to official colour standard
numbers. However, colours corresponding to specific official standard colours may be
established.
Frequently used colours/shades are displayed in HEMPELs colour cards.
The fifth digit may be used to identify specific formulas with the same shade, but a
different type of pigments used, eg conformity to (local) legislation. 0 indicates a
standard formulation, 6 lead-containing pigments.
Note: The shades of primers, many intermediates and antifoulings may fluctuate as a
distinct shade is not important for such products.
Description:
Recommended use:
The purpose(s) for which the product is designed or particularly well suited. The product
may be specified for other uses in tailor-made paint systems for specific purposes.
Service temperature:
Indicates the maximum temperature that will have no immediate detrimental effect on
the paint.
A service temperature constantly near the maximum will result in a shorter lifetime of
the specified paint system compared to the lifetime anticipated when operating at
normal temperatures. If service temperatures are often fluctuating between normal
temperatures and near maximum temperatures this will result in an additional decrease
in the anticipated lifetime of the paint system ("accelerated ageing").
Most paints will change appearance when exposed to high temperatures, either by a
change in colour and/or by loss of gloss.
Page 2A of 10
In addition most paints will become soft at high temperatures and show higher
sensitivity to mechanical or chemical actions.
Exposure to warm liquids, water included, will normally only be recommended for
dedicated paint systems. At high temperatures, wet service will have a more
pronounced influence on lifetime compared to dry service.
When a paint system is exposed to fluctuations of temperatures wet service conditions
will induce more stress to the coating system than dry service at same temperatures.
Furthermore it is of importance whether the liquid has a higher temperature than the
coated steel.
A cold wall effect will increase the risk of blistering and thus put further limitations to
the temperature resistance. Most paint systems do only tolerate a very low negative
gradient of temperature under wet/immersed service conditions.
Approvals, certificates:
Availability:
Delivery of certain products requires notice in advance for logistic reasons. This is
indicated by the expression Local availability subject to confirmation.
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS
Finish:
The appearance of the paint film after drying under optimum conditions in laboratory,
given as high gloss (>90), glossy (60-90), semi-gloss (30-60), semi-flat (15-30), or flat
(<15). All figures are in gloss units and according to ISO 2813:1994(E) (specular gloss,
60 degree geometry). The actual appearance will depend on the conditions during
application and drying/curing.
The finish indicated in the product data sheet is according to optimal conditions (ie
application and measurements under standardised laboratory conditions).
Colours/shade nos:
See SHADE NUMBERS. Certain physical constants may vary from one colour to another.
Volume solids:
Page 3A of 10
The theoretical spreading rate of the paint in a given dry film thickness on a completely
smooth surface is calculated as follows:
__Volume solids x 10___
Dry film thickness (micron)
m/litre
or
Volume solids% x 16.04
Dry film thickness (mils)
sq.ft./US gallon
_
_Area x CF_______
Theoretical spreading rate
Page 4A of 10
The Practical spreading rate thus varies with method of application, skill of the painter,
shape of the object to be painted, texture of the substrate, film thickness applied, and
working conditions.
In any case it is not beneficial to stretch the paint as much as possible, but rather to try
to obtain the specified thickness of the applied paint on the entire area.
Flash point:
The lowest temperature at which a liquid liberates sufficient vapour to form a mixture
with the air near its surface which, if ignited, will make a small flash, but not catch fire.
The flash points of Hempels paints are measured according to the Setaflash method
(closed cup). For two-component products flash points are normally given for the mixed
products. The figures are given as guidance with a view to local regulations for
precautions against fire during use.
Adding THINNER to a paint may change the flash point of the diluted material.
Specific gravity:
The weight in kilogramme per litre at 25C/77F. An equivalent figure is given in lbs per
US gallon.
For two-component products the specific gravity is given for the mixed product.
The specific gravity may in practice vary in an interval of a few percent compared to the
theoretical value indicated in the product data sheet.
Dry to touch:
Drying time in the product data sheet is dry to touch unless otherwise indicated.
For shopprimers a more relevant figure for "dry to handle" is given.
Drying times refer to a temperature of 20C/68F, 60-70% relative humidity, with
adequate ventilation.
"Dry to touch":
A slight pressure with a finger does not leave a mark and the
surface does not feel sticky
"Dry to handle":
The drying process until "dry to touch" is - for solvent (or water) containing paints - first
and foremost dependent on ventilation. Furthermore it depends on the temperature and
on the film thickness of each coat applied.
All surfaces should be ventilated. It should be noted that water-borne paints have higher
requirements to ventilation than do solvent-borne paints.
In the case of physically drying paints, drying time is also influenced by the number of
coats, the total film thickness of the system and the film thickness per coat. As a rough
rule of thumb, twice the film thickness of a given single coat will require approx 4 times
the drying time with the same amount of ventilation. This goes for both solvent and
water-borne paints.
It should be stressed that when apply applying more coats, entrapped solvents may
result in a softer film than if only one coat is applied. This is especially relevant in the
case of physically drying paints.
Also temperature has much influence on the drying/curing time. A temperature drop of
10C/18F will roughly require twice the drying time for physically drying paints.
Fully cured:
Page 5A of 10
Curing will stop almost completely below the temperature stated under application
conditions as the lowest temperature at which the paint should be applied.
V.O.C.:
The calculated weight of volatile organic content in gramme per litre. An equivalent
figure is given in lbs per US gallon.
Alternatively, VOC can be indicated by a measured value.
Shelf life:
The time the product will keep in good condition when stored under cover in original,
sealed containers under normal storage conditions. Shelf life is indicated only if it is
one year or less at 25C/77F. It will decrease at higher temperatures, eg will be
almost halved at 35C/95F.
If no specific limitation is given, a paint should not be stored for more than five years at
25C/77F or three years at 35C/95F for one-component products and three years at
25C/77F or two years at 35C/95F for two-component products from the date of
production.
Long-term storage and storage at high temperatures may require careful remixing of the
paint prior to application due to (slight) sediment in the can.
If storage conditions are unknown and in any other case in doubt about suitability of a
paint material this can be rather easily verified by checking the following:
a. no corrosion of the inside unopened, undamaged cans
b. apparent viscosity in can: after remix, paint must not appear gelatinous or require
excessive thinning prior to proper application.
c. application in specified film thickness: a uniform, closed paint film is to be
demonstrated
d. drying time to be within the limit specified in the product data sheet
The date of production is indicated in the batch number:
For 7 digit batch numbers: The date of production is indicated in the first 3 digits of the
batch number: The 1st digit indicates the year of production, the 2nd and 3rd digits
indicate the month of production.
For 9 digit batch numbers: The date of production is indicated in 3 digits of the batch
number: The 3rd digit indicates the year of production, the 4th and 5th digits indicate
the month of production. The 1st and 2nd digits identify the production factory.
Storage temperature:
APPLICATION DETAILS
Mixing ratio:
Two-component, chemically curing products are supplied as BASE and CURING AGENT
in the correct mixing ratio. The mixing ratio must be strictly adhered to, also when
subdividing. As a general rule, add the CURING AGENT to the BASE 30 minutes
(induction time) before use (at 20C/68F), unless the pot life is (very) short, and stir
well. This is especially of importance when applying paints to low-temperture surfaces.
In certain cases, more specific advice is given as to induction time.
It is very important for two component products that the prescribed amount of CURING
AGENT is added to the BASE. In order to ensure this the indicated thinner may in most
cases beneficially be used to flush the CURING AGENT can. Once the material has been
mixed the curing will proceed. Therefore, only the quantity needed within the pot life of
the mixture should be mixed at a time.
Application method:
Page 6A of 10
Thinner (max.vol):
Hempels paints are delivered in such a way, that they are ready for application at
20C/68F by brush or airless spray after stirring (for two-component products after
mixing of BASE and CURING AGENT). This goes for a given normal application range of
dry film thickness. If the paint is too thick, eg in cold weather or for special purposes eg
application in lower film thickness, the THINNER(S) indicated under this heading may be
added to give the required viscosity. The amount of thinner to be added, depends on
prevailing temperature, spray method, etc. The usual maximum percentage is indicated
for the respective application method. If more thinning is deemed necessary under
special circumstances, consult nearest Hempel office.
Adding a small percentage of thinner will give no measurable difference in the film
thickness. There are cases, however, when a higher degree of thinning is necessary and
justified. It should then be kept in mind that adding thinner increases the quantity of
liquid paint without contributing to the solids content. Consequently, a proportionally
higher wet film thickness must be applied when adding any significant amount of
thinner in order to obtain the specified dry film thickness.
VS% after thinning =
Example:
0.5 x 100
20
______VS% x 100____
% THINER added + 100
Roughly speaking, the pot life for solvent-borne paints depends on the paint
temperature as follows:
The pot life is halved at an increase in temperature of 10C/18F, and doubled at a
decrease in temperature of 10C/18F.
For HEMPADUR products the pot life is usually shorter for application by airless spray
than for brush application. This is due to the fact that the anti-sagging properties are
gradually lost after expiration of the pot life indicated for airless application. Thus the
high dry film thickness usually specified by airless spray application is only obtainable
within the pot life indicated for airless application.
Note: Pot life cannot be extended by thinning.
In the case of water-borne, two-component epoxy products this rule of thumb will not fit.
The temperature's influence on the pot life is noted in the relevant data sheets.
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Normally the indicated HEMPEL THINNER can be used for cleaning of tools after use.
Where special cleaning agents are recommended it is indicated on the product data
sheet.
Tools used in connection with water-borne paints may be difficult to clean. Therefore, it
is especially important to follow the instructions stated in the product data sheets.
Page 7A of 10
Checking of dry film thicknesses is, generally, done with gauges calibrated on smooth
reference steel panels. Shopprimers are controlled according to a special procedure,
which is available at your Hempel sales office.
Indicated film thickness, wet: Wet film thickness (wft) is indicated in multiple of 25 micron (1 mil) in order to facilitate
the practical measurements with the wet film thickness gauge (comb gauge). These
values are rounded off to the multiple of 25 which is regarded most relevant in each
case.
Recoat interval:
The time required or allowed to pass at 20C/ 68F or the relevant temperature range
for the product in question before the subsequent coat is applied. The intervals are
related to the temperature, film thickness, number of coats, type of future (in service)
exposure and will be affected correspondingly. For maximum intervals the temperature
in this context is the highest surface temperature during the period. For some products
the interval is more critical in regard to intercoat adhesion than others. If the maximum
interval is exceeded it may be necessary to roughen the surface to ensure adhesion of
the next coat. On the other hand, for some paint types the interval may not be critical in
respect of adhesion, but a primer coat should not be left unprotected for too long in an
aggressive environment.
If nothing else is mentioned the indicated intervals refer to recoating with the same
paint. Other paints of different types may require other (recoating) intervals.
Minimum and any maximum intervals should always be adhered to if the paint system is
to provide maximum protection.
Furthermore, beware of undesired influence of moisture and carbon dioxide on epoxy
and polyurethane paints, which especially occurs at low temperatures and high
humidity. This will result in a greasy surface preventing any adhesion of the subsequent
coat.
After exposure of any painted surface in polluted environment thorough cleaning by high
pressure fresh water hosing or another appropriate measure is always recommended
before recoating. Different minimum and maximum recoating intervals are given for
certain products depending on the later exposure, ie
In atmospheric conditions
In water
mild
medium
severe
Details about recoat intervals are stated in the relevant painting specification.
SURFACE PREPARATION:
The recommended degree of cleaning of the surface before painting. The degrees of
cleaning refer to ISO 8501-1:2007. Pictorial Surface Preparation Standards for Painting
of Steel Surfaces, unless otherwise indicated.
For some products a minimum surface profile is mandatory. The profile so specified is
given with reference to one or more of the roughness comparators: Rugotest No. 3,
Keane-Tator Comparator, or the ISO Comparator.
For previously painted surfaces the method and degree of preparatory cleaning is
generally indicated.
APPLICATION CONDITIONS:
If climatic or other limits, beyond what is dictated by normal good painting practice,
apply to the use of a particular quality of paint, this is indicated under this heading.
As a general rule, paint should never be applied under adverse weather conditions.
Even if the weather seems fit for painting there will be condensation if the temperature
of the substrate is at or below the dew point (the temperature at which the atmospheric
humidity condenses, e.g. as dew). To compensate for fluctuations the temperature of
the surface should be at least a few degrees above the dew point during painting and
drying. 3C/5F is often quoted as safe.
Beware of ice on the surface at temperatures below the freezing point.
Page 8A of 10
SUBSEQUENT COAT:
REMARKS:
SAFETY:
Under this heading general safety precautions when handling or working with the
product are given. Packings are provided with applicable safety labels which should be
observed. In addition, Material Safety Data Sheets, national or local safety regulations
should always be followed.
ISSUED BY:
Page 9A of 10
Additional notes and definitions of some expressions used in the product data sheets:
Surface cleaning*
Low pressure water cleaning (LP WC):
High pressure water cleaning (HP WC):
High pressure water jetting (HP WJ):
Ultrahigh pressure water jetting (UHP WJ):
*As defined in "Joint Surface Preparation Standard NACE No. 5/SSPC-SP 12, 1995".
Note: Wet abrasive blasting may be performed with low or high pressure fresh water to
which a relative small amount of abrasives is introduced, and in some cases inhibitors
are added to prevent flash rusting (however, as a general rule it is recommended not to
use inhibitors when cleaning areas to be immersed during service. Surplus of inhibitors
may lead to osmotic blistering).
A blast primer is a paint used for short term protection of a newly blast cleaned steel
surface of an assembled structure in order to ease the working procedures. In this
context blast primers are often regarded an integral part of the surface preparation.
A holding primer is a paint used to prolong (hold) the protective lifetime of a shopprimer
till the specified paint system proper can be applied.
To apply a mist coat or flash coat is a two step application procedure used to minimise
popping when painting on a porous substrate. At first, one or two spray passes are
applied very thin to expel the air from the pores. As soon as this thin coat has flashed
off, the film is built up to the specified film thickness.
A tiecoat is a layer of paint which improves the adhesion between coatings of different
generic types, eg to "bridge" between conventional and advanced coatings, or between
epoxy and physically drying paints.
A sealer coat is a layer of paint which is used to seal off (fill the pores of) porous
surfaces such as zinc silicates and empty, insoluble matrix of certain antifoulings. In
this connection it prevents disturbance of the balance between binder and active
pigments of the new antifouling. Furthermore, certain paints may be used as sealer
coats to minimise popping of the following coat(s) when painting a porous substrate.
When a paint is mentioned to be resistant to spillages and splashes of certain
chemicals it is understood to be limited in both area and time. The spilt chemical must
be removed as soon as possible and not remain on the surface more than 1-2 days.
When stating both metric and US figures the US figures may be rounded off when an
exact figure is of less importance.
Page 10A of 10
Steel surface largely covered with adherent mill scale but little, if any, rust.
B:
Steel surface which has begun to rust and from which the mill scale has begun
to flake.
C:
Steel surface on which the mill scale has rusted away or from which it can be
scraped, but with slight pitting visible under normal vision.
D:
Steel surface on which the mill scale has rusted away and on which general
pitting is visible under normal vision.
A surface preparation method using high pressure water for cleaning is getting more
common. The best definition of terms and surface preparation standards are presented
by ISO 8501-4:2006.
For comparison of the standards see the following pages. The text of the individual
Standards are quoted literally.
Page 1B of 5
ISO 8501-1:2007
Designation
Description
Sa 3
Sa 2
Sa 2
Thorough blast-cleaning.
When viewed without magnification, the surface shall be free from visible oil, grease
and dirt, and from most of the mill scale, rust, paint coatings and foreign matter. Any
residual contamination shall be firmly adhering (see note 2 below). See photographs B
Sa 2, C Sa 2 and D Sa 2.
Sa 1
Light blast-cleaning.
When viewed without magnification, the surface shall be free from visible oil, grease
and dirt, and from poorly adhering mill scale, rust, paint coatings and foreign matter
(see note 2). See photographs B Sa 1, C Sa 1 and D Sa 1.
Notes:
1.
The term "foreign matter" may include water-soluble salts and welding residues.
These contaminants cannot always be completely removed from the surface by
dry blast-cleaning, hand and power tool cleaning or flame cleaning; wet blastcleaning or hydrojetting may be necessary.
2.
St 3
St 2
BS 7079-1990
Page 2B of 5
SSPC
Designation
SSPC-SP-5
SSPC-SP-10
SSPC-SP-6
Description
1.1
A white Metal Blast Cleaned surface, when viewed without magnification, shall
be free of all visible oil, grease, dirt, dust, mill scale, rust, paint, oxides,
corrosion products, and other foreign matter.
1.2
1.3
1.4
Immediately prior to paint application the surface shall comply with the degree
of cleaning as specified herein.
1.5
2.1
2.2
Staining shall be limited to no more than 5 per cent of each square inch of
surface area and may consist of light shadows, slight streaks, or minor
discolorations caused by stains of rust, stains of mill scale, or stains of
previously applied paint.
2.3
2.4
2.5
Immediately prior to paint application, the surface shall comply with the degree
of cleaning as specified herein.
2.6
3.1
3.2
Staining shall be limited to no more than 33 per cent of each square inch of
surface area and may consist of light shadows, slight streaks, or minor
discolourations caused by stains of rust, stains of mill scale, or stains of
previously applied paint. Slight residues of rust and paint may also be left in the
bottoms of pits if the original surface is pitted.
3.3
Page 3B of 5
SSPC
Designation
Description
SSPC-SP-6, cont.
3.4
3.5
Immediately prior to paint application, the surface shall comply with the degree
of cleaning as specified herein.
3.6
4.1
4.2
The entire surface shall be subjected to the abrasive blast. The remaining mill
scale, rust, or paint shall be tight.
4.3
4.4
Immediately prior to paint application, the surface shall comply with the degree
of cleaning as specified herein.
4.5
5.1
5.2
Hand tool cleaning removes all loose mill scale, loose rust, loose paint, and
other loose detrimental foreign matter. It is not intended that adherent mill
scale, rust, and paint be removed by this process. Mill scale, rust, and paint are
considered adherent if they cannot be removed by lifting with a dull putty knife.
5.3
SSPC-SP-7
SSPC-SP-2
ISO 12944-4 is not quoted (translated) but is fully in line with ISO 8501-1:2007 (except
for the extra standards as mentioned on page 10).
Comparing the standards, no doubt that Sa 3 and SSPC-SP-5 are identical in their
demands to surface cleanliness. Also Sa 2 and SSPC-SP-10 seem identical.
Concerning Sa 2 and SSPC-SP-6 these differ slightly, SSPC-SP-6 expressing more
demands to quality. SSPC-SP-6 requires remnants being stains only. Sa 2 states
"residual contamination shall be firmly adhering".
Note: For SSPC the written specification takes preference - for ISO 8501-1:2007, the
photos.
Page 4B of 5
ISO 8504-1:2006
Surface preparation and cleaning of steel and other hard materials by high and ultrahigh
pressure water jetting prior to paint application.
Water jetting is a relatively new method of surface preparation. The standard deals with
the removal of visible and invisible contamination. After cleaning the surface will still be
wet and flash rusting may occur on cleaned steel during the drying period. Additional
Hempel-definitions of flash rust degrees are therefore described below.
Maintenance being the main area of use, any old coating remaining after water jetting
must be well adhering, intact and roughened by the treatment as well as compatible
with the new coating system to be applied.
As a general rule, coatings which are later to be exposed to severe mechanical and/or
chemical exposures, like eg specially wear and impact resistant coatings and chemically
resistant tank coatings, should not be applied to water jetted surfaces. Neither should
coatings for which protection relies upon metallic contact to the steel substrate, such
as zinc rich primers be applied to water jetted surfaces.
Description of the surface appearances after cleaning:
Wa 1
Wa 2
Wa 2
Page 5B of 5
SURFACE PROFILE
Page 1C/1
Roughness profile:
Page 1C of 1
CONVERSION TABLES
Page 1D/5
CONVERSION TABLES
To convert
From
To
Multiply by
Distance:
mil
micron
25
micron
mill
0.04
inches
centimetre (cm)
feet
metre
yards
metre
nautical mile
km
centimetre (cm)
inches
metre
feet
metre
yards
km
nautical mile
2.54
0.3937
0.3048
3.2808
0.9144
1.0936
1.853
0.5396
Area:
sq.ft.
sq.metre (m)
0.0929
10.764
Volume:
US gallon
litre
Imp. gallon
litre
litre
cu.ft.
litre
US gallon
litre
Imp. gallon
cu.ft.
litre
3.785
0.264
4.55
0.22
0.0353
28.32
Area/Volume:
m/litre
sq.ft./US gallon
m/litre
sq.ft./Imp. gallon
sq.ft./US gallon
m/litre
sq.ft./Imp. gallon
m/liter
40.74
0.0245
48.93
0.0204
Weight:
lbs
kg
kg
lbs
0.4536
2.2046
Density:
kg/litre
lbs/US gallon
lbs/US gallon
kg/litre
8.344
0.1198
V.O.C.:
g/litre
lbs/US gallon
0.0083
Pressure:
atm.
atm.
atm.
bar
bar
bar
kp/cm
kp/cm
kp/cm
kp/cm
p.s.i.
p.s.i.
p.s.i.
bar
kp/cm
p.s.i.
atm.
kp/cm
p.s.i.
atm.
bar
p.s.i.
MPa
atm.
bar
kp/cm
1.013
1.033
14.70
0.987
1.02
14.50
0.968
0.981
14.22
0.098
0.068
0.069
0.07
Notes:
Page 1 of 5
CONVERSION TABLES
To convert
From
To
Calculate
Temperature:
Celcius
Fahrenheit
Fahrenheit
Celcius
(9/5 x C) + 32
5/9 x (F - 32)
Film thickness:
(micron)
Wet
Dry
wft x VS%
100
Dry
Wet
dft x 100
VS%
Page 2D/5
wft = wet film thickness, dft = dry film thickness, VS% = Volume Solids
CALCULATION OF
Theoretical Spreading Rate (on completely smooth surface)
VS% x 10
desired dft (micron)
In m per litre =
VS% x 16.04
desired dft (mil)
In litre
In US gallon
Practical consumption:
The practical consumption is influenced by i) simple losses, by ii) additional consumption to fill up the "dead volume"
of the surface roughness, but especially iii) by the "waviness" of the paint surface. However, the term "loss factor" is
still used in parallel with the term "consumption factor" to describe a relationship between the theoretical, calculated
consumption and a practical either observed de-factor consumption or an "aimed at" consumption.
Practical consumption
However, as
Consumption factor
100
z%
100
VS% x 10
DFT
and
theoretical spreading rate
where it is very important to use the "loss"for z and not the consumption factor.
Page 2 of 5
CONVERSION TABLES
Page 3D/5
A = ((2 x d) + B) x Lpp x P
where
d = draught maximum
B = breadth extreme
Lpp = length betw. perpendiculars
P = 0.90 for big tankers, 0.85 for bulk carriers, 0.70-0.75 for dry cargo
liners
or
V
A = Lpp x (Bm + 2 x D) x Bm x Lpp x D
where
Boottop:
A = 2 x h x (Lpp + 0.5 x B)
where
Topsides:
h = width of boottop
Lpp = length betw. perpendiculars
B = breadth extreme
A = 2 x H x (Loa + 0.5 x B)
where
where
Page 3 of 5
CONVERSION TABLES
Page 4D/5
Plate thickness
mm
sq.m/
ton
Plate thickness
mm
sq.m/
ton
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
254.5
127.2
84.8
63.6
50.9
42.4
36.4
31.8
28.3
25.4
23.1
21.2
19.6
18.2
17.0
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
15.9
15.0
14.1
13.4
12.7
12.1
11.6
11.1
10.6
10.2
9.8
9.4
9.1
8.8
8.5
The indicated values are for both sides. If one side only, reduce by half.
Pipes:
pi x iD
pi = 3.14
iD = interior diameter in metres
Page 4 of 5
CONVERSION TABLES
Page 5D/5
Size
Weight
kg/m
Surface area
sq.m/m
sq.m/ton
HEB
100
160
220
280
360
600
20.4
42.6
71.5
103.0
142.0
212.0
0.57
0.92
1.27
1.62
1.85
2.32
27.8
21.5
17.8
15.7
13.0
10.9
INP
80
140
200
260
340
400
5.94
14.3
26.2
41.9
68.0
92.4
0.30
0.50
0.71
0.91
1.15
1.33
51.2
35.1
27.1
21.6
16.9
14.4
RHS
20x20
30x30
40x40
60x60
80x80
1.1
1.8
2.4
3.6
7.3
0.08
0.12
0.16
0.24
0.32
70.8
68.6
67.2
66.0
44.1
UNP
30
50
80
180
280
400
4.3
5.6
8.6
22.0
41.8
71.8
0.17
0.23
0.31
0.61
0.89
1.18
40.7
41.5
36.1
27.8
21.3
16.4
20x3
25x4
30x4
40x4
50x6
50x9
75x7
75x10
100x10
100x16
150x15
0.88
1.5
1.8
2.4
4.5
6.5
7.9
11.1
15.1
23.2
33.8
0.08
0.10
0.12
0.16
0.19
0.19
0.29
0.29
0.39
0.39
0.59
87.5
66.9
65.2
64.1
43.4
30.0
36.7
26.2
25.8
16.8
17.3
In the case of the HEB beam, the first illustration, height and breadth are equal up to the size of 280. The "size" is the
height and equal to the profile number.
In the case of the INP beam, the "size" is the height and equal to the profile number.
In the case of the UNP beam, the "size" is the height and equal to the profile number.
In the case of the v-profile, the two flanges are reckoned equal, the second digit being the thickness of the steel.
Page 5 of 5
Product Data
1/2
Recommended use:
On new wood as well as over previously varnished wood, interior and exterior, above
the waterline.
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Dry to touch:
V.O.C.:
Transparent /00000
Glossy
46 1
18.4 m/litre - 25 micron
738 sq.ft./US gallon - 1 mil
38C/100F
0.9 kg/litre - 7.5 lbs/US gallon
2-3 hours at 20C/68F
430 g/litre - 3.6 lbs/US gallon
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Application method:
Best results will be obtained with a flat varnish brush. Spray application is possible
with most types of spray equipment after thinning, but this application method is
mainly subject to specific local conditions, so no general guidelines can be given.
Cleaning of tools:
THINNER 08230
25 micron/1.0 mil
50 micron/2 mils
6 hours (20C/68F)
See REMARKS overleaf
Safety:
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
2/2
New wood: Saturate the dry surface with a commercial antimould fluid, preferably made from
fungicide dissolved in white spirit. Apply one coat HEMPELS MARINE VARNISH 02220 thinned
with 20% THINNER 08230. Apply a second coat HEMPEL'S MARINE VARNISH 02220 thinned
5-10%. Finally apply 3-5 coats HEMPEL'S MARINE VARNISH 02220 undiluted.
For the best result rub with dry or wet fine sandpaper and dust off between coats for a smooth
finish.
Previously varnished wood: Wash surface with suitable cleaning agent. Do not use detergents
unless they are removed completely, as otherwise residues can spoil the drying properties and
give adhesion problems. Proceed as for new wood. In some cases the antimould treatment and
the first thinned coats can be omitted.
Note: Ammonia water may discolour oak, mahogany and teak.
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
The surface must be completely clean and dry. Do not apply under humid conditions or at
temperatures below 5C/41F. The moisture content in the wood should not exceed 16%.
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
None.
REMARKS:
Recoating:
20C/68F
Recoated with
(Quality nos only)
Atmospheric
02220
Mild
Medium
None
2 days
If the maximum recoating interval is exceeded, rub down the surface to ensure adhesion.
Note:
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPADUR SEALER 05990
BASE 05999 with CURING AGENT 95040
Description:
HEMPADUR SEALER 05990 is a low viscosity, two pack epoxy varnish with good
penetration properties.
Recommended use:
For saturation of well cleaned concrete surfaces before application of pigmented paints.
Must be applied in such an amount that the surface is just saturated. The surface
should not appear glossy in any way.
Service temperatures:
Certificates/Approvals:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Dry to touch:
Fully cured:
V.O.C.:
Transparent/00000
Flat
29 1
Not relevant (See REMARKS overleaf)
25C/77F
0.9 kg/litre - 7.5 lbs/US gallon
3-4 hours at 20C/68F
7 days at 20C/68F
615 g/litre - 5.1 lbs/US gallon
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Mixing ratio for 05990:
Application method:
Thinner (max.vol.):
Pot life:
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
All possible slip agent, oil, grease and other contaminants must be removed by eg volatilizing by
flame cleaning or treatment with suitable detergent. Last mentioned in the following way:
Saturation of the surface with fresh water. Washing with detergent followed by fresh water hosing.
Depending on construction and purpose, abrasive blast, high pressure water jet or treat the
concrete with power tools to obtain a rough and firm surface free of scum layer and other
contamination. Remove dust and loose material. If mechanical treatment is impossible, the
surface may be treated with acid etching. For this purpose an approx. 5% w/w nitric or phosphoric
acid solution is recommended. Note: Strong acids, take necessary precautions, make sure that
safety regulations are obeyed! Prior to etching the concrete should be saturated with fresh water to
prevent acid corrosion of the reinforcement bars. Leave the acid to act for 3-4 minutes and hose
down the surface with fresh water - preferably first a 5% w/w sodium hydroxide solution - and scrub
carefully. After that the surface must dry homogeneously and appear as an even, rough surface
free of a loose outer layer. The surface must have a pH reaction of between 6.5 - 8.0. If any of
these conditions are not fulfilled, the process must be repeated. The surface must be dried with
good ventilation for at least 2 days (65% relative humidity and 20C/68F). The pretreatment is
controlled by scraping with a strong knife. The surface shall feel solid and hard, and the knife must
only leave a clear scratch mark.
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
The concrete must be fully cured, eg 28 days for normal Portland cement, and completely dry
with a humidity content in the surface below 4%. The concrete must also be controlled for absence
of capillary water action or for subsoil water.
Use only where application and curing can proceed at temperatures above 10C/50F. Apply only
on a dry surface, free of dust, grease, oil and other contamination - as described above.
Strongly absorbing surfaces may need repeated treatment. In any case a glossy surface must not
appear and such a surplus of HEMPADUR SEALER 05990 must be removed by sanding, abrasive
sweep-blasting or similar methods before painting takes place.
In confined spaces provide adequate ventilation during application and drying.
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
According to specification.
REMARKS:
VOC - EU directive
2004/42/EC:
VOC:
Film thicknesses/
consumption:
Appearance:
As supplied
5 vol. % thinning
Limit phase I, 2007
VOC in g/l
615
625
750
For VOC of other shades, please refer to Safety Data Sheet.
HEMPADUR SEALER 05990 is used for saturation of the absorbent concrete surface. Application
should be initiated by assessing the degree of dilution in order to obtain a correct result. The
actual amount of thinner required will depend on temperatures, the surface and type of the
concrete and the actual application technique.
Furthermore, a practical theoretical spreading rate cannot be calculated. For practical purposes,
approx. 10 m/litre (410 sq.ft./US gallon) is indicated depending on the surface roughness,
porosity of the concrete, and the application method.
In any case a glossy surface must not appear and such a surplus of HEMPADUR SEALER 05990
must be removed by sanding, abrasive sweep-blasting or similar methods before painting takes
place.
Note:
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPEL'S HI-VEE LACQUER 06520
Description:
Recommended use:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos.:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Dry to touch:
V.O.C.:
Transparent/00000
Glossy
27 1
10.8 m/litre - 25 micron
433 sq.ft./US gallon - 1 mil
32C/90F
0.9 kg/litre - 7.7 lbs/US gallon
1-2 hours at 20C/68F
585 g/litre - 4.9 lbs/US gallon
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Application method:
Best results are obtained with a flat varnish brush. Spray application is possible with
most types of spray equipment after thinning with THINNER 08230, but this application
method is mainly subject to specific local conditions, so no general guidelines can be
given.
Cleaning of tools:
THINNER 08230
25 micron/1 mil
100 micron/4 mils
3 hours (20C/68F)
none (See REMARKS overleaf
Safety:
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
PRECEDING
COAT:
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
None.
REMARKS:
Note:
No maximum recoating interval, but after prolonged exposure to polluted atmosphere, remove
accumulated contamination by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning and allow to dry.
HEMPEL'S HI-VEE LACQUER 06520 is for professional use only.
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
1/2
HEMPELS
THINNER NO.
FLASH POINT
08080
25C/77F
EXAMPLES OF
GENERAL USE
HEMPELS ANTIFOULINGS
GLOBIC, OCEANIC and OLYMPIC
HEMPALIN DECKPAINT 53240.
HEMPAQUICK qualities
All-purpose thinner for HEMPATEX qualities.
HEMPATHANE topcoats and enamels.
08230
32C/90F
08450
23C/73F
08510
3C/37F
HIGHLY
FLAMMABLE
08570
4C/39F
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
2/2
REMARKS:
HEMPELS
THINNER NO.
FLASH POINT
08700
24C/75F
EXAMPLES OF
GENERAL USE
HEMPELS GALVOSILs
For HEMPADURs used as non-popping sealers
on GALVOSILs.
THINNER 08230 has a stronger thinning effect than white spirit or turpentine.
Tools can usually be cleaned with the THINNER prescribed for the product.
Note:
For cleaning of tools which have been used for HEMPADUR products, HEMPELS TOOL CLEANER
99610 is recommended. Do not use it for thinning, nor for cleaning after use of polyurethane
products, HEMPATHANEs.
HEMPEL'S THINNERS are for professional use only.
Safety:
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and paint
containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or national safety
regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do not swallow. Take
precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as protection of the environment.
Apply only in well ventilated areas.
ISSUED BY:
HEMPEL A/S
0808000000CO004
0823000000CO005
0845000000CO009
0851000000CO002
0857000000CO007
0870000000CO006
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPINOL 10220
Description:
Recommended use:
Availability:
Certificates/Approvals:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Surface dry:
Dry to touch:
V.O.C.:
Black /19990
Flat
53 1
3.0 m/liter - 175 micron
121 sq.ft./US gallon - 7 mils
38C/100F
1.1 kg/litre - 9.2 lbs/US gallon
10 (approx.) hours at 20C/68F (ISO 1517)
16 (approx.) hours at 20C/68F
375 g/litre - 3.1 lbs/US gallon
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Application method:
Thinner (max.vol.):
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Airless spray
Air spray
Brush
08080 (2%)
08080 (15%)
08080 (5%)
.021"-.025"
200 bar/2900 psi
(Airless spray data are indicative and subject to adjustment)
THINNER 08080
175 micron/7 mils (See REMARKS overleaf)
325 micron/13 mils
When dry
None
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
HEMPINOL 10220
SURFACE
PREPARATION:
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
PRECEDING
COAT:
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
None.
REMARKS:
May be specified in another film thickness than indicated depending on purpose and area of use.
This will alter spreading rate and may influence the amount of thinning necessary, drying time and
recoating interval. Normal range is 125-200 micron/5-8 mils.
Note:
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPELS BALLAST COAT SH 10880
Description:
Recommended use:
For short to medium-term repair and maintenance of ballast tanks, cofferdams and void
spaces under conditions where abrasive blast cleaning is not feasible. Resistant to
cathodic protection by sacrificial anodes. Resistant to foot traffic during survey of tanks,
but not to continuous mechanical stress.
Availability:
Certificates/Approvals:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Surface dry:
Dry to touch:
V.O.C.:
Alu-bronze/19820 - black/19990
Flat
52 1
3.0 m/liter - 175 micron
119 sq.ft./US gallon - 7 mils
38C/100F
1.1 kg/litre - 9.2 lbs/US gallon
10 (approx.) hours at 20C/68F (ISO 1517)
16 (approx.) hours at 20C/68F
375 g/litre - 3.1 lbs/US gallon
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Application method:
Thinner (max.vol.):
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Airless spray
Air spray
Brush
08080 (2%)
08080 (15%)
08080 (5%)
.021"-.025"
200 bar/2900 psi
(Airless spray data are indicative and subject to adjustment)
THINNER 08080
175 micron/7 mils (See REMARKS overleaf)
325 micron/13 mils
When dry
None
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
Maintenance: Remove all oil and grease, mud and similar contaminants with suitable detergent
followed by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning. Remove rust scale and loose coating material by
abrasive blasting, power tool cleaning or water jetting to minimum Sa 1, St 2 (ISO 8501:2007) or
Wa 1 (ISO 8501-4:2006). Existing epoxy or coal tar epoxy system to be uniformly matted by
grinding, abrasive sweep blasting or water jetting. Dust off residues. Allow the surface to dry. The
durability of the system depends on the achieved degree of surface preparation. Insufficient
removal of scale will result in later flaking.
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
PRECEDING
COAT:
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
None.
REMARKS:
Note:
May be specified in another film thickness than indicated depending on purpose and area of use.
This will alter spreading rate and may influence the amount of thinning necessary, drying time and
recoating interval. Normal range is 125-200 micron/5-8 mils per coat in a two-coat system.
Application of HEMPEL'S BALLAST COAT SH 10880 as a one-coat system is possible,
recommended dry film thickness is 300 micron. The durability of a one-coat system is very much
influenced by the application method.
Ballast tanks may be filled when all painted surfaces are completely dry. It is recommended to
ascertain the drying condition by a thorough inspection before filling.
Regular maintenance of the coating is carried out touching up with HEMPEL'S BALLAST COAT SH
10880 to full film thickness after having prepared the surface as described above.
HEMPELS BALLAST COAT SH 10880 is for professional use only.
ISSUED BY:
Curing before
filling of tanks:
Maintenance:
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPALIN PRIMER 12050
Description:
Recommended use:
General purpose primer for HEMPALIN systems for protection of steel in mild to medium
atmospheric corrosive environments.
Service temperatures:
Certificates/Approvals:
Approved as a low flame spread material by Danish, French, Spanish and Singaporean
authorities according to IMO resolution MSC 61 (67).
Has a Danish, French, Spanish, Singaporean, Malaysian and Indonesian EC-type
Examination Certificate.
Complies with EU Directive 2004/42/EC, subcategory i.
Please see REMARKS overleaf.
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos.:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Dry to touch:
V.O.C.:
Green/40760 - Red/50410
Flat
49 1
12.3 m/litre - 40 micron
491 sq.ft./US gallon - 1.6 mils
38C/100F
1.3 kg/litre - 10.8 lbs/US gallon
2-4 hours at 20C/68F
415 g/litre - 3.5 lbs/US gallon
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Application method:
Thinner (max.vol.):
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
REMARKS:
VOC - EU directive
2004/42/EC:
VOC:
As supplied
5 vol. % thinning
Limit phase I, 2007
VOC in g/l
415
430
600
For VOC of other shades, please refer to Safety Data Sheet.
Some of the certificates are issued under the former quality number 1205.
Film thicknesses:
Recoating:
May be specified in another film thickness than indicated depending on purpose and area of use.
This will alter spreading rate and may influence drying time and recoating interval. Normal range
dry is 30-50 micron/1.2-2 mils.
Recoating intervals related to later conditions of exposure:
(40 micron/1.6 mils dry film thickness of HEMPALIN PRIMER 12050)
Minimum
Maximum
Steel temperature
20C/68F
20C/68F
Recoated with
(Quality Numbers only)
Atmospheric
Atmospheric
Mild
Medium
Mild
Medium
5 hrs
2 days
8 hrs
2 days
none
none
3 days
7 days
If the maximum recoating interval is exceeded, roughening of the surface is necessary to ensure
intercoat adhesion. Before recoating after exposure in contaminated environment, clean surface
thoroughly with (high pressure) fresh water hosing and allow to dry.
Note:
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPELS UNI-PRIMER 13140
Description:
Recommended use:
As a versatile primer on steel and metal surfaces for HEMPALIN or HEMPATEX in mild
to medium corrosive atmospheric environment. It provides the possibility of reducing
the number of primers for maintenance.
Service temperature:
Certificates/Approvals:
Approved as a low flame spread material by the French and Spanish authorities
according to IMO resolution MSC 61 (67).
Has a French and Spanish EC-type Examination Certificate.
Complies with EU Directive 2004/42/EC, subcategory i (see REMARKS overleaf).
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Surface dry:
Dry to touch:
V.O.C.:
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Application method:
Thinner (max.vol.):
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Airless spray
Air spray
Brush/Roller
08080 (5%)
08080 (10%)
08080 (10%)
.019"-.023"
150 bar/2200 psi
(Airless spray data are indicative and subject to adjustment)
HEMPELS THINNER 08080
50 micron/2 mils (See REMARKS overleaf)
125 micron/5 mils
See REMARKS overleaf
See REMARKS overleaf
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
Apply only on a dry and clean surface with a temperature above the dew point to avoid
condensation.
In confined spaces provide adequate ventilation during application and drying.
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
REMARKS:
VOC - EU directive
2004/42/EC:
VOC:
As supplied
10 vol. % thinning Limit phase I, 2007
VOC in g/l
520
555
600
For VOC of other shades, please refer to Safety Data Sheet.
Substrate:
Film thicknesses:
Recoating:
Smooth metal surfaces and zinc-coated steel are only relevant as substrate in case of later mild
exposure conditions.
May be specified in another film thickness than indicated depending on purpose and area of use.
This will alter spreading rate and may influence amount of thinning necessary, drying time, and
recoating interval. Normal range is 25-80 micron/1-3.2 mils.
Recoating intervals related to later conditions of exposure:
(50 micron/2 mils dry film thickness of HEMPELS UNI-PRIMER 13140)
Steel temperature
Recoated with
1)
HEMPALIN
HEMPATEX, HEMPALIN2)
Minimum
20C/68F
Atmospheric
Mild
Medium
1 hour
2 hours
4 hours
6 hours
Maximum
20C/68F
Atmospheric
Mild
Medium
None
3 days
None
None
1)
2)
Recoating with
epoxy and P.U.:
If the maximum recoating interval is exceeded, roughening of the surface is necessary to ensure
intercoat adhesion.
Recoating with HEMPADUR and HEMPATHANE is possible, but should be done with as thin layers
as possible to minimize the risk of lifting. Furthermore, in this case - used as a bridge coating - it
is recommended to apply HEMPELS UNI-PRIMER 13140 in 25 micron/1 mil dry film thickness
only. Make a test patch to secure full compatibility between the old paint system and the new
paint system.
Minimum recoating interval (20C/68F) is 48 hours, maximum none.
Notes:
Before recoating after exposure in contaminated environment, clean surface thoroughly with high
pressure fresh water hosing and allow drying.
HEMPELS UNI-PRIMER 13140 is for professional use only.
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPALIN PRIMER HI-BUILD 13200
Description:
Recommended use:
General purpose primer for HEMPALIN systems for protection of steel in mild to medium
atmospheric corrosive environments.
Service temperatures:
Certificates/Approvals:
Approved as a low flame spread material by Danish, French, Spanish and Singaporean
authorities according to IMO resolution MSC 61 (67).
Has a Danish, French, Spanish, Singaporean, Malaysian and Indonesian EC-type
Examination Certificate.
Complies with EU Directive 2004/42/EC, subcategory i.
Please see REMARKS overleaf.
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos.:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Surface dry:
Dry to touch:
V.O.C.:
White/10000 - Yellow/22430
Flat
47 1
6.3 m/litre - 75 micron
251 sq.ft./US gallon - 3.0 mils
38C/100F
1.3 kg/litre - 10.8 lbs/US gallon
1 (approx.) hr at 20C/68F (ISO 1517)
4 (approx.) hours at 20C/68F
410 g/litre - 3.4 lbs/US gallon
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Application method:
Thinner (max.vol.):
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max.:
Safety:
Airless spray
Brush (touch up)
08080 (5%)
08080 (5%)
.021"-.023"
200 bar/2900 psi
(Airless spray data are indicative and subject to adjustment)
THINNER 08080
75 micron/3 mils
175 micron/7 mils
See REMARKS overleaf
See REMARKS overleaf
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
REMARKS:
VOC - EU directive
2004/42/EC:
VOC:
Film thicknesses:
Recoating:
As supplied
5 vol. % thinning
Limit phase I, 2007
VOC in g/l
410
435
600
For VOC of other shades, please refer to Safety Data Sheet.
Some of the certificates have been issued under the former quality number 1320.
May be specified in another film thickness than indicated depending on purpose and area of use.
This will alter spreading rate and may influence drying time and recoating interval. Normal range
dry is 50-75 micron/2-3 mils.
Recoating intervals related to later conditions of exposure:
(75 micron/3 mils dry film thickness of HEMPALIN PRIMER HI-BUILD 13200)
Surface temperature
Recoated with
HEMPALIN, except 53240 and 13200
13200
53240
Minimum
Maximum
20C/68F
20C/68F
Atmospheric
Atmospheric
Mild
Medium
Mild
Medium
5 hours
5 hours
5 days
8 hours
8 hours
5 days
None
None
None
3 days
None
10 days
Note:
If the maximum recoating interval is exceeded, roughening of the surface is necessary to ensure
intercoat adhesion.
Before recoating after exposure in contaminated environment, clean the surface thoroughly with
(high pressure) fresh water and allow drying.
HEMPALIN PRIMER HI-BUILD 13200 is for professional use only.
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPAQUICK PRIMER 13624
Description:
Recommended use:
As a rust preventing primer on steel, machinery parts, etc. where quick drying is
needed, both as a workshop primer for temporary protection and as a general purpose
primer in fast drying alkyd-based systems for protection of steel in mild to medium
atmospheric corrosive environments.
Service temperatures:
Certificates/Approvals:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade Nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Surface dry:
Dry to touch:
V.O.C.:
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Application method:
Thinner (max.vol.):
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Airless spray
Air spray
Brush
08080 (10%)
08080 (15%)
08080 (5%)
.017"-.021"
150 bar/2175 psi
(Airless spray is indicative and subject to adjustment)
THINNER 08080
80 micron/3.2 mils
175 micron/7 mils
See REMARKS overleaf
See REMARKS overleaf
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
New Steel: Remove oil and grease etc. with suitable detergent. Remove salt and other
contaminants by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning. Abrasive blasting to minimum Sa 2,
alternatively power tool cleaning to St 3 depending on the corrosion impact.
On machinery: May be applied directly on steel and iron after degreasing and mechanical cleaning.
Repair of damaged areas: Remove oil and grease etc. with suitable detergent. Remove salt and
other contaminants by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning. Remove all rust and loose material by
abrasive blasting or power tool cleaning followed by fresh water cleaning. Touch up to full film
thickness.
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
Apply only on a dry and clean surface with a temperature above the dew point to avoid
condensation.
In confined spaces provide adequate ventilation during application and drying.
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
REMARKS:
VOC - EU directive
2004/42/EC:
VOC:
As supplied
15 vol. % thinning Limit phase I, 2007
VOC in g/l
480
535
600
For VOC of other shades, please refer to Safety Data Sheet.
Film thicknesses:
May be specified in another film thickness than indicated depending on purpose and area of use.
This will alter the spreading rate and may influence the amount of thinning necessary, drying time
and recoating interval. Normal range is 40-80 micron/1.6-3.2 mils.
Recoating intervals related to later conditions of exposure:
(80 micron/3.2 mils dry film thickness of HEMPAQUICK PRIMER 13624)
Recoating:
Minimum
Surface temperature
Maximum
20C/68F
20C/68F
Atmospheric
Atmospheric
Recoated with
Mild
Medium
Mild
Medium
HEMPALIN*
15 minutes
30 minutes
None
None
Notes:
Before recoating after exposure to contaminated environment, the surface should be thoroughly
cleaned by high pressure fresh water hosing and allow to dry.
HEMPAQUICK PRIMER 13624 is for professional use only.
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPELS SHOPPRIMER E 15280
BASE 15289 with CURING AGENT 95270
Description:
Recommended use:
As a shopprimer for protection of blast cleaned steel plate and other structural steel
during the storage and building period.
Service temperatures:
Certificates/Approvals:
Approved as a welding primer by Lloyds Register of Shipping and Det Norske Veritas.
Tested for non-toxicity of welding fumes by the Danish Welding Institute and
Schweisstechnische Lehr- und Versuchsanstalt, Germany.
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Dry to handle:
Fully cured:
V.O.C.:
Red/50890
Flat
22 1
See REMARKS overleaf
-4C/25F
1.1 kg/litre
9.2 lbs/US gallon
5-10 min. at 20C/68F
7 days at 20C/68F
640 g/litre - 5.3 lbs/US gallon (According to EPA Fed Ref Method 24)
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Mixing ratio for 15280:
Application method:
Thinner (max.vol.):
Pot life:
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
15 micron/0.6 mils
(See REMARKS overleaf)
Not relevant
6 hours (20C/68F)
None (See REMARKS overleaf)
Safety:
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
New steel: Remove oil and grease, etc. with suitable detergent. Remove salt and other
contaminants by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning. Abrasive blasting to cleaning degree
specified for final coating system, usually Sa 2. Apply immediately after cleaning. All damaged
shopprimer and contamination from storage and fabrication should be thoroughly cleaned prior to
recoating. For repair and touch-up use primer specified for final coating system.
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
Use only where application and curing can proceed at temperatures above 10C/50F. The
temperature of the surface and that of the paint itself must also be above this limit. Maximum
steel temperature approximately 45C/113F. For shopprimer application at temperatures above
app. 45C/113F special measures must be taken (See "Thinning" under REMARKS below).
Apply only on a dry and clean surface with a temperature above the dew point to avoid
condensation. In confined spaces provide adequate ventilation during application and drying.
PRECEDING COAT:
Theoretical
spreading rate:
Air Spray:
Air spray is usually performed by having a low pressure (e.q. 10:1) piston pump pumping the
shopprimer under constant re-circulation.
Recoating
interval:
No maximum recoat interval for adhesion, but dictated by gradual breakdown and damage
during exposure and fabrication.
Thinning:
When applied at higher temperatures extra thinning or use of thinner with slower flash-off time may
be needed to secure proper paint film formation. It is a must that a homogenous and smooth paint
film is obtained.
When used as a "sealer", dilute with minimum 10% THINNER 08700 to obtain optimal antipopping
properties.
Notes:
Before recoating after exposure in contaminated environment, clean the surface thoroughly by high
pressure water cleaning and allow drying.
HEMPELS SHOPPRIMER E 15280 is for professional use only.
ISSUED BY:
This
Product Data
Data Sheet
Sheet supersedes
supersedes those
This Product
thosepreviously
previouslyissued.
issued.
For
explanations, definitions
For explanations,
definitionsand
andscope,
scope,see
seeExplanatory
ExplanatoryNotes
Notesininthe
theHEMPEL
HEMPELBook.
Book.
Data,
specifications,
directions
and
recommendations
given
represent
only
test
results
or or
Data, specifications, directions and recommendations givenininthis
thisdata
datasheet
sheet
represent
only
test
results
experience
obtained
under
controlled
or
specially
defined
circumstances.
Their
accuracy,
completeness
or or
experience obtained under controlled or specially defined circumstances. Their accuracy,
completeness
appropriateness
ofof
the
Products
herein
must
bebe
determined
appropriatenessunder
underthe
theactual
actualconditions
conditionsofofany
anyintended
intendeduse
use
the
Products
herein
must
determined
exclusively
the Buyer
Buyer and/or
and/or User.
exclusively by
by the
User.
The
Products are
are supplied
toto
HEMPEL's
OF
The Products
supplied and
and all
alltechnical
technicalassistance
assistanceisisgiven
givensubject
subject
HEMPEL'sGENERAL
GENERALCONDITIONS
CONDITIONS OF
SALES,
DELIVERYAND
ANDSERVICE,
SERVICE,
unless
otherwise
expresslyagreed
agreedininwriting.
writing.The
The
Manufacturerand
andSeller
Seller
SALES, DELIVERY
unless
otherwise
expressly
Manufacturer
disclaim, and
disclaim,
and Buyer
Buyer and/or
and/orUser
Userwaive
waive all
allclaims
claimsinvolving,
involving,any
anyliability,
liability,including
includingbut
butnot
notlimited
limitedtotonegligence,
negligence,
except as
forall
all results,
results, injury
injury or
or direct
direct or
or consequential
consequential losses
except
as expressed
expressed in
in said
saidGENERAL
GENERAL CONDITIONS
CONDITIONS for
lossesor
or
damages
arising
from
the
use
of
the
Products
as
recommended
above,
on
the
overleaf
or
otherwise.
damages arising from the use of the Products as recommended above, on the overleaf or otherwise.
Product data are subject to change without notice and become void five years from the date of issue.
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPADUR PRIMER 15300
BASE 15309 with CURING AGENT 95040
Description:
Recommended use:
Service temperatures:
Maximum:
Certificates/Approvals:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Surface dry:
Dry to touch:
Fully cured:
V.O.C.:
Red/50890 - Grey/12170
Flat
51 1
12.8 m/litre - 40 micron
511 sq.ft./US gallon - 1.6 mils
26C/79F
1.3 kg/litre - 10.8 lbs/US gallon
1 (app.) hour at 20C/68F (ISO 1517)
2-3 hours at 20C/68F
7 days at 20C/68F
445 g/litre - 3.7 lbs/US gallon
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Mixing ratio for 15300:
Application method:
Thinner (max.vol.):
Pot life:
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval:
Safety:
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
New steel: Abrasive blasting to Sa 2. For temporary protection, if required, use a suitable
shopprimer. All damage of shopprimer and contamination from storage and fabrication should be
thoroughly cleaned prior to final painting. For repair and touch-up use HEMPADUR PRIMER.
Other metals and light alloys: Thorough degreasing and removal of any salty contamination.
Abrasive sweeping to create a suitable dense anchor profile.
Repair and maintenance: Remove oil and grease, etc. with suitable detergent. Remove salt
andother contaminants by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning. Clean damaged areas thoroughly
by power tool cleaning to St 3 (minor areas) or by abrasive blasting to min. Sa 2, preferably to Sa
2. Improved surface preparation will improve the performance of HEMPADUR PRIMER 15300.
Feather edges to sound intact areas. Dust off residues. Touch up to full film thickness.
On pit-corroded surfaces, excessive amounts of salt residues may call for high pressure water
jetting, wet abrasive blasting, alternatively dry abrasive blasting, high pressure fresh water hosing,
drying, and finally, dry abrasive blasting again.
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
Use only where application and curing can proceed at temperatures above 10C/50F.
The temperature of the paint itself should be 15C/59F or above to secure proper application
properties. In confined spaces provide adequate ventilation during application and drying.
Apply only on a dry and clean surface with a temperature above the dew point to avoid
condensation.
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
REMARKS:
VOC - EU directive
2004/42/EC:
VOC:
Weathering/
service
temperatures:
Film thicknesses:
Recoating:
As supplied
35 vol. % thinning Limit phase I, 2007
VOC in g/l
445
550
550
For VOC of other shades, please refer to Safety Data Sheet.
Certificate has been issued under the former quality number 1530.
The natural tendency of epoxy coatings to chalk in outdoor exposure and to become more
sensitive to mechanical damage and chemical exposure at elevated temperatures is also
reflected in this product.
May be specified in another film thickness than indicated depending on purpose and area of use.
This will alter spreading rate and will influence the amount of thinning necessary, drying time and
recoating interval. Normal range dry is 25-75 micron/1-3 mils.
Recoating intervals:
Minimum (primarily only relevant for container coatings): 20 minutes flash-off time for 40
micron/1.6 mils HEMPADUR PRIMER 15300 when topcoated with designed container coatings,
epoxy, polyurethane, acrylic or CR types.
The minimum recoating interval only applies in the case of forced ventilation, proper application
and if the completed paint system is thoroughly dry before exposed to aggressive environments.
Maximum: Recoating interval for non-immersion services is 24 hours for acrylic or CRs, 3 days for
PUs and none for epoxies.
In the case of long recoating intervals, a completely clean surface is mandatory to ensure intercoat
adhesion. Any dirt, oil and grease to be removed with eg suitable detergent followed by high
pressure fresh water cleaning. Salts to be removed by fresh water hosing. Any degraded surface
layer, as a result of a long exposure period, must be removed as well. Water jetting may be
relevant to remove any degraded surface layer and may also replace the above-mentioned cleaning
methods when properly executed. Consult HEMPEL for specific advice if in doubt.
To check whether the quality of the surface cleaning is adequate, a test patch may be relevant.
Note:
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPADUR ZINC 15360
BASE 15369 with CURING AGENT 95740
Description:
Recommended use:
For on-line application on containers. Can be used as a zinc-rich epoxy primer for other
purposes according to separate painting specification.
Service temperatures:
Certificates/Approvals:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Surface dry:
Dry to touch:
Fully cured:
V.O.C.:
Red-grey/19830
Semi-flat
50 1
12.5 m/litre - 40 micron
501 sq.ft./US gallon - 1.6 mils
30C/86F
2.3 kg/litre - 19.2 lbs/US gallon
30 minutes at 20C/68F (ISO 1517)
2 (app.) hours at 20C/68F
7 days at 20C/68F
460 g/litre - 3.8 lbs/US gallon
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Mixing ratio for 15360:
Application method:
Thinner (max.vol.):
Pot life:
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
Remove oil and grease, etc. with suitable detergent. Remove salt and other contaminants by
(high pressure) fresh water cleaning.
Abrasive blasting to Sa 2 with a sharp-edged surface profile corresponding to Rugotest No. 3,
BN9a, Keane-Tator Comparator, 2.0 G/S or ISO Comparator, Medium (G).
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
Use only where application and curing can proceed at temperatures above 10C/50F The
temperature of the surface must also be above these limits, respectively.
The temperature of the paint itself should be 15C/59F or above. Apply only on a dry and clean
surface with a temperature above the dew point to avoid condensation.
In confined spaces provide adequate ventilation during application and drying.
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
According to specification.
REMARKS:
VOC - EU directive
2004/42/EC:
VOC:
As supplied
30 vol. % thinning Limit phase I, 2007
VOC in g/l
460
550
550
For VOC of other shades, please refer to Safety Data Sheet.
Note:
ISSUED BY:
Film thicknesses:
Stirring:
Recoating:
Page 2 of 2
Application
Application Instructions
Instructions
For product description refer to product data sheet
Film thickness:
Depending on the area of use the typical dry film thickness may vary between 15
micron/0.6 mil and up to 50 micron/2 mils. This will alter amount of thinning needed,
spreading rate, drying time and recoating interval as described below.
Indicated film thicknesses are as follows:
Shopprimer, Containers:
Primer,
container systems:
When used as a primer in container systems the dry film thickness is approx. 30-40
micron/1.2-1.6 mils corresponding to 60-80 micron/2.4-3.2 mils wet film thickness.
Dilute 5-10% for airless spray.
Spreading rates:
The film thickness and the spreading rate are inversely proportional. By controlling the
spreading rate, a check of the film thickness can be made.
Theoretical spreading rate calculated for undiluted paint:
15 micron/0.6 mil is 33.3 m/litre or 1337 sq.ft./US gallon
30 micron/1.2 mils is 16.7 m/litre or 668 sq.ft./US gallon
50 micron/2 mils is 10.0 m/litre or 401 sq.ft./US gallon
Thinner:
Airless spray: HEMPEL'S THINNER 08450 or 08570. Lowest nozzle pressure should be
used when highest amount of thinner is added. THINNER 08570 is used for fast setting
at application in shops. (Be aware of increased risk of dry spray).
Air spray and application by brush: Usually only HEMPEL'S THINNER 08450.
Stirring:
Before mixing with the curing agent stir the base thoroughly in order to redisperse any
possible settling after storage. After mixing it is equally important to maintain stirring to
keep the wet paint as a homogeneous mixture.
This is specifically important in case of a high level of thinning and/or long break in
application, where the risk of settlement of zinc particles is the highest.
Page 1 of 3
HEMPEL
HEMPEL
Application
Instructions
Application Instructions
Drying time and recoating interval vary with film thickness, drying/curing temperature
and later exposure conditions.
HEMPADUR ZINC 15360 in a dry film thicknesses of 30-40 micron/1.2-1.6 mils:
Surface temperature
Drying time, approx minutes
Curing time, approx days
10C/50F
20C/68F
30C/86F
1 hour
18
30
7
20
4
40 minutes
2 hours
Not relevant
15 minutes
1 hour
Not relevant
7 minutes
30 minutes
Not relevant
5 hours
8 hours
15 hours
2 hours
3 hours
6 hours
1 hour
1 hours
3 hours
40 hours
30 hours
Not relevant
16 hours
12 hours
Not relevant
8 hours
6 hours
Not relevant
10 days
5 days
Not relevant
4 days
2 days
Not relevant
2 days
1 day
Not relevant
None
75 days
75 days
None
30 days
30 days
None
15 days
15 days
25 days
7 days
Not relevant
10 days
3 days
Not relevant
5 days
1 day
Not relevant
The minimum recoating intervals assume sufficient ventilation and correct application.
In case of forced ventilation and/or drying at higher temperatures sufficient "flash-off"
time should be allowed for. For approx.15 micron/1 mil dry film thickness count for
minimum 10 minutes flash-off (at 20C/68F), for approximately 30 micron/1.6 mils
minimum 15 minutes, for approximately 50 micron/3 mils minimum approximately 30
minutes.
The short minimum recoating intervals when recoated with 46330, 46370 and 46410
are only provided in case the finished paint system is through dry before exposure to
the environment.
If the maximum recoating interval is exceeded, whatever the subsequent coat,
roughening of the surface is necessary to ensure optimum intercoat adhesion.
Before recoating after exposure in contaminated environment, irrespective of recoating
interval, clean the surface thoroughly e.g. by (high pressure) fresh water hosing and
allow to dry. It is very important that any possible zinc salts, "white rust", are
removed. Scrubbing with a stiff brush and plenty of water may be required.
Page 2 of 3
Application Instructions
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
ISSUED BY:
Page 3 of 3
Application Instructions
Product Data
HEMPADUR 15400
BASE 15409 with CURING AGENT 95100
Description:
HEMPADUR 15400 is a two-component, amine adduct cured epoxy paint, which cures to
a coating with excellent resistance to a wide range of chemicals as tabulated in
separate CARGO PROTECTION GUIDE.
Recommended use:
As a tank lining.
Service temperatures:
Maximum:
Complies with Section 175.300 of U.S. Federal Regulations in respect of carriage of dry
and wet foodstuffs.
Approved by Lloyd's Register of Shipping as a recognized corrosion control coating.
Tested for non-contamination of grain cargo at the Newcastle Occupational Health,
Great Britain.
Tested for non-toxicity of welding fumes by the Danish Welding Institute.
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Surface dry:
Dry to touch:
Fully cured:
V.O.C.:
Shelf life:
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Mixing ratio for 15400:
Application method:
Thinner (max.vol.):
Pot life:
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
HEMPADUR 15400
SURFACE
PREPARATION:
Abrasive blasting to near white metal Sa 2 with a surface profile corresponding to Rugotest No.
3, BN10, Keane-Tator Comparator, 3.0 G/S, or ISO Comparator, Rough Medium (G). (Please do
also see Notes under REMARKS).
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
Use only where application and curing can proceed at temperatures above 10C/50F.
A special curing agent 95990 may be available for curing between 5C/41F and 10C/50F if
required, see Application Instructions.
The temperature of the surface and that of the paint itself must also be above this limit.
Optimal spraying properties are obtained at paint temperatures of 15-25C/59-76F.
Apply only on a dry and clean surface with a temperature above the dew point to avoid
condensation. Relative humidity max. 80%, preferably 40-60%.
In confined spaces provide adequate ventilation during application and drying.
PRECEDING
COAT:
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
REMARKS:
Film thicknesses:
Recoating:
Curing:
Notes:
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Application
Application Instructions
Instructions
For product description refer to product data sheet
HEMPADUR 15400
15400: BASE 15409 with CURING AGENT 95100
15402: BASE 15409 with CURING AGENT 95990
Scope:
Steel work:
All welding seams must have a surface finish which ensures that the quality of the paint
system will be maintained in all respects. Holes in weldings seams, undercuts, cracks,
etc. should be avoided. If found, they must be remedied by welding and/or grinding.
All weld spatters must be removed.
All sharp edges must be removed or rounded off in such a way that the specified film
thickness can be build-up on all surfaces. The radius of the rounding should be
approximately 1-2 mm.
The steel must be of first class quality and should not have been allowed to rust more
than corresponding to grade B of ISO 8501-1:2007. Any laminations must be removed.
All steel work (including welding, flame cutting, grinding) must be finished before the
surface preparation starts.
Surface preparation:
Prior to abrasive blast cleaning of the steel, remove oil, grease, salts and other
contamination with a suitable detergent followed by (high pressure) fresh water hosing.
Alkali deposits on new welding seams as well as soap traces from pressure testing of
tanks to be removed by fresh water and scrubbing with stiff brushes. Control for
absence of contamination according to separate guidelines.
On repair jobs, a rough blasting to remove all loosely adhering materials may be
required before degreasing/washing is carried out.
Old steel: Even after a very thorough tank cleanings, pits may typically contain
contamination in the form of remnants of old cargoes as well as water soluble salts. For
this reason, repeated detergent washing plus abrasive blasting may be necessary:
After the first blasting, a very thorough vacuum cleaning is carried out in order to see if
any "cargo bleeding" occurs as well as controls for water soluble salts are made.
Reference is made to separate instructions. Special care should be taken in evaluating
pitted areas.
To obtain full chemical resistance according to the CARGO PROTECTION GUIDE, the
steel surface must be abrasive blast cleaned according to ISO 8501-1: 2007, Sa 2.
The resulting surface profile must be equivalent to Rugotest No. 3, min. BN 10, KeaneTator Surface Comparator, G/S min. 3.0 or ISO 8503/1 rough MEDIUM (G).
Use steel grit, aluminium silicate or similar sharp-edged abrasives of a good quality free
of foreign matters, soft particles, and the like. Control for possible contamination
according to separate guidelines.
Steel grit with particle sizes of 0.2 - 1.2 mm or aluminium silicate of 0.4 - 1.8 mm will
usually create the desired surface profile when the air pressure measured at the nozzle
is 6 - 7 bar/85 -100 psi.
Page 1 of 6
HEMPEL
HEMPEL
Application
Instructions
Application Instructions
HEMPADUR 15400
The compressed air must be dry and clean. The compressor must be fitted with suitable
oil and water traps.
When the abrasive blasting is completed, remove residual grit and dust by vacuum
cleaning. Abrasive particles not removed by vacuum cleaning are to be removed by
brushing with clean brushes followed by vacuum cleaning.
The importance of systematic working must be stressed when blasting. Poorly blasted
areas covered with dust are very difficult to locate during the blast inspection made
after the rough cleaning.
Shopprimed and previously painted surfaces: Existing coating materials to be
completely removed. Depending on the type of shopprimer and the requested chemical
resistance, the shopprimer should be removed completely or partly. Reference is made
to HEMPEL's CARGO PROTECTION GUIDE/tank coating specification.
Note: Degree of steelwork finish and surface preparation are more detailed described
in HEMPELs Technical Standard for Tank Coating Work.
Application equipment:
Min. 45:1
.018-.021"
200 bar (2900 psi)
To avoid excessive loss of pressure in long hoses, hoses with an
internal diameter of up to 0.5" can be used
(Spray data are indicative and subject to adjustment).
Thinning:
If required: max. 10% of THINNER 08450, possibly higher if tendency to dust-spray will
require more thinning eg at higher temperatures. Thinning should only be at the required
level to avoid possible risk of solvent entrapment.
Only add thinner to the mixed paint.
Cleaning of equipment:
The whole equipment to be cleaned thoroughly with HEMPELS TOOL CLEANER 99610
after use.
a. Mix the entire content of corresponding base and curing agent packings. If it is
necessary to mix smaller portions, this must be done properly by either weighing
base and curing agent in the prescribed weight ratio: 87 parts by weight of base
and 13 parts by weight of curing agent or by volume: 4.0 parts by volume base and
1.0 parts by volume curing agent.
b. Stir the mixed paint thoroughly by means of a clean mechanical mixer until a
homogeneous mixture is obtained.
c. Allow the mixed paint to pre-react before application, see table below.
d. Use all mixed paint before the pot life is exceeded. The pot life depends on the
temperature of the paint as shown in table below (valid for a 20 litres can):
CURING AGENT 95100:
Temperature of mixed paint
(10C/50F1)
15C/59F1)
20C/68F
25C/77F
30C/86F2)
(30)
(4)
6
25
3
5
15
2
4
10
1
3
5
1
2
1) At paint temperatures below 15C/59F the viscosity can be too high for airless spray application.
2) Temperatures at 30C/86F and above should be avoided due to an enhanced risk of dry-spray and poor film
formation.
Page 2 of 6
Application Instructions
HEMPADUR 15400
CURING AGENT 95990:
Temperature of mixed paint
(5C/41F1)
(10C/50F1)
15C/59F1)
25
(30)
(35)
Induction time, minutes
1
(2)
(3)
Pot life, hours, airless
4
4
4
spray
Pot life, hours, brush
1) At paint temperatures below 15C/59F the viscosity can be too high for airless spray application.
Application procedure:
The first full coat is usually applied immediately after vacuum cleaning. The first stripe
coat afterwards. The final dry film thickness of the three coat system must be between
240-500 micron.
The wet film thickness must be 175-200 micron and must be measured regularly.
Film-build/continuity: With this tank coating, it is of special importance that a
continuous, pinhole-free paint film is obtained at application of each coat. An application
technique must be adopted to ensure good film formation on all surfaces and no dust
spray. It is very important to use nozzles of the correct size, ie not too big. Select small
nozzles for spray application of complicated structures, while bigger nozzles may be
used for regular surfaces. A proper, uniform distance of the spray gun to the surface,
30-50 cm, should be aimed at. To obtain good and steady atomising, the viscosity of
the paint must be suitable and the spray equipment must be sufficient in output
pressure and capacity. At high working temperatures, use of extra thinner may be
necessary to avoid dust-spray.
The paint layer must be applied homogeneously and as close to the specification as
possible. The consumption of paint must be controlled and heavy layers must be
avoided because of the risk of sags and cracks and solvent retention.
Furthermore, great care must be taken to cover edges, openings, rear sides of
stiffeners etc. Thus, on these areas a stripe coat will usually be necessary.
The finished coating must appear as a homogeneous film with a smooth surface and
irregularities such as dust, dry spray, abrasives, must be remedied.
Note: In the case of old, pit-corroded steel, application of a diluted, extra first coat is
recommended to obtain better "penetration" in the fine pits. For this purpose, it is
relevant to dilute approximately 10%. Application by brush is recommended and film
thickness so low that the surface is "saturated" only.
Stripe coating:
All places difficult to cover properly by spray application should be stripe coated twice by
brushing. The first stripe coat is applied either before or after the first full coat. The
second stripe coat is most typically applied after the second full coat. Which procedure
to follow depends on the actual working conditions. A sprayed coat using small spray
nozzles with a narrow angle may substitute the second brush-applied stripe coat,
however, lightening holes and similar, plus possible undercuts and similar will still
demand brush- applied stripe coating.
Micro climate:
Page 3 of 6
Application Instructions
HEMPADUR 15400
Drying and curing,
ventilation:
Curing time:
Curing time
18 days
11 days
7 days
5 days
4 days
(3 days)
*Avoid application at elevated temperatures to avoid dry-spray and poor film formation.
Curing time
Recoating intervals:
25 days
18 days
11 days
Provided observance of the above stated ventilation and relative humidity the following
recoating intervals in relation to the (steel) temperature are valid:
CURING AGENT 95100:
Steel temperature
10C/50F
15C/59F
20C/68F
25C/77F
30C/86F
35C/95F
Minimum
Maximum
30 hours
28 days
14 hours
25 days
10 hours
21 days
7 hours
18 days
5 hours
14 days
4 hours
10 days
Steel temperature
5C/41F
10C/50F
15C/59F
Minimum
Maximum
45 hours
35 days
30 hours
28 days
14 hours
25 days
Page 4 of 6
Application Instructions
HEMPADUR 15400
The maximum relative humidity before and between the coats should not exceed 80%
and the steel temperature should always be above the dew point, in practice minimum
3C/5F above the dew point.
The maximum intervals assume that the film formation is of good quality and without dry
spray and that no kind of surface contamination exists except contamination which can
be removed completely by vacuum cleaning. Furthermore, the coating must not have
been exposed to direct sunlight for more than maximum 2 days.
Conditions for
paint application work:
Dry spray is not acceptable as this will reduce the protective characteristics of the
paint and make later tank cleaning difficult. Dry spray can be avoided by using adequate
staging, spraying equipment and methods.
Hold the spray gun at a right angle to and about 30-50 cm/1-1 foot from the surface
making even parallel passes at a rate to produce the specified wet film thickness as per
specification.
Avoid dry spray (overspray creating excessive paint mist), e.g. by using a smaller fan
angle, and the lowest possible pressure. A small fan angle should also be used, if spray
application is used, for "stripe coating" of for instance reverse sides of stiffeners.
Each layer must be applied homogeneously and as near above the specification of 80
micron dry film thickness as possible. The consumption of paint must be controlled, and
heavy layers must be avoided because of the risk of sagging, cracks and solvent
retention.
Surface irregularities such as dry spray, sagging, exaggerated thickness or embedded
dust or abrasives will have to be remedied.
If sandpapering between layers, for instance on the bottom, is needed, great care must
be taken to avoid damage of otherwise intact surfaces. When using mechanical means
only lightweight equipment should be used, orbital sander is recommended. Yet, avoid
sandpapering on top of welds or irregularities or near to vertical surfaces.
The finished coating must appear as a homogeneous surface without pores, runners or
contamination of any kind.
For the standard specification following applies to the dry film thickness:
The minimum dry film thickness is 240 micron; the maximum thickness to be aimed at
is approximately 500 micron. The minimum dry film thickness is evaluated according to
the "80-20" rule, i.e. no more than 20% of the total number of individual measurements
must be lower than the minimum dry film thickness, and the lowest individual
measurement must be at least 80% of the minimum dry film thickness, ie 192 micron.
Dry film thickness control is not to be carried out within the first 24 hours after
application of final coat (20C, sufficient ventilation). The measurement must be carried
out using an electromagnetic dry film thickness gauge calibrated with shims placed on a
smooth steel substrate. The maximum dry film thickness can be evaluated according to
the "80-20" rule.
Repairs:
Page 5 of 6
Application Instructions
HEMPADUR 15400
The repair process:
Safety:
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
ISSUED BY:
Page 6 of 6
Application Instructions
Product Data
HEMPADUR 15500
BASE 15509 with CURING AGENT 97580
Description:
Recommended use:
As a tank lining.
Service temperatures:
Certificates/Approvals:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Surface dry:
Dry to touch:
Fully cured:
V.O.C.:
Shelf life:
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Mixing ratio for 15500:
Application method:
Thinner (max.vol.):
Pot life:
Induction time:
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
HEMPADUR 15500
SURFACE
PREPARATION:
For optimum performance to the full range of chemicals in accordance with the main CARGO
PROTECTION GUIDE, abrasive blasting to very near white metal Sa 2-3 with a surface profile
corresponding to Rugotest No. 3, BN10, Keane-Tator Comparator 3.0 G/S, or ISO Comparator
Rough Medium (G).
Consult separate APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS.
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
Use only where application and curing can proceed at temperatures above 10C/50F. The steel
temperature must never drop below this limit until full curing has taken place. The
temperature of the paint itself must be above 15C/59F, best results are obtained at 1723C/62-73F. Relative humidity max. 80%, preferably 40-60%. Apply on a dry and clean surface
with a temperature above the dew point to avoid condensation.
Provide adequate ventilation during application and drying in confined spaces.
Consult separate APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS.
PRECEDING
COAT:
None.
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
REMARKS:
Film thicknesses:
None.
Note:
Some of the certificates have been issued under the former quality number 1550.
Minimum total dry film thickness for the system is 300 micron/12 mils. May be specified in higher
film thickness than indicated depending on purpose and area of use. This will alter spreading rate
and influence drying time. For further information about film thicknesses, see separate
APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS.
Minor differences in shade 11630 may occur.
Roughening of the surface is necessary if the maximum recoating interval is exceeded.
The thoroughly mixed BASE and CURING AGENT must be prereacted before application (15
minutes at 20C/68F), at other temperatures, please see APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS.
Keep thinning at an absolute minimum. Do not dilute the components separately - only the
mixture.
Resistance to the widest range of cargoes is provided by additional heat curing, see APPLICATION
INSTRUCTIONS and CARGO PROTECTION GUIDE.
HEMPADUR 15500 is for professional use only.
ISSUED BY:
Colour:
Recoating:
Mixing:
Thinning:
Curing:
Page 2 of 2
Application
Application Instructions
Instructions
For product description refer to product data sheet
HEMPADUR 15500
CURING AGENT 97580
Scope:
Steel work:
All welding seams must have a surface finish which ensures that the quality of the paint
system will be maintained in all respects. Holes in welding seams, undercuts, cracks,
etc. should be avoided. If found, they must be remedied by welding and/or grinding.
All weld spatters must be removed.
All sharp edges must be removed or rounded off in such a way that the specified film
thickness can be build-up on all surfaces. The radius of the rounding should be
minimum 2 mm.
The steel must be of first class quality and should not have been allowed to rust more
than corresponding to grade B of ISO 8501-1:2007. Any laminations must be removed.
All steel work (including welding, flamecutting, grinding) must be finished before the
surface preparation starts.
Surface preparation:
Prior to abrasive blast cleaning of the steel, remove oil, grease, salts and other
contamination with a suitable detergent followed by high pressure fresh water hosing.
Alkali deposits on new welding seams as well as soap traces from pressure testing of
tanks to be removed by fresh water and scrubbing with stiff brushes.
Control for absence of contamination according to separate guidelines.
On repair jobs, a rough blasting to remove all loosely adhering materials may be
required before degreasing/washing is carried out.
Old steel: Even after a very thorough tank cleanings, pits may typically contain
contamination in the form of remnants of old cargoes as well as water soluble salts. For
this reason, repeated detergent washing plus abrasive blasting may be necessary. After
the first blasting, a very thorough vacuum cleaning is carried out in order to see if any
"cargo bleeding" occurs as well as controls for water soluble salts (reference is made
to separate instructions) are made. Special care should be taken in evaluating pitted
areas - ask for special guidelines.
Grit blast to min Sa 2, ISO 8501-1:2007.
To obtain full chemical resistance according to the CARGO PROTECTION GUIDE, the
steel surface must be abrasive blast cleaned according to ISO 8501-1:2007, very near
to white metal Sa 2-Sa 3. In practice, this requirement is to be understood as white
metal Sa 3 at the moment of abrasive blasting, but allows a slight reduction at the
moment of paint application.
The resulting surface profile must be equivalent to Rugotest No. 3, min. BN 10, KeaneTator Surface Comparator, G/S min. 3.0 or ISO 8503/1 rough MEDIUM (G).
Use steel grit, aluminium silicate, or similar sharp edged abrasives of a good quality
free of foreign matters, soft particles, and the like. Control for possible contamination
according to separate guidelines.
Page 1 of 7
HEMPEL
HEMPEL
Application
Instructions
Application Instructions
HEMPADUR 15500
In case steel grit is used this must furthermore be controlled so that a proper grain size
distribution is maintained.
Steel grit with particle sizes of 0.2 - 1.2 mm or aluminium silicate of 0.4 - 1.8 mm will
usually create the desired surface profile when the air pressure measured at the nozzle
is 6 - 7 bar/85 -100 psi.
The compressed air must be dry and clean. The compressor must be fitted with suitable
oil and water traps.
When the abrasive blasting is completed, remove residual grit and dust by vacuum
cleaning. Abrasive particles not removed by vacuum cleaning are to be removed by
brushing with clean brushes followed by vacuum cleaning.
The importance of systematic working must be stressed when blasting. Poorly blasted
areas covered with dust are very difficult to locate during the blast inspection made
after the rough cleaning.
Shopprimed and previously painted surfaces: All shopprimer or existing coating
materials to be completely removed. Avoid the use of zinc shopprimer whenever
possible.
However, if the steel is shopprimed with zinc, it is very important that all zinc is
removed by abrasive blast cleaning. Separate check procedures will be necessary to
demonstrate the effectiveness of removal. More blast cleaning may be deemed
necessary! Use of a red zinc shopprimer will facilitate the visual check of the blast
cleaning and is considered necessary in order to obtain an acceptable surface
preparation.
Note: Degree of steelwork finish and surface preparation are more detailed described
in HEMPELs Technical Standard for Tank Coating Work.
Application equipment:
Min. 45:1
.018"-.021"
200 bar (2900 psi)
To avoid excessive loss of pressure in long hoses, hoses with an
internal diameter of up to 0.5" can be used
If required: max. 10% of THINNER 08450, Additional thinning may be required at higher
temperatures to counteract dry-spray. However, never use more thinner than required
to avoid possible risk of solvent entrapment. Thinner only to be added to the mixed
paint.
Only add thinner to the mixed paint.
Cleaning of equipment:
The whole equipment to be cleaned thoroughly with HEMPELS TOOL CLEANER 99610
after use.
a.
Mix the entire content of corresponding base and curing agent packings. If it is
necessary to mix smaller portions, this must be done properly by either weighing
base and curing agent in the prescribed weight ratio: 93.8 parts by weight of base
and 6.2 parts by weight of curing agent or by volume: 8.9 parts by volume base
and 1.1 parts by volume curing agent.
b.
Stir the mixed paint thoroughly by means of a clean mechanical mixer until a
homogeneous mixture is obtained.
Page 2 of 7
Application Instructions
HEMPADUR 15500
c.
d.
20C/68F
25C/77F
(30C/86F2))
Induction time
Pot life
15 minutes
3 hours
10 minutes
2 hours
(5 minutes)
(1 hour)
1)
2)
Application procedure:
Allow the mixed paint to pre-react before application, see table below.
Use all mixed paint before the pot life is exceeded. The pot life depends on the
temperature of the paint as shown in table below (valid for a 20 litres can):
(25 minutes)
(4 hours)
At 15C/59F and below, the viscosity can be too high for airless spray application.
Temperatures at 30C/86F and above should be avoided due to a risk of dry-spray.
The first full coat is usually applied immediately after vacuum cleaning.
The first stripe coat afterwards.
Film-build/continuity: With this tank coating intended for aggressive cargoes, it is of
special importance that a continuous, pinhole-free paint film is obtained at application
of each coat. An application technique which will ensure good film formation and no dryspray on all surfaces must be adopted.
It is very important to use nozzles of the correct size, ie not too big. Select small
nozzles for spray application of complicated structures, while bigger nozzles may be
used for regular surfaces.
A proper, uniform distance of the spray gun to the surface, 30-50 cm, should be aimed
at. To obtain good and steady atomizing, the viscosity of the paint must be suitable and
the spray equipment must be sufficient in output pressure and capacity. At high working
temperatures, use of extra thinner may be necessary to avoid dry-spray.
The paint layer must be applied homogenously and as close to the specification as
possible. The consumption of paint must be controlled and heavy layers must be
avoided because of the risk of sags and cracks and solvent retention.
Furthermore, great care must be taken to cover edges, openings, rear sides of
stiffeners etc. Thus, on these areas a stripe coat will usually be necessary.
The finished coating must appear as a homogeneous film with a smooth surface and
irregularities such as dust, dry spray, abrasives, must be remedied.
Note: In the case of old, pit corroded steel, application of a diluted, extra first coat is
recommended to obtain better "penetration" in the fine pits. For this purpose, it is
relevant to dilute 5-10%. Application by brush is recommended and film thickness so
low that the surface is "saturated" only.
Stripe coating:
All places difficult to cover properly by spray application should be stripe coated twice
by brushing immediately before the spray application. Typically, first stripe coat is
applied after the first full coat and the second stripe coat after the second full coat.
The second stripe coat with brush can be replaced with spray application with a small
narrow nozzle, but still air slots and similar and possible undercuts (welds) and the like
will require brush application.
Film thicknesses:
The final dry film thickness of the three coat system must be between 300-600 micron
(max. 450 micron below 15C)/12-24 mils (max. 18 mils below 59F).
Corresponding to 100 micron/4 mils dry film thickness, the wet film thickness must be
150-175 micron/6-7 mils and must be measured regularly.
Normally up to 200 micron/8 mils per coat may be accepted for 100 micron/4 mils
specifications, but at temperatures below 15C/59F, it is important not to exceed a
dry film thickness of 150 micron/6 mils in any area.
Page 3 of 7
Application Instructions
HEMPADUR 15500
Micro climate:
In a dry film thickness of 100 micron/4 mils, with a steel temperature of 20C/68F, a
relative air humidity of maximum 80% and adequate ventilation, HEMPADUR 15500 will
be dry to touch after 4-6 hours. Under these drying conditions, the paint film will accept
light traffic after approximately 16 hours.
Correct film formation depends on an adequate ventilation during drying.
A good guideline for tank coating work is to ventilate to a calculated 10% of LEL during
application and until the coating is dry.
One litre undiluted HEMPADUR 15500 gives off in total 82 litres solvent vapour until it
is completely dry.
The lower explosive limit, LEL, is 1.0%.
To reach a common safety requirement of 10% LEL, the theoretical ventilation
requirement is 82 m per litre paint.
Because solvent vapours are heavier than atmospheric air, effective ventilation requires
forced ventilation with exhaust from the lowest part of the tank.
During the following period until full curing a few air shifts per hour will suffice. Take
actions to avoid "pockets" of stagnant air.
Please contact HEMPEL for further advice.
Actual safety precautions may require stronger ventilation.
Page 4 of 7
Application Instructions
HEMPADUR 15500
Curing time:
14 days
10 days
8 days
7 days
(6 days)
*Avoid application at elevated temperatures to avoid dry-spray and poor film formation.
Post curing:
The chemical resistance of the coating can be extended by post curing, which
preferably should take place within the first year in service.
Post curing is accomplished by carrying a hot cargo of mineral lube oil, vegetable oil or
animal oil at minimum 50C/122F. The curing time is 8 days at 50C/122F and 4
days at 60C/140F.
Post curing of double-hull tankers may also be accomplished by using tank cleaning
machines to spray hot, clean fresh water to achieve a minimum steel temperature of
60C/140F and maximum 80C/176F. The curing time is 16 hours at 60C/140F
and 3 hours at 80C/176F. All adjacent ballast tanks must be empty and all
adjacent cargo tanks must be either empty or carrying a liquid cargo of minimum
40C/104F.
Contact HEMPEL for detailed advice about post curing.
Recoating intervals:
Provided observance of the above stated ventilation and relative humidity the following
recoating intervals in relation to the (steel) temperature are valid:
Steel temperature
Minimum
Maximum:
10C/50F*
15C/59F
20C/68F
25C/77F
30C/86F
90 hours
60 hours
47 days
60 hours
40 hours
34 days
36 hours
24 hours
21 days
24 hours
16 hours
16 days
18 hours
12 hours
14 days
The maximum relative humidity before and between the coats should not exceed 80%
and the steel temperature should always be above the dew point, in practice minimum
3C/5F above the dew point.
Conditions for
paint application work:
Dry spray is not acceptable as this will reduce the protective characteristics of the
paint and make later tank cleaning difficult. Dry spray can be avoided by using adequate
staging, spraying equipment and methods.
Hold spray gun at a right angle to and about 30-50 cm from surface making even
parallel passes at a rate to produce the specified wet film thickness as per
specification.
Avoid dry spray (overspray creating excessive paint mist), e.g. by using a smaller fan
angle, and the lowest possible pressure. A small fan angle should also be used, if
spray application is used, for "stripe coating" of for instance reverse sides of stiffeners.
Each layer must be applied homogeneously and as near above the specification of 100
micron/4 mils dry film thickness, as possible. The consumption of paint must be
controlled, and heavy layers must be avoided because of the risk of sagging, cracks and
solvent retention.
Surface irregularities such as dry spray, sagging, exaggerated thickness or embedded
dust or abrasives will have to be remedied.
If a sandpapering between layers, for instance on the bottom, is needed, great care
must be taken to avoid damage of otherwise intact surfaces. When using mechanical
means only lightweight equipment should be used, orbital sander is recommended. Yet,
avoid sandpapering on top of welds or irregularities or near to vertical surfaces.
The finished coating must appear as a homogeneous surface without pores, runners or
contamination of any kind.
Page 5 of 7
Application Instructions
HEMPADUR 15500
Control of
dry film thicknesses:
For the standard specification the following applies to the dry film thickness:
The minimum dry film thickness is 300 micron/12 mils, the maximum thickness is
approximately 600 micron/24 mils (below 15C/59F: 450 micron/18 mils). The
minimum dry film thickness is evaluated according to the "80-20" rule, ie no more than
20% of the total number of individual measurements must be lower than the minimum
dry film thickness, and the lowest individual measurement must be at least 80% of the
minimum dry film thickness, ie 240 micron/9.6 mils. Dry film thickness control is not to
be carried out within the first 24 hours after application of final coat (20C/68F,
sufficient ventilation). The measurement must be carried out using an electromagnetic
dry film thickness gauge calibrated with shims placed on a smooth steel substrate. The
maximum dry film thickness can also be evaluated according to the "80-20" rule.
Do not use the tank before the coating is properly cured. Reference is made to curing
time on page 5.
Repairs:
Page 6 of 7
Application Instructions
HEMPADUR 15500
Safety:
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
ISSUED BY:
Page 7 of 7
Application Instructions
Product Data
HEMPADUR 15553
BASE 15557 with CURING AGENT 98021
Description:
Recommended use:
Service temperatures:
Certificates/Approvals:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Dry to touch:
Fully cured:
V.O.C.:
Shelf life:
Off-white/11630
Flat
55 1
11.0 m/litre - 50 micron
441 sq.ft./US gallon - 2.0 mils
30C/86F
1.6 kg/litre - 13.4 lbs/US gallon
3 (app) hours at 20C/68F
7 days at 20C/68F
400 g/litre - 3.3 lbs/US gallon. See REMARKS overleaf.
year (25C/77F) from time of production. Depending on storage conditions,
mechanical stirring may be necessary before usage.
If the shelf life is exceeded please contact HEMPEL for further advice.
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Mixing ratio for 15553:
Application method:
Thinner (max.vol.):
Pot life:
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Page 1 of 3
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
HEMPADUR 15553
SURFACE
PREPARATION:
Stainless steel and aluminium surfaces: Remove dirt, oil and grease etc. with suitable detergent.
Remove salt and other contaminants by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning. It is very important
that all contamination and dust are removed.
Roughening of the surface is recommended for optimum adhesion.
Galvanizing: Remove oil and grease, etc. with suitable detergent. Remove salt and other
contaminants by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning. Zinc salts (white rust) must be removed by
high pressure hosing combined with rubbing with a stiff nylon brush if necessary.
It is recommended to recoat spray-metallised surfaces as soon as possible to avoid possible
contamination.
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
Apply only on a dry and clean surface with a temperature above the dew point to avoid
condensation. At the freezing point and below be aware of the risk of ice on the surface, which will
hinder adhesion.
Use only where application and curing can proceed at temperatures above -10C/14F. The
temperature of the surface must also be above this limit.
The temperature of the paint itself should be 15-25C/59-77F.
In confined spaces provide adequate ventilation during application and drying.
As supplied
5 vol. % thinning
Limit phase I, 2007
VOC in g/l
400
425
550
For VOC of other shades, please refer to Safety Data Sheet.
Passivation/
Ammonium chloride or any other passivation agent should not be present on the surface when
surface preparation: coating the galvanized surface.
Water should not be used for cooling down the steel.
Cleaning of steel should not be initiated unless the steel temperature is below 30C/86F.
Application:
As the galvanized zinc layer may be porous it is recommended to apply a mist coat of undiluted
HEMPADUR 15553, allow air to escape, and then apply a full coat of HEMPADUR 15553 a few
minutes later.
Film thicknesses:
May be specified in another film thickness than indicated depending on purpose and area of use.
This will alter spreading rate and may influence drying time and recoating interval. Normal range dry
is 50-80 micron/2.0-3.2 mils.
Recoating:
Recoating intervals related to later conditions of exposure (50 micron/2 mils dry):
Surface temperature
Minimum
Maximum
20C/68F
20C/68F
Atmospheric
Recoated with
Mild
Medium
Atmospheric
Severe
Mild
Medium
Severe
12 hours
24 hours
None
3 hours
30 minutes
30 minutes
HEMPATEX
None*
None*
None
6 hours
3 hours
3 hours
HEMPADUR
3 days
10 days*
None
6 hours
3 hours
3 hours
HEMPATHANE
*Except for mild climatic conditions avoid long-term exposure of galvanized steel coated with a thin layer of paint only as this
may create white rust under the paint.
If the maximum recoating interval is exceeded, whatever the subsequent coat, roughening of the
surface is necessary to ensure optimum intercoat adhesion or in the case of recoating with
coatings other than HEMPADUR, apply a (thin) additional coat of HEMPADUR 15553 within the
above directions for recoating.
A completely clean surface is mandatory to ensure intercoat adhesion, especially in the case of
long recoating intervals. Any dirt, oil and grease have to be removed with eg suitable detergent
followed by high pressure fresh water cleaning. Salts to be removed by fresh water hosing.
Any degraded surface layer, as a result of a long exposure period, must be removed as well.
Water jetting may be relevant to remove any degraded surface layer and may also replace the
above-mentioned cleaning methods when properly executed. Consult HEMPEL for specific advice if
in doubt.
To check whether the quality of the surface cleaning is adequate, a test patch may be relevant.
Page 2 of 3
HEMPADUR 15553
Note:
ISSUED BY:
Page 3 of 3
Product Data
HEMPADUR FAST DRY 15560
BASE 15569 with CURING AGENT 97560
Description:
HEMPADUR FAST DRY 15560 is a two-component, polyamine adduct cured epoxy paint
with a very short drying time. Contains zinc phosphate.
Recommended use:
As a quick drying primer or intermediate coat in HEMPADUR systems for especially fast
recoatable in-shop applications.
Can be used for on-site work too if eg VOC compliance is requested.
Service temperatures:
Certificates/Approvals:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Surface dry:
Dry to touch:
Fully cured:
V.O.C.:
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Mixing ratio for 15560:
Application method:
Thinner (max. vol.):
Pot life:
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Page 1 of 3
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
New steel (dry conditions): Abrasive blasting to Sa 2. For temporary protection, if required, use
suitable shopprimer. All damage of shopprimer and contamination from storage and fabrication
should be thoroughly cleaned prior to final painting. For repair and touch-up use HEMPADUR
15560.
Maintenance: Remove oil and grease, etc. with suitable detergent. Remove salt and other
contaminants by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning. Remove all rust and loose material by wet
or dry abrasive blasting or power tool cleaning. Feather edges to sound and intact areas. After wet
abrasive blasting hose down the surface with fresh water and allow drying. Touch up bare spots to
full film thickness.
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
Use only where application and curing can proceed at temperatures above 0C/32F.
The temperature of the paint itself should be 15C/60F or above to secure proper application
properties.
PRECEDING COAT:
As supplied
15 vol. % thinning Limit phase I, 2007
VOC in g/l
355
420
550
For VOC of other shades, please refer to Safety Data Sheet.
CURING AGENT 97560 will become darker during storage. This will result in a darker and more
yellowish shade than grey 12170. The colour change will have no influence on the performance.
The natural tendency of epoxy coatings to chalk in outdoor exposure and to become more
sensitive to mechanical damage and chemical exposure at elevated temperatures is also
reflected in this product.
May be specified in another film thickness than indicated depending on purpose and area of use.
This will alter spreading rate and may influence drying time and recoating interval. Normal range is
75-150 micron/3-6 mils.
Special care should be taken in relation to irregular surfaces (welding seams, undercuts etc.) as
application with an excessive film thickness - typically being more than 400 micron/16 mils per
coat - may result in cracking especially on such areas.
Recoating intervals related to later conditions of exposure:
(Dry film thickness of HEMPADUR FAST DRY 15560 as indicated below)
Surface
temperature
Exposure during
service
Recoated with
HEMPATEX
HEMPADUR
HEMPATHANE
58030
Minimum
In-field application*
100 micron/4 mils
20C/68F
Minimum
Workshop application
75 micron/3 mils
20C/68F
Atmospheric
Atmospheric
Medium
1 hour
2 hours
2 hours
1 hour
Severe
2 hours
3 hours
3 hours
2 hours
Medium
15 minutes
1 hour
1 hour
1 hour
Severe
1 hour
1 hours
1 hours
1 hours
Maximum**
20C/68F
Atmospheric
Medium
8 hours
None
10 days
24 hours
Severe
8 hours
None
3 days
8 hours
*In case of general maintenance involving epoxy systems of high total dry film thickness, the minimum
recoating interval may advantageously be doubled up.
** For mild atmospheric exposure recoating with HEMPADUR and HEMPATHANE qualities has no maximum.
For other qualities please contact HEMPEL.
If the maximum recoating interval is exceeded, whatever the subsequent coat, roughening of the
surface is necessary to ensure optimum intercoat adhesion or in the case of recoating with
coatings other than HEMPADUR, apply a (thin) additional coat of HEMPADUR FAST DRY 15560
within the above directions for recoating.
A completely clean surface is mandatory to ensure intercoat adhesion, especially in the case of
long recoating intervals. Any dirt, oil and grease have to be removed with eg suitable detergent
followed by high pressure fresh water cleaning. Salts to be removed by fresh water hosing.
Any degraded surface layer, as a result of a long exposure period, must be removed as well.
Page 2 of 3
ISSUED BY:
Page 3 of 3
Product Data
HEMPADUR 15570
BASE 15579 with CURING AGENT 95570
Description:
Recommended use:
Service temperatures:
Certificates/Approvals:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Dry to touch:
Fully cured:
V.O.C.:
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Mixing ratio for 15570:
Application method:
Thinner (max. vol.):
Pot life:
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
HEMPADUR 15570
SURFACE
PREPARATION:
New steel (dry conditions): Abrasive blasting to Sa 2. For temporary protection, if required, use
suitable shopprimer. All damage of shopprimer and contamination from storage and fabrication
should be thoroughly cleaned prior to final painting. For repair and touch-up use HEMPADUR
15570.
Light alloys: Thorough degreasing and (light) abrasive sweeping to remove contamination and to
secure adhesion - surface profile depending on later exposure.
Stainless steel: (Eg ballast tanks of chemical carriers) to be abrasive blast cleaned to a uniform,
sharp, dense profile (Rugotest No. 3, BN9a, ISO Comparator Medium (G), Keane-Tator Comparator
2.0 G/S) corresponding to Rz minimum 50 micron. Any salts, grease, oil, etc. to be removed
before abrasive blasting is commenced.
Maintenance: Remove oil and grease, etc. with suitable detergent. Remove salt and other
contaminants by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning. Clean damaged areas thoroughly by power
tool cleaning to St 3 (minor areas) or by abrasive blasting to minimum Sa 2, preferably to Sa 2.
Improved surface preparation will improve the performance of HEMPADUR 15570.
As an alternative to dry cleaning, water jetting to sound, well adhering coat and/or to steel. Intact
coat must appear with roughened surface after the water jetting. By water jetting to steel,
cleanliness shall be Wa 2 - Wa 2 (atmospheric exposure) / minimum Wa 2 (immersion) (ISO
8501-4:2006). A flash-rust degree of maximum M (atmospheric exposure) / M, preferably L
(immersion) (ISO 8501-4:2006) is acceptable before application. Feather edges to sound and
intact areas. Dust off residues. Touch up bare spots to full film thickness when the surface has
reached the condition of being damp, may be moist.
In case of wet abrasive blasting a suitable inhibitor may be used. Surplus inhibitor and residual
abrasives and sludge must be removed by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning before recoating.
Cleaning with hot water is recommended.
Note 1: Inhibitors are generally not recommended for surfaces which will be immersed during
service.
Note 2: Damp surfaces: Water is not readily detectable, but the temperature of the surface is
below the dew point. Moist surfaces: pools of water and droplets have been removed, but there is
a noticeable film of water. Wet surfaces: Droplets or pools of water are present).
APPLICATION
Use only where curing can proceed at temperatures above -10C/14F.
CONDITIONS:
At the freezing point and below be aware of the risk of ice on the surface, which will hinder the
adhesion.
The temperature of the paint itself should be 15C/60F or above to secure proper application
properties.
In confined spaces provide adequate ventilation during application and drying.
Occurrence of standing water or droplets on the painted surface immediately after application may
result in discolouration.
PRECEDING COAT: None, or according to specification.
SUBSEQUENT COAT: None, HEMPADUR, HEMPATHANE or HEMPATEX as per specification.
REMARKS:
VOC - EU directive
2004/42/EC:
VOC:
Curing agent:
Note:
As supplied
15 vol. % thinning Limit phase I, 2007 Limit phase II, 2010
VOC in g/l
425
485
550
500
For VOC of other shades, please refer to Safety Data Sheet.
Certificates are issued under the former quality number 1557.
The natural tendency of epoxy coatings to chalk in outdoor exposure and to become more
sensitive to mechanical damage and chemical exposure at elevated temperatures is also
reflected in this product.
May be specified in another film thickness than indicated depending on purpose and area of use.
This will alter spreading rate and may influence drying time and recoating interval. Normal range is
50-125 micron/2-5 mils.
Curing agent 95570 is hazy. This is intended and has no negative influence on the performance.
HEMPADUR 15570 is for professional use only.
ISSUED BY:
Weathering/
service
temperatures:
Film thicknesses:
Page 2 of 2
Application
Application Instructions
Instructions
For product description refer to product data sheet
HEMPADUR 15570
BASE 15579 with CURING AGENT 95570
Physical data
versus temperature:
Drying time and recoating interval vary with film thickness, temperature and later
exposure conditions, thus:
(75-100 micron/3-4 mils dry film thickness of HEMPADUR 15570)
Surface temperature
-10C/14F
0C/32F
10C/50F
20C/68F
30C/86F
36 hours
2 months
16 hours
1 month
8 hours
14 days
4 hours
7 days
3 hours
5 days
18 hours
36 hours
9 hours
18 hours
4 hours
8 hours
2 hours
4 hours
1 hours
3 hours
Surface temperature
-10C/14F
0C/32F
10C/50F
20C/68F
30C/86F
Immersion
Not relevant
Not relevant
11 hours
6 hours
4 hours
18 hours
18 hours
36 hours
8 hours
8 hours
16 hours
4 hours
4 hours
8 hours
3 hours
3 hours
6 hours
36 hours
36 hours
3 days
3 days
2 days
36 hours
23 hours
16 hours
10 hours
8 hours
5 hours
6 hours
4 hours
Not relevant
Not relevant
48 hours
24 hours
18 hours
None
None
Extended**
None
None
Extended**
None
None
Extended**
None
None
Extended**
None
None
Extended**
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
HEMPEL
Application
Instructions
Application Instructions
HEMPADUR 15570
Maximum recoating intervals, for HEMPASIL NEXUS 27302:
If the maximum recoating interval is exceeded, apply a (thin) additional coat of
HEMPADUR 15570 within the above directions for recoating.
Furthermore, reference is made to special Application Instructions/painting
specifications for HEMPASIL paint systems.
Long recoating intervals, in general:
A completely clean surface is mandatory to ensure intercoat adhesion, especially in the
case of long recoating intervals. Any dirt, oil and grease have to be removed with eg
suitable detergent followed by high pressure fresh water cleaning. Salts to be removed
by fresh water hosing. Any degraded surface layer, as a result of a long exposure
period, must be removed as well. Water jetting may be relevant to remove any
degraded surface layer and may also replace the above-mentioned cleaning methods
when properly executed. Consult HEMPEL for specific advice if in doubt.
Safety:
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Application Instructions
Product Data
HEMPADUR 15590
BASE 15599 with CURING AGENT 95100
Description:
Recommended use:
As a blast primer for heavy duty epoxy systems on submersed and none-submersed
areas according to specification.
For use at temperatures of 5C/41F, preferably 10C/50F or higher.
Service temperatures:
Certificates/Approvals:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Dry to touch:
Fully cured:
V.O.C.:
Shelf life:
Red/56880
Semi-gloss
44 1
11.0 m/litre - 40 micron
441 sq.ft./US gallon - 1.6 mils
26C/79F
1.4 kg/litre - 11.7 lbs/US gallon
3 (approx.) hours at 20C/68F
7 days at 20C/68F
515 g/litre - 4.3 lbs/US gallon
1 year (25C/77F) from time of production. Depending on storage conditions,
mechanical stirring may be necessary before usage.
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Mixing ratio:
Application method:
Thinner (max.vol.):
Pot life:
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
HEMPADUR 15590
SURFACE
PREPARATION:
New steel: Abrasive blasting to Sa 2-3 depending on area of use. Minimum surface profile
corresponding to Rugotest No. 3, BN11a, Keane-Tator Comparator, 5.5 G/S, or ISO Comparator
Coarse (G) - or as per the specification for the subsequent coat(s). Oil and grease must be
removed with suitable detergent, salts and other contaminants by (high pressure) fresh water
cleaning prior to blasting. After blasting, clean the surface carefully from abrasives and dust.
Maintenance: On old steel surfaces having been exposed to salt water, excessive amounts of salt
residues in pitting may call for wet abrasive blasting followed by dry abrasive blasting. Alternatively,
dry abrasive blasting followed by high pressure fresh water cleaning, drying, and finally, dry
abrasive blasting again.
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
Apply only to a dry and clean surface with a temperature above the dew point to avoid
condensation. Minimum temperature for application is 5C/41F, preferably above 10C/50F.
Relative humidity maximum 80%, preferably below 60%.
The temperature of the paint itself should preferably be between 15C/59F and 25C/77F.
In confined spaces provide adequate ventilation during application and drying.
PRECEDING
COAT:
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
None.
REMARKS:
VOC - EU directive
2004/42/EC:
VOC:
Film thicknesses:
Note:
May be specified in another film thickness than indicated depending on purpose and area of use.
This will alter spreading rate and may influence drying time and recoating interval. Normal range dry
is 30-50 micron/1.2-2 mils.
The stated minimum recoating interval may be halved for areas not intended for water immersion.
To secure good adhesion and the best possible mechanical properties, the following implies:
The coating has been applied in a dry film thickness as near as possible to the specified 40
micron.
The film formation has been of good quality and without any dry spray.
The drying and curing conditions have been according to APPLICATION CONDITIONS, please see
above. (In the case of long recoating intervals: until full curing has been obtained).
No kind of surface contamination exists, except loose dust, etc. which is possible to remove by
vacuum cleaning (tanks) / hosing down (exterior).
The surface MUST be completely clean before recoating. The coating is checked carefully and
should be without patchy, whitish, and/or greasy formations, which can hinder adhesion of
subsequent coat. Note: Exudation of curing agent causes the mentioned patchy, whitish, and/or
greasy formations which will take place if HEMPADUR 15590 is applied at low temperature
without proper induction time and/or if the coating is exposed to water (rain, condensation)
during drying and curing.
Depending on actual local conditions, extended maximum recoating intervals may apply.
Please contact HEMPEL for further advice.
If the maximum recoating interval is exceeded, roughening of the surface is necessary to ensure
intercoat adhesion. Before recoating after exposure in contaminated environment, clean surface
thoroughly by (high pressure) fresh water hosing and allow to dry. HEMPADUR 15590 will resist a
hosing down of the surface 8 hours after application at a steel temperature of 20C/68F.
HEMPADUR 15590 is for professional use only.
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPELS GALVOSIL 15700
BASE 15709 with HEMPELS ZINC METAL PIGMENT 97170
Description:
Recommended use:
Service temperatures:
Certificates/Approvals:
Certificated by Scientific & Technical Services to comply with the requirements of low
moisture fats and oil according to FDA.
Approved by Lloyd's Register of Shipping as a recognized corrosion control coating.
Meets the requirements laid down by ASTM A-490 Class "B" for Slip-Co-efficient and
Creep Resistance.
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Dry to touch:
Fully cured:
V.O.C.:
Shelf life:
Metal grey/19840
Flat
64 1
12.8 m/litre - 50 micron
513 sq.ft./US gallon - 2 mils
14C/57F
2.65 kg/litre - 22.1 lbs/US gallon
30 (approx.) min. at 20C/68F (65-75% RH)
16 hours at 20C/68F and min. 75% RH (See REMARKS overleaf)
435 g/litre - 3.6 lbs/US gallon
1 year (25C/77F) for liquid 15709 and 3 years for Hempels zinc metal pigment
97170 (stored in closed container) from time of production.
Shelf life is dependent on storage temperature. Shelf life is reduced at storage
temperatures above 25C/77F. Do not store above 40C/104F.
Shelf life is exceeded if the liquid is gelled or if the mixed product forms gels before
application.
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Mixing ratio for 15700:
Application method:
Thinner (max.vol.)
Pot life:
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
Remove oil and grease, etc.with suitable detergent. Remove salt and other contaminants by
(high pressure) fresh water cleaning. Abrasive blasting with sharp abrasive to minimum Sa 2 with
a surface profile equivalent to Rugotest No. 3, BN10, Keane-Tator Comparator, min. 3.0 G/S, or
ISO Comparator rough Medium (G). In case of new steel to be exposed to no more than medium
aggressive (industrial) environment and without any extraordinary demands to lifetime, a surface
preparation degree of SSPC-SP6 may suffice.
Consult separate APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS, and - as relevant - the corresponding PAINTING
SPECIFICATION for cargo tanks.
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
The surface must be completely clean and dry with a temperature above the dew point to avoid
condensation.
At temperatures ranging from 0C/32F to 40C/105F, curing needs minimum 65% relative
humidity and is very retarded at lower temperatures.
Consult separate APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS.
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
As a tank coating: None, i.e. no other paints are acceptable in combination with HEMPELS
GALVOSIL 15700. Otherwise according to specification.
REMARKS:
Service
temperatures:
Some of the certificates have been issued under the former quality number 1570.
If used as anticorrosive protection under insulation of high temperature equipment it is very
important that NO moisture can penetrate during shut-down periods. This to avoid risk of "wet
corrosion" when the temperature rises.
Wet service temperature, non-saline water: Maximum 60C/140F.
Wet service temperature, other liquids: Consult the corresponding CARGO PROTECTION GUIDE.
Hot sea water washing and (low pressure) steam cleaning should never be executed on tank
coatings which have not been in service for at least one month. Contact HEMPEL about
temperatures permissible.
Film thicknesses:
If topcoated with a heavy- duty system, 50-80 micron/2-3,2 mils dry film thickness (75-125
micron/3-5 mils wet) is recommended. Consult separate APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS before
recoating. For long-term protection without topcoat, 75 micron/3 mils dry film thickness (100-125
micron/4-5 mils wet) is generally recommended. In tanks 100 micron/4 mils dry film thickness
(150 micron/6 mils wet) is recommended but may be applied in 125 micron/5 mils dry film
thickness (200 micron/8 mils wet).
High temperature service: To avoid cracking during service, it is important to keep the dry film
thickness at maximum 40-50 micron/1.6-2 mils, especially in cases where service conditions
include sudden temperature changes.
(The dry film thickness range does not take into account the correction factors for rough surfaces
as listed in ISO 19840).
Mixing:
When mixing part of the content in a can the mixing ratio on volume should be made as follows:
Measure 7.4 parts of liquid 15709, then add Hempels zinc metal pigment 97170 up to a total of
10,0 parts by volume.
Thinning:
For application at high temperatures, a special thinner is available.
Recoating:
Recoating intervals are strongly dependent on both temperature and humidity. Deviations from the
standard conditions may shorten or prolong the recoating intervals.
Full curing will be obtained after:
0C/32F and min. 75% RH: 3 days
10C/40F and min. 75% RH: 36 hours
20C/68F and min. 75% RH: 16 hours
(a certain curing does take place at temperatures below 0C/32F, but at an extremely low speed).
Furthermore consult separate APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS.
Curing, cargo tanks: Before cargo tanks are taken into use, the coating must be completely through-cured. It is
recommended to carry out low pressure hosing of the tanks with (fresh) water 2-3 times at ambient
temperatures. Let the tanks remain wet between the washings. Reference is made to APPLICATION
INSTRUCTIONS.
Note:
HEMPEL'S GALVOSIL 15700 is for professional use only.
ISSUED BY:
HEMPEL A/S - 1570019840CO028
This Product Data Sheet supersedes those previously issued.
For explanations, definitions and scope, see Explanatory Notes in the HEMPEL Book.
Data, specifications, directions and recommendations given in this data sheet represent only test results or experience obtained
under controlled or specially defined circumstances. Their accuracy, completeness or appropriateness under the actual conditions
of any intended use of the Products herein must be determined exclusively by the Buyer and/or User.
The Products are supplied and all technical assistance is given subject to HEMPEL's GENERAL CONDITIONS OF SALES, DELIVERY
AND SERVICE, unless otherwise expressly agreed in writing. The Manufacturer and Seller disclaim, and Buyer and/or User waive
all claims involving, any liability, including but not limited to negligence, except as expressed in said GENERAL CONDITIONS for all
results, injury or direct or consequential losses or damages arising from the use of the Products as recommended above, on the
overleaf or otherwise.
Product data are subject to change without notice and become void five years from the date of issue.
Page 2 of 2
Application
Application Instructions
Instructions
For product description refer to product data sheet
Steel work:
For optimum performance, eg. relevant for cargo tank coating, the following is
recommended:
All welding seams must have a surface finish which ensures that the quality of the paint
system will be maintained in all respects. Holes in welding seams, undercuts, cracks,
etc. should be avoided. If found, they must be remedied by welding and/or grinding.
All weld spatters must be removed.
All sharp edges must be removed or rounded off in such a way that the specified film
thickness can be build-up on all surfaces. The radius of the rounding should be
approximately 1-2 mm. Any laminations must be removed.
The steel must be of first class quality and should not have been allowed to rust more
than corresponding to grade B of ISO 8501-1:2007.
Note: Porous surfaces such as certain types of cast iron cannot be properly protected
with zinc silicate. Deeply corroded steel may also be difficult to protect with a zinc
silicate.
All steel work (including welding, flame cutting, grinding) must be finished before the
surface preparation starts.
Surface preparation:
Prior to abrasive blast cleaning of the steel, remove oil, grease, salts and other
contamination with a suitable detergent followed by high pressure fresh water hosing.
Alkali deposits on new welding seams as well as soap traces from pressure testing of
tanks to be removed by fresh water and scrubbing with stiff brushes. Control for
absence of contamination according to separate guidelines.
On repair jobs, a rough blasting to remove all loosely adhering materials may be
required before degreasing/washing is carried out.
Old steel: Even after a very thorough cleaning, pits may typically contain contamination
in the form of remnants of chemicals/water soluble salts. For this reason, repeated
detergent washing plus abrasive blasting may be necessary. After the first blasting, a
very thorough vacuum cleaning is carried out in order to see if any "chemical bleeding"
occurs as well as controls for water soluble salts (reference is made to separate
instructions) are made. Special care should be taken in evaluating pitted areas - ask for
special guidelines.
Abrasive blasting with sharp abrasive to min Sa 2, ISO 8501-1:2007.
To obtain full chemical resistance according to the CARGO PROTECTION GUIDE, the
steel surface must be abrasive blast cleaned according to ISO 8501-1:2007, very near
to white metal Sa 2-Sa 3. In practice, this requirement is to be understood as white
metal Sa 3 at the moment of abrasive blasting, but allows for a slight reduction at the
moment of paint application.
The resulting surface profile must be equivalent to Rugotest No. 3, min. BN 10, KeaneTator Surface Comparator, G/S min 3.0 or ISO 8503/1 rough Medium (G).
Page 1 of 7
HEMPEL
HEMPEL
Application
Instructions
Application Instructions
GALVOSIL 15700 can be applied by conventional spray equipment (pressure pot type),
airless spray equipment, or by brush.
Conventional Spray equipment: Standard industrial spray equipment with mechanical
agitator and pressure regulators, air filters, and water traps.
Air hose:
Material hose:
Hoses should be as short as possible, preferably not longer than 10 metres/30 feet.
Pot pressure:
Atomization pressure:
Nozzle orifice:
Page 2 of 7
Application Instructions
Teflon
.019" through .023".
40 through 70.
100-150 bar (1400-2100 psi).
The amount of thinning necessary will depend upon prevailing conditions: Temperature,
humidity, wind/ventilation, method of spraying, spray equipment, etc.
In the case of a high level of thinning and/or long stops in application, the mixed paint
must be re-circulated to avoid settlement of zinc particles in the spray hoses.
The coating must be wet and smooth just after application. Besides correct spray
technique, the amount of thinner added must be selected securing this optimum film
formation.
Too little thinning will typically lead to dry-spray and too much thinning to sagging and
settling of zinc particles in the can or in the spray hoses.
Cleaning of equipment:
The whole equipment must be cleaned thoroughly with THINNER 08700 after use.
Additionally for conventional spray-guns:
In the case of short stops, prevent packing of zinc around the needle by placing the
spray gun in THINNER 08700 and let some air pass the spray gun. In the case of longer
stops, clean the spray gun with THINNER 08700.
Mixing:
a.
Do not open packings until immediately before use. The entire content of the two
packings must be used for each batch to ensure a correct mixture. Leftovers in
the packings cannot be used later. Protect HEMPELS ZINC METAL PIGMENT
97170 against moisture before mixing.
b.
Before mixing, shake or stir the GALVOSIL 15709 LIQUID very thoroughly.
c.
Pour HEMPELS ZINC METAL PIGMENT 97170 slowly down into the LIQUID with
constant mechanical stirring. Do not mix in the reverse order. Continue stirring
until the mixture is free of lumps.
d.
Strain the mixture through a screen, 60 - 80 mesh (250 - 160 DIN Norm. 4188).
Pot life:
4 hours (20C/68F)
Temperature of paint:
In a hot climate it is important that the cans with LIQUID are kept out of the sun and
that the temperature of the liquid is kept below 30C/86F in order to avoid excessive
dry spray.
Page 3 of 7
Application Instructions
Application procedure,
tank coating:
Stripe coating:
All places difficult to cover properly by spray application must be stripe coated with a
brush immediately before or after the spray application
Microclimate:
The actual climatic conditions at the substrate during application and until acceptance:
Recommended minimum surface temperature is 0C/32F.
The maximum recommended surface temperature is approx. 40C/104F. Higher steel
temperatures are acceptable provided dry-spray is avoided by (extra thinning and) proper
spray application. In extreme cases a reduction of the dry film thickness may also be
necessary. In a warm climate it is recommended to carry out application during night
time.
The steel temperature must be above the dew point. As a rule of thumb a steel
temperature which is 3C/5F above the dew point can be considered safe.
Page 4 of 7
Application Instructions
Curing time:
State of curing:
Can be checked by rubbing the coating with a rag soaked in THINNER 08700. If the
coating remains unaffected, state of curing is sufficient for recoating with other paint
materials (when used as a cargo tank coating this state of curing may be described as
"near to complete").
Full curing for cargo loading:
Before tanks are taken into use, the coating must be completely through-cured. This
is secured by low pressure hosing/washing the tanks with (fresh) water 2-3 times
after the above described condition of "near to complete curing" has been obtained.
By using the tank washing equipment, the normal hour cycle is applied with half a
day to one day between washings. Let the tanks remain wet between the washing.
Page 5 of 7
Application Instructions
Extra coat
recoating (by itself):
Too low film thickness can be made good by applying an extra coat of HEMPEL'S
GALVOSIL 15700. Surface preparation procedure - if necessary - and dilution of paint
according to page 4 "Application procedure, tank coating".
Application of an extra coat should be done before full curing is obtained, ie during the
curing period with low relative humidity. The relative humidity must be kept below 60%,
absolute maximum 65%, all the time until recoating and the painted surface is not
exposed to open weather, contamination of the like.
Spreading rate:
dft, mils
m/litre
sq.ft./US gallon
50
75
100
2
3
4
12.8
8.5
6.4
513
342
257
dft, micron
dft, mils
m/litre
sq.ft./US gallon
50
75
100
2
3
4
7.1
4.7
3.6
285
190
143
Page 6 of 7
Application Instructions
HEMPELS GALVOSIL 15700 must be fully cured before recoating with a full paint
system.
Topcoating procedure:
Non-weathered zinc silicate coatings are porous and popping may occur in the
subsequent coat(s). One way to reduce the risk of popping is to apply a mist coat as
the first pass of the subsequent coat, let the air escape, and then apply the remainder
of the topcoat.
Some of HEMPEL's products will substantially reduce the risk of popping when applied
directly on top of the zinc silicate. See painting specification.
Advanced paint systems are recommended for topcoating, e.g. HEMPADUR qualities.
Surface cleaning:
Intact zinc silicate surface with sporadic formation of white rust (zinc corrosion
products).
a.
b.
Remove "white rust" by high pressure fresh water cleaning 200-350 bar
(2900-5000 psi) at a nozzle-to-surface distance of 15-20 cm (6-8").
If the surface is only slightly contaminated, corresponding to 1-2 months
of exposure in a mildly corrosive environment, hosing down of the surface
with fresh water and scrubbing with stiff brushes (nylon) may be sufficient
and more practical. Check that the coating is through dry before
recoating.
2.
3.
Safety:
ISSUED BY:
Zinc silicate surface with extreme formation of white rust which cannot be
removed as described above.
a.
b.
c.
Restore the zinc layer with any solvent-borne GALVOSIL quality or zinc
epoxy (HEMPADUR ZINC).
b.
c.
d.
Restore the zinc layer with any solvent-borne GALVOSIL quality or zinc
epoxy (HEMPADUR ZINC).
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
HEMPEL A/S - 1570019840CO028
Page 7 of 7
Application Instructions
Product Data
HEMPEL'S GALVOSIL 1571A
BASE 1571N with HEMPEL'S ZINC METAL PIGMENT 97170
Description:
Recommended use:
1.
2.
Service temperatures:
Approvals/certificates:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Dry to touch:
Fully cured:
V.O.C.:
Shelf life:
Grey-green/42200
Flat
58 1
11.6 m/litre - 50 micron
465 sq.ft./US gallon - 2 mils
14C/57F
2.5 kg/litre - 20.9 lbs/US gallon
30 (approx.) minutes at 20C/68F (75% RH)
16 (approx.) hours at 20C/68F (75% RH) (see REMARKS overleaf)
640 g/litre - 5.3 lbs/US gallon
6 months (25C/77F) for liquid 1571N and 3 years for Hempels zinc metal pigment
97170 (stored in closed container) from time of production.
Shelf life is dependent on storage temperature. Shelf life is reduced at storage
temperatures above 25C/77F. Do not store above 40C/104F.
Shelf life is exceeded if the liquid is gelled or if the mixed product forms gels before
application.
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Mixing ratio for 1571A:
Application method:
Thinner (max.vol.):
Pot life:
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
Remove oil and grease, etc. with suitable detergent. Remove salt and other contaminants by
(high pressure) fresh water cleaning. Abrasive blasting with sharp abrasive to minimum Sa 2 with
a surface profile equivalent to Rugotest No. 3, BN10, Keane-Tator Comparator, min. 3.0 G/S, or
ISO Comparator rough Medium (G). In case of new steel to be exposed to no more than medium
aggressive (industrial) environment and without any extraordinary demands to lifetime, a surface
preparation degree of SSPC-SP6 may suffice.
Consult separate APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS.
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
The surface must be completely clean and dry with a temperature above the dew point to avoid
condensation.
At temperatures ranging from -5C/23F to 40C/105F.
Curing needs minimum 60% relative humidity for curing by itself. Lower humidity will require fresh
water hosing during curing.
Do not hose down before initial drying and curing for minimum 7 hours at 20C/68F. Tolerates
light showers after 7 hours. Consult separate Application Instructions.
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
REMARKS:
Service
temperatures:
Film thickness:
Mixing:
Recoating:
Note:
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Application
Application Instructions
Instructions
For product description refer to product data sheet
All welds must be free of pinholes and must be of highest quality so that they can be
protected by the paint. This means perfectly filled, smooth welds with a slightly wavy
surface.
All welds must be complete and continuous which will otherwise cause coating
discontinuity.
All weld spatters must be removed.
All sharp edges must be removed or rounded off in such a way that the specified film
thickness can be build-up on all surfaces. Recommended radius of the rounding is
approximately 1-2 mm.
The steel must be of first class quality and should not have been allowed to rust more
than corresponding to grade B of ISO 8501-1:2007.
Note: Porous surfaces such as certain types of cast iron cannot be properly protected
with zinc silicate. Deeply corroded steel may also be difficult to protect with a zinc
silicate.
All steel work (including welding, flame cutting, grinding) must be finished before the
surface preparation starts.
Surface preparation:
Prior to abrasive blast cleaning of the steel, remove oil, grease, salts and other
contamination with a suitable detergent followed by high pressure fresh water hosing.
Alkali deposits on new welding seams as well as soap traces from pressure testing of
tanks to be removed by fresh water and scrubbing with stiff brushes. Control for
absence of contamination according to separate guidelines.
On repair jobs, a rough blasting to remove all loosely adhering materials may be
required before degreasing/washing is carried out.
Old steel: Even after a very thorough cleaning pits may typically contain contamination
in the form of oil and grease as well as water soluble salts. For this reason, repeated
detergent washing plus abrasive blasting may be necessary.
After the first blasting a very thorough vacuum cleaning is carried out in order to see if
any "bleeding" occurs as well as controls for water soluble salts are made. Reference
is made to separate instructions. Special care should be taken in evaluating pitted
areas.
Abrasive blasting with sharp abrasive to min Sa 2, ISO 8501-1:2007, SSPC-SP-10.
The resulting surface profile must be equivalent to Rugotest No. 3, min. BN 10, KeaneTator Surface Comparator, G/S min 3.0 or ISO 8503/1 Medium (G).
Note: A lower surface profile than specified will cause reduced adhesion and increased
tendency to mud cracking.
Note: A lower surface profile than specified will cause reduced adhesion and increased
tendency to mud cracking.
Page 1 of 7
HEMPEL
HEMPEL
Application
Instructions
Application Instructions
GALVOSIL 1571A can be applied by conventional spray equipment (pressure pot type),
airless spray equipment, or by brush.
Conventional Spray equipment: Standard industrial spray equipment with mechanical
agitator and pressure regulators, air filters, and water traps.
Air hose:
Material hose:
Hoses should be as short as possible, preferably not longer than 10 metres/30 feet.
Pot pressure:
Atomization pressure:
Nozzle orifice:
Note: The amount of thinning necessary will depend upon prevailing conditions:
Temperature, humidity, wind/ventilation, method of spraying, etc.
The pressure pot must be placed at the same level as or at a higher level than the
spray gun when spraying, owing to the weight of the material. Alternatively a pistonpump (e.g. 10:1) may be used instead of the pressure pot. This will facilitate the use
of longer hoses or having the spray gun at a higher level than the pump.
When painting undersides, the spray gun will need intermittent cleaning with THINNER
08700 to prevent clogging of the nozzle.
With conventional spray application regulation of the pot and the atomizing air
pressures can be made as follows:
Page 2 of 7
Application Instructions
2.
Regulate the pressure in the pot so that the material reaches approximately 60
cm/20" horizontally out from the gun before falling to the ground.
3.
Airless spray equipment: A large, slow-working pump is preferred, eg. 30:1, with a
pump capacity of 8-12 litres/minute. The in-line filter should be 60 mesh.
Gaskets:
Nozzle orifice:
Fan angle:
Nozzle pressure:
Teflon
.019" through .023".
40 through 70.
100-150 bar (1400-2100 psi).
The amount of thinning necessary will depend upon prevailing conditions: Temperature,
humidity, wind/ventilation, method of spraying, spray equipment, etc.
In the case of a high level of thinning and long stops in application, it might be
necessary to recirculate the mixed paint to avoid settlement of zinc particles in the
spray hoses.
The coating must be wet and smooth just after application. Besides correct spray
technique, the amount of thinner added must be selected securing this optimum film
formation.
Too little thinning will typically lead to dry-spray and too much thinning to sagging and
settling of zinc particles in the can.
Cleaning of equipment:
The whole equipment to be cleaned thoroughly with THINNER 08700 after use.
Additionally for conventional spray-guns:
At short stops, prevent packing of zinc around the needle by placing the spray gun in
THINNER 08700 and let some air pass the spray gun.
At longer stops, clean the spray gun with THINNER 08700.
Mixing:
a.
Do not open packings until immediately before use. The entire content of the two
packings must be used for each batch to ensure a correct mixture. Leftovers in
the packings cannot be used later. Protect HEMPELS ZINC METAL PIGMENT
97170 against moisture before mixing.
b.
Before mixing, shake or stir the GALVOSIL 1571N LIQUID very thoroughly.
c.
Pour HEMPELS ZINC METAL PIGMENT 97170 slowly down into the LIQUID with
constant mechanical stirring. Do not mix in the reverse order. Continue stirring
until the mixture is free of lumps.
d.
Strain the mixture through a screen, 60 - 80 mesh (250 - 160 DIN Norm. 4188).
Pot life:
2 hours at 20C/68F.
Temperature of paint:
In a hot climate it is important that the cans with LIQUID are kept out of the sun and
that the temperature of the liquid is kept below 30C/86F in order to avoid excessive
dry spray.
Page 3 of 7
Application Instructions
"Wet-in-almost dry"
application:
Stripe coating:
All places difficult to cover properly by spray application should be stripe coated with a
brush immediately before the spray application - if necessary to obtain the specified
film thickness also after the spray application.
Microclimate:
The actual climatic conditions at the substrate during application and until approval:
The minimum surface temperature is -5C/23F.
The maximum recommended surface temperature is approx. 40C/104F. Higher steel
temperatures are acceptable provided dry-spray is avoided by (extra thinning and)
proper spray application. In extreme cases a reduction of the dry film thickness may
also be necessary. In a warm climate it is recommended to carry out application during
night-time.
The steel temperature must be above the dew point. As a rule of thumb a steel
temperature which is 3C/5F above the dew point can be considered safe.
With temperatures at or below the freezing point beware of ice on the surface, which
will hinder the adhesion, and use a capacitive RH-meter for measuring the relative
humidity.
In confined spaces, supply an adequate amount of fresh air during application and
drying to assist the evaporation of solvent. All surfaces must be ventilated. However,
avoid ventilators blowing directly onto the freshly applied paint.
Page 4 of 7
Application Instructions
Recommended
film thickness:
Page 5 of 7
Application Instructions
Too low film thicknesses can be made good by applying an extra coat, of diluted
GALVOSIL 1571A. This must be done before full curing is obtained, i.e. during the
curing period with low relative humidity. Light sandpapering of the surface is
recommended in order to remove any spray dust before recoating takes place. Vacuum
cleaning must be carried out if necessary. Dilute the extra coat approximately 20-25%.
Spreading rate:
DFT, mils
m/l
sq.ft./US gallon
50
75
100
2
3
4
11.6
7.7
5.8
465
310
233
DFT, mils
m/l
sq.ft./US gallon
50
75
100
2
3
4
6.4
4.3
3.2
258
172
129
Recoating interval:
GALVOSIL 1571A must be fully cured before recoating with a full paint system.
Topcoating:
Non-weathered zinc silicate coatings are porous and popping may occur in the
subsequent coat(s).
Procedure:
One way to reduce the risk of popping is to apply a mist coat as the first pass of the
topcoat, let the air escape, and then apply the remainder of the topcoat.
Some of HEMPEL's products will substantially reduce the risk of popping when applied
directly on top of the zinc silicate. See painting specifications.
Advanced paint systems are recommended for topcoating, eg HEMPADUR qualities.
In specifications with a high total film thickness the GALVOSIL 1571A film thickness
can advantageously be kept at 50 micron/2 mils.
Surface cleaning:
2.
Intact zinc silicate surface with sporadic formation of white rust (zinc corrosion
products).
a.
b.
Remove "white rust" by high pressure fresh water cleaning 200-350 bar
(2900-5000 psi) at a nozzle-to-surface distance of 15-20 cm (6-8"). If the
surface is only slightly contaminated, corresponding to 1-2 months of
exposure in a mildly corrosive environment, hosing down of the surface with
fresh water and scrubbing with stiff brushes (nylon) may be sufficient and
more practical. Check that the coating is through dry before recoating.
Zinc silicate surface with extreme formation of white rust which cannot be re
moved as described above.
a.
b.
c.
Restore the zinc layer with any solvent borne GALVOSIL quality, HEMPADUR
ZINC 15360/16363 or HEMPELS ZINC PRIMER 16490.
Please observe that abrasive blast sweeping may "open" porosities inside the
"white-rusted" zinc silicate wherefore popping may occur in the following coats.
Page 6 of 7
Application Instructions
b.
c.
d.
Restore the zinc layer with any solvent borne GALVOSIL quality, HEMPADUR
ZINC 15360/15363 or HEMPELS ZINC PRIMER 16490.
Safety:
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
ISSUED BY:
Page 7 of 7
Application Instructions
Product Data
HEMPELS GALVOSIL 15780
HEMPELS LIQUID 15789 with HEMPELS ZINC METAL PIGMENT 97170
Description:
HEMPELS GALVOSIL 15780 is a two-component, medium-zinc, solvent-borne, selfcuring inorganic zinc silicate coating. Applicable by airless spray.
Recommended use:
Service temperatures:
Certificates/Approvals:
Meets the requirements laid down in ASTM A-490 Class "B" for Slip-Co-efficient and
Creep Resistance.
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Dry to touch:
Fully cured:
V.O.C.:
Shelf life:
Metal grey/19840
Flat
61 1
12.2 m/litre - 50 micron
489 sq.ft./US gallon - 2 mils
14C/57F
2.4 kg/litre - 20.0 lbs/US gallon
30 (approx.) min. at 20C/68F (75% RH)
16 (approx.) hours at 20C/68F (75% RH)
445 g/litre - 3.7 lbs/US gallon
6 months (25C/77F) for liquid 15789 and 3 years for Hempels zinc metal pigment
97170 (stored in closed container) from time of production.
Shelf life is dependent on storage temperature. Shelf life is reduced at storage
temperatures above 25C/77F. Do not store above 40C/104F.
Shelf life is exceeded if the liquid is gelled or if the mixed product forms gels before
application.
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Mixing ratio for 15780:
Application method:
Thinner (max.vol.):
Pot life:
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Subsequent coat, max:
Safety:
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
Remove oil and grease, etc. with suitable detergent. Remove salt and other contaminants by
(high pressure) fresh water cleaning. Abrasive blasting with sharp abrasive to minimum Sa 2 with
a surface profile equivalent to Rugotest No. 3, BN10, Keane-Tator Comparator, min. 3.0 G/S, or
ISO Comparator rough Medium (G). In case of new steel to be exposed to no more than medium
aggressive (industrial) environment and without any extraordinary demands to lifetime, a surface
preparation degree of SSPC-SP6 may suffice.
Consult separate APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS.
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
From 0C/32F to 40C/104F. Curing needs minimum 65% relative humidity and is very retarded
at lower temperatures. Furthermore consult separate APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS.
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
According to specification. Recoating is expected to take place within 6 months after application
of HEMPELS GALVOSIL 15780.
REMARKS:
Service
temperature:
Note:
Film thicknesses:
Mixing:
Thinning:
Recoating:
Note:
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Application
Application Instructions
Instructions
For product description refer to product data sheet
Steel work:
All welding seams must have a surface finish which ensures that the quality of the
paint system will be maintained in all respects. Holes in welding seams, undercuts,
cracks, etc. should be avoided. If found, they must be remedied by welding and/or
grinding.
All weld spatters must be removed.
All sharp edges must be removed or rounded off in such a way that the specified film
thickness can be build-up on all surfaces. The radius of the rounding should be
approximately 1-2 mm. Any laminations must be removed.
The steel must be of first class quality and should not have been allowed to rust more
than corresponding to grade B of ISO 8501-1:2007.
Note: Porous surfaces such as certain types of cast iron cannot be properly protected
with zinc silicate. Pit-corroded steel (Grade D of ISO 8501-1:2007) may also be difficult
to protect with a zinc silicate.
All steel work (including welding, flame cutting, grinding) must be finished before the
surface preparation starts.
Surface preparation:
Prior to abrasive blast cleaning of the steel, remove oil and grease and other
contamination with a suitable detergent followed by fresh water high pressure hosing.
Alkali deposits on new welding seams as well as possible soap traces from pressure
testing (tanks) are removed by fresh water wash (scrubbing with stiff brushes).
Abrasive blasting with sharp abrasive to min. Sa 2, ISO 8501-1: 2007.
Surface profile equivalent to Rugotest No. 3, min. BN 10 Keane-Tator Surface
Comparator, G/S min 3.0 or ISO 8503/1 rough Medium (G).
In case of new steel to be exposed to no more than medium aggressive (industrial)
environment and without any extraordinary demands to lifetime, a surface preparation
degree of SSPC-SP6 may suffice.
Use steel grit, aluminium silicate or similar sharp edged abrasive of a good quality free
of foreign matters, soft particles and the like. Control for absence of contamination
according to separate guidelines.
The compressed air must be dry and clean. The compressor must be fitted with
suitable oil and water traps.
Steel grit with a particle size of 0.2-1.0 mm or aluminium silicate of 0.4-1.8 mm will
usually create the desired surface profile when the air pressure measured behind the
nozzle is 6-7 bars/85-100 psi.
When blasting is completed, remove residual grit and dust.
Note: Lower surface profile than specified will cause reduced adhesion and increased
tendency to mud cracking. On the other hand too high surface profile (steel grit) should
be avoided as this may introduce a risk of pin-point rusting.
Page 1 of 5
HEMPEL
HEMPEL
Application
Instructions
Application Instructions
Application:
GALVOSIL 15780 can be applied by conventional spray (pressure pot type), airless
spray or brush.
Conventional Spray equipment: Standard industrial spray equipment with mechanical
agitator and pressure regulators, air filters, and water traps.
Air hose:
Material hose:
Hoses should be as short as possible, preferably not longer than 10 metres/30 feet.
Pot pressure:
Atomization pressure:
Nozzle orifice:
The pressure pot must be placed at the same level as or at a higher level than the
spray gun when spraying, owing to the weight of the material. Alternatively a pistonpump (e.g. 10:1) may be used instead of the pressure pot. This will facilitate the use
of longer hoses or having the spray gun at a higher level than the pump.
When painting undersides, the spray gun will need intermittent cleaning with THINNER
08700 to prevent clogging of the nozzle.
With conventional spray application regulation of the pot and the atomizing air
pressures can be made as follows:
1. Shut off the atomizing air.
2. Regulate the pressure in the pot so that the material reaches approximately 60
cm/20" horizontally out from the gun before falling to the ground.
3. Turn on the atomizing air using lowest possible pressure.
Airless spray equipment: A large, slow-working pump is preferred, e.g 30:1, with a
pump capacity of 8-12 litres/minute. The in-line filter should be 60 mesh.
Gaskets:
Nozzle orifice:
Fan angle:
Nozzle pressure:
Teflon
.019" through .023".
40 through 70.
100-150 bar (1400-2100 psi).
Wet film thickness must be checked immediately after application, but can be used as
a rough guidance only because of the fast drying.
Thinning:
The amount of thinning necessary will depend upon prevailing conditions: Temperature,
humidity, wind/ventilation, method of spraying, spray equipment, etc.
Too little thinning will typically lead to dry-spray and too much thinning to sagging and
settling of zinc particles in the can or in the spray hoses.
In the case of a high level of thinning and/or long stops in application, the mixed paint
must be recirculated to avoid settlement of zinc particles in the spray hoses.
Page 2 of 5
Application Instructions
The coating must be wet and smooth just after application. Besides correct spray
technique, the amount of thinner added must be selected securing this optimum film
formation.
Cleaning of equipment:
All equipment must be cleaned thoroughly with THINNER 08700 after use.
Additionally for conventional spray-guns:
In the case of short stops, prevent packing of zinc around the needle by placing the
spray gun in THINNER 08700 and let some air pass the spray gun. In the case of
longer stops, clean the spray gun with THINNER 08700.
Mixing:
a.
Do not open packings until immediately before use. The entire content of the two
packings must be used for each batch to ensure a correct mixture. Leftovers in
the packings cannot be used later. Protect HEMPELS ZINC METAL PIGMENT
97170 against moisture before mixing.
b.
Before mixing, shake or stir the GALVOSIL 15789 LIQUID very thoroughly.
c.
Pour HEMPELS ZINC METAL PIGMENT 97170 slowly down into the LIQUID with
constant mechanical stirring. Do not mix in the reverse order. Continue stirring
until the mixture is free of lumps.
d.
Strain the mixture through a screen, 60 - 80 mesh (250 - 160 DIN Norm. 4188).
Pot life:
4 hours (20C/68F)
Temperature of paint:
In a hot climate it is important that the cans with LIQUID are kept out of the sun and
that the temperature of the liquid is kept below 30C/86F in order to avoid excessive
dry spray.
Stripe coating:
All places difficult to cover properly by spray should be stripe coated with brush
immediately before spray application - if necessary also after spray application.
Microclimate:
Curing time:
Page 3 of 5
Application Instructions
Extra coat
(recoating by itself):
Too low film thicknesses can be made good by applying an extra coat, of diluted
HEMPELS GALVOSIL 15780. This should be done before full curing is obtained, ie
during the curing period with low relative humidity. Light sandpapering of the surface is
recommended in order to remove any spray dust before overcoating takes place.
Vacuum cleaning should be carried out if necessary. Dilute the extra coat
approximately 20-25%.
There is a risk of mud cracking or peeling if applied in too high film thickness
(more than approx. 125 micron/5 mils dry film thickness).
Spreading rate:
Recoating
(with other paints):
Micron
(Mils)
m/litre
(sq.ft./US gallon
Theoretical:
(on smooth surface):
50
75
(2)
(3)
12.2
8.1
(489)
(326)
Practical (consumption
factor 1.8):
50
75
(2)
(3)
6.8
4.5
(272)
(181)
Recoating interval:
b.
Remove white rust by high pressure water jetting with fresh water
(250-300 bar (3625-4350 psi) at a nozzle distance of 15-20 cm (6-8")).
Page 4 of 5
Application Instructions
3.
Zinc silicate surface with extreme formation of white rust which cannot be
removed as described above.
a.
Remove oil, grease and dirt by a detergent wash (or solvent wash).
b.
c.
Remove oil, grease and dirt by a detergent wash (or solvent wash).
b.
c.
d.
Safety:
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
ISSUED BY:
Page 5 of 5
Application Instructions
Product Data
HEMPELS SHOPPRIMER ZS 15890
BASE 15899 with HEMPELS LIQUID 99751
Description:
Recommended use:
For short to medium-term protection of blastcleaned steel plates and other structural
steel during the storage, fabrication, and construction periods.
Certificates/Approvals:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Dry to handle:
Fully cured:
V.O.C.:
Shelf life:
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Mixing ratio for 15890:
Application method:
Thinner (max.vol.):
Pot life:
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
Remove oil and grease with suitable detergent. Abrasive blasting to minimum Sa 2 with a
surface profile equivalent to Rugotest No. 3, min. N9a, Keane-Tator Comparator, 2 mils segments
or ISO Comparator Medium (G,S).
For special purposes grit blasting is necessary.
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
The surface must be completely clean and dry with a temperature above the dew point to avoid
condensation. Minimum steel temperature 0C/32F, max. approximately 55C/131F:
Curing: Minimum temperature for curing 0C/32F, minimum 50%, preferably above 65% relative
humidity.
Consult separate APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS.
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
As per specification.
REMARKS:
Ballast tanks:
Film thicknesses
and theoretical
spreading rates:
Thinning:
Curing:
Recoating:
Shelf life:
Pot life:
Note:
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Application
Application Instructions
Instructions
HEMPELS SHOPPRIMER ZS 15890
HEMPEL'S LIQUID 99751
Scope:
Surface preparation:
Note: For steel to be used for ballast tanks, IMO Resolution MSC.215(82) requires that
the contamination with water soluble salts measured according to ISO 8502-9 must
not exceed a conductivity equivalent to 50 mg/m2 sodium chloride. The dust quantity
rating assessed according to ISO 8502-3 must not exceed rating 1 for dust size
classes 3, 4 or 5.
a.
Prior to abrasive blast cleaning of the steel, remove oil and grease and other
contamination with a suitable detergent, followed by high pressure fresh water
hosing.
b.
c.
When the abrasive blasting is completed, remove all grit and dust by vacuum
cleaning.
Note: As abrasive blasted surfaces will rust rapidly, HEMPEL'S SHOPPRIMER ZS
15890 must be applied immediately after the abrasive blasting and de-dusting. If
re-rusting occurs, re-blasting is necessary.
Application equipment:
Page 1 of 3
HEMPEL
HEMPEL
Application
Instructions
Application Instructions
Thinning:
a.
Do not open packing until immediately before use. The entire content of the two
packing must be used for each batch to ensure a correct mixture. Left-overs in
the packing cannot be used later.
b.
c.
d.
Pour the liquid slowly into the zinc paste with constant mechanical
stirring. Do not mix in the reverse order. Continue stirring until the mixture is free
of lumps.
e.
Strain the mixture through a screen, 60-80 mesh (250-160 DIN Norm. 4188).
f.
Pot life:
Application:
The coating must be wet and smooth just after application. Avoid dry-spray and
excessive film thicknesses, which especially may be encountered at manual spray
application.
Micro climate:
Page 2 of 3
Application Instructions
Curing time:
Recoating interval:
Recoating procedure:
Remove oil and grease, dirt, etc. with suitable detergent followed by fresh water
hosing. Remove weld spatters. Damaged areas, burns, etc. to be cleaned by rotary wire
brushing, by disc grinding, by abrasive sweeping, or by abrasive blasting according to
specification and touch up with the primer of the coating system proper. In case of
"white rust" on intact surfaces, it is recommended to clean by fresh water hosing and
scrubbing with stiff brushes.
It is risky to make a general cleaning of the exposed surface by grinding, and especially
by wire-brushing as this process easily tends to give a smooth, polished surface to
which the adhesion of following coats usually will be reduced.
In any case abrasive grit sweep the entire surface if the subsequent coat is GALVOSIL
15700 or similar, or if the shopprimer is polished (smooth) and the following paint
system will be exposed to aggressive environments during service.
Especially if the paint system will be exposed to heavy wear - for instance a MULTISTRENGTH-system - a very thorough abrasive grit sweeping is recommended, in severe
cases a full reblasting.
Removal of dust is mandatory before recoating.
Safety:
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
ISSUED:
Page 3 of 3
Application Instructions
Product Data
HEMPELS ZINC PRIMER 16490
Description:
Recommended use:
Service temperatures:
Certificates/Approvals:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Surface dry:
Dry to touch:
V.O.C.:
Metal grey/19840
Flat
33 1
9.4 m/litre - 35 micron
378 sq.ft./US gallon - 1.4 mils
7C/45F
1.7 kg/litre - 14.2 lbs/US gallon
15 (app) minutes at 20C/68F (ISO 1517)
30 (app) minutes at 20C/68F
595 g/litre - 5.0 lbs/US gallon
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Application method:
Thinner (max. vol.):
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Airless spray
Brush
08450 (5%)
08450 (5%)
.019"-.021"
200 bar/2900 psi
(Airless spray data are indicative and subject to adjustment)
THINNER 08450 or HEMPEL'S TOOL CLEANER 99610
35 micron/1.4 mils
100 micron/4 mils
30 minutes (20C/68F)
None (See REMARKS overleaf)
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
New steel: Abrasive blasting to minimum Sa 2 with a surface profile corresponding to Rugotest
No. 3, N9a to N10, preferably BN9a to BN10, Keane-Tator Comparator, 2.0 G/S or ISO
Comparator, Medium (G).
Repair of galvanized steel or zinc-rich coating: Remove oil and grease, etc. with suitable
detergent. Remove salts and others contaminants by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning.
Remove rust and loose material by abrasive blasting or power tool cleaning (avoid burnishing the
surface). Dust off residues.
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
The surface must be completely clean and dry at the time of application and its temperature must
be above the dew point to avoid condensation.
Tolerates low temperature application which, however, will increase drying time. At the freezing
point and below be aware of the risk of ice on the surface, which will hinder the adhesion.
In confined spaces provide adequate ventilation during application and drying.
PRECEDING
COAT:
None.
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
REMARKS:
VOC - EU directive
2004/42/EC:
VOC:
Film thicknesses:
Recoating:
As supplied
5 vol. % thinning
Limit phase I, 2007
VOC in g/l
595
600
600
For VOC of other shades, please refer to Safety Data Sheet.
Note: Due to a risk of corrosion from possible moisture penetration, many experts advise against
the use of zinc primers behind high temperature insulation.
May be specified in another film thickness than indicated depending on purpose and area of use.
Normal range is 25-35 micron/1.0-1.4 mils.
If the coating has been exposed to the atmosphere for some time, the surface should be
thoroughly hosed down and scrubbed with a stiff brush to remove white rust (zinc corrosion
products) in addition to the usual cleaning for dirt, oil, grease, etc. Allow surface to dry before
recoating.
When overcoated, the entire paint system must be through dry and fully cured before full
mechanical strength is obtained.
Care should be taken to avoid water contamination in the cans to prevent gelling or gassing.
Note:
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPELS SILICONE ZINC 16900
Description:
HEMPELS SILICONE ZINC 16900 is a heat resistant zinc pigmented silicone primer.
It is air drying at ambient temperature and resists temperatures up to 400C/750F.
(See REMARKS overleaf)
Recommended use:
Service temperatures:
Certificates/Approvals:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Surface dry:
Dry to touch:
V.O.C.:
Metal grey/19840
Flat
54 1
13.5 m itre - 40 micron
541 sq.ft./US gallon - 1.6 mil
25C/77F
2.6 kg/litre - 21.7 lbs/US gallon
1 (approx.) hours at 20C/68F (ISO 1517)
2-3 hours at 20C/68F
415 g/litre - 3.5 lbs/US gallon
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Application method:
Thinner (max.vol.):
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Airless spray
Air spray
Brush
08080 (5%)
08080 (15%)
08080 (5%)
.017"
125 bar/1800 psi
(Airless spray data are indicative and subject to adjustments)
THINNER 08080
40 micron/1.6 mil
75 micron/3 mils
24 hours (20C/68F)
(See REMARKS overleaf)
None (See REMARKS overleaf)
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
Remove oil and grease etc. thoroughly with suitable detergent. Remove salts and other
contaminants by high pressure fresh water cleaning.
Abrasive blasting to Sa 2. If shopprimer is required, only zinc silicate type is recommended.
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
Clean and dry surface with a temperature above the dew point to avoid condensation. In confined
spaces provide adequate ventilation during application and drying.
PRECEDING
COAT:
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
REMARKS:
VOC - EU directive
2004/42/EC:
VOC:
As supplied
15 vol. % thinning Limit phase I, 2007
VOC in g/l
415
475
600
For VOC of other shades, please refer to Safety Data Sheet.
Note: If used as anticorrosive protection under insulation of high temperature equipment it is very
important that NO moisture can penetrate during slow-down periods. This to avoid risk of "wet
corrosion" when the temperature rises.
Thermoplasticity:
Film thicknesses:
High temperature
service:
First exposure
to heat:
Curing:
Recoating:
Note:
ISSUED BY:
This
Product Data
Data Sheet
Sheet supersedes
supersedes those
This Product
thosepreviously
previouslyissued.
issued.
For
explanations, definitions
For explanations,
definitionsand
andscope,
scope,see
seeExplanatory
ExplanatoryNotes
Notesininthe
theHEMPEL
HEMPELBook.
Book.
Data,
specifications,
directions
and
recommendations
given
represent
only
test
results
or or
Data, specifications, directions and recommendations givenininthis
thisdata
datasheet
sheet
represent
only
test
results
experience
obtained
under
controlled
or
specially
defined
circumstances.
Their
accuracy,
completeness
or or
experience obtained under controlled or specially defined circumstances. Their accuracy,
completeness
appropriateness
ofof
the
Products
herein
must
bebe
determined
appropriatenessunder
underthe
theactual
actualconditions
conditionsofofany
anyintended
intendeduse
use
the
Products
herein
must
determined
exclusively
the Buyer
Buyer and/or
and/or User.
exclusively by
by the
User.
The
Products are
are supplied
toto
HEMPEL's
OF
The Products
supplied and
and all
alltechnical
technicalassistance
assistanceisisgiven
givensubject
subject
HEMPEL'sGENERAL
GENERALCONDITIONS
CONDITIONS OF
SALES,
DELIVERYAND
ANDSERVICE,
SERVICE,
unless
otherwise
expresslyagreed
agreedininwriting.
writing.The
The
Manufacturerand
andSeller
Seller
SALES, DELIVERY
unless
otherwise
expressly
Manufacturer
disclaim,
disclaim, and
and Buyer
Buyer and/or
and/orUser
Userwaive
waive all
allclaims
claimsinvolving,
involving,any
anyliability,
liability,including
includingbut
butnot
notlimited
limitedtotonegligence,
negligence,
except as
forall
all results,
results, injury
injury or
or direct
direct or
or consequential
consequential losses
except
as expressed
expressed in
in said
saidGENERAL
GENERAL CONDITIONS
CONDITIONS for
lossesor
or
damages
arising
from
the
use
of
the
Products
as
recommended
above,
on
the
overleaf
or
otherwise.
damages arising from the use of the Products as recommended above, on the overleaf or otherwise.
Product data are subject to change without notice and become void five years from the date of issue.
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPADUR ZINC 17340
BASE 17349 with CURING AGENT 97040
Description:
HEMPADUR ZINC 17340 is a two-component zinc rich epoxy paint. It cures to a strong
and corrosion resistant coating.
Recommended use:
1.
2.
Certificates/Approvals:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Surface dry:
Dry to touch:
Fully cured:
V.O.C.:
Red-grey/19830
Semi-flat
66 1
13.2 m/litre - 50 micron
529 sq.ft./US gallon - 2 mils
30C/86F
2.3 kg/litre - 19.2 lbs/US gallon
2 (approx.) hrs at 20C/68F (ISO 1517)
3 (approx.) hours at 20C/68F
7 days at 20C/68F
330 g/litre - 2.8 lbs/US gallon
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Mixing ratio for 17340:
Application method:
Thinner (max.vol.):
Pot life:
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
APPLICATION :
CONDITIONS
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
REMARKS:
VOC - EU directive
2004/42/EC:
VOC:
Recoating:
New steel: Remove oil and grease, etc. with suitable detergent. Remove salt and other
contaminants by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning. Abrasive blasting to Sa 2.
For temporary protection, if required, use suitable zinc shopprimer. All damage of shopprimer and
contamination from storage and fabrication should be thoroughly cleaned prior to final painting. For
repair and touch-up use HEMPADUR ZINC 17340.
Maintenance: Remove oil and grease etc. with suitable detergent. Remove salt and other
contaminants by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning. Remove all rust and loose material
preferably by dry abrasive blasting. Minor areas may be power tool cleaned.
Use only where application and curing can proceed at temperatures above -10C/14F.
At the freezing point and below be aware of ice on the surface, which will hinder the adhesion.
The temperature of the paint itself should be 15C/60F or above to secure proper application
properties. In confined spaces provide adequate ventilation during application and drying.
Apply only on a dry and clean surface with a temperature above the dew point to avoid
condensation.
According to specification.
As supplied
15 vol. % thinning Limit phase I, 2007 Limit phase II, 2010
VOC in g/l
330
400
550
500
For VOC of other shades, please refer to Safety Data Sheet.
Note: If used as anticorrosive protection under insulation of high temperature equipment it is very
important that NO moisture can penetrate during slow-down periods. This to avoid risk of "wet
corrosion" when the temperature rises.
May be specified in another film thickness than indicated depending on purpose and area of use.
This will alter spreading rate and may influence drying time and recoating interval. Normal range is
50-75 micron/2-3 mils.
(The dry film thickness range does not take into account the correction factors for rough surfaces
as listed in ISO 19840).
Recoating intervals, 50 micron/1 mil dry film thickness for HEMPADUR ZINC 17340:
Surface temperature
Recoated with
(Quality numbers only)
58030
46410. 46370
HEMPADUR
HEMPATHANE
Minimum
Maximum
20C/68F
20C/68F
Atmospheric
Atmospheric
As a container
coating
30 minutes
30 minutes
30 minutes
30 minutes
As a general
protective coating
1 hour
1 hour
4 hours
Not relevant
8 hours
5 hours
30 days*
3 days
* If the coating has been subjected to direct sunlight for a short period only, the maximum recoating interval
may be prolonged.
Note:
Before recoating after exposure in contaminated environment, clean the surface thoroughly by
(high pressure) fresh water hosing and allow to dry.
If the maximum recoating interval is exceeded, roughening of the surface is necessary to ensure
intercoat adhesion.
A completely clean surface is mandatory to ensure intercoat adhesion, especially at long recoating
intervals. Any dirt, oil, grease, and other foreign matter must be removed with suitable detergent
followed by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning. In addition, scrubbing with a stiff brush may be
necessary to remove zinc corrosion products (white rust).
HEMPADUR ZINC 17340 is for professional use only.
ISSUED BY:
This
Product Data
Data Sheet
Sheet supersedes
supersedes those
This Product
thosepreviously
previouslyissued.
issued.
For
explanations, definitions
For explanations,
definitionsand
andscope,
scope,see
seeExplanatory
ExplanatoryNotes
Notesininthe
theHEMPEL
HEMPELBook.
Book.
Data,
specifications,
directions
and
recommendations
given
represent
only
test
results
or or
Data, specifications, directions and recommendations givenininthis
thisdata
datasheet
sheet
represent
only
test
results
experience
obtained
under
controlled
or
specially
defined
circumstances.
Their
accuracy,
completeness
or or
experience obtained under controlled or specially defined circumstances. Their accuracy,
completeness
appropriateness
ofof
the
Products
herein
must
bebe
determined
appropriatenessunder
underthe
theactual
actualconditions
conditionsofofany
anyintended
intendeduse
use
the
Products
herein
must
determined
exclusively
the Buyer
Buyer and/or
and/or User.
exclusively by
by the
User.
The
Products are
are supplied
toto
HEMPEL's
OF
The Products
supplied and
and all
alltechnical
technicalassistance
assistanceisisgiven
givensubject
subject
HEMPEL'sGENERAL
GENERALCONDITIONS
CONDITIONS OF
SALES,
DELIVERYAND
ANDSERVICE,
SERVICE,
unless
otherwise
expresslyagreed
agreedininwriting.
writing.The
The
Manufacturerand
andSeller
Seller
SALES, DELIVERY
unless
otherwise
expressly
Manufacturer
disclaim, and
disclaim,
and Buyer
Buyer and/or
and/orUser
Userwaive
waive all
allclaims
claimsinvolving,
involving,any
anyliability,
liability,including
includingbut
butnot
notlimited
limitedtotonegligence,
negligence,
except as
forall
all results,
results, injury
injury or
or direct
direct or
or consequential
consequential losses
except
as expressed
expressed in
in said
saidGENERAL
GENERAL CONDITIONS
CONDITIONS for
lossesor
or
damages
arising
from
the
use
of
the
Products
as
recommended
above,
on
the
overleaf
or
otherwise.
damages arising from the use of the Products as recommended above, on the overleaf or otherwise.
Product data are subject to change without notice and become void five years from the date of issue.
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPADUR ZINC 17360
BASE 17369 with CURING AGENT 97040
Description:
HEMPADUR ZINC 17360 is a two-component, zinc rich epoxy primer. It cures to a hard
wearing and highly weather-resistant coating. Offers cathodic protection of local
mechanical damage.
Recommended use:
As a "V.O.C.-compliant", versatile, long-term primer on steel for epoxy, vinyl and acrylic
coating systems in medium to severely corrosive environments.
In compliance with SSPC-Paint 20, type 2, level 2 and ISO 12944-5.
Service temperatures:
Certificates/Approvals:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Surface dry:
Dry to touch:
Fully cured:
V.O.C.:
Red-grey/19830
Flat
65 1
13.0 m/litre - 50 micron
521 sq.ft./US gallon - 2 mils
24C/75F
2.8 kg/litre - 23.4 lbs/US gallon
(approx.) hour at 20C/68F (ISO 1517)
1 (approx.) hour at 20C/68F
7 days at 20C/68F
345 g/litre - 2.9 lbs/US gallon
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1..
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Mixing ratio for 17360:
Application method:
Thinner (max.vol.):
Pot life:
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
Remove oil and grease thoroughly with suitable detergent. Remove salt and other contaminants
by high pressure fresh water cleaning.
Abrasive blasting to Sa 2 with a sharp-edged surface profile corresponding to Rugotest No. 3,
BN9a, Keane-Tator Comparator, 2.0 G/S, 2 S, or ISO Comparator, Medium (G).
APPLICATION
Use only where application and curing can proceed at temperatures above -10C/15F. The
CONDITIONS:
temperature of the surface must also be above this limit. The paint itself should be 15C/59F or
above. Apply only on a dry and clean surface with a temperature above the dew point to avoid
condensation.
In confined spaces provide adequate ventilation during application and drying.
SUBSEQUENT COAT: As listed below in accordance with specification.
REMARKS:
VOC - EU directive
2004/42/EC:
VOC:
Weathering/
service
temperatures:
Film thicknesses:
Stirring:
Recoating:
As supplied
15 vol. % thinning Limit phase I, 2007 Limit phase II, 2010
VOC in g/l
345
410
550
500
For VOC of other shades, please refer to Safety Data Sheet.
Note: If used as anticorrosive protection under insulation of high temperature equipment it is very
important that NO moisture can penetrate during slow-down periods. This to avoid risk of "wet
corrosion" when the temperature rises.
The natural tendency of epoxy coatings to chalk in outdoor exposure and to become more
sensitive to mechanical damage and chemical exposure at elevated temperatures is also
reflected in this product.
May be specified in another film thickness than indicated depending on purpose and area of use.
Most typical range is 40-50 micron/1.6-2 mils, but thicknesses down to 15 micron/0.6 mils (extra
thinning) and up to 80 micron/3.2 mils may be possible. This will alter spreading rate and may
influence amount of thinning necessary, drying time, and recoating interval.
(The dry film thickness range does not take into account the correction factors for rough surfaces
as listed in ISO 19840).
Before mixing with the curing agent stir the base thoroughly in order to redisperse any possible
settling after storage. After mixing it is equally important to maintain stirring to keep the wet paint
as a homogeneous mixture.
This is specifically important in case of a high level of thinning and/or long break in application,
where the risk of settlement of zinc particles is the highest.
Recoating intervals, 50 micron dry film thickness for HEMPADUR ZINC 17360:
Minimum
Surface temperature
Maximum
20C/68F
Atmospheric
Water immersion**
20C/68F
Atmospheric
Water immersion**
Recoated with
(Quality numbers only)
Medium
Severe
Medium
Severe
Not relevant
8 hours
12 hours
Not relevant
1 hour
30 minutes
58030
Not relevant
5 hours
8 hours
Not relevant
1 hour
30 minutes
46410. 46370
Not relevant
8 hours
12 hours
Not relevant
1 hour
30 minutes
46330
30 days*
30 days*
None
4 hours
4 hours
2 hours
17630
Not relevant
30 days*
None
Not relevant
4 hours
2 hours
45880
* Depending on actual local conditions, extended maximum recoating intervals may apply.
Please contact HEMPEL for further advice.
** Water immersion service is only recommended if HEMPADUR ZINC 17360 is applied in maximum 30-40 micron/1.2-1.6
mils and recoated with en epoxy coating system in 250-300 micron/10-12 mils.
Note:
ISSUED BY:
If the maximum recoating interval is exceeded, roughening of the surface is necessary to ensure
intercoat adhesion.
Before recoating after exposure in contaminated environment, clean the surface thoroughly by high
pressure fresh water hosing and allow drying. In addition, scrubbing with a stiff brush may be
necessary to remove zinc corrosion products (white rust).
HEMPADUR ZINC 17360 is for professional use only.
HEMPEL A/S - 1736019830CO008
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPADUR 17630/
HEMPADUR 17633
17630: BASE 17639 with CURING AGENT 97330
17633: BASE 17639 with CURING AGENT 98420
Description:
Recommended use:
As a selfprimed coating for ballast water tanks and similar. As a primer for epoxy
systems for atmospheric or in-water service, eg ship hulls. Suitable for application down
to -10C/ 15F.
HEMPADUR 17633 is intended for use in cold/temperate climates, HEMPADUR 17630
is intended for use in temperate to warm climates.
Service temperatures:
Certificates/Approvals:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Version; mixed product:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Dry to touch:
Fully cured:
V.O.C.:
17630
Grey/12170 - Red/50630
Semi-flat
69 1
4.6 m/litre - 150 micron
184 sq.ft./S gallon - 6 mils
32C/90F
1.4 kg/litre - 11.7 lbs/US gallon
7-8 hours at 20C/68F
7 days at 20C/68F
310 g/litre - 2.6 lbs/US gallon
17633
Grey/12170 - Red/50630
Semi-flat
69 1
4.6 m/litre - 150 micron
184 sq.ft./S gallon - 6 mils
32C/90F
1.4 kg/litre - 11.7 lbs/US gallon
16 hours (app.) at 5C/41F
20 days at 5C/41F
305 g/litre - 2.5 lbs/US gallon
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1..
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Mixing ratio:
Application method:
Thinner (max.vol.):
Pot life:
Induction time:
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
17630
Base 17639 : Curing agent 97330
4 : 1 parts by volume
Airless spray
Brush
08450 (5%)
08450 (5%)
2 hours (20C/68F)
17633
Base 17639 : Curing agent 98420
4 : 1 parts by volume
Airless spray
Brush
08450 (5%)
08450 (5%)
2 hours (20C/68F)
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
HEMPADUR 17630/17633
SURFACE
PREPARATION:
New steel: Remove oil and grease, etc. with suitable detergent. Remove salt and other
contaminants by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning. Abrasive blasting to Sa 2. For temporary
protection, if required, use a suitable shopprimer. All damage of shopprimer and contamination
from storage and fabrication should be thoroughly cleaned prior to final painting. For repair and
touch up, use HEMPADUR 17630.
Ballast tanks: For PSPC type approved coating, consult separate APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS BALLAST TANKS for HEMPADUR 17630.
Repair and maintenance: Remove oil and grease, etc. with suitable detergent. Remove salt and
other contaminants by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning. Clean damaged areas thoroughly by
power tool cleaning to St 3 (minor areas) or by abrasive blasting to min. Sa 2, preferably to Sa 2.
Improved surface preparation will improve the performance of HEMPADUR 17630/17633.
As an alternative to dry cleaning, water jetting to sound, well adhering coat and/or to steel. Intact
coat must appear with roughened surface after the water jetting. By water jetting to steel,
cleanliness shall be Wa 2 - WA 2 (atmospheric exposure) / minimum Wa 2 (immersion) (ISO
8501-4:2006). A flash-rust degree of maximum M (atmospheric exposure) / M, preferably L
(immersion) (ISO 8501-4:2006) is acceptable before application. Feather edges to sound and
intact paint. Dust off residues. Touch up to full film thickness.
On pit-corroded surfaces, excessive amounts of salt residues may call for water jetting or wet
abrasive blasting, alternatively dry abrasive blasting followed by high pressure fresh water hosing,
drying, and finally, dry abrasive blasting again.
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
Use only where application and curing can proceed at temperatures above -10C/14F (curing
agent 98420) and 0C/32F (curing agent 97330). The temperature of the paint itself should be
above 15C/59F for proper application. Apply only on a dry and clean surface with a temperature
above the dew point to avoid condensation.
In confined spaces provide adequate ventilation during application and drying.
None or according to specification.
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
REMARKS:
VOC - EU directive
2004/42/EC:
VOC:
17630
5 vol. % thinning
Limit phase I, 2007
VOC in g/l
335
550
17633
As supplied
5 vol. % thinning
Limit phase I, 2007
VOC in g/l
305
330
550
For VOC of other shades, please refer to Safety Data Sheet.
As supplied
310
The natural tendency of epoxy coatings to chalk in outdoor exposure and to become more
sensitive to mechanical damage and chemical exposure at elevated temperatures is also
reflected in this product.
May be specified in another film thickness than indicated depending on purpose and area of use.
This will alter spreading rate and may influence drying time and recoating interval. Normal range
dry is 125-200 micron/5-8 mils.
Curing agent 98420 is hazy. This is intended and has no negative influence on the performance.
To facilitate proper application properties it is recommended to allow the thoroughly mixed BASE
and CURING AGENT to prereact before application. In case two-component spray-equipment is
used consult separate APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS.
Note:
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Application
Application Instructions
Instructions
For product description refer to product data sheet
HEMPADUR 17630/
HEMPADUR 17633
Medium to high temperatures: 17630 with CURING AGENT 97330
Low to medium temperatures: 17633 with CURING AGENT 98420
Scope:
Abrasive blasting/
abrasive sweep blasting:
Before blasting any deposits of grease or oil must be removed from the steel surface
with a suitable detergent followed by fresh water hosing. Minor spots of oil/grease may
be cleaned with thinner and clean rags - avoid smearing out the contamination. Possible
alkali weld deposits, chemicals used for testing of welds, soap residues from the
pressure testing must be removed by fresh water hosing.
Repair:
Before blasting, old steel surfaces must be checked for any contamination. Possible
blisters must be broken. If thick rust scale has been removed or deep pittings have
been encountered, control procedures for contamination must be carried out. If still
contaminated, the abrasive blast cleaned steel surface will need a repeated cleaning
for salts and/or oil/grease followed by final abrasive blast cleaning.
Newbuilding/new steelwork: To obtain full performance of the ballast tank coating,
welds, burns, damaged and rusty shopprimer must be abrasive blast cleaned to Sa 2.
Minor areas mechanically cleaned to St 3.
If welds have previously been coated with a (shop)primer just after welding this
(shop)primer must be removed by abrasive blasting (sweeping) in order to obtain
optimum performance.
Intact shopprimer:
Zinc salted surfaces, deposits of black iron oxides of plasma cutting and similar foreign
matters to be removed by light abrasive sweep blasting. Chalk markings and plate
marking of a non-compatible nature to be removed as well.
The shopprimer must have been checked randomly for excessive film thicknesses and
areas detected to have film thicknesses above approx 40 micron/1.6 mils (as
measured directly on the shopprimed surface with equipment calibrated on smooth
steel) are to be sweep blasted in order to remove most of the shopprimer.
Page 1 of 5
HEMPEL
HEMPEL
Application
Instructions
Application Instructions
HEMPADUR 17630/17633
Spot-checking for possible salt contamination of the surface to be executed before and
after abrasive sweep blasting.
When blasting, the importance of working systematically must be stressed. Poorly
blasted areas covered with dust are very difficult to locate during the blast inspection
made after the rough cleaning.
In the case of abrasive blast cleaning, the surface profile must be equivalent to
Rugotest No. 3, BN9-BN10 or Keane-Tator Comparator, 3.0 G/S. According to ISO
8503-1 the grade will be MEDIUM (G).
Note: If any doubt exists about the quality of the primary surface preparation (before
shoppriming), the substrate must be re-blasted in situ as defined above.
Block assembly zones: Overlap zones must be treated with great care. Damage caused
by possible over-blasting must be avoided, paint edges must be feathered and
consecutive layers of paint coatings given greater and greater overlaps - old layers
being roughened corresponding to these overlaps (when sand papering, use free-cut
paper, grain size 80).
Furthermore, these areas may be either masked off with tape - to keep them as narrow
as possible - or left with a thin zinc epoxy primer coat applied on these areas after
secondary surface preparation at blockstage.
Secondary surface preparation of block assembly zones are preferably to be abrasive
spot-blasted. However, mechanical cleaning to St 3 may be acceptable if zones are
narrow and an extra coat of HEMPADUR 17630/17633 is applied to these areas. The
procedure of masking off with tape or using the zinc epoxy primer as described above
may advantageously be used in case of mechanical cleaning.
Repair:
Corroded pits deeper than approx 2 mm, but not repaired by welding, are recommended
to be filled with HEMPADUR EPOXY FILLER 35250 after blast priming has been carried
out.
Stainless Steel: (Ballast tanks of chemical carriers) to be abrasive blast cleaned to a
uniform, sharp, dense, profile (Rugotest No. 3, BN9-10, ISO Comparator Medium (G),
Keane-Tator Comparator 2.0 G/S corresponding to Rz minimum 50 micron). Any salts,
grease, oil etc. to be removed before abrasive blasting is commenced.
Water jetting:
This procedure will primarily be relevant for repair jobs. However, the very good removal
of water-soluble salts may also make it useful in other cases.
The resulting standard is to be equal to the Wa 2 (ISO 8501-4:2006).
Sufficient dehumidification equipment must be used to dry out the tanks as quickly as
possible between the water jetting and the coating application.
Local ventilators may be required to distribute the drying air evenly in tanks. All "slurry"
is to be removed before it dries. New rust will be acceptable as discoloration only, not
as powdery, loose rust. Acceptable degree of flash rust is maximum M (ISO 85014:2006). Inhibitors are not to be used.
All surfaces must be free from contamination at the time of painting and the relative
humidity is to be below 85%.
Refurbishment:
Page 2 of 5
Application Instructions
HEMPADUR 17630/17633
In the case of contamination, cleaning procedures must be repeated and/or improved.
Especially pit-corroded steel will need special attention and the only possible way to
remove contamination from the pits may often be to carry out very thorough cleaning
with fresh water after abrasive blast cleaning. After repeated control and drying, the
entire surface will need abrasive blast cleaning to obtain the specified degree of
cleaning. Alternatively, the pit-corroded areas are cleaned by water jetting, any surplus
of water is mopped up or removed by vacuum cleaning, allow to dry.
Note: Actual type of steel work and surface preparation is dependent on factors such
a shipyard technology, contractual specification, required lifetime, etc. Reference is
also made to HEMPELs Technical Standard for Ballast Tank Coating Work.
Application equipment:
min 45:1
12 litres/minute (theoretical)
min. 6 bar/90 psi
max. 100 metres/300 feet, internal diameter
max. 30 metres/100 feet, 3/8" internal diameter
max. 6 metres/20 feet, 1/4" internal diameter
60 mesh
Nozzle size:
Fan angle:
.021"-.025
60-80.
Page 3 of 5
Application Instructions
HEMPADUR 17630/17633
Application on
zinc silicate:
Pot life/mixing/
induction time:
(both curing agents):
When measured under standard conditions the pot life is 3 hours at 15C/59F and 2
hours at 20C/68F. However, for a 20 litres/5 US gallons mix, the heat developed by
the chemical reaction between BASE and CURING AGENT may make the corresponding
practical pot life shorter.
a.
Mix the entire content of corresponding base and curing agent packing. If it is
necessary to mix smaller portions, this must be done properly by either weighing
base and curing agent in the prescribed weight ratio: 86 parts by weight of base
and 14 parts by weight of curing agent or by volume: 4.0 parts by volume base and
1.0 parts by volume curing agent.
b.
Stir the mixed paint thoroughly by means of a clean mechanical mixer until a
homogeneous mixture is obtained.
c.
Use all mixed paint before the pot life is exceeded. The pot life depends on the
temperature of the paint as shown in table below (valid for a 20 litres can):
15C/59F1)
20C/68F
25C/77F
30C/86F2)
3 hours
2 hours
1 hours
1 hour
Pot life
1)
2)
At 15C/59F and below, the viscosity can be too high for airless spray application.
Temperatures above 30C/86F should preferably be avoided.
Induction time:
At steel temperatures below 5C/41F the paint may advantageously be prereacted 1020 minutes before spray application (longer pre-reaction time at lower temperatures).
When two-component spray equipment is used, heating may be relevant to obtain a
proper spray fan and a uniform and smooth paint film. This can either be done by
preheating the two-component paint or by using a flow-heater on the pressure side. As
an indication, a paint temperature of approx 40C/104F will be relevant, but has to be
adjusted according to the actual conditions.
Physical data
versus temperature:
0C/32F
10C/50F
20C/68F
30C/86F
Drying time
Curing time
32 hours
28 days
14 hours
14 days
7 hours
7 days
5 hours
3 days
Initial curing*
20 days
10 days
5 days
2 days
45 hours
56 days
23 hours
28 days
10 hours
14 days
Initial curing*
40 days
20 days
10 days
* When the state "initial curing" has been reached, the coating may exceptionally be exposed
to ballast water provided it has been applied within the specified limits of film thicknesses
and that all painted areas have been subject to thorough ventilation.
Page 4 of 5
Application Instructions
HEMPADUR 17630/17633
Recoating:
10C/50F
20C/68F
Recoated with:
(quality no. only)
Itself (ballast
tanks)**
45182
16 hours
8 hours
16 hours
8 hours
17633
Maximum
10C/50
Minimum
Maximum
20C/68F
-10C/14F
0C/32F
-10C/14F
0C/32F
90 days*
30 days*
3 days
36 hours
(90 days)*
90 days*
90 days
30 days
3 days
36 hours
(90 days)
90 days
Depending on actual local conditions, extended maximum recoating intervals may apply. Please contact
HEMPEL for further advice.
** Stripe coat can be applied when it is possible to walk on the surface without damage to the coating.
To check whether the quality of the surface cleaning is adequate, a test patch may be
relevant
Safety:
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
ISSUED BY:
Page 5 of 5
Application Instructions
Application Instructions
BALLAST TANKS
Application Instructions
HEMPADUR 17630
17630: BASE 17639 with CURING AGENT 97330
Scope:
The steel shall preferably be Rust Grade A or B according to ISO 8501-1:2007. The use
of steel with Rust Grade C requires more tight inspection of surface profile after blasting as well as of possible salt contamination. Rust grade D is not should not be used
for ballast tanks.
The steel surface shall be prepared so that the coating achieves an even distribution at
the specified nominal dry film thickness of 320 micron and has an adequate adhesion
by removing sharp edges, grinding weld beads and removing weld spatter and any other
surface contamination. PSPC makes reference to ISO 8501-3: Preparation of steel
substrates before application of paints and related products - Visual assessment of surface cleanliness.
For optimum performance the following is recommended: All welding seams shall be
partially dressed to remove irregular profiles.
Surface pores, pits and craters shall be sufficiently open to allow penetration of the
paint.
Sharp edges shall be treated to a rounded radius of minimum 2 mm, subjected to a
three-pass grinding or treated with an equivalent process that produces an edge profile
that results in a dry film thickness retention equivalent to or better than that of three
pass grinding. Sharp edge means all edges except natural rounded/rolled edges of sections or profiled steel bars.
Visible roll overs/laminations shall be removed.
The surface shall be free of all welding spatter.
Abrasive blasting/
abrasive sweep blasting:
The coating system shall only be applied on steel primed with a pre-qualified zinc containing inhibitor free zinc silicate shopprimer according to PSPC, Table 1.2.1-3. Steel
shopprimed with a shopprimer not pre-qualified must be abrasive blast cleaned to Sa 2
removing at least 70% of intact shopprimer, while steel, which has not been
shopprimed must be blasted to Sa 2.
Before blasting any deposits of grease or oil must be removed from the steel surface
using a suitable detergent followed by fresh water hosing. Minor spots of oil/grease
may be cleaned with thinner and clean rags - avoid smearing out the contamination.
Possible alkali weld deposits, chemicals used for testing of welds, soap residues from
the pressure testing must be removed by fresh water hosing.
The shopprimer must have been checked randomly for excessive film thickness. Areas
detected to have film thicknesses above approx 40 micron/1.6 mils (as measured directly on the shopprimed surface with equipment calibrated on smooth steel) are to be
blasted to Sa 2 removing at least 70% of the shopprimer.
Welds as well as shopprimed areas with damage, burn marks and rust must be blasted
to Sa 2.
Surfaces with zinc salts, deposits of black iron oxides from plasma cutting, markings
and similar foreign matters shall be cleaned by light abrasive sweep blasting.
Page 1 of 5
HEMPEL
Application Instructions
Application Instructions
BALLAST
BALLAST TANKS
TANKS
Application Instructions
HEMPADUR 17630
Welds coated with a temporary (shop)primer after welding must be cleaned by hard
abrasive sweeping, preferably abrasive blasting.
Spot-checks for possible salt contamination of the surface must be executed after secondary surface preparation. The upper water soluble salts limit is 50 mg/m sodium
chloride equivalents when measured according to ISO 8502-9:1998. To limit salt contamination from abrasives it is recommended to use abrasives showing a water-soluble
contaminant level equivalent to less than 25 mS/m according to ISO 11127-6:1993.
When blasting, the importance of working systematically must be stressed. Poorly
blasted areas covered with dust are very difficult to locate during the blast inspection
made after the rough cleaning.
In the case of full or partial abrasive blast cleaning, the surface profile must be 40-75
micron/1.6-3.0 mils approximately equivalent to Rugotest No. 3, BN9-BN10 or KeaneTator Comparator, 3.0 G/S or to ISO 8503-1, grade Medium (G).
Dust must be removed just before application of the paint to a dust quantity rating 1
for dust size class 3, 4 or 5. Lower dust size classes shall be removed from the
surface if visible without magnification.
Note: If any doubt exists about the quality of the primary surface preparation (before
shoppriming), the substrate must be re-blasted in situ as defined above.
Block assembly zones: Overlap zones must be treated with great care. Damage caused
by possible over-blasting must be avoided, paint edges must be feathered and consecutive layers of paint coatings given larger and larger overlaps. Roughening must be carried out when the maximum recoating interval is exceeded (when sand papering, use
free-cut paper, grain size 80).
Furthermore, these areas may be either masked off with tape - to keep them as narrow
as possible. Application of a thin zinc epoxy primer coat on these areas after secondary
surface preparation at block stage is acceptable if removed before the application of
HEMPADUR 17630.
Secondary surface preparation of block assembly zones is preferably abrasive spotblasting. However, mechanical cleaning to St 3 may be acceptable if zones are narrow
and an extra coat of HEMPADUR 17630 is applied to these areas. The procedure of
masking off with tape or using the zinc epoxy primer as described above may advantageously be used in case of mechanical cleaning.
Stainless steel: (Ballast tanks of chemical carriers) To be abrasive blast cleaned to a
uniform, sharp, dense, profile (Rugotest No. 3, BN9-10, ISO Comparator Medium (G),
Keane-Tator Comparator 2.0 G/S corresponding to Rz minimum 50 micron). Any salts,
grease, oil etc. shall be removed before abrasive blasting is commenced. Surface
preparation and paint application to be carried out concurrently with treatment of surrounding carbon steel.
Application equipment:
HEMPADUR 17630, being a high viscosity material, may require special measures to be
taken at application.
Recommended airless spray equipment:
Pump ratio:
Pump output:
Input pressure:
Spray hoses:
Issued:
2007
Issued: September
December 2007
Filter:
min 45:1
12 litres/minute (theoretical)
min. 6 bar/90 psi
max. 100 metres/300 feet, internal diameter
max. 30 metres/100 feet, 3/8" internal diameter
max. 6 metres/20 feet, 1/4" internal diameter
60 mesh
Nozzle size:
Fan angle:
.021"-.025
60-80.
Page
Page 22 of
of 55
Application Instructions
Application Instructions
BALLAST
BALLAST TANKS
TANKS
Application Instructions
HEMPADUR 17630
PSPC requires the application of minimum two spray applied coatings and minimum two
stripe coats.
Spray application: A continuous, pinhole-free paint film must be obtained at application
of each spray applied coat. An application technique which will ensure good film formation on all surfaces must be adopted. It is very important to use nozzles of the correct
size, not too large, and to have a proper, uniform distance of the spray gun to the surface, 30-50 cm should be aimed at. Furthermore, great care must be taken to cover
edges, openings, rear sides of stiffeners etc. even though these areas also must be
stripe coated. To obtain good and steady atomising, the viscosity of the paint must be
suitable and the spray equipment must be sufficient in output pressure and capacity. At
high working temperatures, use of extra thinner may be necessary to avoid dust spray.
The paint layer must be applied homogeneously and as close to the specification as
possible. Care shall be taken to avoid exaggerated film thicknesses. Wet film thickness
shall be regularly checked during the application.
The finished coating must appear as a homogeneous film with a smooth surface and
irregularities such as dust, dry spray, abrasives, should be remedied.
Stripe coating: The required two stripe coats must each be applied as a coherent film
showing good film formation and no visible defects such as pores or un-wetted areas.
The application method must ensure that all areas which require stripe coating are
properly stripe coated by alternative application methods which include brush or roller.
Application by airless spray requires the use of relatively small, narrow-angled nozzles.
PSPC accepts that the second stripe coat, by way of welded seams only, may be reduced in scope where it is proven that the nominal dry film thickness (NDFT) can be met
by the coats applied. The first stripe coating should preferably be applied after first full
coat to avoid contamination of the steel substrate.
Pot life/mixing/
induction time:
Issued:
2007
Issued: September
December 2007
When measured under standard conditions the pot life is 3 hours at 15C/59F and 2
hours at 20C/68F. However, for a 20 litres/5 US gallons mix, the heat developed by
the chemical reaction between BASE and CURING AGENT may make the corresponding
practical pot life shorter.
a.
Mix the entire content of corresponding base and curing agent packing. If it is
necessary to mix smaller portions, this must be done properly by either weighing
base and curing agent in the prescribed weight ratio: 86 parts by weight of base
and 14 parts by weight of curing agent or by volume: 4.0 parts by volume base and
1.0 parts by volume curing agent.
b.
Stir the mixed paint thoroughly by means of a clean mechanical mixer until a
homogeneous mixture is obtained.
c.
Use all mixed paint before the pot life is exceeded. The pot life depends on the
temperature of the paint as shown in table below (valid for a 20 litres can):
Page
Page 33 of
of 55
Application Instructions
Application Instructions
BALLAST
BALLAST TANKS
TANKS
Application Instructions
HEMPADUR 17630
15C/59F1)
20C/68F
25C/77F
30C/86F2)
3 hours
2 hours
1 hours
1 hour
Pot life
1)
2)
At 15C/59F and below, the viscosity can be too high for airless spray application.
Temperatures above 30C/86F should preferably be avoided.
Induction time:
At steel temperatures below 5C/41F the paint may advantageously be prereacted 1020 minutes before spray application (longer prereaction time at lower steel temperatures).
Two-component spray equipment: Heating may be required to obtain a proper spray fan
and a uniform and smooth paint film. This can either be done by preheating the twocomponent paint or by using a flow-heater on the pressure side. As an indication, a
paint temperature of approx 40C/104F will be relevant, but has to be adjusted according to the actual conditions.
Dry film thickness:
PSPC requires that the nominal dry film thickness (NDFT) shall be 320 micron and
achieved by minimum two spray coats and two stripe coats. The dry film thickness distribution shall be evaluated according to the 90/10 rule.
Dry film thickness (DFT)
DFT
micron/mils
Remark
Minimum DFT
per coat
90/3.5
2,000/80
The maximum DFT is valid for isolated spots less than 1% of the total surface
area per tank. The stated maximum DFT is for guidance and should be kept as
close to the specified nominal DFT as possible. Frequent control of wet film
thickness during application is recommended
Maximum DFT
(complete coating system)
Physical data
versus temperature:
0C/32F
10C/50F
20C/68F
30C/86F
Drying time
Walk-on time
Curing time
32 hours
32 hours
28 days
14 hours
14 hours
14 days
7 hours
7 hours
7 days
5 hours
5 hours
3 days
Initial curing*
20 days
10 days
5 days
2 days
* When the state "initial curing" has been reached, the coating may exceptionally be exposed
to ballast water provided it has been applied within the specified limits of film thicknesses
and that all painted areas have been subject to thorough ventilation.
Recoating:
10C/50F
Minimum
20C/68F 30C/86F
40C/104F 10C/50F
Maximum
20C/68F 30C/86F
17 hours
9 hours
4 hours
30 days*
7 hours
60 days*
40C/104F
Depending on actual local conditions, extended maximum recoating intervals may apply. Please contact
HEMPEL for further advice.
** Stripe coat can be applied when it is possible to walk on the surface without damage to the coating.
Issued:
2007
Issued: September
December 2007
Page
Page 44 of
of 55
Application Instructions
Application Instructions
BALLAST
BALLAST TANKS
TANKS
Application Instructions
HEMPADUR 17630
Any degraded surface layer, as a result of a long exposure period, must be removed
as well. Water jetting may be relevant to remove any degraded surface layer and may
also replace the above-mentioned cleaning methods when properly executed. Consult HEMPEL for specific advice if in doubt.
To check whether the quality of the surface cleaning is adequate, a test patch may be
relevant.
8.2 Repair process
Safety:
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
ISSUED BY:
Page
Page 55 of
of 55
Application Instructions
Product Data
HEMUCRYL PRIMER HI-BUILD 18032
Description:
HEMUCRYL PRIMER HI-BUILD 18032 is a water-borne, acrylic dispersion paint with good
anticorrosive properties. Especially suited for application by airless spray.
Recommended use:
Service temperatures:
Certificates/Approvals:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Surface dry:
Dry to touch:
V.O.C.:
Grey/12170 - Red/50710
Flat
43 1
5.7 m/litre - 75 micron
230 sq.ft./US gallon - 3 mils
> 93C/199F
1.2 kg/litre - 10.0 lbs/US gallon
(approx.) hour at 20C/68F (ISO 1517)
1 (approx.) hour at 20C/68F
45 g/litre - 0.3 lbs/US gallon
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Application method:
Thinner (max. vol.):
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Airless spray
Brush (touch-up)
Fresh water (5%)
HEMUCRYL BRUSH AGENT 99810 (3-8%)
.015"-.019"
130 bar/1900 psi
(Airless spray data are indicative and subject to adjustment)
Fresh water (See REMARKS overleaf)
75 micron/3 mils (See REMARKS overleaf)
175 micron/7 mils
2 hours (20C/68F)
None (See REMARKS overleaf)
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
New steel: Remove oil and grease, etc. with suitable detergent. Remove salt and other
contaminants by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning. Abrasive blasting to minimum Sa 2. For
temporary protection, if required, use suitable shopprimer. All damaged shopprimer and
contamination from storage and fabrication should be thoroughly cleaned prior to final painting. For
repair and touch-up use HEMUCRYL PRIMER HI-BUILD 18032.
Repair: Remove oil and grease, etc. with suitable detergent. Remove salt and other contaminants
by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning. Remove rust and loose paint by abrasive blasting or
power tool cleaning to St 3 before recoating. Touch up bare spots with HEMUCRYL PRIMER HIBUILD 18030.
Aluminium: Very careful degreasing, followed by high pressure fresh water cleaning to remove all
salts and other contamination. Any anodizing must be completely removed. Thorough sand
papering or abrasive sweeping with mineral abrasives is recommended.
Cast aluminium is recommended to be abrasive swept to a uniform, evenly grey appearance.
Hot dip galvanized steel: Wet rubbing/grinding with ammonia - water 1:20, followed by fresh water
hosing. In case this method is not feasible, the procedure described for stainless steel may be
used.
Stainless steel: Very careful degreasing, followed by fresh water hosing to remove all
contamination.
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
Use only where application can proceed at temperatures above 10C/50F. Apply on a clean and
dry surface with a temperature above the dew point to avoid condensation. Relative humidity:
during application above 60%, preferably 75-90% to avoid dry spray. During drying below 80%,
preferably between 40-60%. (Contact HEMPEL for further advice). Good ventilation during
application and drying is necessary. During drying it is of utmost importance that sufficient
ventilation is covering all parts of the surfaces painted. Ventilation requirements to remove the
water vapours liberated during application and drying are approximately 75 m/litre of the paint at
20C/68F. (Relative humidity of the air supply 40%).
Shelf life/
storage:
Note:
As supplied
5 vol. % thinning
Limit phase I, 2007 Limit phase II, 2010
VOC in g/l
45
45
140
140
For VOC of other shades, please refer to Safety Data Sheet.
May be specified in another film thickness than indicated depending on purpose and area of use.
This will alter spreading rate and may influence drying time and recoating interval. Normal range
dry is 50-100 micron/2-4 mils. When used in 50 micron dry film thickness, 3-5% thinning will be
necessary to secure proper film formation. For proper film formation the recommended nozzle
sizes should be used.
The durability/performance of water-borne coatings is to a very high degree depending on the
fulfilment of good painting practice. For instance application to riveted and skip-welded
constructions will require extra care when coating sharp edges, riveted joints, etc. Avoid too high
thicknesses per coat. Preferably apply an extra stripe coat.
As water-borne paints have a high tendency to "withdraw" from sharp edges, etc., proper corrosion
protection will be highly supported by careful rounding of edges and that any joints are completely
closed and tight.
Add 3-8% by volume of HEMUCRYL BRUSH AGENT 99810. Typical dry film thickness per coat will
be 30-40 micron/1.2-1.6 mils.
If the painted items will be exposed to humidity/water at temperatures below 5-10C/40-50F
shortly after finishing the paint application, it is of utmost importance for later good performance
that the following rules are complied with:
The (last applied) paint layer must dry for at least 6 hours at 20C/68F - 40-60% RH, 9 hours
at 15C/59F - 40-60% RH before exposure to temperatures below 10C/50F and/or
condensation/water exposure.
Avoid outdoor application in seasons with low night temperatures especially in combination with
condensation or rain.
No maximum recoating interval, but after prolonged exposure to polluted atmosphere remove
accumulated contamination by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning and allow to dry.
Clean tools carefully with fresh water or lukewarm soap water immediately after use.
Dried remains of paint can be removed with HEMPEL'S TOOL CLEANER 99610.
Store at temperatures between 5-40C/41-104F. Shelf life is reduced at temperatures above
30C/86F. Do not expose to frost during storage and transport, or before the coating is dry.
HEMUCRYL PRIMER HI-BUILD 18032 is for professional use only.
ISSUED BY:
Good painting:
practice:
"Edge effect":
Brush application:
Exposure to low
temperatures
shortly after
application:
Recoating:
Cleaning of tools:
Page 2 of 2
Surface preparation,
primers:
New steel: Remove oil and grease, etc. with suitable detergent. Remove salt and
other contaminants by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning. Abrasive blasting to
minimum Sa 2. For temporary protection, if required, use suitable shopprimer. All
damaged shopprimer and contamination from storage and fabrication should be
thoroughly cleaned prior to final painting. For repair and touch-up use the specified
HEMUCRYL primer type.
Repair: Remove oil and grease, etc. with suitable detergent. Remove salt and other
contaminants by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning. Remove rust and loose paint by
abrasive blasting or power tool cleaning to St 3 before recoating. Touch up bare spots
with the specified HEMUCRYL primer type.
Aluminium: Very thorough degreasing, followed by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning
to remove all salts and other contamination. Any anodizing must be completely
removed. Thorough sand papering or abrasive sweeping with mineral abrasives is
recommended. Cast aluminium is recommended to be abrasive swept to a uniform,
evenly grey appearance.
Stainless steel: Very thorough degreasing with alkaline degreaser, ie HEMPEL'S LIGHT
CLEANER 99350, followed by fresh water hosing to remove all contamination.
Hot-dipped galvanized steel: Wet rubbing/grinding with ammonia water 1:20 followed
by fresh water hosing. In the case this method is not feasible, the procedure as
described for stainless steel may be used.
Zinc silicate coated surfaces: Remove oil and grease, etc, with suitable detergent.
Remove salt and other contaminants by high pressure fresh water cleaning. After
exposure to high humidity, zinc salts ("white rust") must be removed carefully by (high
pressure) fresh water cleaning - if necessary combined with scrubbing with stiff nylon
brushes. Consult the APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS for the relevant GALVOSIL product.
Note:
Among the HEMUCRYL primer types, HEMUCRYL TI-COAT 18200 is designed to be
used as the first coat on aluminium, hot-dipped galvanized steel, stainless steel and
on zinc silicate coated surfaces.
Surface preparation,
topcoats:
Preceding coats should be sound and tightly adhering. Remove oil and grease with
suitable detergent. Remove salts and other contaminants by (high pressure) fresh
water cleaning. Remove rust and loose material by abrasive blasting or power tool
cleaning. Dust off residues. Touch up to full system before recoating with specified
HEMUCRYL topcoat type.
Concrete: Any oil, grease and other contaminants should be removed by eg volatilizing
by flame cleaning or treatment with suitable detergent, the latter in the following way:
1)
2)
Remove loose material eg by stiff brushes or blasting, high pressure jetting or flame
cleaning followed by fresh water hosing depending on circumstances. Three last
mentioned methods are also able to remove scum layer if necessary. After surface
preparation the surface should feel solid and hard. Remove dust. Saturate surface with
suitable sealer, eg micro dispersed acrylic type or by the HEMUCRYL topcoat diluted
15-20% with water.
Page 1 of 2
Application Instructions
Use only where application can proceed at temperatures above 5C/41F, preferably
above 10C/50F. Apply on a clean and dry surface with a temperature above the dew
point to avoid condensation.
Relative humidity: During application above 60%, preferably 75-90%, to avoid dry
spray. If RH is below 60%, special thinner may be added in order to reduce dry spray.
During drying below 80%, preferably between 40-60%. (Contact HEMPEL for further
advice). Good ventilation during application and drying is necessary. Especially during
drying it is of utmost importance that sufficient ventilation is covering all parts of the
surfaces painted. Ventilation requirements to remove water vapours liberated during
application and drying are app. 75 m/litre of the paint at 20C/68F. (Relative
humidity of the air supply 40%).
REMARKS:
Good painting practice:
"Edge effect":
The (last applied) paint layer must dry for at least 6 hours at 20C/68F - 40-60%
RH, 12 hours at 10C/50F - 40-60% RH before exposure to temperatures below
5C/41F and/or condensation/water exposure.
Avoid outdoor application in seasons with low night temperatures, frost and frost in
combination with condensation or rain.
Shelf life/storage:
Cleaning of tools:
Tools must be cleaned immediately with lukewarm soap water and/or fresh water
followed by thoroughly rinsing to remove residues of detergent.
Dried remains of paint can be removed with HEMPEL'S TOOL CLEANER 99610.
Safety:
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
Note:
Any deviations from the above of a particular HEMUCRYL will be stated in the product
data sheet for this paint.
ISSUED BY:
HEMPEL A/S
Page 2 of 2
Application Instructions
Product Data
HEMUCRYL TI-COAT 18200
Description:
HEMUCRYL TI-COAT 18200 is a water-borne acrylic dispersion paint with good adhesive
properties.
Recommended use:
Service temperatures:
Certificates/Approvals:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Surface dry:
Dry to touch:
V.O.C.:
Red/50710
Flat
38 1
19.0 m/litre - 20 microns
762 sq.ft./US gallon - 0.8 mils
> 93C/199F
1.2 kg/litre - 10.0 lbs/US gallon
15 (approx.) min. at 20C/68F (ISO 1517)
30 (approx.) min. at 20C/68F
40 g/litre - 0.3 lbs/US gallon
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Application method:
Thinner (max. vol.):
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Airless spray
Brush (touch-up)
Fresh water (5%)
Fresh water (5%)
.015"-.017"
130 bar/1900 psi
(Airless spray data are indicative and subject to adjustment)
Fresh water (See APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS)
20 microns/0.8 mils
50 microns/2 mils
24 hours (at 20C/68F) (See REMARKS overleaf)
None (See REMARKS overleaf)
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
REMARKS:
VOC - EU directive
2004/42/EC:
VOC:
As supplied
5 vol. % thinning
Limit phase I, 2007
VOC in g/l
40
40
140
For VOC of other shades, please refer to Safety Data Sheet.
Recoating:
If the subsequent coat is a HEMUCRYL-system the minimum recoating interval can be reduced to 2
hours at 20C/68F and ventilation. Reference is made to separate HEMUCRYL APPLICATION
INSTRUCTIONS.
No maximum recoating interval, but after prolonged exposure to polluted atmosphere remove
accumulated contamination by high pressure fresh water cleaning and allow to dry.
Other REMARKS:
Note:
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Surface preparation,
primers:
New steel: Remove oil and grease, etc. with suitable detergent. Remove salt and
other contaminants by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning. Abrasive blasting to
minimum Sa 2. For temporary protection, if required, use suitable shopprimer. All
damaged shopprimer and contamination from storage and fabrication should be
thoroughly cleaned prior to final painting. For repair and touch-up use the specified
HEMUCRYL primer type.
Repair: Remove oil and grease, etc. with suitable detergent. Remove salt and other
contaminants by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning. Remove rust and loose paint by
abrasive blasting or power tool cleaning to St 3 before recoating. Touch up bare spots
with the specified HEMUCRYL primer type.
Aluminium: Very thorough degreasing, followed by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning
to remove all salts and other contamination. Any anodizing must be completely
removed. Thorough sand papering or abrasive sweeping with mineral abrasives is
recommended. Cast aluminium is recommended to be abrasive swept to a uniform,
evenly grey appearance.
Stainless steel: Very thorough degreasing with alkaline degreaser, ie HEMPEL'S LIGHT
CLEANER 99350, followed by fresh water hosing to remove all contamination.
Hot-dipped galvanized steel: Wet rubbing/grinding with ammonia water 1:20 followed
by fresh water hosing. In the case this method is not feasible, the procedure as
described for stainless steel may be used.
Zinc silicate coated surfaces: Remove oil and grease, etc, with suitable detergent.
Remove salt and other contaminants by high pressure fresh water cleaning. After
exposure to high humidity, zinc salts ("white rust") must be removed carefully by (high
pressure) fresh water cleaning - if necessary combined with scrubbing with stiff nylon
brushes. Consult the APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS for the relevant GALVOSIL product.
Note:
Among the HEMUCRYL primer types, HEMUCRYL TI-COAT 18200 is designed to be
used as the first coat on aluminium, hot-dipped galvanized steel, stainless steel and
on zinc silicate coated surfaces.
Surface preparation,
topcoats:
Preceding coats should be sound and tightly adhering. Remove oil and grease with
suitable detergent. Remove salts and other contaminants by (high pressure) fresh
water cleaning. Remove rust and loose material by abrasive blasting or power tool
cleaning. Dust off residues. Touch up to full system before recoating with specified
HEMUCRYL topcoat type.
Concrete: Any oil, grease and other contaminants should be removed by eg volatilizing
by flame cleaning or treatment with suitable detergent, the latter in the following way:
1)
2)
Remove loose material eg by stiff brushes or blasting, high pressure jetting or flame
cleaning followed by fresh water hosing depending on circumstances. Three last
mentioned methods are also able to remove scum layer if necessary. After surface
preparation the surface should feel solid and hard. Remove dust. Saturate surface with
suitable sealer, eg micro dispersed acrylic type or by the HEMUCRYL topcoat diluted
15-20% with water.
Page 1 of 2
Application Instructions
Use only where application can proceed at temperatures above 5C/41F, preferably
above 10C/50F. Apply on a clean and dry surface with a temperature above the dew
point to avoid condensation.
Relative humidity: During application above 60%, preferably 75-90%, to avoid dry
spray. If RH is below 60%, special thinner may be added in order to reduce dry spray.
During drying below 80%, preferably between 40-60%. (Contact HEMPEL for further
advice). Good ventilation during application and drying is necessary. Especially during
drying it is of utmost importance that sufficient ventilation is covering all parts of the
surfaces painted. Ventilation requirements to remove water vapours liberated during
application and drying are app. 75 m/litre of the paint at 20C/68F. (Relative
humidity of the air supply 40%).
REMARKS:
Good painting practice:
"Edge effect":
The (last applied) paint layer must dry for at least 6 hours at 20C/68F - 40-60%
RH, 12 hours at 10C/50F - 40-60% RH before exposure to temperatures below
5C/41F and/or condensation/water exposure.
Avoid outdoor application in seasons with low night temperatures, frost and frost in
combination with condensation or rain.
Shelf life/storage:
Cleaning of tools:
Tools must be cleaned immediately with lukewarm soap water and/or fresh water
followed by thoroughly rinsing to remove residues of detergent.
Dried remains of paint can be removed with HEMPEL'S TOOL CLEANER 99610.
Safety:
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
Note:
Any deviations from the above of a particular HEMUCRYL will be stated in the product
data sheet for this paint.
ISSUED BY:
HEMPEL A/S
Page 2 of 2
Application Instructions
Product Data
HEMUDUR 18500
BASE 18509 with CURING AGENT 97710
Description:
Recommended use:
Service temperatures:
Certificates/Approvals:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Surface dry:
Dry to touch:
Fully cured:
V.O.C.:
Grey/12170 - Red/51320
Semi-flat
53 1
7.1 m/litre - 75 micron
283 sq.ft./US gallon - 3 mils
> 93C/199F
1.4 kg/litre - 11.7 lbs/US gallon
2 (approx) hours at 20C/68F
4 (approx) hours at 20C/68F
7 days at 20C/68F
20 g/litre - 0.2 lbs/US gallon
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Mixing ratio for 18500:
Application method:
Thinner (max.vol.):
Pot life:
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoating:
Surface temperature
Recoated with
HEMUCRYL
HEMUDUR
*
Mild
2 hours
2 hours
Minimum
Maximum
20C/68F
Atmospheric
20C/68F
Atmospheric
Medium
6 hours
6 hours
Severe
6 hours
6 hours
Mild
None*
None*
Medium
Severe
1 week* 24 hours*
None* 3 weeks*
Before recoating, clean the surface thoroughly for all contamination. To check adequate quality
of the preparatory cleaning, a test patch is recommended before actual recoating.
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
HEMUDUR 18500
SURFACE
PREPARATION:
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
PRECEDING
COAT:
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
New steel: Remove oil and grease etc. with suitable detergent. Remove salt and other
contaminants by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning. Abrasive blasting to minimum Sa 2. For
temporary protection, if required, use suitable shopprimer. All damaged shopprimer and
contamination from storage and fabrication should be thoroughly cleaned prior to final painting. For
repair and touch-up use HEMUDUR 18500.
Repair: Remove oil and grease etc. with suitable detergent. Remove salt and other contaminants
by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning. Remove rust and loose paint by abrasive blasting or power
tool cleaning to St 3 (minor areas) before recoating. Touch up bare spots with HEMUDUR 18500.
Use only where application and curing can proceed at temperatures above 15C/59F.
Apply on a clean and dry surface with a temperature above the dew point to avoid condensation.
Relative humidity: During drying below 80%, preferably between 40-60%. Good ventilation during
application and drying is necessary. During drying it is of the utmost importance that sufficient
ventilation is covering all parts of the surfaces painted. Ventilation requirements to remove the
water vapours liberated during application and drying are approx. 75 m/litre of paint at
20C/68F. (Relative humidity of the air supply 40%.)
None, HEMPADUR ZINC 17360, HEMUDUR ZINC 18560 or according to specification.
HEMUDUR, HEMUCRYL or according to specification.
REMARKS:
VOC - EU directive
2004/42/EC:
VOC:
Application:
Film thicknesses:
As supplied
5 vol. % thinning
Limit phase I, 2007 Limit phase II, 2010
VOC in g/l
20
20
140
140
For VOC of other shades, please refer to Safety Data Sheet.
For proper film formation the recommended nozzle sizes should be used.
May be specified in another film thickness than indicated depending on purpose and area of use.
This will alter spreading rate and may influence amount of thinning necessary, drying time and
recoating interval. Normal range is 50-100 micron/2-4 mils. Application at lower film thicknesses
is possible, but requires thinning for proper film formation.
Good painting:
The durability/performance of water-borne coatings is to a very high degree depending on the
practice:
fulfilment of good painting practice. For instance application to riveted and skip-welded
constructions will require extra care when coating sharp edges, riveted joints, etc. Avoid too high
thicknesses per coat. Preferably apply an extra stripe coat.
"Edge effect":
As water-borne paints have a high tendency to "withdraw" from sharp edges, etc., proper corrosion
protection will be highly supported by careful rounding of edges and that any joints are completely closed and tight.
Exposure to low
If the painted items will be exposed to humidity/water at temperatures below 15C/59F shortly
temperature shortly after finishing the paint application, it is of utmost importance for later good performance that
after application:
the following rules are complied with:
Excessive film thickness must be avoided
The (last applied) paint layer must dry for at least 6 hours at 20C/68F - 40-60% RH before
exposure to temperatures below 15C/59F and/or condensation/water exposure.
Avoid outdoor application in seasons with low night temperatures especially in combination with
condensation or rain.
Cleaning of tools:
Tools must be cleaned immediately with lukewarm soap water and/or fresh water followed by
thoroughly rinsing to remove residues of detergent. Dried paint residues may be removed with
HEMPELS TOOL CLEANER 99610.
Shelf life/storage:
Store at temperatures between 5-40C/41-105F. The shelf life is reduced at temperatures above
30C/86F. Do not expose to frost during storage and transport.
Pot life:
The pot life time is not indicated eg by an increase in viscosity. Although the paint still looks
usable after 1 hour at 20C/68F, it is important that the paint is no longer used as its
protective properties are dramatically reduced after this time. Be aware that the pot life will
decrease when the temperature decreases, eg to 30 minutes at 15C/59F. Use eg an alarm
clock to indicate when the pot life has been exceeded.
Note:
HEMUDUR 18500 is for professional use only.
ISSUED BY:
This
Product Data
Data Sheet
Sheet supersedes
supersedes those
This Product
thosepreviously
previouslyissued.
issued.
For
explanations, definitions
For explanations,
definitionsand
andscope,
scope,see
seeExplanatory
ExplanatoryNotes
Notesininthe
theHEMPEL
HEMPELBook.
Book.
Data,
specifications,
directions
and
recommendations
given
represent
only
test
results
or or
Data, specifications, directions and recommendations givenininthis
thisdata
datasheet
sheet
represent
only
test
results
experience
obtained
under
controlled
or
specially
defined
circumstances.
Their
accuracy,
completeness
or or
experience obtained under controlled or specially defined circumstances. Their accuracy,
completeness
appropriateness
ofof
the
Products
herein
must
bebe
determined
appropriatenessunder
underthe
theactual
actualconditions
conditionsofofany
anyintended
intendeduse
use
the
Products
herein
must
determined
exclusively
the Buyer
Buyer and/or
and/or User.
exclusively by
by the
User.
The
Products are
are supplied
toto
HEMPEL's
OF
The Products
supplied and
and all
alltechnical
technicalassistance
assistanceisisgiven
givensubject
subject
HEMPEL'sGENERAL
GENERALCONDITIONS
CONDITIONS OF
SALES,
DELIVERYAND
ANDSERVICE,
SERVICE,
unless
otherwise
expresslyagreed
agreedininwriting.
writing.The
The
Manufacturerand
andSeller
Seller
SALES, DELIVERY
unless
otherwise
expressly
Manufacturer
disclaim,
disclaim, and
and Buyer
Buyer and/or
and/orUser
Userwaive
waive all
allclaims
claimsinvolving,
involving,any
anyliability,
liability,including
includingbut
butnot
notlimited
limitedtotonegligence,
negligence,
except as
forall
all results,
results, injury
injury or
or direct
direct or
or consequential
consequential losses
except
as expressed
expressed in
in said
saidGENERAL
GENERAL CONDITIONS
CONDITIONS for
lossesor
or
damages
arising
from
the
use
of
the
Products
as
recommended
above,
on
the
overleaf
or
otherwise.
damages arising from the use of the Products as recommended above, on the overleaf or otherwise.
Product data are subject to change without notice and become void five years from the date of issue.
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMUDUR ZINC 18560
HEMPELS ZINC METAL PIGMENT 97110
CURING AGENT 97700
Description:
Recommended use:
In moderately to severely atmospheric exposure as an anticorrosive primer for waterborne paint systems.
In compliance with SSPC-Paint 20, type 2, level 1 and ISO 12944-5.
Service temperatures:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Surface dry:
Dry to touch:
Fully cured:
V.O.C.:
Grey/19840
Flat
51 1
10.2 m/litre - 50 micron
409 sq.ft/US gallon - 2 mils
> 93C/199F
2.5 kg/litre - 20.9 lbs/US gallon
1 (approx) hour at 20C/68F (ISO 1517)
2 (approx) hours at 20C/68F
7 days at 20C/68F
10 g/litre - 0.1 lbs/US gallon
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Mixing ratio for 18560:
Application method:
Thinner (max.vol.):
Pot life:
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoating:
BASE 18569, 4.3 parts by volume : Hempels zinc metal pigment 97110,
17.0 parts by weight (totally 6.7 parts by volume) : CURING AGENT 97700,
3.3 parts by volume.
Add Hempels zinc metal pigment 97110 slowly while stirring to BASE 18569. Stir
constantly with an efficient mechanical mixer and continue until a homogeneous mixture
is obtained. Then mix with CURING AGENT 97700.
Airless spray
Brush (touch-up)
Fresh water (10%)
Fresh water (5%)
3 hours (20C/68F) (See REMARKS overleaf)
1 hours (15C/59F)
.015"-.019"
150 bar/2200 psi
(Airless spray data are indicative and subject to adjustment).
Fresh water (See REMARKS overleaf)
50 micron/2 mils (See REMARKS overleaf)
100 micron/4 mils
Recoating intervals related to later conditions of exposure:
(50 micron/2 mils dry film thickness of HEMUDUR 18560, steel temp. 20C/68F)
Recoated with
Mild
Minimum
Maximum
Atmospheric
Atmospheric
Medium
Severe
Mild
Medium
Severe
HEMUCRYL
2 hours
3 hours
3 hours
None**
1 week** 24 hours**
HEMUDUR
2 hours*
3 hours
3 hours
None**
None**
3 weeks**
* HEMUDUR ZINC 18560 can be recoated with HEMUDUR 18500 with a minimum recoating interval of 10
minutes if both layers are specified in 30 micron/1.2 mils dry film thickness and are fully dried before
applying a third coat.
** The surface must be completely clean before recoating. In the case of "white rust", scrubbing with a stiff
brush and plenty of water may be necessary.
If the maximum recoating interval is exceeded, roughening of the surface is necessary to ensure
intercoat adhesion.
Safety:
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
Remove oil and grease thoroughly with suitable detergent. Remove salt and other contaminants
by high pressure fresh water cleaning. Abrasive blasting to Sa 2 with a sharp-edged surface
profile corresponding to Rugotest No. 3, BN9a, Keane-Tator Comparator, 2.0 G/S or ISO
Comparator, Medium (G).
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
Use only where application and curing can proceed at temperatures above 15C/59F.
Apply to a clean and dry surface with a temperature above the dew point to avoid condensation.
Relative humidity: During drying below 80%, preferably between 40-60%.
Good ventilation during application and drying is necessary.
During drying it is of utmost importance that sufficient ventilation is covering all parts of the
surfaces painted. Ventilation requirements to remove the water vapours liberated during
application and drying are approx. 75 m/litre of paint at 20C/68F. (Relative humidity of the air
supply 40%.)
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
REMARKS:
Note: If used as anticorrosive protection under insulation of high temperature equipment it is very
important that NO moisture can penetrate during slow-down periods. This to avoid risk of "wet
corrosion" when the temperature rises.
Application:
For proper film formation the recommended nozzle sizes should be used.
Film thicknesses:
May be specified in another film thickness than indicated depending on purpose and area of use.
This will alter spreading rate and may influence amount of thinning necessary, drying time and
recoating interval. Normal range is 30-75 micron/1.2-3.0 mils.
Good painting:
The durability/performance of water-borne coatings is to a very high degree depending on the
practice:
fulfilment of good painting practice. For instance application to riveted and skip-welded
constructions will require extra care when coating sharp edges, riveted joints, etc. Avoid too high
thicknesses per coat. Preferably apply an extra stripe coat.
"Edge effect":
As water-borne paints have a high tendency to "withdraw" from sharp edges, etc., proper corrosion
protection will be highly supported by careful rounding of edges and that any joints are completely
closed and tight.
Exposure to low
If the painted items will be exposed to humidity/water at temperatures below 15C/59F shortly
temperature shortly after finishing the paint application, it is of utmost importance for later good performance that
after application:
the following rules are complied with:
The (last applied) paint layer must dry for at least 6 hours at 20C/68F - 40-60% RH before
exposure to temperatures below 15C/59F and/or condensation/water exposure.
Avoid outdoor application in seasons with low night temperatures especially in combination with
condensation or rain.
Cleaning of tools:
Tools must be cleaned immediately with lukewarm soap water and/or fresh water followed by
thoroughly rinsing to remove residues of detergent. Dried paint residues may be removed with
HEMPELS TOOL CLEANER 99610.
Shelf life/storage: Store at temperatures between 5-40C/41-104F. The shelf life is reduced at temperatures above
30C/86F. Do not expose to frost during storage and transport.
Pot life:
The pot life time is not visible eg by an increase in viscosity. Although the paint still looks
usable after 3 hours at 20C/68F, it is important that the paint is no longer used as its
protective properties are dramatically reduced after this time. Be aware that the pot life will
decrease when the temperature decreases eg to 1 hour at 15C/59F. Use eg an alarm clock
to indicate when the pot life has been exceeded. Temperatures indicated are understood as the
common temperature for both paint material and the steel to be painted.
Note:
HEMUDUR ZINC 18560 is for professional use only.
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPATEX E.V. PRIMER 19151
Former name: Werofa Spezial E-Firnis 19151D
Description:
HEMPATEX E.V. PRIMER 19151 is a paint based on a special resin for temporary
corrosion protection of high temperature equipment.
Recommended use:
Approvals, certificates:
Approved as a welding primer according to DAST-Richtlinie 006 (20 micron/0.8 mil dry
film thickness).
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Dry to touch:
V.O.C.:
Red/50670
Flat
48 1 (DIN 53219)
8 m/litre - 60 micron
321 sq.ft./US gallon - 2.4 mils
24C/77F
1.6 kg/litre - 13.4 lbs/US gallon
30 (approx) minutes at 20C/68F
410 g/litre - 3.4 lbs/US gallon
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Application method:
Thinner (max.vol.):
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Airless spray
Brush
Roller
08080 (5%)
08080 (5%)
08080 (5%)
.013"-0.017"
130 bar/1885 psi
(Airless spray data are indicative and subject to adjustment)
HEMPEL'S THINNER 08080
60 micron/2.4 mils
125 micron/5 mils
When dry
None
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
APPLICATION AND
CURING
CONDITIONS:
Clean and dry surface with temperature above the dew point to avoid condensation. Use only
where application and drying can proceed at temperatures above 0C/30F with a relative
humidity below 80% RH.
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
None
REMARKS:
May be specified in another film thickness than indicated depending on purpose. This will alter
spreading rate and may influence drying time.
Note:
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPASIL NEXUS 27302
FOULING RELEASE TIECOAT
BASE 27309 with CURING AGENT 98100 and ADDITIVE 99700
Description:
HEMPASIL NEXUS 27302 is a high solid three component silicone based product.
Recommended use:
As a tiecoat for the HEMPASIL FOULING RELEASE System, securing adhesion between
the anticorrosive system and the Hempasil Fouling Release topcoat.
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colour/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Dry to touch:
Fully cured:
V.O.C.:
Shelf life:
Black/19990 - Grey/13200
Semi-gloss
70 (see REMARKS overleaf)
5.8 m/litre - 120 micron
234 sq.ft./US gallon - 4.8 mils
30C/86F
1.3 kg/litre - 10.8 lbs/US gallon
2 hours at 20C/68F
7 days at 20C/68F
280 g/litre - 2.3 lbs/US gallon
1 year (25C/77F) from time of production. Depending on storage conditions,
mechanical stirring may be necessary before usage.
If the shelf life is exceeded please contact HEMPEL for further advice.
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Mixing ratio:
Application method:
Thinner:
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
"Pot life":
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
New construction: According to painting specification/product data sheet for the specified
HEMPADUR system.
Maintenance, non-F/R systems: This is feasible provided the general condition of the old paint
system is good and very thorough cleaning is carried out.
Spot repair is to be carried out with specified HEMPADUR system. A bridge coating is
subsequently used as full coat before application of HEMPASIL NEXUS 27302.
Maintenance, old F/R systems: Possible spot repair with specified HEMPADUR system followed
by spot application of HEMPASIL NEXUS 27302.
In any of the above-mentioned cases, a detailed working specification is available upon request.
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
Use only where application can proceed at temperatures above 10C/50F. The temperature of
the surface and that of the paint itself must also be above this limit. Apply only on a surface with a
temperature above the dew point to avoid condensation. The surface should be clean and dry.
In confined spaces provide adequate ventilation during application and drying.
PRECEDING
COAT:
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
REMARKS:
It is of the utmost importance that thorough protection and cleaning procedures are followed
before and after application respectively. It is advisable to apply HEMPASIL system after all other
exterior painting is complete. This is to avoid silicone contamination of other painted surfaces.
Before application cover all surfaces surrounding the areas to be applied with plastic sheeting to
avoid overspray. After application clean all equipment thoroughly, before re-using equipment. See
below.
Volume solids:
The stated value is the theoretical volume solids: solid content of the mixed product. Due to the
chemical reaction in the mixture the practical volume solid will be approx. 5% lower than indicated.
Mixing:
Add ADDITIVE 99700 to BASE 27309 while stirring. Immediately after add CURING AGENT 98100
and mix.
Pot life:
The pot life is 1 hour at 20C/68F. No change in the paints physical properties (e.g. viscosity
increase) is apparent when this time is exceeded. It is important that the paint is no longer used
as its adhesion properties to the preceding coat are dramatically reduced after that time.
Application method: A well executed spray application is necessary. This paint material has special application
properties and it is recommended first to make a small-scale application to get familiar with the
properties.
Thinning:
Not recommended. In exceptional cases use THINNER 08080 (max 5 vol.%).
Recoating by itself: HEMPASIL NEXUS 27302 must be applied in one coat.
In case HEMPASIL NEXUS 27302 has to be recoated by itself, application must be wet in wet.
Weather conditions: Please refer to application manual.
Cleaning of tools:
Very thorough cleaning with THINNER 08080 is necessary. DISPOSE OF CLEANING SOLVENTS
AFTER USE. DO NOT RE-USE SOLVENTS AFTER CLEANING.
Storage of cans:
Must be stored under absolutely dry conditions, protect against seeping humidity.
Note:
HEMPASIL NEXUS 27302 is for professional use only.
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPADUR FILLER 35250
BASE 35259 with CURING AGENT 95250
Description:
Recommended use:
1.
2.
Service temperatures:
Maximum:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Dry to touch:
Fully cured:
V.O.C.:
Light grey/19810
Semi-gloss
100
92C/198F
1.6 kg/litre - 13.4 lbs/US gallon
8 (approx.) hours at 20C/68F
5 (approx.) days at 20C/68F
10 g/litre - 0.1 lbs/US gallon
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances. Further reference is made to "Explanatory Notes" in the HEMPEL book.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Mixing ratio for 35250:
Application method:
Thinner (max.vol.):
Pot life:
Cleaning of tools:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
Metal: Remove oil and grease, etc. with suitable detergent. Remove salt and other contaminants
by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning. Abrasive blasting, power tool cleaning or sanding,
depending on material and condition of the surface. Pitted steel should be blast cleaned and/or
ground with high speed burrs. Round off sharp edges. Finally clean the area with HEMPELS
THINNER 08450. Priming after abrasive blast cleaning can be done with a thin layer of eg
HEMPADUR 15590.
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
Use only where application and curing can proceed at temperatures above 5C/41F.
The temperature of the substrate should also be above this limit. Apply only on a dry and clean
surface with a temperature above the dew point to avoid condensation.
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
REMARKS:
Mix and stir the two components thoroughly until an even light grey colour is achieved, where after
the filler is ready for use.
Do not mix more than is necessary for use within the pot life.
If the maximum recoating interval is exceeded, roughening of the surface is necessary to ensure
intercoat adhesion.
May be sanded after 16 hours (20C/68F).
Note:
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPADUR SPRAY-GUARD 35490/
HEMPADUR SPRAY-GUARD 35493
High temperatures: 35490 with CURING AGENT 95690
Medium temperatures: 35493 with CURING AGENT 95790
Description:
Recommended use:
Service temperatures:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Surface dry:
Dry to touch:
Fully cured:
V.O.C.:
Grey-green/41690
Semi-gloss, textured
100
0.4 m/litre - 2.5 mm
16.0 sq.ft./US gallon - 100 mils
> 60C/140F
1.9 kg/litre - 15.8 lbs/US gallon
See REMARKS overleaf
See REMARKS overleaf
See REMARKS overleaf
0 g/litre - 0 lbs/US gallon
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances. Further reference is made to "Explanatory Notes" in the HEMPEL
book.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Mixing ratio:
Application method:
Thinner (max. vol.):
Pot life:
Recommended equipment:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoating interval, min:
Recoating interval, max:
Safety:
35490
35493
Base 35499 : Curing agent 95690
Base 35499 : Curing agent 95790
5.6 : 1.0 by volume; 23.0 : 2.0 by weight 5.7 : 1.0 by volume; 23.0 : 2.15 by weight
Spray (small areas: notched trowel)
Spray (small areas: notched trowel)
(Consult separate Application Instructions) (Consult separate Application Instructions)
Do not dilute (see REMARKS overleaf)
Do not dilute (see REMARKS overleaf)
See REMARKS overleaf
See REMARKS overleaf
Air spray by worm-pump equipment, by hose pump or by modified piston pump.
(Consult separate Application Instructions)
For small areas Quick Spray Hopper Gun.
HEMPELS TOOL CLEANER 99610.
2.5 mm/100 mils
2.5 mm/100 mils
See REMARKS overleaf
See REMARKS overleaf
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
20C/68F
10C/50F
10C/50F
2C/36F
7 days at 20C/68F
7 days at 10C/50F
Dry to touch:
Fully cured:
Dry to handle:
To facilitate stirring and mixing, the material temperature should in no case be less than approx
20C/68F.
PRECEDING COAT:
None, HEMPADUR SEALER 05990, HEMPADUR 15590, or according to specification.
SUBSEQUENT COAT: None, or HEMPADUR qualities according to specification. In case a "smoothening" of the surface
is required, HEMPADUR MULTI-STRENGTH 45751 may be used.
REMARKS:
The natural tendency of epoxy coatings to chalk in outdoor exposure and to become more
Weathering/
service sensitive to mechanical damage and chemical exposure at elevated temperatures is also
temperatures:
reflected in this product.
Film thicknesses:
May be specified and applied in higher film thicknesses than indicated. Not recommended below
2.5 mm /100 mils, since HEMPADUR SPRAY-GUARD 35490/35493 will not form a close and
pinhole-free film at lower film thicknesses.
Adhesion:
Proper adhesion is obtained by applying HEMPADUR SPRAY-GUARD 35490/35493 directly to the
steel. If a blast primer is required, HEMPADUR 15590 is recommended.
Thinning:
Do not dilute as this will influence adhesion and cohesion of the paint system.
Pot life:
Material temperature
30C/86F
20C/68F
10C/50F
30 minutes
1 hour
Not relevant
Not relevant
30 minutes
1 hour
30C/86F
20C/68F
10C/50F
Recoating interval:
Substrate temperature
Note:
ISSUED BY:
Min
Max
4 hours
2 weeks
8 hours
1 month
Not relevant
2 months
Min
Max
2 hours
2 weeks
4 hours
1 month
8 hours
2 months
Page 2 of 2
Application Instructions
For product description refer to product data sheet
Scope:
Surface preparation:
Page 1 of 5
HEMPEL
Application Instructions
Page 2 of 5
Application Instructions
Pot life:
Do not mix more material than can be used during the pot life at the prevailing
temperature. In hot climate it is recommended to mix only one set at a time just prior to
use.
Procedure:
Page 3 of 5
Application Instructions
Even for short interruptions of spraying it is important to stop the gun and the pump
simultaneously to prevent paint build-up in hoses and gun. Automatic devices for this
purpose can be delivered as standard for most equipment.
If the nozzle is blocked, the following procedure is mandatory:
Control of wet
film thickness:
Circulate the material at equal pressures (do not increase the pressure on the
material hose).
The applied paint film thickness must be measured immediately after application with
a wet film thickness gauge suitable for this range of thicknesses (scale: 1-5 mm/40200 mils).
Besides, control of consumption in relation to the area coated is carried out regularly.
Theoretically, a film thickness of 2.5 mm corresponds to a consumption of 2.5 litres
HEMPADUR SPRAY-GUARD 35490 or 35493 per square metre.
Additional material must be applied in case the thickness is insufficient, and in case of
improper film formation.
Equipment cleaning:
Page 4 of 5
Application Instructions
The dry film is checked all over for discontinuities and correct minimum thickness with a
High Voltage Holiday Detector operating at 12 KV. These checks can take place on
HEMPADUR SPRAY-GUARD 35490 after curing with CURING AGENT 95690 for minimum
24 hours at 20C/68F, on HEMPADUR SPRAY-GUARD 35493 after curing with CURING
AGENT 95790 for minimum 24 hours at 10C/50F.
Discontinuities and areas with too low film thickness showing spark discharge must be
touched up.
Touch-up:
Safety:
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
ISSUED BY:
Page 5 of 5
Application Instructions
Application:
After careful mixing, HEMPADUR SPRAY-GUARD 35490/35493 is applied by a widenotched trowel with 10 mm clearance.
In order to remove irregularities caused by application using a trowel, and obtain a
uniform layer, smoothen with a spatula dipped into HEMPEL'S THINNER 08080.
Maintain a uniform pressure when using a spatula.
To obtain a non-skid surface, roll the surface with a nylon roller with hair of a medium
length. Should be dipped into HEMPEL'S THINNER 08080.
Checking:
The film thickness is checked by measuring the wet film as well as by calculating the
consumption corresponding to the area. Theoretically, a film thickness of 2.5 mm
corresponds to 2.5 litres of HEMPADUR SPRAY-GUARD 35490/35493 per square
metre.
The coating is checked all over for pinholes by high-voltage pinhole detection with 12
kilovolt. Where sparks are observed the spots are marked and repaired with specified
thickness as a minimum.
ISSUED BY:
HEMPEL A/S
Page 1 of 1
Product Data
HEMPADUR MULTI-STRENGTH 35530
BASE 35539 with CURING AGENT 95530
Description:
Recommended use:
Service temperatures:
Certificates/Approvals:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Surface dry:
Dry to touch:
Fully cured:
V.O.C.:
Grey/10500 - Red/51320
Semi-gloss
100
3.3 m/litre - 300 micron
134 sq.ft./US gallon - 12 mils
> 100C/212F
1.3 kg/litre - 10.8 lbs/US gallon
12 (approx.) hrs at 20C/68F (ISO 1517)
24 (approx.) hours at 20C/68F
7 days at 20C/68F
10 g/litre - 0.1 lbs/US gallon
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances. The theoretical spreading rate has been calculated on the basis of a
100% solids volume.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Mixing ratio for 35530:
Application method:
Thinner (max.vol.):
Pot life:
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
When used as a heavy duty coating or in potable water tanks and pipelines:
Abrasive blasting to min. Sa 2 with a surface profile corresponding to ISO Comparator Rough
Medium (G).Oil and grease must be removed with suitable detergent, salts and other contaminants
by (high pressure) fresh water hosing prior to blasting. After blasting, clean the surface carefully
from abrasives and dust.
On old steel surfaces having been exposed to salt water, excessive amounts of salt residues in
pittings may call for abrasive blasting, high pressure fresh water hosing, drying, and finally, dry
abrasive blasting again. Alternatively, water jetting may be used provided the steel surface has
already the surface profile as described above.
Concrete: Remove slip agent and other possible contaminants by emulsion washing followed by
high pressure hosing with fresh water. Remove scum layer and loose matter to a hard, rough and
uniform surface, preferably by abrasive blasting, possibly by other mechanical treatment, flame
cleaning or acid etching. Seal surface with suitable sealer, eg HEMPADUR SEALER 05990
(furthermore, please see Product Data Sheet for 05990).
APPLICATION
Use only where application and curing can proceed at temperatures above 10C/50F at all
CONDITIONS:
times until curing is completed. The temperature of the paint itself must be above 15C/59F for
proper application. In-can temperature of the paint should preferably be below 25C/77F.
Apply only on a dry and clean surface with a temperature above the dew point to avoid
condensation. Relative humidity max 85%.
For application in warm climates, HEMPADUR MULTI-STRENGTH 45751 may preferably replace
HEMPADUR MULTI-STRENGTH 35530 as a heavy duty coating. For potable water tanks and pipes
please check local product assortment.
PRECEDING COAT: None, HEMPADUR SEALER 05990, HEMPADUR 15590 or according to specification.
SUBSEQUENT COAT: None, HEMPADUR or HEMPATHANE qualities as per specification.
REMARKS:
VOC - EU directive
2004/42/EC:
VOC:
Weathering/
service
temperatures:
Film thicknesses:
Recoating:
As supplied
0 vol. % thinning
Limit phase I, 2007 Limit phase II, 2010
VOC in g/l
10
10
550
500
For VOC of other shades, please refer to Safety Data Sheet.
Certificates have been issued under the former quality number 3553.
The natural tendency of epoxy coatings to chalk in outdoor exposure and to become more sensitive
to mechanical damage and chemical exposure at elevated temperatures is also reflected in this
product.
May be specified in another film thickness than indicated depending on purpose and area of use.
This will alter spreading rate and may influence drying time and recoating interval. Normal range dry
is 200-300 micron/8-12 mils.
Recoating intervals related to later conditions of exposure:
(300 micron/12 mils dry film thickness of HEMPADUR MULTI-STRENGTH 35530)
Minimum
Surface temperature
Maximum
20C/68F
Atmospheric
Recoated with
Severe
HEMPADUR
HEMPATHANE
24 hours
12 hours
Water immersion
20C/68F
Atmospheric
Water immersion
Severe
24 hours
Not relevant
5 days
24 hours
5 days
Not relevant
Mix and stir the two components until an even colour is achieved, where after the paint is ready for
use. If improved colour stability is requested for exposure to sunshine, it is recommended to
topcoat with e.g. HEMPATHANE TOPCOAT 55210.
Potable water tanks: See APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS, as to time before taking into use and post
treatment of coated surfaces to be in contact with potable water.
Note:
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Application
Application Instructions
Instructions
For product description refer to product data sheet
Scope:
Surface preparation:
Steel:
Abrasive blasting to min. Sa 2 with a surface profile corresponding to ISO Comparator
Rough Medium (G). Oil and grease must be removed with suitable detergent, salts and
other contaminants by (high pressure) fresh water hosing prior to blasting. After
blasting, clean the surface carefully from abrasives and dust. HEMPADUR 15590 may
be used as a blast primer/hold-coat.
On old steel surfaces having been exposed to salt water, excessive amounts of salt
residues in pittings may call for dry abrasive blasting, high pressure fresh water hosing,
drying, and finally, dry abrasive blasting again. Alternatively, water jetting may be used
provided the steel surface has already the surface profile as described above.
In case of extensively pit-corroded surfaces (tank bottoms): Remove oil and grease
with suitable detergent. Blasting to Sa 2, ISO 8501-1: 2007. Pittings on tank bottoms
are often omega-shaped (typically in the case of chloride-induced corrosion) for which
reason the following procedure is recommended:
After rough cleaning for dust and abrasives, the tank surfaces are to be thoroughly high
pressure fresh water hosed. Let the water remain in the tank so that all pit corroded
areas are covered by approx 5 cm/2" of water.
After 24 hours the water is removed by wet vacuum cleaning and the tank is dried.
If needed, i.e. if there is still salt contamination to be found in the pits, the washing
treatment has to be repeated. After cleaning, the surfaces are blasted to min. Sa 2
with a surface roughness profile as described above. After blasting clean the surface
carefully for abrasives and dust. Special care must be taken when cleaning the tank
bottom.
Concrete: The concrete must be of good quality and fully cured, eg 28 days for normal
Portland cement, and completely dry with a humidity content in the surface below 4%.
The concrete must also be controlled for absence of capillary water action or for subsoil
water.
Minimum pull-off value should normally be 20 kilopond/cm measured after surface
preparation. Any cracks, crevices and voids must be repaired.
All possible slip agent, oil, grease and other contaminants must be removed by eg
abrasive blasting, volatilising by flame cleaning or treatment with suitable detergent.
The last mentioned in the following way: Saturation of the surface with fresh water.
Washing with suitable detergent followed by fresh water hosing.
Depending on construction and purpose, abrasive blast, high pressure water jet or treat
the concrete with power tools to obtain a rough and firm surface free of scum layer and
other contamination. Remove dust and loose material.
If mechanical treatment is impossible, the surface may be treated with acid etching. For
this purpose an approx. 5% w/w nitric or phosphoric acid solution is recommended.
Note: Strong acids, take necessary precautions, make sure that safety regulations are
obeyed!
Page 1 of 5
HEMPEL
HEMPEL
Application
Instructions
Application Instructions
Complicated surfaces:
Nozzle size:
.019" through .023"
Fan angle:
40
Note: Avoid the use of a suction hose. Use an interchangeable pipe, which makes it
possible to remove cured paint If longer spray hoses are necessary the pump ratio
must be raised to 60:1 or more, yet the high output capacity of the pump must be
maintained.
Thinning:
Alternatively 1-2% THINNER 08450 may be added, but thinning must be done with care
as the antisagging properties are drastically reduced by overthinning. Do NOT use
thinning when coating surfaces to be in contact with potable water.
Airless spray data are indicative and subject to adjustment.
Mixing:
Stir the CURING AGENT 95530 well before mixing with BASE. Continue the mixing until a
complete uniform colour is achieved.
Hot airless spray equipment:
Use the same airless spray pump as described above.
On the output side of the pump an electrically heated, explosion proof, high pressure,
material heater is fitted. For instance 2500 Watt, max. working pressure well above 300
bar (4-1 safety factor) equipment.
Spray hoses:
Regular surfaces:
Nozzle size:
Fan angle:
Complicated surfaces:
Nozzle size:
.019" through .023".
Fan angle:
40.
Page 2 of 5
Application Instructions
When measured under standard conditions the pot life is one hour at 20C/68F.
However, for a 20 litres/5 US gallons mix, the heat developed by the chemical reaction
between BASE and CURING AGENT is so intense that the corresponding practical pot life
is substantially shorter.
Therefore:
Keep an eye on the paint temperature frequently for instance by touching the can
with your hand. If it feels more than hand warm, discard the paint and flush the
equipment immediately irrespective of type of spray equipment.
Paint temperature:
If the in-can temperature is below approximately 15C/59F viscosity will be too high for
application. If the paint temperature at mixing is 25C/77F or higher a substantial risk
of shortened pot life and curing in can/spray equipment exists. When working in warm,
subtropical/ tropical climates a refrigerated container can be used for storing/
cooling of the paint before application.
Application:
Page 3 of 5
Application Instructions
Edges, corners, manual welds, and places difficult to cover properly by spray application
should be stripe coated (touched up) either before or after the spray application.
One or two stripe coats will usually be necessary, but depending on actual conditions.
HEMPADUR MULTI-STRENTGH 35530 may be slightly thinned with THINNER 08450,
except for stripe coating of surfaces to be in contact with potable water.
Extra thickness - extra layer(s) - may be necessary in case of severely pitted and/or
where very high degrees of antiabrasive properties are needed.
When applied in two coats it is an advantage to apply the first coat thicker than the
second coat, for instance 300 micron for first, 200 micron for the second layer.
Recoating intervals:
Within a maximum of 85% Relative Humidity the following recoating intervals apply
(d=days h=hours):
Steel temperature C/F
10/50
15/59
20/68
25/77
30/86
HEMPADUR qualities
Min
Max
60 h
13 d
38 h
8d
24 h
5d
16 h
3 d
12 h
2 d
HEMPATHANE qualities
Min
Max
30 h
60 h
19 h
38 h
12 h
24 h
8h
16 h
6h
12 h
35/95
40/104
9 hours 8 hours
44 hours 36 hours
4 h
9h
4h
8h
C/F
10/50
15/59
20/68
25/77
30/86
35/95
40/104
18 days
7 days
11 days
5 days
7 days
3 days
5 days
2 days
3 days
1 days
2 days
1 day
2 days
1 day
Tanks or pipelines should generally not be taken into use before HEMPADUR
MULTI-STRENGTH 35530 is fully cured (see above).
Full curing is mandatory in case of potable water service.
Exposure to ballast water and crude oil may exceptionally take place after an "initial
curing" time as listed above.
Water resistance:
10C/50F
15C/59F
20C/68F
25C/77F
30C/86F
60 hours
32 hours
24 hours
20 hours
15 hours
Note: HEMPADUR 35530 must not be exposed to water or high humidity between
stripe coating and full coating respectively between full coating and any necessary
second full coating as there is a certain risk of curing agent exudation which will hinder
adhesion. If exudation is present on the surface this must be removed by very thorough
cleaning. Cleaning should be carried out by hand-warm fresh water washing at a
pressure of approx 60 bar. Such cleaning must not take place before the minimum
curing time for obtaining water resistance as listed above has elapsed. Contact the
nearest Hempel office for further details.
Ventilation during
application:
Ventilation is not required for drying/curing of the coating, but some ventilation is
recommended in order to remove eg spray dust from application.
Page 4 of 5
Application Instructions
When the painted surface will be exposed to abrasion shortly after out-docking, the
recommended minimum drying/curing time before out-docking is:
Steel temperature
C/F
Minimum days
10/50
15/59
20/68
25/77
30/86
(35/95)
(40/104)
12
(2)
(1)
When out-docking takes place into water with a temperature at or above 10C/50F,
and sufficient time afterwards is allowed for full cure before the coating is exposed to
abrasion, the recommended minimum time before out-docking is:
Steel temperature
Minimum days
C/F
10/50
15/59
20/68
25/77
30/86
(35/95)
(40/104)
(1)
(1)
Notes:
1. The temperatures in the tables above are mean values, but the temperature during
curing should at no time come below 10C/50F.
2. Curing will proceed under water when the water temperature is above 10C/50F.
Remarks:
After complete curing, i.e. minimum 7 days at 20C/68F, and before being taken
into use, the surfaces must be cleaned properly. This will be subject to local/individual
specification or regulation but as a minimum for tanks a careful hosing down with clean
fresh water (max. 40C/104F if warm water is used) and/or - ideally - by filling with
water allowed to stand for at least 24 hours. Drain and repeat the procedure, and finally
flush with clean fresh water. Disinfection by for instance chlorination can be very
aggressive towards the coating and separate instructions are available.
Safety:
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
ISSUED BY:
Page 5 of 5
Application Instructions
Product Data
HEMPADUR 35560
BASE 35569 with CURING AGENT 98560
Description:
Recommended use:
Service temperatures:
Maximum
Certificates/Approvals:
Approved by Water Research Centre (WRAS), Great Britain, for potable water up to
23C/73F.
Approved by Folkehelseinstituttet, Norway, for use in tanks for potable water offshore.
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Dry to touch:
Fully cured:
V.O.C.:
Shelf life:
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Mixing ratio for 35560:
Application method:
Thinner (max.vol.):
Pot life:
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
HEMPADUR 35560
SURFACE
PREPARATION:
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
Use only where application and curing can proceed at temperatures above 10C/50F at all
times until curing is completed. The temperature of the paint itself must be above 15C/59F for
proper application. In-can temperature of the paint should preferably be below 30C/86F.
Apply only on a dry and clean surface with a temperature above the dew point to avoid
condensation. Relative humidity max. 85%, but at temperatures (10-15C/50-59F) the first two
days of curing will require a relative humidity of max. 60%.
PRECEDING COAT:
None.
The natural tendency of epoxy coatings to chalk in outdoor exposure and to become more sensitive
to mechanical damage and chemical exposure at elevated temperatures is also reflected in this
product.
May be specified in another film thickness than indicated depending on purpose and area of use.
This will alter spreading rate and may influence drying time and recoating interval. Normal range
Is 200-400 micron/8-16 mils dry film thickness.
At a paint temperature of 20C/68F the paint may advantageously be prereacted 10 minutes
before spray application (20 minutes at 15C/59F).
Certification by WRAS has been obtained with a minimum recoat interval of 3 days.
Light red 50900 to be applied as first coat.
After complete curing, i.e. minimum 12 days at 20C/68F, and before being taken
into use, the surfaces must be cleaned properly. This will be subject to local/individual
specification or regulation but as a minimum for tanks a careful hosing down with clean fresh water
(max. 40C/104F if warm water is used) and/or - ideally - by filling with water allowed to stand for
at least 24 hours. Drain and repeat the procedure, and finally flush with clean fresh water.
Disinfection by for instance chlorination can be very aggressive towards the coating and separate
instructions are available.
Note:
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Application
Application Instructions
Instructions
For product description refer to product data sheet
HEMPADUR 35560
BASE 35569 with CURING AGENT 98560
Scope:
Surface preparation:
Steel:
Abrasive blasting to min. Sa 2 with a surface profile corresponding to ISO Comparator
Rough Medium (G). Oil and grease must be removed with suitable detergent, salts and
other contaminants by (high pressure) fresh water hosing prior to blasting. After
blasting, clean the surface carefully from abrasives and dust.
On old steel surfaces having been exposed to salt water, excessive amounts of salt
residues in pittings may call for dry abrasive blasting, high pressure fresh water hosing,
drying, and finally, dry abrasive blasting again. Alternatively, water jetting may be used
provided the steel surface has already the surface profile as described above.
In case of extensively pit-corroded surfaces (tank bottoms): Remove oil and grease
with suitable detergent. Blasting to Sa 2, ISO 8501-1: 2007. Pittings on tank bottoms
are often omega-shaped (typically in the case of chloride-induced corrosion) for which
reason the following procedure is recommended:
After rough cleaning for dust and abrasives, the tank surfaces are to be thoroughly high
pressure fresh water hosed. Let the water remain in the tank so that all pit corroded
areas are covered by approx 5 cm/2" of water.
After 24 hours the water is removed by wet vacuum cleaning and the tank is dried.
If needed, i.e. if there is still salt contamination to be found in the pits, the washing
treatment has to be repeated. After cleaning, the surfaces are blasted to min. Sa 2
with a surface roughness profile as described above. After blasting clean the surface
carefully for abrasives and dust. Special care must be taken when cleaning the tank
bottom.
Concrete: The concrete must be of good quality and fully cured, eg 28 days for normal
Portland cement, and completely dry with a humidity content in the surface below 4%.
The concrete must also be controlled for absence of capillary water action or for subsoil
water.
Minimum pull-off value should normally be 20 kilopond/cm measured after surface
preparation. Any cracks, crevices and voids must be repaired.
All possible slip agent, oil, grease and other contaminants must be removed by eg
abrasive blasting, volatilising by flame cleaning or treatment with suitable detergent.
The last mentioned in the following way: Saturation of the surface with fresh water.
Washing with suitable detergent followed by fresh water hosing.
Depending on construction and purpose, abrasive blast, high pressure water jet or treat
the concrete with power tools to obtain a rough and firm surface free of scum layer and
other contamination. Remove dust and loose material.
If mechanical treatment is impossible, the surface may be treated with acid etching. For
this purpose an approx. 5% w/w nitric or phosphoric acid solution is recommended.
Note: Strong acids, take necessary precautions, make sure that safety regulations are
obeyed!
Page 1 of 4
HEMPEL
HEMPEL
Application
Instructions
Application Instructions
HEMPADUR 35560
Prior to etching the concrete should be saturated with fresh water to prevent acid
corrosion of the reinforcement bars. Leave the acid to act for 3-4 minutes and hose
down the surface with fresh water - preferably first a 5% w/w sodium hydroxide solution
- and scrub carefully. After that the surface must dry homogeneously and appear as an
even, rough surface free of a loose outer layer. The surface must have a pH reaction of
between 6.5-8.0. If any of these conditions are not fulfilled, the process must be
repeated. The surface must be dried with good ventilation for at least 2 days at 65%
relative humidity and 20C/68F. The pre-treatment is controlled by scraping with a
strong knife. The surface must feel solid and hard, and the knife must only leave a clear
scratch mark.
Seal the surface with HEMPADUR SEALER 05990 in such a way that the surface is just
saturated. Surplus must be removed (do also see the Product Data sheet for
HEMPADUR SEALER 05990).
Application equipment:
HEMPADUR 35560, being a solvent free, high viscosity material, requires special
measures to be taken at application.
Standard airless heavy duty spray equipment:
Pump ratio:
Pump output:
Input pressure:
Spray hoses:
Do NOT thin.
Pit-corroded surfaces:
In case of extensive pit corrosion (old tank bottoms) it is advisable to apply the first
coat by brush. The coating must be worked well into all pits facilitating a good wetting of
the steel and closing the porosities. The following coat(s) can be applied by brush as
well as by airless spray (as per above) securing full covering of the uneven/rough
surface.
Pot life:
When measured under standard conditions the pot life is 1 hour at 20C/68F.
However, for a 20 litres/5 US gallons mix, the heat developed by the chemical reaction
between BASE and CURING AGENT is so intense that the corresponding practical pot life
is substantially shorter.
Therefore:
Paint temperature:
Keep an eye on the paint temperature frequently for instance by touching the can
with your hand. If it feels more than hand warm, discard the paint and flush the
equipment immediately irrespective of type of spray equipment.
If the in-can temperature is below approximately 15C/59F viscosity will be too high for
application. If the paint temperature at mixing is 25C/77F or higher a substantial risk
Page 2 of 4
Application Instructions
HEMPADUR 35560
of shortened pot life and curing in can/spray equipment exists. When working in warm,
subtropical/ tropical climates a refrigerated container can be used for storing/
cooling of the paint before application.
Application:
Film-build/continuity:
Hempadur 35560 may be used in one-coat and two coat specifications. Especially in
one-coat specifications it is of great importance that a continuous, pinhole-free paint
film is obtained. An application technique which will ensure good film formation on all
surfaces must be adopted. It is very important to use nozzles of the correct size, not too
big, and to have a proper, uniform distance of the spray gun to the surface, 30-50 cm
should be aimed at. Furthermore, great care must be taken to cover edges, openings,
rear sides of stiffeners etc. The usual way of obtaining this result is to spray-coat all
these areas separately followed by a full coat all over. Furthermore, stripe coating by
brush will typically be required. To obtain good and steady atomizing, the viscosity of the
paint must be suitable and the spray equipment must be sufficient in output pressure
and capacity.
The paint layer must be applied homogenously and as close to the specification as
possible. The consumption of paint must be controlled to avoid exaggerated film
thickness, e.g. by controlling paint consumption and/or measuring wet film thickness.
The finished coating must appear as a homogeneous film with a smooth surface and
irregularities such as dust, dry spray, abrasives, should be remedied.
Due to thixotropic nature, the surface tension of the product and entrapped air after
spray application, there will often be a deviation between the measured wet film
thickness (WFT) and the later measured dry film thickness (DFT).
In practice this can be compensated by applying approx. 50 m WFT extra in addition to
the specified DFT. The extra wet film thickness will compensate the wavy surface
structure that will become more smooth upon curing as well as entrapped air that is
released during curing, This extra wet film thickness will consequently not cause a
higher paint consumption.
Stripe coating:
Edges, corners, manual welds, and places difficult to cover properly by spray application
should be stripe coated (touched up) either before or after the spray application.
One or two stripe coats will usually be necessary, but depending on actual conditions.
Extra thickness - extra layer(s) - may be necessary in case of severely pitted steel.
Recoating intervals:
Within a maximum of 85% Relative Humidity the following recoating intervals apply
(d=days h=hours):
Steel temperature C/F
HEMPADUR qualities
10/50
15/59
20/68
25/77
30/86
35/95
40/104
60 h
75 d
41 h
51 d
24 h
30 d
16 h
21 d
12 h
15 d
9h
10 d
7h
9d
Min
Max
Before recoating, the layer of HEMPADUR 35560 must NOT be exposed to (steel)
temperatures below 10C/50F, to condensing humidity or to relative humidity higher
than 85% before recoating.
At low temperature (10C-15C / 50F-59F), the relative humidity should be 60% or
lower during the first 2 days of curing, also before recoating.
Curing table:
C/F
10/50
15/59
20/68
25/77
30/86
35/95
40/104
24 days
18 days
12 days
10 days
7 days
6 days
5 days
Page 3 of 4
Application Instructions
HEMPADUR 35560
adhesion. If exudation is present on the surface this must be removed by very thorough
cleaning. Cleaning should be carried out by hand-warm fresh water washing at a
pressure of approx 60 bar. Such cleaning must not take place before the minimum
curing time for obtaining water resistance as listed above has elapsed. Contact the
nearest Hempel office for further details.
Ventilation during
application:
Ventilation is not required for drying/curing of the coating, but some ventilation is
recommended in order to remove e.g. spray dust from application.
After complete curing, i.e. minimum 12 days at 20C/68F, and before being taken
into use, the surfaces must be cleaned properly. This will be subject to local/individual
specification or regulation but as a minimum for tanks a careful hosing down with clean
fresh water (max. 40C/104F if warm water is used) and/or - ideally - by filling with
water allowed to stand for at least 24 hours. Drain and repeat the procedure, and finally
flush with clean fresh water. Disinfection by for instance chlorination can be very
aggressive towards the coating and separate instructions are available.
Safety:
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
ISSUED BY:
Page 4 of 4
Application Instructions
Product Data
HEMPADUR GLASS FLAKE 35851/
HEMPADUR GLASS FLAKE 35853
Medium to high temperatures: 35851: BASE 35858 with CURING AGENT 97652
Low to medium temperatures: 35853: BASE 35858 with CURING AGENT 98750
Description:
Recommended use:
Service temperatures:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Version; mixed product:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Dry to touch:
Fully cured:
V.O.C.:
35851
Grey/12340 - Red/50630
Semi-gloss
78 1
3.9 m/litre - 200 micron
156 sq.ft./US gallon - 8 mils
25C/77F
1.6 kg/litre - 13.4 lbs/US gallon
7-8 hours at 20C/68F
7 days at 20C/68F
260 g/litre - 2.1 lbs/US gallon
35853
Grey/12340 - Red/50630
Semi-gloss
74 1
3.6 m/litre - 200 micron
148 sq.ft./US gallon - 8 mils
27C/81F
1.6 kg/litre - 13.4 lbs/US gallon
8-10 hours at 10C/50F
14 days at 10C/50F
245 g/litre - 2.0 lbs/US gallon
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Mixing ratio:
Application method:
Thinner (max.vol.):
Pot life:
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
35851
Base 35858 : Curing agent 97652
3 : 1 by volume
Airless spray
Brush (touch-up)
08450 (2%)
08450 (2%)
1 hour (20C/68F)
.021"-.023" (Reversible)
250 bar/3600 psi
(Airless spray data are indicative
and subject to adjustment)
HEMPELS TOOL CLEANER 99610
200 micron/8 mils
275 micron/11 mils
6 hours (20C/68F)
30 days (20C/68F
35853
Base 35858 : Curing agent 98750
3 : 1 by volume
Airless spray
Brush (touch-up)
08450 (2%)
08450 (2%)
1 hour (20C/68F)
.021"-.023" (Reversible)
250 bar/3600 psi
(Airless spray data are indicative
and subject to adjustment)
HEMPELS TOOL CLEANER 99610
200 micron/8 mils
275 micron/11 mils
12 hours (10C/50F)
60 days (10C/50F)
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
New steel, "heavy duty use": Abrasive blasting to min. Sa 2 according to ISO 8501-1:2007
with a surface profile equivalent to Rugotest No. 3 BN10, Keane-Tator Comparator 3.0 G/S or ISO
Comparator, rough Medium (G).
Oil and grease must be removed with suitable detergent, salts and other contaminants by (high
pressure) fresh water hosing prior to blasting. After blasting, clean the surface carefully from
abrasive and dust.
Repair and maintenance: Remove oil and grease etc. with suitable detergent. Remove salt and
other contaminants by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning. Clean damaged areas thoroughly by
abrasive blasting or power tool cleaning (minor areas only). Feather edges to sound intact areas.
Dust off residues. Touch-up to full film thickness.
On old ship bottoms and similar pit corroded surfaces, excessive amounts of salt residues may
call for dry abrasive blasting, high pressure fresh water hosing, drying, and finally, dry abrasive
blasting again. Alternatively, water jetting may be used provided the steel surface has already the
surface profile as described above: New steel, "heavy duty use".
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
Use only where application and curing can proceed at temperatures above -10C/14F for
HEMPADUR GLASS FLAKE 35853 and above 10C/50F for HEMPADUR GLASS FLAKE 35851.
The temperature of the paint itself should be above 15C/59F, preferably above 20C/68F for
HEMPADUR GLASS FLAKE 35851 for proper application. Apply only on a dry and clean surface
with a temperature above the dew point to avoid condensation. Relative humidity max. 90%.
In confined spaces provide adequate ventilation during application and drying.
PRECEDING
COAT:
None, but HEMPADUR 15590 can be used as a "blast primer" for HEMPADUR GLASS FLAKE
35851. HEMPADUR GLASS FLAKE 35853 can be used as a blast primer for HEMPADUR GLASS
FLAKE 35853 when diluted 15-25% with HEMPELS THINNER 08450.
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
REMARKS:
Colour of
Curing agent:
Weathering/
service
temperatures:
Film thicknesses:
Curing agent:
Application
equipment:
Recoating:
The curing agent 98750 has a tendency to become darker at storage. This has no influence on
performance, but may influence the shade of the mixed product.
The natural tendency of epoxy coatings to chalk in outdoor exposure and to become more
sensitive to mechanical damage and chemical exposure at elevated temperatures is also
reflected in this product.
May be specified in another film thickness than indicated depending on purpose and area of use.
This will alter spreading rate and may influence drying time and recoating interval. Normal range
dry is 150-250 micron/6-10 mils.
It is recommended to use heavy airless spray equipment with a pump transmission rate of 60:1
(approximately), and a theoretical output of min. 12 litres per minute.
Curing agents 97652 and 98750 are hazy. This is intended and has no negative influence on the
performance.
A reversible nozzle is recommended.
Filter: Surge tank filter and tip filter should be removed.
Thinning:
The long maximum recoating interval for HEMPADUR will be reduced if the coating is more than
just scarcely exposed to direct sunshine before recoating.
If the interval is exceeded, roughening of surface is necessary to ensure intercoat adhesion.
Normally not to be diluted.
Note:
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPADUR MULTI-STRENGTH GF 35870
BASE 35879 with CURING AGENT 98870
Description:
Recommended use:
As a self-primed, high build coating primarily for areas subject to abrasion and/or to a
highly corrosive environment. E.g. splash zones, jetty pilings and working decks.
Can be used as interior lining for crude oil and fuel oil storage tanks.
Service temperatures:
Maximum:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Surface dry:
Dry to touch:
Fully cured:
V.O.C.:
Black/19990
Glossy
87 1
2.5 m/litre - 350 microns
100 sq.ft./US gallon - 14 mils
32C/90F
1.3 kg/litre
10.8 lbs/US gallon
4 (approx.) hours at 20C/68F
6 (approx.) hours at 20C/68F
7 days at 20C/68F
180 g/litre - 1.5 lbs/US gallon
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Mixing ratio for 35870:
Application method:
Thinner (max.vol.):
Pot life:
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
New steel (dry conditions): Abrasive blasting to Sa 2, (ISO 8501-1:2007) with a surface profile
equivalent to Rugotest No. 3 BN 10, Keane-Tator Comparator 3.0 G/S or ISO Comparator, ROUGH
MEDIUM (G).
Remove any oil, grease and other contaminants by detergent and salts by high fresh water hosing
prior to abrasive blasting.
Maintenance: Remove oil and grease etc. with suitable detergent. Remove salt and other
contaminants by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning. Remove all rust and loose material by wet or
dry abrasive blasting or for minor areas power tool cleaning. Feather edges to sound and intact
areas. After wet abrasive blasting hose down the surface by hot water rinsing ("steam cleaning").
Touch up bare spots to full film thickness when the surface has become visually dry.
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
HEMPADUR MULTI-STRENGTH GF 35870 may be applied and will cure at temperatures down to
5C/41F.
The temperature of the paint itself should be above 15C/59F. The best result is obtained at 2030C/68-86F.
In confined spaces provide adequate ventilation.
PRECEDING COAT:
Recoating:
The natural tendency of epoxy coatings to chalk in outdoor exposure and to become more
sensitive to mechanical damage and chemical exposure at elevated temperatures is also
reflected in this product.
Light shades will have a tendency to yellow when exposed to sunshine and darken when exposed
to heat.
Maximum peak temperature in water is 80C/176F.
May be specified in another film thickness than indicated depending on purpose and area of use.
This will alter spreading rate and may influence drying time and recoating interval. Normal range
dry is 350-500 micron/14-20 mils.
Standard airless heavy-duty spray equipment:
Pump ratio:
min 45:1 (see Note below)
Pump output:
min 12 litres/minute (theoretical)
Spray hoses:
max 15 metres/50 feet, 3/8" internal diameter
max 3 metres/10 feet, 1/4" internal diameter
Note: If longer spray hoses are necessary, up to 50 metres/150 feet hose (" internal diameter)
can be added. The pump ratio must be raised to 60:1 or more, however, the high output capacity
of the pump must be maintained. Bigger spray nozzles will also call for increased pump size.
A reversible nozzle is recommended.
Filter: Surge tank filter and tip filter should be removed.
Recoating intervals related to later conditions of exposure at 20C/68F :
(350 micron/14 mils dry film thickness of HEMPADUR MULTI-STRENGHT GF 35870).
Recoated with
Minimum
Maximum
Atmospheric
Medium
Severe
HEMPATHANE
4 hours
HEMPADUR
6 hours
Atmospheric
Immersion
Medium
Severe
Immersion
6 hours
NR
10 Days
3 Days
NR
8 hours
16 hours
60 Days
30 Days
30 Days
ISSUED BY:
This
Product Data
Data Sheet
Sheet supersedes
supersedes those
This Product
thosepreviously
previouslyissued.
issued.
For
explanations, definitions
For explanations,
definitionsand
andscope,
scope,see
seeExplanatory
ExplanatoryNotes
Notesininthe
theHEMPEL
HEMPELBook.
Book.
Data,
specifications, directions
represent
only
test
results
or or
Data, specifications,
directionsand
andrecommendations
recommendationsgiven
givenininthis
thisdata
datasheet
sheet
represent
only
test
results
experience
circumstances.
Their
accuracy,
completeness
or or
experience obtained
obtainedunder
undercontrolled
controlledororspecially
speciallydefined
defined
circumstances.
Their
accuracy,
completeness
appropriateness
ofof
the
Products
herein
must
bebe
determined
appropriatenessunder
underthe
theactual
actualconditions
conditionsofofany
anyintended
intendeduse
use
the
Products
herein
must
determined
exclusively
the Buyer
Buyer and/or
and/or User.
exclusively by
by the
User.
The
Products are
are supplied
toto
HEMPEL's
OF
The Products
supplied and
and all
alltechnical
technicalassistance
assistanceisisgiven
givensubject
subject
HEMPEL'sGENERAL
GENERALCONDITIONS
CONDITIONS OF
SALES,
DELIVERYAND
ANDSERVICE,
SERVICE,
unless
otherwise
expresslyagreed
agreedininwriting.
writing.The
The
Manufacturerand
andSeller
Seller
SALES, DELIVERY
unless
otherwise
expressly
Manufacturer
disclaim, and
disclaim,
and Buyer
Buyer and/or
and/orUser
Userwaive
waive all
allclaims
claimsinvolving,
involving,any
anyliability,
liability,including
includingbut
butnot
notlimited
limitedtotonegligence,
negligence,
except as
forall
all results,
results, injury
injury or
or direct
direct or
or consequential
consequential losses
except
as expressed
expressed in
in said
saidGENERAL
GENERAL CONDITIONS
CONDITIONS for
lossesor
or
damages arising
damages
arisingfrom
fromthe
theuse
useof
ofthe
theProducts
Productsas
asrecommended
recommendedabove,
above,on
onthe
theoverleaf
overleafororotherwise.
otherwise.
Product data are subject to change without notice and become void five years from the date of issue.
Issued: December 2007
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPELS VINYL ESTER GF 35910
(formerly 359QA)
BASE 35919 with HARDENER 99410
Description:
HEMPELS VINYL ESTER GF 35910 is a two component cold cured vinyl ester/acrylic
copolymer, reinforced with glass flakes. Applicable in thick coats by standard heavy duty
airless spray equipment.
Recommended use:
Service temperatures:
Maximum:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Finish:
Colours/Shade nos:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Dry to touch:
Fully cured:
V.O.C.:
Shelf life:
In seawater:
95C/203F
Flat
Off-white/11630
100 (See REMARKS overleaf)
1.5 m/litre - 650 micron
62 sq.ft./US gallon - 26 mils
28C/82F
1.2 kg/litre - 10.0 lbs/US gallon
6 (approx.) hours at 20C/68F
4 days at 20C/68F
35 g/litre - 0.3 lbs/US gallon
6 months (20C/68F) from time of production.
Shelf life is dependent on storage temperature. Shelf life is reduced at storage
temperatures above 20C/68F. (See separate Application instructions)
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Mixing ratio:
Application method:
Thinner:
Pot life:
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoating interval, min:
Recoating interval, max:
Safety:
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
Use only when application and curing can proceed at temperatures above 10C/50F.
The in-can temperature of the product material should be between 15C/59F and 25C/77F to
facilitate proper application properties.
Apply only on a dry and clean surface with a temperature above the dew point to avoid
condensation. Relative humidity max. 85%. In confined spaces provide adequate ventilation during
application and curing.
RETARDER 99190 should be added when application temperatures exceed 25C/77F - see
separate application instructions.
PRECEDING
COAT:
None.
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
REMARKS:
Film thicknesses:
Volume solids:
Note:
ISSUED BY:
May be specified in another film thickness than indicated depending on purpose and area of use.
Normal range dry is 500 - 1200 micron/20-60 mils per coat.
Theoretically, the products contains 100% solid. Depending on the application and curing
conditions some of the volatile reactants may evaporate. Furthermore, the curing process is
accompanied by a contraction.
These two factors result in a theoretical volume solids of 90% and a spreading rate of 1.4 m/l
at 650 micron (56 sq.ft./US gallon).
By unfavourable application conditions, higher losses may result in a practical spreading rate of
approximately 1.2 m/l at 650 micron (49 sq.ft./US gallon).
HEMPELS VINYL ESTER GF 35910 is for professional use only.
HEMPEL A/S - 3591011630
Page 2 of 2
Application Instructions
Application Instructions
For product description refer to product data sheet
Scope:
Surface preparation:
New steel: Remove oil and grease, etc. with suitable detergent. Remove salt and other
contaminants by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning. Abrasive blasting to Sa 2.
Minimum surface profile corresponding to Rugotest No. 3, BN11, Keane-Tator
Comparator, 5.5 G/S, or ISO Comparator Coarse (G). After blasting, clean the surface
carefully from abrasives and dust.
On pit-corroded surfaces, excessive amounts of salt residues may call for dry abrasive
blasting, high pressure fresh water hosing, drying, and finally, dry abrasive blasting
again as described above.
Galvanized, Zinc primed steel etc.: Metallic zinc inhibits the curing process - the
product is not compatible with galvanized steel or other zinc coated substrates. Steel
primed with zinc dust containing pre-fabrication primers must be re-blasted to min. Sa
2-3 to remove all traces of zinc.
Application equipment:
Do not thin. Alternatively max. 5% styrene may be added, but this must be done with
care as the anti-sagging properties are drastically reduced and chemical resistance may
be affected.
Airless spray data are indicative and subject to adjustment.
Page 1 of 4
HEMPEL
Application Instructions
Pot life:
When measured under standard conditions the pot life is 45 minutes at 20C/68F.
However, for a 20 litres/5 US gallons mix, the heat developed by the chemical reaction
is so intense that the corresponding practical pot life is substantially shorter.
Therefore:
Irrespective of equipment, use the paint immediately after mixing. At a normal
application speed the 20 litres/5 US gallons are used in approx. 10 minutes.
Observe the paint temperature frequently for instance by touching the can
with your hand. If it feels more than hand warm (above approx. 50C/120F, discard
the paint and flush the equipment immediately irrespective of type of spray
equipment.
Paint temperature:
If the temperature in the can is below approximately 15C/59F, the viscosity will be too
high for application. If the paint temperature when mixing is 25C/77F or higher, a
substantial risk of shortened pot life and curing in can/spray equipment exists. When
working in warm, subtropical/tropical climates a refrigerated container can be used for
storing/cooling of the paint before application.
Stripe coating:
Edges, corners, manual welds, and places difficult to cover properly by spray application
should be stripe coated either before or after the spray application.
One or two stripe coats will usually be necessary, but depending on actual conditions.
For service in corrosive chemicals a thorough stripe coating procedure is mandatory.
Extra thickness - extra layer(s) - may be necessary in case of severely pitted and/or for
exposure to highly corrosive chemicals.
Between 500 and 3000 micron in one or more coats depending on later service
conditions.
Recoating intervals:
Within a maximum of 85% Relative Humidity the following recoating intervals apply:
Steel temperature
With 35910
Page 2 of 4
Min
Max
10C/50F
12 hours
3 days
15C/59F
9 hours
3 days
Application Instructions
The equipment should be flushed out and cleaned using styrene followed by methyl
ethyl ketone (MEK).
Curing table:
10C/50F
8 days
15C/59F
6 days
20C/68F
4 days
25C/77F
3 days
30C/86F (35C/95F)
2 days
(2 days)
When the painted surface will be exposed to heavy duty service (e.g. exposure to
chemicals, heavy wear and tear), the recommended minimum curing time is:
Steel temperature
Minimum
10C/50F
8 days
15C/59F
6 days
20C/68F
4 days
25C/77F
3 days
30C/86F (35C/95F)
2 days
(2 days)
Notes:
10C/50F
60 hours
15C/59F
40 hours
20C/68F
24 hours
25C/77F
24 hours
30C/86F (35C/95F)
18 hours
(12 hours)
Post curing:
Remarks:
In case of deep pittings higher film thickness is recommended on areas with pittings.
To secure sufficient curing at low surface temperatures as well as to secure a pinholefree paint film at any temperature, the product should always be applied in a wet film
thickness above 600 micron.
Quality Control:
As HEMPELS VINYL ESTER GF 35910 is often used in highly corrosive service proper
quality control is of particular importance. Such controls should include following:
1. Control that the proper dry film thickness has been achieved
2. Holiday/pinhole detection at high voltage (Voltage according to specified thickness)
3. Test of full cure (Acetone test)
a. A small area should be washed with clean Acetone to dissolve the surface
inhibited film and remove stickiness; the area should then be allowed to
dry.
b. Gently rub the washed surface with a piece of cloth soaked with Acetone.
Should the surface become tacky or if it was impossible to obtain a tack
free surface under a), then the coating is not fully cured.
Repairs:
Page 3 of 4
Application Instructions
Shelf life
Safety:
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
ISSUED BY:
Page 4 of 4
Application Instructions
Product Data
HEMPELS POLYESTER GF 35920
BASE 35929 with HARDENER 99020
Description:
Recommended use:
1. As rust preventing coating for areas exposed to high abrasion and impact.
2. As rust preventing coating for areas requiring short interval between application
and seawater immersion - 6 hours at 20C/68F is required.
Service temperatures:
Maximum:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Finish:
Colours/Shade nos:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Dry to touch:
Fully cured:
V.O.C.:
Shelf life:
Flat
Off-white/11630 - Yellow/20820 (RAL 1006)
90 (See REMARKS overleaf)
1.4 m/litre - 650 micron
56 sq.ft./US gallon - 26 mils
26C/79F
1.2 kg/litre - 10.2 lbs/US gallon
4 (approx.) hours at 20C/68F
7 days at 20C/68F
35 g/litre - 0.3 lbs/US gallon
6 months (25C/77F) from time of production.
Shelf life is dependent on storage temperature. Shelf life is reduced at storage
temperatures above 25C/77F. Do not store above 40C/104F.
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Mixing ratio:
Application method:
Thinner:
Pot life:
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoating interval, min:
Recoating interval, max:
Safety:
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
Use only when application and curing can proceed at temperatures above 10C/50F.
The in-can temperature of the polyester material should be between 15C/59F and 25C/77F to
facilitate proper application properties.
Apply only on a dry and clean surface with a temperature above the dew point to avoid
condensation. Relative humidity max. 85%. In confined spaces provide adequate ventilation during
application and curing.
PRECEDING
COAT:
None.
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
REMARKS:
Film thicknesses:
Note:
May be specified in another film thickness than indicated depending on purpose and area of use.
Normal range dry is 650-750 micron/26-30 mils. Absolute minimum is 500 micron/20 mils.
Maximum not more than 1250 micron/50 mils.
Theoretically, the products contains 100% solid.
By practical spray application, however, one of the reactive components added in surplus will be
lost as volatile in an amount of approx 0.035 kg per litre.
Furthermore, the curing process is accompanied by a contraction of approximately 6%. These two
factors result in a volume solids of 90% and a spreading rate of 1.4 m/l at 650 micron.
By extremely unfavourable application conditions, higher losses may result in a "theoretical"
spreading rate of approximately 1.2 m/l at 650 micron. The curing is, however, not affected by
the higher loss.
HEMPELS POLYESTER GF 35920 is for professional use only.
ISSUED BY:
Volume solids:
Page 2 of 2
Application Instructions
1/3
Scope:
Surface preparation:
New steel: Remove oil and grease, etc. with suitable detergent. Remove salt and other
contaminants by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning. Abrasive blasting to Sa 2.
Minimum surface profile corresponding to Rugotest No. 3, BN11, Keane-Tator
Comparator, 5.5 G/S, or ISO Comparator Coarse (G). After blasting, clean the surface
carefully from abrasives and dust.
On pit-corroded surfaces , excessive amounts of salt residues may call for dry abrasive
blasting, high pressure fresh water hosing, drying, and finally, dry abrasive blasting
again as described above.
Application equipment :
Note: Avoid the use of a suction hose. Use an interchangeable pipe, which makes it
possible to remove cured paint.
The pump should preferably be fitted with leather seals although Teflon (PTFE) seals
are acceptable for small jobs.
If longer spray hoses are necessary, up to 50 metres/150 feet hose (" internal
diameter) can be added. The pump ratio must be raised to 60:1 or more, yet, the high
output capacity of the pump must be maintained. Before application starts, the filter
should be removed and hoses should be washed with styrene.
Thinning:
Alternatively max. 5% styrene may be added, but thinning must be done with care as
the anti-sagging properties are drastically reduced by overthinning.
Airless spray data are indicative and subject to adjustment.
Mixing:
Page 1 of 3
HEMPEL
Application Instructions
2/3
When measured under standard conditions the pot life is 45 minutes at 20C/68F.
However, for a 20 litres/5 US gallons mix, the heat developed by the chemical reaction
is so intense that the corresponding practical pot life is substantially shorter.
Therefore:
Irrespective of equipment, use the paint immediately after mixing. At a normal
application speed the 20 litres/5 US gallons are used in approx. 10 minutes.
Keep an eye on the paint temperature frequently for instance by touching the can
with your hand. If it feels more than hand warm, discard the paint and flush the
equipment immediately irrespective of type of spray equipment.
Paint temperature :
If the temperature in the can is below approximately 15C/59F, the viscosity will be
too high for application. If the paint temperature when mixing is 25C/77F or higher, a
substantial risk of shortened pot life and curing in can/spray equipment exists. When
working in warm, subtropical/tropical climates a refrigerated container can be used for
storing/cooling of the paint before application.
Stripe coating:
Edges, corners, manual welds, and places difficult to cover properly by spray
application should be stripe coated (touched up) either before or after the spray
application.
One or two stripe coats will usually be necessary, but depending on actual conditions.
Extra thickness - extra layer(s) - may be necessary in case of severely pitted and/or
where very high degrees of antiabrasive properties are needed.
1500 micron on splash zone areas, 1000 micron on immersed areas below splash
zone, and 750 micron on decks are recommend.
Recoating intervals:
Within a maximum of 85% Relative Humidity the following recoating intervals apply:
Steel temperature
10C/50F
15C/59F
20C/68F
25C/77F
30C/86F
(35C/95F)
With 35920
Min
Max
5 hours
7 days
3 hours
5 days
2 hours
3 days
1 hours
2 days
1 hour
1 days
(45 min.)
(1 day)
Min
Max
32 hours
7 days
24 hours
5 days
16 hours
3 days
12 hours
2 days
8 hours
1 days
(6 hours)
(1 day)
The polyester MUST NOT be exposed to (steel) temperatures below 10C/50F nor to
condensation or Relative Humidit y higher than 85% before recoating.
Cleaning of tools:
The equipment should be flushed out and cleaned using styrene followed by methyl
ethyl ketone (MEK).
Page 2 of 3
Application Instructions
3/3
10C/50F
15C/59F
20C/68F
25C/77F
18 days
11 days
7 days
5 days
30C/86F (35C/95F)
3 days
(2 days)
When the painted surface will be exposed to heavy duty service (e.g. exposure to
chemicals, heavy wear and tear), the recommended minimum curing time is:
Steel temperature
Minimum
10C/50F
15C/59F
20C/68F
25C/77F
7 days
5 days
3 days
2 days
30C/86F (35C/95F)
1 days
(1 day)
If not exposed to heavy duty service (eg exposure to light traffic only):
Steel temperature
Minimum
10C/50F
15C/59F
20C/68F
25C/77F
60 hours
40 hours
24 hours
16 hours
30C/86F (35C/95F)
12 hours
(8 hours)
Notes:
10C/50F
15C/59F
20C/68F
25C/77F
15 hours
10 hours
6 hours
5 hours
30C/86F (35C/95F)
4 hours
(3 hours)
1. The temperatures in the tables above are mean values, but the temperature
during curing should at no time come below 10C/50F.
2. Curing will proceed under water when the water temperature is above
10C/50F.
3. Less curing than stated above before exposure to seawater may result in significant
discoloration of the surface.
Remarks:
Safety:
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
ISSUED BY:
Page 3 of 3
Application Instructions
Product Data
HEMPALIN UNDERCOAT 42460
Description:
Recommended use:
Service temperatures:
Certificates/Approvals:
Approved as a low flame spread material by Danish, French, Spanish and Singaporean
authorities according to IMO resolution MSC 61 (67).
Has a Danish, French, Spanish, Singaporean, Malaysian and Indonesian EC-type
Examination Certificate.
Complies with EU Directive 2004/42/EC, subcategory i.
Please see REMARKS overleaf.
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos.:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Dry to touch:
V.O.C.:
White/10000
Flat
53 1
13.3 m/litre - 40 micron
531 sq.ft./US gallon - 1.6 mils
38C/100F
1.4 kg/litre - 11.7 lbs/US gallon
4 (approx.) hours at 20C/68F
385 g/litre - 3.2 lbs/US gallon
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Application method:
Thinner (max.vol.):
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval max:
Safety:
Airless spray
Air spray
Brush
08230 (5%)
08230 (15%)
08230 (5%)
.015"-.018"
150 bar/2200 psi
(Airless spray data are indicative and subject to adjustment)
THINNER 08230
40 micron/1.6 mils
75 micron/3 mils
See REMARKS overleaf
See REMARKS overleaf
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
PRECEDING
COAT:
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
REMARKS:
VOC - EU directive
2004/42/EC:
VOC:
Film thicknesses:
Thinning:
Recoating:
As supplied
15 vol. % thinning Limit phase I, 2007
VOC in g/l
395
450
600
For VOC of other shades, please refer to Safety Data Sheet.
Some of the certificates have been issued under the former quality number 4246.
May be specified in another film thickness than indicated depending on purpose and area of use.
This will alter spreading rate and may influence drying time and recoating interval. Normal range
dry is 30-40 micron/1.2-1.6 mils.
THINNER 08080 may be used for spray application, however, with a certain risk of wrinkling of a
preceding fresh HEMPALIN coat.
Recoating intervals related to later conditions of exposure:
(40 micron/1.6 mils dry film thickness of HEMPALIN UNDERCOAT 42460)
Minimum
Maximum
20C/68F
20C/68F
Atmospheric
Atmospheric
Surface Temperature
Recoated with
HEMPALIN
(white spirit only)
Mild
Medium
Mild
Medium
5 hours
8 hours
None
7 days
If this maximum recoating interval is exceeded, roughening of the surface is necessary to ensure
intercoat adhesion.
Before recoating after exposure in contaminated environment, clean surface thoroughly by (high
pressure) fresh water cleaning and allow to dry.
Note:
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPADUR 45080/
HEMPADUR 45083
Medium to high temperatures 45080: BASE 45089 with CURING AGENT 95010
Low to medium temperatures 45083: BASE 45089 with CURING AGENT 97480
Description:
Recommended use:
Service temperatures:
Certificates/Approvals:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Version; mixed product:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Surface dry:
Dry to touch:
Fully cured:
V.O.C.:
45080
Off-white/11630
Flat
48 1
6.4 m/litre - 75 micron
257 sq.ft./US gallon - 3 mils
30C/86F
1.4 kg/litre - 11.7 lbs/US gallon
1 (app) hours at 20C/68F (ISO 1517)
4 (app) hours at 20C/68F
7 days at 20C/68F
500 g/litre - 4.2 lbs/US gallon
45083
Off-white/11630
Flat
45 1
6.0 m/litre - 75 micron
241 sq.ft./US gallon - 3 mils
30C/86F
1.4 kg/litre - 11.7 lbs/US gallon
3 (app) hours at 10C/50F (ISO 1517)
6 (app) hours at 10C/50F
14 days at 10C/50F
520 g/litre - 4.3 lbs/US gallon
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Mixing ratio:
Application method:
Thinner (max.vol.):
Pot life:
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
45080
45083
Base 45089 : Curing agent 95010
Base 45089 : Curing agent 97480
8.4 : 1.6 by volume
8.4 : 1.6 by volume
Airless spray
Brush
Airless spray
Brush
08450 (5%)
08450 (5%)
08450 (5%)
08450 (5%)
6 hours (20C/68F)
4 hours (10C/50F) (Airless)
8 hours (20C/68F)
8 hours (10C/50F) (Brush)
.015"-.021"
150 bar/2100 psi
(Airless spray data are indicative and subject to adjustment)
HEMPELS TOOL CLEANER 99610 or THINNER 08450
75 micron/3 mils (See REMARKS overleaf)
150 micron/6 mils
See REMARKS overleaf
See REMARKS overleaf
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
HEMPADUR 45080/45083
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
Apply only on a dry and clean surface with a temperature above the dew point to avoid
condensation.
Use only where application and curing can proceed at temperatures above 10C/50F when using
CURING AGENT 95010, and above -10C/14F when using CURING AGENT 97480. The
temperature of the paint itself should be minimum 15C/59F.
In confined spaces provide adequate ventilation during application and drying.
PRECEDING
COAT:
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
REMARKS:
VOC - EU directive
2004/42/EC:
VOC:
Weathering/
service
temperatures:
Film thicknesses:
Recoating:
45080
5 vol. % thinning
Limit phase I, 2007
VOC in g/l
515
550
45083
As supplied
5 vol. % thinning
Limit phase I, 2007
VOC in g/l
520
535
550
For VOC of other shades, please refer to Safety Data Sheet.
As supplied
500
The natural tendency of epoxy coatings to chalk in outdoor exposure and to become more
sensitive to mechanical damage and chemical exposure at elevated temperatures is also
reflected in this product.
May be specified in another film thickness than indicated depending on purpose and area of use.
This will alter spreading rate and may influence drying time and recoating interval. Normal range
dry is 50-125 micron/2-5 mils.
Before recoating, clean the surface thoroughly of all contamination. Especially at long intervals
before recoating very careful cleaning is required.
To check adequate quality of the preparatory cleaning a test patch is recommended before actual
recoating.
Recoating intervals related to later conditions of exposure:
(75 micron/3 mils dry film thickness of HEMPADUR 45080/45083)
Curing agent 95010
Minimum
Surface temperature
Recoated with
Medium
HEMPATHANE
topcoats
Maximum
20C/68F
Atmospheric
Severe Medium
4 hours 8 hours
None*
Minimum
Maximum
10C/50F
Atmospheric
Severe Medium Severe
Severe
Medium
None*
6 hours 12 hours
None*
None*
*If there is any doubt about the adequacy of the surface preparation, a thin, fresh coat of
HEMPADUR 45080/45083 is applied to secure adhesion of the following coat.
Note:
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPADUR 45141/
HEMPADUR 45143
45141: BASE 45148 with CURING AGENT 97820
45143: BASE 45148 with CURING AGENT 97430
Description:
Recommended use:
1. As a high build primer, intermediate and/or finishing coat in (heavy duty) paint
systems according to specification. (As a finishing coat where a cosmetic
appearance is of less importance).
2. For repair and maintenance work at application temperatures above -10C/15F on
hatch covers, decks, in cargo holds, etc.
3. As a ballast tank coating.
HEMPADUR 45143 is intended for use in cold/temperate climates, HEMPADUR 45141
for warmer climates - see APPLICATION CONDITIONS overleaf.
Service temperatures:
Certificates/Approvals:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Version; mixed product:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Surface dry:
Dry to touch:
Fully cured:
V.O.C.:
45141
45143
Red/50630*
Red/50630*
Semi-gloss
Semi-gloss
60 1
60 1
4.0 m/litre - 150 micron
4.0 m/litre - 150 micron
160 sq.ft./US gallon - 6 mils
160 sq.ft./US gallon - 6 mils
26C/79F
26C/79F
1.3 kg/litre - 10.8 lbs/US gallon
1.3 kg/litre - 10.8 lbs/US gallon
4 (approx.) hrs at 20C/68F (ISO 1517) 5 (approx.) hrs at 5C/41F (ISO 1517)
7 (approx.) hours at 20C/68F
11 (approx.) hours at 5C/41F
7 (approx.) days at 20C/68F
20 (approx.) days at 5C/41F
380 g/litre - 3.2 lbs/US gallon
375 g/litre - 3.1 lbs/US gallon
*Other shades including a MIO version, colour no. 12430, according to assortment list.
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved
formulas. They are subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard
deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Mixing ratio:
Application method:
Thinner (max.vol.):
Pot life:
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
45141
45143
Base 45148 : Curing agent 97820
Base 45148 : Curing agent 97430
3 : 1 by volume
3 : 1 by volume
Airless spray Brush
Airless spray Brush
08450 (5%) 08450 (5%)
08450 (5%) 08450 (5%)
(See REMARKS overleaf)
(See REMARKS overleaf)
2 hrs (20C/68F) 4 hrs (20C/68F)
2 hrs (15C/59F) 4 hrs (15C/59F)
(See REMARKS overleaf)
(See REMARKS overleaf)
.019"-.023"
250 bar/3600 psi
(Airless spray data are indicative and subject to adjustment)
HEMPELS TOOL CLEANER 99610 or THINNER 08450
150 micron/ 6 mils (See REMARKS overleaf)
250 micron/10 mils
As per separate APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS
As per separate APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
Page 1 of 3
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
HEMPADUR 45141/45143
SURFACE
PREPARATION:
New steel: When used selfprimed surface preparation as to specification. When being an integral
part in heavy duty systems abrasive blasting to Sa 2. Reference is made to separate
APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS.
New steel, ballast tanks and similar areas: Abrasive blasting to Sa 2. For temporary protection,
if required, use a suitable shopprimer. All damage of shopprimer and contamination from storage
and fabrication should be thoroughly cleaned prior to final painting - preferably by abrasive
blasting. For repair and touch-up, use HEMPADUR 45141/45143.
Stainless steel: (Ballast tanks in chemical carriers) to be abrasive blasted to a uniform, sharp,
dense profile, ISO Comparator Medium (G), corresponding to Rz minimum 50 micron. Any salts,
grease, oil, etc. to be removed before abrasive blasting is commenced.
Repair and maintenance: Remove oil and grease, etc. with suitable detergent. Remove salt and
other contaminants by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning. Clean damaged areas thoroughly by
power tool cleaning to St 3 (spot-repairs) or by abrasive blasting to min. Sa 2, preferably to Sa 2.
Improved surface preparation will improve the performance of HEMPADUR 45141/45143.
As an alternative to dry cleaning, water jetting to sound, well adhering coat and/or to steel. Intact
coat must appear with roughened surface after the water jetting. By water jetting to steel,
cleanliness shall be Wa 2 - Wa 2 (atmospheric exposure) / minimum Wa 2 (immersion) (ISO
8501-4:2006). A flash-rust degree of maximum M (atmospheric exposure) / M, preferably L
(immersion) (ISO 8501-4:2006) is acceptable before application. Feather edges to sound and
intact paint. Dust off residues. On pit-corroded surfaces, excessive amounts of salt residues may
call for water jetting, wet abrasive blasting, alternatively dry abrasive blasting, high pressure fresh
water hosing, drying, and finally, dry abrasive blasting again.
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
Apply only on a dry an clean surface with a temperature above the dew point to avoid
condensation. HEMPADUR 45143 is intended for curing conditions down to -10C/14F,
HEMPADUR 45141 is to be selected in warmer climates. A shift from 45143 to 45141 is most
convenient to take place when the temperature is between 15C/59F and 25C/77F, however,
HEMPADUR 45141 may be used for curing conditions down to 0C/32F in cases where surfaces
are not to be immersed. Optimal spraying properties are obtained at paint temperatures of 1822C/64-72F. In warm climates, the paint should be stored in a cool place. At paint temperatures
below 15C/59F or in the case of very long spray hoses, thinning may be necessary. This will
cause lower film build and longer drying time.
In confined spaces provide adequate ventilation during application and drying.
PRECEDING COAT:
VOC - EU directive
2004/42/EC:
VOC:
As supplied
5 vol. % thinning
Limit phase I, 2007
VOC in g/l
375
400
550
For VOC of other shades, please refer to Safety Data Sheet.
Certificates/
Approvals:
Certificates have been issued under the former quality number 4514.
Approved by Lloyd's Register of Shipping as a recognised corrosion control coating. Tested for noncontamination of grain cargo at the Newcastle Occupational Health, Great Britain.
Approved as a ballast tank coating by Germanischer Lloyd, Germany.
Classified as a class 1 material according to BS 476, Part 7: 1987 (fire testing).
Accepted as a corrosion control coating by Maritime Register of Shipping, Russia.
Complies with Section 175.300 of the Code of Federal Regulations in respect of carriage of dry
foodstuffs (FDA) in spaces with an internal surface area larger than 1000 m/10,750 sq.ft.
The natural tendency of epoxy coatings to chalk in outdoor exposure and to become more
sensitive to mechanical damage and chemical exposure at elevated temperatures is also
reflected in this product.
Light shades will have a tendency to yellow when exposed to sunshine.
May be specified in another film thickness than indicated depending on purpose and area of use.
This will alter spreading rate and may influence drying time and recoating interval. Normal range
dry is 125-175 micron/5-7 mils.
Curing agent 97820 and 97430 are hazy. This is intended and has no negative influence on the
performance.
Thinning above 5% may cause lower film build and slower drying/curing. Mix the components
thoroughly.
If the paint temperature, as an exception, is below approx. 10C/50F, allow the mixture to prereact 30 minutes before use.
Weathering/
service
temperatures:
Colour:
Film thicknesses:
Curing agent:
Thinning:
Induction time:
Page 2 of 3
HEMPADUR 45141/45143
Recoating:
Note:
ISSUED BY:
This Product Data Sheet supersedes those previously issued. For explanations, definitions and scope, see Explanatory
Notes in the HEMPEL Book.
Data, specifications, directions and recommendations given in this data sheet represent only test results or experience
obtained under controlled or specially defined circumstances. Their accuracy, completeness or appropriateness under the
actual conditions of any intended use of the Products herein must be determined exclusively by the Buyer and/or User. The
Products are supplied and all technical assistance is given subject to HEMPEL's GENERAL CONDITIONS OF SALES,
DELIVERY AND SERVICE, unless otherwise expressly agreed in writing. The Manufacturer and Seller disclaim, and Buyer
and/or User waive all claims involving, any liability, including but not limited to negligence, except as expressed in said
GENERAL CONDITIONS for all results, injury or direct or consequential losses or damages arising from the use of the
Products as recommended above, on the overleaf or otherwise.
Product data are subject to change without notice and become void five years from the date of issue.
Page 3 of 3
Application
Application Instructions
Instructions
For product description refer to product data sheet
HEMPADUR 45141/
HEMPADUR 45143
45141: BASE 45148 with CURING AGENT 97820
45143: BASE 45148 with CURING AGENT 97430
Scope:
Surface preparation:
Page 1 of 5
HEMPEL
HEMPEL
Application
Instructions
Application Instructions
HEMPADUR 45141/45143
Stainless steel: (Ballast tanks in chemical carriers) to be abrasive blasted to a
uniform, sharp, dense profile, ISO Comparator Medium (G), corresponding to Rz
minimum 50 micron. Any salts, grease, oil, etc. to be removed before abrasive
blasting is commenced.
2. If the HEMPADUR 45141/45143 will form an integral part of heavy duty systems
(impact and antiabrasion purposes) best performance will be obtained by applying it
directly to the blast-cleaned steel, subsidiary using HEMPADUR 15590 as "blast
primer".
Note: On old steel surfaces having been exposed to salt water, excessive amounts of
salt residues in pittings may call for high pressure water jetting, wet abrasive blasting,
alternatively dry abrasive blasting, high pressure fresh water hosing, drying, and finally,
dry abrasive blasting again.
Application equipment:
min 45:1
12 litres/minute (theoretical)
min. 6 bar/90 psi
max 100 metres/300 feet, internal diameter
max. 30 metres/100 feet, 3/8" internal diameter
max. 6 metres/20 feet, 1/4" internal diameter
60 mesh
Regular surfaces:
Nozzle size:
Fan angle:
.021"-.023"
60-80.
Page 2 of 5
Application Instructions
HEMPADUR 45141/45143
On poorly prepared surfaces it is always recommended to apply first coat by brush.
Extra thinning will facilitate the penetration of the paint material but will also require an
extra layer to be applied.
Wet/dry film thickness:
The thixotropic nature of HEMPADUR 45141/45143 may give a rather "wavy" surface of
the paint just after application. This smoothens at drying but can make it necessary to
let the wet film readings be of a higher value than indicated. In many cases, the wet
film thickness reading should be 25-50 micron/1-2 mils higher than calculated. As the
wavy surface becomes smoother at drying this extra wet film thickness readings will not
cause higher paint consumption than otherwise stipulated.
Pot life:
When measured under standard conditions the pot life is 2 hours at 15C/59F when
using CURING AGENT 97430. However, for a 20 litres/5 US gallons mix, the heat
developed by the chemical reaction between BASE and CURING AGENT may make the
corresponding practical pot life shorter.
At these temperatures therefore: Irrespective of equipment, use the paint immediately
after mixing. (At a normal application speed the 20 litres/5 US gallons are used in
approx. 10 minutes.) Anyhow, at paint temperatures, as an exception, being lower than
15C/59F allow the mixture to pre-react approximately 30 minutes before use. After
this induction time, apply the paint immediately.
Safety:
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
ISSUED BY:
Attached:
To check whether the quality of the surface cleaning is adequate, a test patch may be
relevant.
This Product Data Sheet supersedes those previously issued.
For explanations, definitions and scope, see Explanatory Notes in the HEMPEL Book.
Data, specifications, directions and recommendations given in this data sheet represent only test results or
experience obtained under controlled or specially defined circumstances. Their accuracy, completeness or
appropriateness under the actual conditions of any intended use of the Products herein must be determined
exclusively by the Buyer and/or User.
The Products are supplied and all technical assistance is given subject to HEMPEL's GENERAL CONDITIONS OF
SALES, DELIVERY AND SERVICE, unless otherwise expressly agreed in writing. The Manufacturer and Seller
disclaim, and Buyer and/or User waive all claims involving, any liability, including but not limited to negligence,
except as expressed in said GENERAL CONDITIONS for all results, injury or direct or consequential losses or
damages arising from the use of the Products as recommended above, on the overleaf or otherwise.
Product data are subject to change without notice and become void five years from the date of issue.
Page 3 of 5
Application Instructions
HEMPADUR 45141/45143
Physical data
versus temperature:
20C/68F
30C/86F
7 hours
7 days
3 hours
3 days
6 hours
8 hours
3 hours
4 hours
11 hours
11 hours
6 hours
6 hours
8 hours
9 hours
12 hours
4 hours
5 hours
6 hours
12 hours
12 hours
6 hours
6 hours
10 hours
10 hours
5 hours
5 hours
Medium
Severe
3 days
1 days
36 hours
18 hours
None
None
30 days
None
None
15 days
Page 4 of 5
Application Instructions
HEMPADUR 45141/45143
Physical data
versus temperature:
-10C/14F
0C/32F
10C/50F
20C/68F
35 hours
2 months
14 hours
28 days
7 hours
14 days
4 hours
7 days
28 hours
36 hours
14 hours
18 hours
6 hours
8 hours
3 hours
4 hours
Not relevant
Not relevant
12 hours
12 hours
6 hours
6 hours
Not relevant
Not relevant
36 hours
45 hours
54 hours
18 hours
23 hours
27 hours
8 hours
10 hours
12 hours
4 hours
5 hours
6 hours
4 days
4 days
45 hours
45 hours
20 hours
20 hours
10 hours
10 hours
34 hours
34 hours
15 hours
15 hours
7 hours
7 hours
Not relevant
Not relevant
6 days
3 days
3 days
1 days
None
None
60 days
None
None
30 days
2 days
2 days
Not relevant
Not relevant
None
None
(90 days)
None
None
90 days
Page 5 of 5
Application Instructions
Product Data
HEMPADUR 45182
CURING AGENT 98180
Description:
Recommended use:
For marine and protective use as a "tiecoat" (tackcoat) between epoxy and physically
drying coatings. For marine use also as a sealer of old antifouling.
Service temperatures:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos.:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Dry to touch:
Fully cured:
V.O.C.:
Yellowish grey/25150
Flat
46 1
4.6 m/litre - 100 micron
184 sq.ft./US gallon - 4 mils
23C/73F
1.3 kg/litre - 10.8 lbs/US gallon
6 (approx.) hours at 20C/68F
7 days at 20C/68F
485 g/litre - 4.0 lbs/US gallon
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Mixing ratio for 45182:
Application method:
Thinner (max.vol.):
Pot life:
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
HEMPADUR 45182
SURFACE
PREPARATION:
New steel: Abrasive blasting to Sa 2. For temporary protection if required use suitable
shopprimer. Any damage of shopprimer and contamination from storage and fabrication should be
thoroughly cleaned prior to final painting. For priming purposes, specified HEMPADUR paint.
Maintenance: Remove oil and grease, etc. with suitable detergent. Remove salt and other
contaminants by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning.
When used as tiecoat: remove all rust and other loose material by abrasive blasting or power
tool cleaning. Feather edges to sound and intact areas. Dust off residues. Touch up to full film
thickness with specified HEMPADUR paint (see REMARKS below).
When used as sealer on old antifouling: a very careful high pressure freshwater cleaning -or
jetting, if needed - to remove possible leached layer of antifouling and make sure that old layers of
weak intercoat adhesion (sandwich structure) really are removed.
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
Use only where application and curing can proceed at temperatures higher than -10C/14F. The
temperature of the surface and that of the paint itself must also be above this limit. Apply only on
a dry and clean surface with a temperature above the dew point to avoid condensation.
In
confined spaces such as sea chest or stagnant air under large flat bottoms provide adequate
ventilation during application and drying.
PRECEDING
COAT:
HEMPADUR systems according to specification. In case of an old antifouling system this must be
well cleaned and in good condition.
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
REMARKS:
Film thicknesses:
Note:
May be specified in another film thickness than indicated depending on purpose and area of use.
This will alter spreading rate and may influence drying time and recoating interval. Normal range
dry is 75-125 micron/3-5 mils.
As sealer typically to be specified in 50 -75 micron/2-3 mils dry film thickness. Thinning may be
required to facilitate proper film formation.
HEMPADUR 45182 is designed for recoating with antifoulings in any normal specified total
film thicknesses. HEMPADUR 45182 is not designed for recoating with heavy duty epoxy systems.
Later maintenance of paint systems with HEMPADUR 45182 as a part of the system is
accordingly most conveniently carried out by touch-up with a mastic type epoxy and with a
proper overlap of intact surrounding paint system.
A completely clean surface is mandatory to ensure intercoat adhesion, especially in the case of
long recoating intervals. Any dirt, oil and grease have to be removed with eg suitable detergent
followed by high pressure fresh water cleaning. Salts to be removed by fresh water hosing. Any
degraded surface layer, as a result of a long exposure period, must be removed as well. Water
jetting may be relevant to remove any degraded surface layer and may also replace the abovementioned cleaning methods when properly executed. To check whether the quality of the surface
cleaning is adequate, a test patch may be relevant. A thin extra coat of HEMPADUR 45182 may
advantageously be applied if there is any doubt about suitability of cleaning process.
HEMPADUR 45182 is for professional use only.
ISSUED BY:
Film thicknesses,
subsequent coats:
Recoating:
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPADUR HI-BUILD 45200
BASE 45209 with CURING AGENT 95040
Description:
HEMPADUR HI-BUILD 45200 is a two-component, high build epoxy paint. It forms a hard
and tough coating resistant to seawater, mineral oils and splashes from petrol and
related products.
Recommended use:
Service temperatures:
Certificates/Approvals:
Complies with Section 175.300 of U.S. Federal Regulations in respect of carriage of dry
foodstuffs.
Complies with EU Directive 2004/42/EC, subcategory j (see REMARKS overleaf).
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Surface dry:
Dry to touch:
Fully cured:
V.O.C.:
Grey/12170*
Semi-flat
58 1
7.3 m/litre - 80 micron
291 sq.ft./US gallon - 3.2 mils
26C/79F
1.3 kg/litre - 10.8 lbs/US gallon
2 (approx.) hrs at 20C/68F (ISO 1517)
5-7 hours at 20C/68F
7 days at 20C/68F
390 g/litre - 3.3 lbs/US gallon
*Other shades according to assortment list.
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Mixing ratio for 45200:
Application method:
Thinner (max. vol.):
Pot life:
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
Apply only on a dry and clean surface with a temperature above the dew point to avoid
condensation. Use only when application and curing can proceed at temperatures above
10C/50F, preferably above 15C/59F. The temperature of the surface must also be above this
limit. The temperature of the paint itself should be 15C/60F or above to secure proper
application properties. In confined spaces provide adequate ventilation during application and
drying.
PRECEDING
COAT:
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
REMARKS:
VOC - EU directive
2004/42/EC:
VOC:
Colours:
As supplied
5 vol. % thinning
Limit phase I, 2007
VOC in g/l
425
445
550
For VOC of other shades, please refer to Safety Data Sheet.
Recoating interval:
Certain lead-free red and yellow colours may discolour when exposed to chlorine- containing
atmosphere.
Leaded colours may become discoloured when exposed to sulphide-containing atmosphere.
To obtain full opacity, an extra coat may be necessary, especially for certain lead-free colours in eg
red, orange, yellow and green.
The natural tendency of epoxy coatings to chalk in outdoor exposure and to become more
sensitive to mechanical damage and chemical exposure at elevated temperatures is also
reflected in this product.
May be specified in another film thickness than indicated depending on purpose and area of use.
This will alter spreading rate and may influence drying time and recoating interval. Normal range dry
is 60-90 micron/2.4-3.6 mils for use on containers. For other uses (contact Hempel) normal range
is 100-125 micron/4-5 mils which is achieved by none or limited diluting at application.
According to relevant container painting specification.
Note:
ISSUED BY:
Weathering/
service
temperatures:
Film thicknesses:
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPADUR MULTI-STRENGTH 45540
BASE 45549 with CURING AGENT 97531
Description:
Recommended use:
As a self-primed, high build coating primarily for maintenance of eg splash zones, jetty
pilings and bridge under decks.
Service temperatures:
Maximum:
Certificates/Approvals:
Conforms with NORSOK M-501, rev. 4, system no. 7 below splash zone.
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Surface dry:
Dry to touch:
Fully cured:
V.O.C.:
Black/19990
Glossy
84 1
2.4 m/litre - 350 microns
96 sq.ft./US gallon - 14 mils
26C/79F
1.7 kg/litre
14.2 lbs/US gallon
4 (approx.) hours at 20C/68F
6 (approx.) hours at 20C/68F
7 days at 20C/68F
180 g/litre - 1.5 lbs/US gallon
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Mixing ratio for 45540:
Application method:
Thinner (max.vol.):
Pot life:
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
New steel (dry conditions): Abrasive blasting to Sa 2, (ISO 8501-1:2007) with a surface profile
equivalent to Rugotest No. 3 BN 10, Keane-Tator Comparator 3.0 G/S or ISO Comparator, rough
Medium (G).
Remove any oil, grease and other contaminants by detergent and salts by high fresh water hosing
prior to abrasive blasting.
Maintenance: Remove oil and grease, etc. with suitable detergent. Remove salt and other
contaminants by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning. Remove all rust and loose material by wet or
dry abrasive blasting or for minor areas power tool cleaning. Feather edges to sound and intact
areas. After wet abrasive blasting hose down the surface by hot water rinsing ("steam cleaning").
Touch up bare spots to full film thickness when the surface has become visually dry.
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
HEMPADUR MULTI-STRENGTH 45540 may be applied and will cure at temperatures down to
5C/41F.
The temperature of the paint itself should be above 15C/59F. The best result is obtained at 2030C/68-86F.
In confined spaces provide adequate ventilation.
PRECEDING
COAT:
None.
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
REMARKS:
Weathering/
service
temperatures:
Colour:
Service
temperatures:
Recoating:
The natural tendency of epoxy coatings to chalk in outdoor exposure and to become more
sensitive to mechanical damage and chemical exposure at elevated temperatures is also
reflected in this product.
Being an epoxy paint this product is not colour stable, therefore light shades will have a strong
tendency to yellow when exposed to sunshine and darken when exposed to heat.
Maximum peak temperature in water is 90C/194F.
If the maximum recoat interval is exceeded, roughening of the surface is necessary to ensure
adhesion.
Note:
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPADUR PRO 45601/
HEMPADUR PRO 45603
45601: BASE 45609 with CURING AGENT 97330
45603: BASE 45609 with CURING AGENT 98420
Description:
Recommended use:
As a universal primer and self primed high performance coating system for atmospheric
or in-water service. HEMPADUR 45603 is intended for use in cold/temperate climates
and for in-shop applications where fast recoating and handling is required, HEMPADUR
45601 is intended for use in temperate to warm climates. For in-water service, the
aluminium shade (19870) can advantageously be used as first coat.
Certificates/Approvals:
Availability:
Features:
Service temperatures:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Version; mixed product:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Dry to touch:
Fully cured:
V.O.C.:
45601
Grey 12170*
Semi-flat
65 1
4.3 m/litre - 150 micron
174 sq.ft./US gallon - 6 mils
32C/90F
1.3 kg/litre - 11.7 lbs/US gallon
7 hours (app.) at 20C/68F
7 days at 20C/68F
310 g/litre - 2.6 lbs/US gallon
*) See REMARKS overleaf
45603
Grey 12170*
Semi-flat
65 1
4.3 m/litre - 150 micron
174 sq.ft./US gallon - 6 mils
32C/90F
1.3 kg/litre - 11.7 lbs/US gallon
16 hours (app.) at 5C/41F
20 days at 5C/41F
310 g/litre - 2.5 lbs/US gallon
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Mixing ratio:
Application method:
Thinner (max.vol.):
Pot life:
Induction time:
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
45601
45603
Base 45609 : Curing agent 97330
Base 45609 : Curing agent 98420
4 : 1 parts by volume
4 : 1 parts by volume
Airless spray
Brush
Airless spray
Brush
08450 (5%)
08450 (5%)
08450 (5%)
08450 (5%)
2 hours (20C/68F)
2 hours (20C/68F)
See REMARKS overleaf
.021"-.025"
250 bar/3600 psi
(Airless spray data are indicative and subject to adjustment)
HEMPELS TOOL CLEANER 99610
150 micron/6 mils (See REMARKS overleaf)
225 micron/9 mils
See separate APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS
See separate APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
New steel: When used as an intermediate or finishing coat please refer to the data sheet for the
preceding GALVOSIL or HEMPADUR primer. When used as a primer please refer to the
specification.
Ballast tanks: For PSPC type approved coating, consult separate APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS BALLAST TANKS for HEMPADUR PRO 45601/45603.
Zinc silicate painted or spray-metallized surfaces: Remove oil and grease, etc. with suitable
detergent. Remove salt and other contaminants by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning. Zinc salts
(white rust) must be removed by high pressure hosing combined with rubbing with a stiff nylon
brush if necessary. It is recommended to recoat spray-metallized surfaces as soon as possible to
avoid possible contamination.
Concrete: Remove slip agent and other possible contaminants by emulsion washing followed by
high pressure hosing with fresh water. Remove scum layer and loose matter to a hard, rough and
uniform surface, preferably by abrasive blasting, possibly by other mechanical treatment or acid
etching. Seal surface with suitable sealer e.g. HEMPADUR SEALER 05990, as per relevant painting
specification.
Major refurbishment of steel: Remove oil and grease, etc. with suitable detergent. Remove salt
and other contaminants by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning. Clean damaged areas thoroughly
by abrasive blasting to min. Sa 2. As an alternative to dry cleaning, water jetting may be
employed. When water-jetting to bare steel the degree of cleaning shall be min. Wa 2 (ISO 85014:2006). A flash-rust degree of maximum M for atmospheric exposure and M, preferably L for
immersion service (ISO 8501-4:2006) is acceptable.
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
Use only where application and curing can proceed at temperatures above -10C/14F (curing
agent 98420) and 0C/32F (curing agent 97330). The temperature of the paint itself should be
above 15C/59F for proper application. Apply only on a dry and clean surface with a temperature
above the dew point to avoid condensation.
In confined spaces provide adequate ventilation during application and drying.
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
REMARKS:
Weathering/
service
temperatures:
Film thicknesses:
The natural tendency of epoxy coatings to chalk in outdoor exposure and to become more
sensitive to mechanical damage and chemical exposure at elevated temperatures is also
reflected in this product.
May be specified in another film thickness than indicated depending on purpose and area of use.
This will alter spreading rate and may influence drying time and recoating interval. Normal range
dry is 125-200 micron/5-8 mils.
Shades:
Other shades including a MIO-pigmented, is available according to assortment list. The aluminium
pigmented version 19870 is designed for primer-coat application, holds same volume solids
(65%), but has a slightly higher VOC (340 g/litre - 2.8 lbs/US gallon) than the other shades.
Curing agent:
Curing agent 98420 is hazy. This is intended and has no negative influence on performance.
Mixing/
To facilitate proper application properties it is recommended to allow the thoroughly mixed BASE
induction time:
and CURING AGENT to pre-react before application. In case two-component spray-equipment is
used, consult separate APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS.
Application onto zinc It is recommended to apply HEMPADUR PRO 45601/45603 by using a "mist-coat" procedure:
silicate or sprayA thin coat is applied (the mist coat) and after a few minutes, a second coat is applied in the full
metallized surfaces specified film thickness. Depending on actual conditions of application, such as temperature,
(thinning):
porosity of substrate, method of spray, thinning (up to 50%) may be required.
Note:
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Application
Application Instructions
Instructions
For product description refer to product data sheet
Surface preparation:
Application equipment:
HEMPADUR PRO 45601/45603 being a high viscosity material, may require special
measures to be taken at application.
Recommended airless spray equipment:
Pump ratio:
Pump output:
Input pressure:
Spray hoses:
Filter:
min 45:1
12 litres/minute (theoretical)
min. 6 bar/90 psi
max. 100 metres/300 feet, internal diameter
max. 30 metres/100 feet, 3/8" internal diameter
max. 6 metres/20 feet, 1/4" internal diameter
60 mesh
Nozzle size:
Fan angle:
.021"-.025
60-80.
Page 1 of 5
HEMPEL
HEMPEL
Application
Instructions
Application Instructions
First coat on steel substrates: HEMPADUR PRO 45601/3 in shade 19870 (Grey Alu) is recommended as first coat
when the product is applied directly to steel substrates - independent of method of
surface preparation.
Application on
zinc silicate or spray
metallised surfaces:
Pot life/mixing/
induction time
(both curing agents):
Mix the entire content of corresponding base and curing agent packing. If it is
necessary to mix smaller portions, this must be done properly by either weighing
base and curing agent in the prescribed weight ratio: 86 parts by weight of base
and 14 parts by weight of curing agent or by volume: 4.0 parts by volume base and
1.0 parts by volume curing agent.
b.
Stir the mixed paint thoroughly by means of a clean mechanical mixer until a
homogeneous mixture is obtained.
c.
Use all mixed paint before the pot life is exceeded. The pot life depends on the
temperature of the paint as shown in table below (valid for a 20 litres can):
15C/59F1)
20C/68F
25C/77F
30C/86F2)
3 hours
2 hours
1 hours
1 hour
At 15C/59F and below, the viscosity can be too high for airless spray application.
Temperatures above 30C/86F should preferably be avoided.
Induction time:
At steel temperatures below 5C/41F the paint may advantageously be prereacted 1020 minutes before spray application (longer pre-reaction time at lower temperatures).
Page 2 of 5
Application Instructions
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
ISSUED BY:
Attached:
To check whether the quality of the surface cleaning is adequate, a test patch may be
relevant.
Page 3 of 5
Application Instructions
0C/32F
10C/50F
20C/68F
30C/86F
40C/104F
Drying time
Curing time
32 hours
28 days
14 hours
14 days
7 hours
7 days
5 hours
3 days
3 hours
2 days
Initial curing
20 days
10 days
5 days
2 days
1 days
Recoating:
-10C/14F
0C/32F
10C/50F
20C/68F
30C/86F
Drying time
Curing time
45 hours
56 days
23 hours
28 days
10 hours
14 days
5 hours
7 days
4 hours
3 days
Initial curing
40 days
20 days
10 days
5 days
2 days
10C/50
20C/68F
30C/86F
12 hours
12 hours
6 hours
6 hours
6 hours
7 hours
8 hours
4 hours
5 hours
5 hours
3 days
1 days
36 hours
18 hours
None
None
30 days
None
None
15 days
24 hours
24 hours
12 hours
14 hours
16 hours
Medium
Severe
6 days
3 days
None
None
90 days
20 days
6 days
Not relevant
10 days
3 days
Not relevant
5 days
36 hours
Not relevant
Page 4 of 5
Application Instructions
-10C/14F
0C/32F
10C/50F
20C/68F
Not relevant
Not relevant
Not relevant
Not relevant
16 hours
16 hours
8 hours
8 hours
36 hours
45 hours
54 hours
18 hours
23 hours
27 hours
8 hours
10 hours
12 hours
4 hours
5 hours
6 hours
Not relevant
Not relevant
Not relevant
Not relevant
6 days
3 days
3 days
1 days
None
None
60 days
None
None
30 days
20 days
6 days
10 days
3 days
None
None
(90 days)
None
None
90 days
90 days
30 days
45 days
15 days
Workshop application:
For Workshops managing strict consumption control and equipped with proper
ventilation, minimum recoat interval may be reduced for HEMPADUR PRO 45603:
(125 micron/5 mils dry film thickness of HEMPADUR PRO 45603)
Surface temperature
10C/50F
20C/68F
30C/86F
2 hours
2 hours
1 hours
1 hours
Page 5 of 5
4 hours
4 hours
Application Instructions
Application Instructions
BALLAST TANKS
Application Instructions
Scope:
The steel shall preferably be Rust Grade A or B according to ISO 8501-1:2007. The use
of steel with Rust Grade C requires more tight inspection of surface profile after blasting as well as of possible salt contamination. Rust grade D is not should not be used
for ballast tanks.
The steel surface shall be prepared so that the coating achieves an even distribution at
the specified nominal dry film thickness of 320 micron and has an adequate adhesion
by removing sharp edges, grinding weld beads and removing weld spatter and any other
surface contamination. PSPC makes reference to ISO 8501-3: Preparation of steel
substrates before application of paints and related products - Visual assessment of surface cleanliness.
For optimum performance the following is recommended: All welding seams shall be
partially dressed to remove irregular profiles.
Surface pores, pits and craters shall be sufficiently open to allow penetration of the
paint.
Sharp edges shall be treated to a rounded radius of minimum 2 mm, subjected to a
three-pass grinding or treated with an equivalent process that produces an edge profile
that results in a dry film thickness retention equivalent to or better than that of three
pass grinding. Sharp edge means all edges except natural rounded/rolled edges of sections or profiled steel bars.
Visible roll overs/laminations shall be removed.
The surface shall be free of all welding spatter.
Abrasive blasting/
abrasive sweep blasting:
The coating system shall only be applied on steel primed with a pre-qualified zinc containing inhibitor free zinc silicate shopprimer according to PSPC, Table 1.2.1-3. Steel
shopprimed with a shopprimer not pre-qualified must be abrasive blast cleaned to Sa 2
removing at least 70% of intact shopprimer, while steel, which has not been
shopprimed must be blasted to Sa 2.
Before blasting any deposits of grease or oil must be removed from the steel surface
using a suitable detergent followed by fresh water hosing. Minor spots of oil/grease
may be cleaned with thinner and clean rags - avoid smearing out the contamination.
Possible alkali weld deposits, chemicals used for testing of welds, soap residues from
the pressure testing must be removed by fresh water hosing.
The shopprimer must have been checked randomly for excessive film thickness. Areas
detected to have film thicknesses above approx 40 micron/1.6 mils (as measured directly on the shopprimed surface with equipment calibrated on smooth steel) are to be
blasted to Sa 2 removing at least 70% of the shopprimer.
Welds as well as shopprimed areas with damage, burn marks and rust must be blasted
to Sa 2.
Page 1 of 5
HEMPEL
Application Instructions
Application Instructions
BALLAST
BALLAST TANKS
TANKS
Application Instructions
HEMPADUR 17630
PRO 45601/45603
Welds coated with a temporary (shop)primer after welding must be cleaned by hard
abrasive sweeping, preferably abrasive blasting.
Spot-checks for possible salt contamination of the surface must be executed after secondary surface preparation. The upper water soluble salts limit is 50 mg/m sodium
chloride equivalents when measured according to ISO 8502-9:1998. To limit salt contamination from abrasives it is recommended to use abrasives showing a water-soluble
contaminant level equivalent to less than 25 mS/m according to ISO 11127-6:1993.
When blasting, the importance of working systematically must be stressed. Poorly
blasted areas covered with dust are very difficult to locate during the blast inspection
made after the rough cleaning.
In the case of full or partial abrasive blast cleaning, the surface profile must be 40-75
micron/1.6-3.0 mils approximately equivalent to Rugotest No. 3, BN9-BN10 or KeaneTator Comparator, 3.0 G/S or to ISO 8503-1, grade Medium (G).
Dust must be removed just before application of the paint to a dust quantity rating 1
for dust size class 3, 4 or 5. Lower dust size classes shall be removed from the
surface if visible without magnification.
Note: If any doubt exists about the quality of the primary surface preparation (before
shoppriming), the substrate must be re-blasted in situ as defined above.
Block assembly zones: Overlap zones must be treated with great care. Damage caused
by possible over-blasting must be avoided, paint edges must be feathered and consecutive layers of paint coatings given larger and larger overlaps. Roughening must be carried out when the maximum recoating interval is exceeded (when sand papering, use
free-cut paper, grain size 80).
Furthermore, these areas may be either masked off with tape - to keep them as narrow
as possible. Application of a thin zinc epoxy primer coat on these areas after secondary
surface preparation at block stage is acceptable if removed before the application of
HEMPADUR PRO 45601/45603.
Secondary surface preparation of block assembly zones is preferably abrasive spotblasting. However, mechanical cleaning to St 3 may be acceptable if zones are narrow
and an extra coat of HEMPADUR PRO 45601/45603 is applied to these areas. The procedure of masking off with tape or using the zinc epoxy primer as described above may
advantageously be used in case of mechanical cleaning.
Stainless steel: (Ballast tanks of chemical carriers) To be abrasive blast cleaned to a
uniform, sharp, dense, profile (Rugotest No. 3, BN9-10, ISO Comparator Medium (G),
Keane-Tator Comparator 2.0 G/S corresponding to Rz minimum 50 micron). Any salts,
grease, oil etc. shall be removed before abrasive blasting is commenced. Surface
preparation and paint application to be carried out concurrently with treatment of surrounding carbon steel.
Application equipment:
HEMPADUR PRO 45601/45603, being a high viscosity material, may require special
measures to be taken at application.
Recommended airless spray equipment:
Pump ratio:
Pump output:
Input pressure:
Spray hoses:
Issued:
2007
Issued: September
December 2007
Filter:
min 45:1
12 litres/minute (theoretical)
min. 6 bar/90 psi
max. 100 metres/300 feet, internal diameter
max. 30 metres/100 feet, 3/8" internal diameter
max. 6 metres/20 feet, 1/4" internal diameter
60 mesh
Nozzle size:
Fan angle:
.021"-.025
60-80.
Page
Page 22 of
of 55
Application Instructions
Application Instructions
BALLAST
BALLAST TANKS
TANKS
Application Instructions
HEMPADUR 17630
PRO 45601/45603
PSPC requires the application of minimum two spray applied coatings and minimum two
stripe coats.
Spray application: A continuous, pinhole-free paint film must be obtained at application
of each spray applied coat. An application technique which will ensure good film formation on all surfaces must be adopted. It is very important to use nozzles of the correct
size, not too large, and to have a proper, uniform distance of the spray gun to the surface, 30-50 cm should be aimed at. Furthermore, great care must be taken to cover
edges, openings, rear sides of stiffeners etc. even though these areas also must be
stripe coated. To obtain good and steady atomising, the viscosity of the paint must be
suitable and the spray equipment must be sufficient in output pressure and capacity. At
high working temperatures, use of extra thinner may be necessary to avoid dust spray.
The paint layer must be applied homogeneously and as close to the specification as
possible. Care shall be taken to avoid exaggerated film thicknesses. Wet film thickness
shall be regularly checked during the application.
The finished coating must appear as a homogeneous film with a smooth surface and
irregularities such as dust, dry spray, abrasives, should be remedied.
Stripe coating: The required two stripe coats must each be applied as a coherent film
showing good film formation and no visible defects such as pores or un-wetted areas.
The application method must ensure that all areas which require stripe coating are
properly stripe coated by alternative application methods which include brush or roller.
Application by airless spray requires the use of relatively small, narrow-angled nozzles.
PSPC accepts that the second stripe coat, by way of welded seams only, may be reduced in scope where it is proven that the nominal dry film thickness (NDFT) can be met
by the coats applied. The first stripe coating should preferably be applied after first full
coat to avoid contamination of the steel substrate.
Pot life/mixing/
induction time:
Issued:
2007
Issued: September
December 2007
When measured under standard conditions the pot life is 3 hours at 15C/59F and 2
hours at 20C/68F. However, for a 20 litres/5 US gallons mix, the heat developed by
the chemical reaction between BASE and CURING AGENT may make the corresponding
practical pot life shorter.
a.
Mix the entire content of corresponding base and curing agent packing. If it is
necessary to mix smaller portions, this must be done properly by either weighing
base and curing agent in the prescribed weight ratio: 86 parts by weight of base
and 14 parts by weight of curing agent or by volume: 4.0 parts by volume base and
1.0 parts by volume curing agent.
b.
Stir the mixed paint thoroughly by means of a clean mechanical mixer until a
homogeneous mixture is obtained.
c.
Use all mixed paint before the pot life is exceeded. The pot life depends on the
temperature of the paint as shown in table below (valid for a 20 litres can):
Page
Page 33 of
of 55
Application Instructions
Application Instructions
BALLAST
BALLAST TANKS
TANKS
Application Instructions
HEMPADUR 17630
PRO 45601/45603
15C/59F1)
20C/68F
25C/77F
30C/86F2)
3 hours
2 hours
1 hours
1 hour
Pot life
1)
2)
At 15C/59F and below, the viscosity can be too high for airless spray application.
Temperatures above 30C/86F should preferably be avoided.
Induction time:
At steel temperatures below 5C/41F the paint may advantageously be prereacted 1020 minutes before spray application (longer prereaction time at lower steel temperatures).
Two-component spray equipment: Heating may be required to obtain a proper spray fan
and a uniform and smooth paint film. This can either be done by preheating the twocomponent paint or by using a flow-heater on the pressure side. As an indication, a
paint temperature of approx 40C/104F will be relevant, but has to be adjusted according to the actual conditions.
Dry film thickness:
PSPC requires that the nominal dry film thickness (NDFT) shall be 320 micron and
achieved by minimum two spray coats and two stripe coats. The dry film thickness distribution shall be evaluated according to the 90/10 rule.
Dry film thickness (DFT)
DFT
micron/mils
Remark
Minimum DFT
per coat
90/3.5
2,000/80
The maximum DFT is valid for isolated spots less than 1% of the total surface
area per tank. The stated maximum DFT is for guidance and should be kept as
close to the specified nominal DFT as possible. Frequent control of wet film
thickness during application is recommended
Maximum DFT
(complete coating system)
Physical data
versus temperature:
0C/32F
10C/50F
20C/68F
30C/86F
40C/104F
Drying time
Walk-on time
Curing time
32 hours
32 hours
28 days
14 hours
14 hours
14 days
7 hours
7 hours
7 days
5 hours
5 hours
3 days
3 hours
3 hours
2 days
Initial curing*
20 days
10 days
5 days
2 days
1 days
-10C/14F
0C/32F
10C/50F
20C/68F
30C/86F
Drying time
Walk-on time
Curing time
45 hours
45 hours
56 days
23 hours
23 hours
28 days
10 hours
10 hours
14 days
5 hours
5 hours
7 days
4 hours
4 hours
3 days
Initial curing*
40 days
20 days
10 days
5 days
2 days
* When the state "initial curing" has been reached, the coating may exceptionally be exposed
to ballast water provided it has been applied within the specified limits of film thicknesses
and that all painted areas have been subject to thorough ventilation.
Recoating:
10C/50F
Minimum
20C/68F 30C/86F
40C/104F 10C/50F
Maximum
20C/68F 30C/86F
17 hours
9 hours
4 hours
30 days*
7 hours
60 days*
40C/104F
22 days* 15 days*
Depending on actual local conditions, extended maximum recoating intervals may apply. Please contact
HEMPEL for further advice.
** Stripe coat can be applied when it is possible to walk on the surface without damage to the coating.
Issued:
2007
Issued: September
December 2007
Page
Page 44 of
of 55
Application Instructions
Application Instructions
BALLAST
BALLAST TANKS
TANKS
Application Instructions
HEMPADUR 17630
PRO 45601/45603
Minimum
-10C/14F 0C/32F
10C/50F
20C/68F
Maximum
-10C/14F 0C/32F
10C/50F
20C/68F
59 hours
7 hours
90 days*
30 days*
29 hours
13 hours
90 days*
60 days*
Depending on actual local conditions, extended maximum recoating intervals may apply. Please contact
HEMPEL for further advice.
** Stripe coat can be applied when it is possible to walk on the surface without damage to the coating.
Any degraded surface layer, as a result of a long exposure period, must be removed
as well. Water jetting may be relevant to remove any degraded surface layer and may
also replace the above-mentioned cleaning methods when properly executed. Consult HEMPEL for specific advice if in doubt.
To check whether the quality of the surface cleaning is adequate, a test patch may be
relevant.
8.2 Repair process
Safety:
ISSUED BY:
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
HEMPEL A/S - 4560112170CS002 / 4560312170CS002
Page
Page 55 of
of 55
Application Instructions
Product Data
HEMPADUR MULTI-STRENGTH 45751/
HEMPADUR MULTI-STRENGTH 45753
Medium to high temperatures: 45751: BASE 45755 with CURING AGENT 97652
Low to medium temperatures: 45753: BASE 45755 with CURING AGENT 98750
Description:
Recommended use:
Service temperatures:
Certificates/Approvals:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Version; mixed product:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Dry to touch:
Fully cured:
V.O.C.:
HEMPADUR MULTI-STRENGTH 45751/45753 is a self-priming, two-component, highbuild, epoxy-polyamide/amine paint which cures to an abrasion and corrosion resistant
coating. Applicable by standard heavy duty airless spray equipment.
As a heavy duty coating for areas exposed to abrasion and aggressive corrosive climate
such as ramps, ship hulls and holds of bulk carriers.
As a ballast tank coating for special purposes such as chemical carriers carrying hot
cargoes and other purposes where pure epoxy coating is requested.
As a finishing coat where a cosmetic appearance is of less importance.
HEMPADUR MULTI-STRENGTH 45751 is intended for use in warm climates.
HEMPADUR MULTI-STRENGTH 45753 is intended for use in cold climates - see
APPLICATION CONDITIONS overleaf.
Dry exposure only:
Maximum 140C/284F (See REMARKS overleaf)
Ballast water service:
Resists normal ambient temperatures at sea*
Other water service:
50C/122F (no temperature gradient)
Other liquids:
Contact HEMPEL
*Avoid long-term exposure to negative temperature gradients.
Tested for non-contamination of grain cargo at the Newcastle Occupational Health,
Great Britain. Approved by Lloyds Register of Shipping as a recognized corrosion control
coating. Approved as a ballast tank coating by Germanischer Lloyd, Germany.
HEMPADUR MULTI-STRENGTH 45753 has been classified B1 by DNV, Norway.
Recognized by Lloyds Register of Shipping as a low friction surface coating for ships
navigating in first year ice conditions. Conforms with Norsok M-501, system no. 7.
HEMPADUR MULTI-STRENGTH 45753 has been tested by Teknologisk Institutt AS,
Norway, and approved for internal use in pipe lines for water power generation according
to NS 5417.
Complies with EU Directive 2004/42/EC, subcategory j (see REMARKS overleaf).
Part of Group Assortment. Local availability subject to confirmation.
45751
Grey/12340 - Red/50630
Semi-gloss
79 1
4.0 m/litre - 200 micron
158 sq.ft./US gallon - 8 mils
27C/81F
1.6 kg/litre - 13.4 lbs/US gallon
7-8 hours at 20C/68F
7 days at 20C/68F
260 g/litre - 2.2 lbs/US gallon
45753
Grey/12340 - Red/50630
Semi-gloss
79 1
4.0 m/litre - 200 micron
158 sq.ft./US gallon - 8 mils
27C/81F
1.6 kg/litre - 13.4 lbs/US gallon
8-10 hours at 10C/50F
14 days at 10C/50F
245 g/litre - 2.0 lbs/US gallon
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Mixing ratio:
Application method:
Thinner (max.vol.):
Pot life:
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
45751
45753
Base 45755 : Curing agent 97652
Base 45755 : Curing agent 98750
3 : 1 by volume
3 : 1 by volume
Airless spray
08450 (5%)(See PRECEDING COAT overleaf and separate APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS)
1 hour (20C/68F)
1 hour (20C/68F)
.021"-.023"
.021"-.023"
250 bar/3600 psi
250 bar/3600 psi
(Airless spray data are indicative and subject to adjustment)
HEMPELS TOOL CLEANER 99610
200 micron/8 mils
200 micron/8 mils
250 micron/10 mils
250 micron/10 mils
6 hours (20C/68F)
12 hours (10C/50F)
See REMARKS overleaf
See REMARKS overleaf
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
Page 1 of 3
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
SURFACE
PREPARATION:
New steel:
"Heavy duty use": Abrasive blasting to min. Sa 2 with a surface profile corresponding to
Rugotest No. 3, min. BN10, Keane-Tator Comparator 3.0 G/S, or ISO Comparator Rough Medium
(G). Oil and grease must be removed with suitable detergent, salts and other contaminants by
(high pressure) fresh water hosing prior to blasting. After blasting, clean the surface carefully from
abrasive and dust.
Ballast tanks: For PSPC type approved coating, consult separate APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS BALLAST TANKS for HEMPADUR MULTI-STRENGTH 45753.
Stainless steel: (Ballast tanks in chemical carriers) to be abrasive blasted to a uniform, sharp,
dense profile, ISO Comparator Medium (G), corresponding to Rz minimum 50 micron. Any salts,
grease, oil, etc. to be removed before abrasive blasting is commenced.
Repair and maintenance: The actual purpose and conditions may make other types and degrees
of surface preparation than the above described relevant. Reference is made to separate
application instructions.
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
Use only where application and curing can proceed at temperatures above -10C/14F for
HEMPADUR MULTI-STRENGTH 45753 and above 10C/50F for HEMPADUR MULTI-STRENGTH
45751. The temperature of the paint itself should be above 15C/59F, preferably above
20C/68F for HEMPADUR MULTI-STRENGTH 45751, for proper application. Apply only on a dry
and clean surface with a temperature above the dew point to avoid condensation. Relative
humidity max. 90%. In confined spaces provide adequate ventilation during application and drying.
PRECEDING
COAT:
None, but HEMPADUR 15590 can be used as a "blast primer" for HEMPADUR MULTI-STRENGTH
45751. HEMPADUR MULTI-STRENGTH 45753 can be used as a "blast primer for HEMPADUR
MULTI-STRENGTH 45753 when diluted 25-30% with HEMPELS THINNER 08450.
SUBSEQUENT COAT: None, HEMPADUR or HEMPATHANE-paint as per specification, depending on area of use.
REMARKS:
VOC - EU directive
2004/42/EC:
VOC:
Colour of curing
agent:
Weathering/
service
temperatures:
Film thicknesses:
Curing agent:
45751
5 vol. % thinning
Limit phase I, 2007 Limit phase II, 2010
VOC in g/l
290
550
500
45753
As supplied
5 vol. % thinning
Limit phase I, 2007 Limit phase II, 2010
VOC in g/l
245
275
550
500
For VOC of other shades, please refer to Safety Data Sheet.
The curing agent 98750 has a tendency to become darker at storage. This has no influence on
performance, but may influence the shade of the mixed product.
Some certificates have been issued under the former quality numbers 45750 or 4575.
HEMPADUR MULTI-STRENGTH 45751 is identical with the former 45750 except that mixing ratio
and thixotropy properties have been adjusted to specific demands of application, for instance dual
feed two component spray equipment and supply in 1000 litres paint containers.
The natural tendency of epoxy coatings to chalk in outdoor exposure and to become more
sensitive to mechanical damage and chemical exposure at elevated temperatures is also
reflected in this product.
May be specified in another film thickness than indicated depending on purpose and area of use.
This will alter spreading rate and may influence drying time and recoating interval. Normal range
dry is 150-250 micron/6-10 mils. It is recommended to use heavy airless spray equipment with a
pump transmission rate of 60:1 (approximately), and a theoretical output of min. 12 litres per
minute.
Curing agents 97652 and 98750 are hazy. This is intended and has no negative influence on the
performance.
As supplied
260
Page 2 of 3
Recoating:
Minimum
Maximum
20C/68F
Atmospheric
Medium
Severe
10C/50F
Atmospheric
Immer-
Medium Severe
Atmospheric
Immersion *
Medium
Severe
sion *
Atmospheric
Immer-
Medium Severe
Immersion *
sion *
HEMPADUR
4 hours
5 hours
6 hours
None
HEMPATHANE Topcoat
4 hours
5 hours
N/R
10 days
None
3 days
30 days
N/R
8 hours
10 hours 12 hours
8 hours
10 hours
N/R
None
20 days
None
6 days
60 days
N/R
* and heavy wear - eg bulk cargo holds and fender areas. If such areas are to be topcoated with HEMPATHANE, same max as
for atmospheric/severe apply. The long maximum recoating interval for HEMPADUR will be reduced if the coating is more than
just scarcely exposed to direct sunshine before recoating. If the interval is exceeded, roughening of surface is necessary to
ensure intercoat adhesion.
Thinning:
Note:
ISSUED BY:
This Product Data Sheet supersedes those previously issued. For explanations, definitions and scope, see Explanatory
Notes in the HEMPEL Book.
Data, specifications, directions and recommendations given in this data sheet represent only test results or experience
obtained under controlled or specially defined circumstances. Their accuracy, completeness or appropriateness under the
actual conditions of any intended use of the Products herein must be determined exclusively by the Buyer and/or User. The
Products are supplied and all technical assistance is given subject to HEMPEL's GENERAL CONDITIONS OF SALES,
DELIVERY AND SERVICE, unless otherwise expressly agreed in writing. The Manufacturer and Seller disclaim, and Buyer
and/or User waive all claims involving, any liability, including but not limited to negligence, except as expressed in said
GENERAL CONDITIONS for all results, injury or direct or consequential losses or damages arising from the use of the
Products as recommended above, on the overleaf or otherwise.
Product data are subject to change without notice and become void five years from the date of issue.
Page 3 of 3
Application
Application Instructions
Instructions
For product description refer to product data sheet
Surface preparation:
The specific type and degree of surface preparation depends on type and condition of
the actual substrate and on desired performance. The better the surface preparation
the better the performance, but it will not always be economic feasible to go for the
highest degree within a given type of surface preparation.
For use as a heavy duty coating:
Bulk cargo holds, fender areas, hulls of ice-going vessels, ramps, splash zones etc.:
New steel:
Abrasive blasting to min. Sa 2 with a surface profile corresponding to Rugotest No. 3,
min. BN10, Keane-Tator Comparator 3.0 G/S, or ISO Comparator Rough Medium (G). Oil
and grease must be removed with suitable detergent, salts and other contaminants by
(high pressure) fresh water hosing prior to blasting. After blasting, clean the surface
carefully from abrasive and dust. HEMPADUR 15590 may be used as a blast
primer/hold-coat (min. temperature 10C/50F) or alternatively HEMPADUR MULTISTRENGTH 45751 or HEMPADUR MULTI-STRENGTH 45753 (for temperatures below
10C/50F) diluted 15-25% with HEMPELS THINNER 08450.
Old steel:
For old steel with widespread surface corrosion, often in the state of large areas of fine,
dense pit-corrosion - like Grade D, ISO 8501-1:2007 - an overall degree of cleaning
corresponding to Sa 2 can be the economical optimum treatment of surfaces exposed
to combined mechanical abrasion/impact and atmospheric corrosion in marine
environments. May advantageously be combined with a thorough fresh water hosing - or
replaced by a water jetting - (degree Wa 2 according to ISO 8501-4:2006) as long as
the formation of flash rust is low, (maximum degree M as per ISO 8501-4:2006).
The fresh water cleaning will assist in removal of salt residues, yet total removal of
salts embedded in the pittings will in practise, on large areas, be extremely difficult
irrespective of method of cleaning.
In cases where elimination of risk of osmotic blistering is important, for instance
frequently/permanently immersed surfaces or fresh water exposure a combined dry
abrasive blasting, to remove black scale and water jetting (minimum Wa 3) may be
relevant (possible formation of flash rust to be maximum, L).
After water jetting as surface preparation it is recommended to apply a diluted
HEMPADUR MULTI-STRENGTH 45751/45753 (15-25% THINNER 08450) as an (extra)
first coat. Surfaces to be dry at application.
Concrete: The concrete must be of good quality and fully cured, eg 28 days for normal
Portland cement, and completely dry with a humidity content in the surface below 4%.
The concrete must also be controlled for absence of capillary water action or for subsoil
water.
Minimum pull-off value should normally be 20 kilopond/cm measured after surface
preparation. Any cracks, crevices and voids must be repaired (see below).
All possible slip agent, oil, grease and other contaminants must be removed by eg
abrasive blasting, volatilising by flame cleaning or treatment with suitable detergent.
The last mentioned in the following way: Saturation of the surface with fresh water.
Washing with suitable detergent followed by fresh water hosing.
Page 1 of 6
HEMPEL
HEMPEL
Application
Instructions
Application Instructions
Ballast tanks,
surface preparation:
Before blasting any deposits of grease or oil must be removed from the steel surface
with a suitable detergent followed by fresh water hosing. Minor spots of oil/grease may
be cleaned with thinner and clean rags - avoid smearing out the contamination. Possible
alkali weld deposits, chemicals used for testing of welds, soap residues from the
pressure testing must be removed by fresh water hosing.
Newbuilding/new steelwork: To obtain full performance of the ballast tank coating,
welds, burns, damaged and rusty shopprimer must be abrasive blast cleaned to Sa 2.
Minor areas mechanically cleaned to St 3.
If welds have previously been coated with a (shop)primer just after welding this
(shop)primer must be removed by abrasive blasting (sweeping) in order to obtain
optimum performance.
Page 2 of 6
Application Instructions
Page 3 of 6
Application Instructions
min 45:1
12 litres/minute (theoretical)
min. 6 bar/90 psi
max. 100 metres/300 feet, internal diameter
max. 30 metres/100 feet, 3/8" internal diameter
max. 6 metres/20 feet, 1/4" internal diameter
60 mesh
Regular surfaces:
Nozzle size:
Fan angle:
Ballast tanks
.021"-.023
60-80
Complicated surfaces:
Nozzle size:
.019"
Fan angle:
40.
After finishing the application, clean the equipment immediately with HEMPELS TOOL
CLEANER 99610.
Note: Increasing spray hose diameter may ease paint flow thereby improving the spray
fan. If longer hoses are necessary it may be necessary to raise the pump ratio to 60:1,
maintaining the high output capacity of the pump.
Alternatively up to approximately 5% THINNER 08450 may be added, but thinning must
be done with care as the maximum obtainable film thickness is reduced significantly by
overthinning. Airless spray data are indicative and subject to adjustment.
Application:
Page 4 of 6
Application Instructions
When measured under standard conditions the pot life is 2 hours at 15C/59F and 1
hours at 20C/68F. However, for a 20 litres/5 US gallons mix, the heat developed by
the chemical reaction between BASE and CURING AGENT may make the corresponding
practical pot life shorter.
a.
Mix the entire content of corresponding base and curing agent packings. If it is
necessary to mix smaller portions, this must be done properly by either weighing
base and curing agent. The weight ratio for HEMPADUR MULTI-STRENGTH
45751/45753 is 135 parts by weight of base and 25 parts by weight of curing
agent or by volume: 3.0 parts by volume base and 1.0 parts by volume curing
agent.
b.
Stir the mixed paint thoroughly by means of a clean mechanical mixer until a
homogeneous mixture is obtained.
c.
Use all mixed paint before the pot life is exceeded. The pot life depends on the
temperature of the paint as shown in table below (valid for a 20 litres can):
15C/59F1)
20C/68F
25C/77F
30C/86F2)
Pot life
2 hours
1 hour
hour
(1/4 hour)
1) At 15C/59F and below, the viscosity will be too high for airless spray application.
2) Temperatures above 30C/86F should be avoided.
Induction time:
At Steel temperatures below 5C/41F the paint may advantageously be prereacted 10
minutes before spray application (longer prereaction time at lower steel temperatures).
When two-component spray equipment is used, heating may be relevant to obtain a
proper spray fan and a uniform and smooth paint film. This can either be done by
preheating the two-component paint or by using a flow-heater on the pressure side. As
an indication, a paint temperature of approx 40C/104F will be relevant, but has to be
adjusted according to the actual conditions.
Physical data
versus temperature:
10C/50F
20C/68F
30C/86F
Drying time
Curing time*
20 hours
18 days
8 hours
7 days
4 hours
3 days
Initial curing*
13 days
5 days
2 days
-10C/14F
0C/32F
10C/50F
Drying time
Curing time*
45 hours
63 days
23 hours
32 days
10 hours
14 days
Initial curing*
45 days
23 days
10 days
Page 5 of 6
Application Instructions
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
ISSUED BY:
Page 6 of 6
Application Instructions
Application Instructions
BALLAST TANKS
Application Instructions
Scope:
The steel shall preferably be Rust Grade A or B according to ISO 8501-1:2007. The use
of steel with Rust Grade C requires more tight inspection of surface profile after blasting as well as of possible salt contamination. Rust grade D is not should not be used
for ballast tanks.
The steel surface shall be prepared so that the coating achieves an even distribution at
the specified nominal dry film thickness of 320 micron and has an adequate adhesion
by removing sharp edges, grinding weld beads and removing weld spatter and any other
surface contamination. PSPC makes reference to ISO 8501-3: Preparation of steel
substrates before application of paints and related products - Visual assessment of surface cleanliness.
For optimum performance the following is recommended: All welding seams shall be
partially dressed to remove irregular profiles.
Surface pores, pits and craters shall be sufficiently open to allow penetration of the
paint.
Sharp edges shall be treated to a rounded radius of minimum 2 mm, subjected to a
three-pass grinding or treated with an equivalent process that produces an edge profile
that results in a dry film thickness retention equivalent to or better than that of three
pass grinding. Sharp edge means all edges except natural rounded/rolled edges of sections or profiled steel bars.
Visible roll overs/laminations shall be removed.
The surface shall be free of all welding spatter.
Abrasive blasting/
abrasive sweep blasting:
The coating system shall only be applied on steel primed with a pre-qualified zinc containing inhibitor free zinc silicate shopprimer according to PSPC, Table 1.2.1-3. Steel
shopprimed with a shopprimer not pre-qualified must be abrasive blast cleaned to Sa 2
removing at least 70% of intact shopprimer, while steel, which has not been
shopprimed must be blasted to Sa 2.
Before blasting any deposits of grease or oil must be removed from the steel surface
using a suitable detergent followed by fresh water hosing. Minor spots of oil/grease
may be cleaned with thinner and clean rags - avoid smearing out the contamination.
Possible alkali weld deposits, chemicals used for testing of welds, soap residues from
the pressure testing must be removed by fresh water hosing.
The shopprimer must have been checked randomly for excessive film thickness. Areas
detected to have film thicknesses above approx 40 micron/1.6 mils (as measured directly on the shopprimed surface with equipment calibrated on smooth steel) are to be
blasted to Sa 2 removing at least 70% of the shopprimer.
Welds as well as shopprimed areas with damage, burn marks and rust must be blasted
to Sa 2.
Surfaces with zinc salts, deposits of black iron oxides from plasma cutting, markings
and similar foreign matters shall be cleaned by light abrasive sweep blasting.
Page 1 of 5
HEMPEL
Application Instructions
Application Instructions
BALLAST
BALLAST TANKS
TANKS
Application Instructions
HEMPADUR 17630
MULTI-STRENGTH 45753
Welds coated with a temporary (shop)primer after welding must be cleaned by hard
abrasive sweeping, preferably abrasive blasting.
Spot-checks for possible salt contamination of the surface must be executed after secondary surface preparation. The upper water soluble salts limit is 50 mg/m sodium
chloride equivalents when measured according to ISO 8502-9:1998. To limit salt contamination from abrasives it is recommended to use abrasives showing a water-soluble
contaminant level equivalent to less than 25 mS/m according to ISO 11127-6:1993.
When blasting, the importance of working systematically must be stressed. Poorly
blasted areas covered with dust are very difficult to locate during the blast inspection
made after the rough cleaning.
In the case of full or partial abrasive blast cleaning, the surface profile must be 40-75
micron/1.6-3.0 mils approximately equivalent to Rugotest No. 3, BN9-BN10 or KeaneTator Comparator, 3.0 G/S or to ISO 8503-1, grade Medium (G).
Dust must be removed just before application of the paint to a dust quantity rating 1
for dust size class 3, 4 or 5. Lower dust size classes shall be removed from the
surface if visible without magnification.
Note: If any doubt exists about the quality of the primary surface preparation (before
shoppriming), the substrate must be re-blasted in situ as defined above.
Block assembly zones: Overlap zones must be treated with great care. Damage caused
by possible over-blasting must be avoided, paint edges must be feathered and consecutive layers of paint coatings given larger and larger overlaps. Roughening must be carried out when the maximum recoating interval is exceeded (when sand papering, use
free-cut paper, grain size 80).
Furthermore, these areas may be either masked off with tape - to keep them as narrow
as possible. Application of a thin zinc epoxy primer coat on these areas after secondary
surface preparation at block stage is acceptable if removed before the application of
HEMPADUR MULTI-STRENGTH 45753.
Secondary surface preparation of block assembly zones is preferably abrasive spotblasting. However, mechanical cleaning to St 3 may be acceptable if zones are narrow
and an extra coat of HEMPADUR MULTI-STRENGTH 45753 is applied to these areas.
The procedure of masking off with tape or using the zinc epoxy primer as described
above may advantageously be used in case of mechanical cleaning.
Stainless steel: (Ballast tanks of chemical carriers) To be abrasive blast cleaned to a
uniform, sharp, dense, profile (Rugotest No. 3, BN9-10, ISO Comparator Medium (G),
Keane-Tator Comparator 2.0 G/S corresponding to Rz minimum 50 micron). Any salts,
grease, oil etc. shall be removed before abrasive blasting is commenced. Surface
preparation and paint application to be carried out concurrently with treatment of surrounding carbon steel.
Application equipment:
HEMPADUR MULTI-STRENGTH 45753, being a high viscosity material, may require special measures to be taken at application.
Recommended airless spray equipment:
Pump ratio:
Pump output:
Input pressure:
Spray hoses:
Issued:
2007
Issued: September
December 2007
Filter:
min 45:1
12 litres/minute (theoretical)
min. 6 bar/90 psi
max. 100 metres/300 feet, internal diameter
max. 30 metres/100 feet, 3/8" internal diameter
max. 6 metres/20 feet, 1/4" internal diameter
60 mesh
Regular surfaces:
Nozzle size:
Fan angle:
.021"-.023
60-80
Page
Page 22 of
of 55
Complicated surfaces
Nozzle size:
.019"
Fan angle:
60
Application Instructions
Application Instructions
BALLAST
BALLAST TANKS
TANKS
Application Instructions
HEMPADUR 17630
MULTI-STRENGTH 45753
After finishing the application, clean the equipment immediately with HEMPELS TOOL
CLEANER 99610.
Note: Increasing hose diameter may ease paint flow thereby improving the spray fan. If
longer hoses are used it may be necessary to increase the pump ratio to 60:1, maintaining the high output capacity of the pump.
Alternatively up to approximately 5% THINNER 08450 may be added, but thinning must
be done with care as the maximum obtainable film thickness is reduced significantly by
exaggerated thinning.
Airless spray data are indicative and subject to adjustment.
Application:
PSPC requires the application of minimum two spray applied coatings and minimum two
stripe coats.
Spray application: A continuous, pinhole-free paint film must be obtained at application
of each spray applied coat. An application technique which will ensure good film formation on all surfaces must be adopted. It is very important to use nozzles of the correct
size, not too large, and to have a proper, uniform distance of the spray gun to the surface, 30-50 cm should be aimed at. Furthermore, great care must be taken to cover
edges, openings, rear sides of stiffeners etc. even though these areas also must be
stripe coated. To obtain good and steady atomising, the viscosity of the paint must be
suitable and the spray equipment must be sufficient in output pressure and capacity. At
high working temperatures, use of extra thinner may be necessary to avoid dust spray.
The paint layer must be applied homogeneously and as close to the specification as
possible. Care shall be taken to avoid exaggerated film thicknesses. Wet film thickness
shall be regularly checked during the application.
The finished coating must appear as a homogeneous film with a smooth surface and
irregularities such as dust, dry spray, abrasives, should be remedied.
Stripe coating: The required two stripe coats must each be applied as a coherent film
showing good film formation and no visible defects such as pores or un-wetted areas.
The application method must ensure that all areas which require stripe coating are
properly stripe coated by alternative application methods which include brush or roller.
Application by airless spray requires the use of relatively small, narrow-angled nozzles.
PSPC accepts that the second stripe coat, by way of welded seams only, may be reduced in scope where it is proven that the nominal dry film thickness (NDFT) can be met
by the coats applied. The first stripe coating should preferably be applied after first full
coat to avoid contamination of the steel substrate.
Pot life/mixing/
induction time:
Issued:
2007
Issued: September
December 2007
When measured under standard conditions the pot life is 3 hours at 15C/59F and 2
hours at 20C/68F. However, for a 20 litres/5 US gallons mix, the heat developed by
the chemical reaction between BASE and CURING AGENT may make the corresponding
practical pot life shorter.
a.
Mix the entire content of corresponding base and curing agent packing. If it is
necessary to mix smaller portions, this must be done properly by either weighing
base and curing agent in the prescribed weight ratio: 86 parts by weight of base
and 14 parts by weight of curing agent or by volume: 4.0 parts by volume base and
1.0 parts by volume curing agent.
b.
Stir the mixed paint thoroughly by means of a clean mechanical mixer until a
homogeneous mixture is obtained.
c.
Use all mixed paint before the pot life is exceeded. The pot life depends on the
temperature of the paint as shown in table below (valid for a 20 litres can):
Page
Page 33 of
of 55
Application Instructions
Application Instructions
BALLAST
BALLAST TANKS
TANKS
Application Instructions
HEMPADUR 17630
MULTI-STRENGTH 45753
15C/59F1)
20C/68F
25C/77F
30C/86F2)
2 hours
1 hour
hour
(1/4 hour)
Pot life
1)
2)
At 15C/59F and below, the viscosity can be too high for airless spray application.
Temperatures above 30C/86F should preferably be avoided.
Induction time:
At steel temperatures below 5C/41F the paint may advantageously be prereacted 10
minutes before spray application (longer prereaction time at lower steel temperatures).
Two-component spray equipment: Heating may be required to obtain a proper spray fan
and a uniform and smooth paint film. This can either be done by preheating the twocomponent paint or by using a flow-heater on the pressure side. As an indication, a
paint temperature of approx 40C/104F will be relevant, but has to be adjusted according to the actual conditions.
Dry film thickness:
PSPC requires that the nominal dry film thickness (NDFT) shall be 320 micron and
achieved by minimum two spray coats and two stripe coats. The dry film thickness distribution shall be evaluated according to the 90/10 rule.
Dry film thickness (DFT)
DFT
micron/mils
Remark
Minimum DFT
per coat
90/3.5
2,000/80
The maximum DFT is valid for isolated spots less than 1% of the total surface
area per tank. The stated maximum DFT is for guidance and should be kept as
close to the specified nominal DFT as possible. Frequent control of wet film
thickness during application is recommended
Maximum DFT
(complete coating system)
Physical data
versus temperature:
-10C/14F
0C/32F
10C/50F
20C/68F
Drying time
Walk-on time
Curing time
32 hours
54 hours
63 days
16 hours
27 hours
32 days
7 hours
12 hours
14 days
3 hours
6 hours
7 days
Initial curing*
45 days
23 days
10 days
5 days
* When the state "initial curing" has been reached, the coating may exceptionally be exposed
to ballast water provided it has been applied within the specified limits of film thicknesses
and that all painted areas have been subject to thorough ventilation.
Recoating:
Minimum
-10C/14F 0C/32F
10C/50F
20C/68F
Maximum
-10C/14F 0C/32F
10C/50F
20C/68F
41 hours
5 hours
90 days*
(30 days*)
21 hours
9 hours
90 days*
60 days*
Depending on actual local conditions, extended maximum recoating intervals may apply. Please contact
HEMPEL for further advice.
** Stripe coat can be applied when it is possible to walk on the surface without damage to the coating.
Issued:
2007
Issued: September
December 2007
Page
Page 44 of
of 55
Application Instructions
Application Instructions
BALLAST
BALLAST TANKS
TANKS
Application Instructions
HEMPADUR 17630
MULTI-STRENGTH 45753
Any degraded surface layer, as a result of a long exposure period, must be removed
as well. Water jetting may be relevant to remove any degraded surface layer and may
also replace the above-mentioned cleaning methods when properly executed. Consult HEMPEL for specific advice if in doubt.
To check whether the quality of the surface cleaning is adequate, a test patch may be
relevant.
8.2 Repair process
Safety:
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
ISSUED BY:
Issued:
2007
Issued: September
December 2007
Page
Page 55 of
of 55
Application Instructions
Product Data
HEMPADUR MASTIC 45880/
HEMPADUR MASTIC 45881
High temperatures: 45881: BASE 45889 with CURING AGENT 95881
Low to medium temperatures: 45880: BASE 45889 with CURING AGENT 95880
Description:
Recommended use:
Service temperatures:
Certificates/Approvals:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Version, mixed product:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Dry to touch:
Fully cured:
V.O.C.:
45880
45881
Grey/12170*
Grey/12170*
Semi--gloss
Semi--gloss
77 1
77 1
3.9 m/litre - 200 micron
3.9 m/litre - 200 micron
154 sq.ft./US gallon - 8 mils
154 sq.ft./US gallon - 8 mils
35C/95F
35C/95F
1.4 kg/litre - 11.7 lbs/US gallon
1.4 kg/litre - 11.7 lbs/US gallon
4 (approx) hours at 20C/68F
3 (approx) hours at 30C/86F
7 days at 20C/68F
5 days at 30C/86F
220 g/litre - 1.8 lbs/US gallon
220 g/litre - 1.8 lbs/US gallon
*Other shades including a MIO version, colour no. 12430, according to assortment list.
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Version:
Mixing ratio:
Application method:
Thinner (max. vol.):
Pot life:
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min/max:
Safety:
45880
45881
Base 45889 : Curing agent 95880
Base 45889 : Curing agent 95881
3 : 1 by volume
3 : 1 by volume
Airless spray
Brush (touch up)
Airless spray
Brush (touch up)
Depending on purpose usually less than 5% THINNER 08450 (See REMARKS overleaf)
1 hour (20C/68F) (Airless spray)
1 hour (30C/86F) (Airless spray)
2 hours (20C/68F) (Brush)
2 hours (30C/86F) (Brush)
.017"-.023" (See separate APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS)
250 bar/3600 psi (Airless spray data are indicative and subject to adjustment)
HEMPELS TOOL CLEANER 99610 or HEMPEL'S THINNER 08450
200 micron/8 mils (see REMARKS overleaf)
275 micron/11 mils
According to separate APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and paint
containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or national safety
regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do not swallow. Take
precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as protection of the environment.
Apply only in well ventilated areas
Page 1 of 3
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
New steel: When used as an intermediate or finishing coat please refer to the data sheet for the
preceding GALVOSIL or HEMPADUR primer. When used as a primer please refer to the
specification.
Zinc silicate painted or spray-metallized surfaces: Remove oil and grease, etc. with suitable
detergent. Remove salt and other contaminants by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning. Zinc salts
(white rust) must be removed by high pressure hosing combined with rubbing with a stiff nylon
brush if necessary. It is recommended to recoat spray-metallized surfaces as soon as possible to
avoid possible contamination.
Concrete: Remove slip agent and other possible contaminants by emulsion washing followed by
high pressure hosing with fresh water. Remove scum layer and loose matter to a hard, rough and
uniform surface, preferably by abrasive blasting, possibly by other mechanical treatment or acid
etching. Seal surface with suitable sealer, as per relevant painting specification.
Repair and maintenance: Remove oil and grease, etc. with suitable detergent. Remove salt and
other contaminants by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning. Clean damaged areas thoroughly by
power tool cleaning to minimum St 2 (spot-repairs) or by abrasive blasting to min. Sa 2, preferably
to Sa 2. Improved surface preparation will improve the performance of HEMPADUR MASTIC
45880/45881. As an alternative to dry cleaning, water jetting to min. Wa 2 (ISO 85014:2006)(or according to specification), may be used. A flash-rust degree of maximum M (ISO 85014:2006) is acceptable before application. Feather edges to sound and intact paint. Dust off
residues.
On pit-corroded surfaces, excessive amounts of salt residues may call for water jetting, wet
abrasive blasting, alternatively dry abrasive blasting, high pressure fresh water hosing, drying, and
finally, dry abrasive blasting again.
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
Apply only on a dry and clean surface with a temperature above the dew point to avoid
condensation. Use only when application and curing can proceed at temperatures above -5C/23F
(recommended lowest temperature is 0C/32F) for HEMPADUR MASTIC 45880 and above approx
15C/59F for HEMPADUR MASTIC 45881. The temperature of the paint itself should be
15C/59F or above, but advantageously below approximately 30C/86F to secure proper
application properties. Optimal spraying properties are obtained at a paint temperature of 1822C/64-72F. In warmer climates, the paint should be stored in a cool place and the paint
temperature should preferably be kept below 30C/86F. In confined spaces provide adequate
ventilation during application and drying. In cases where faster drying at very low temperatures is
required, HEMPADUR MASTIC 45880 may advantageously be replaced by HEMPADUR 45143.
Please also see separate APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS.
PRECEDING and
SUBSEQUENT COAT: None or according to specification.
REMARKS:
VOC - EU directive
2004/42/EC:
45880
5 vol. % thinning
Limit phase I, 2007 Limit phase II, 2010
VOC in g/l
305
550
500
45881
As supplied
5 vol. % thinning
Limit phase I, 2007 Limit phase II, 2010
VOC in g/l
255
280
550
500
VOC:
For VOC of other shades, please refer to Safety Data Sheet.
Certificates have been issued under the former quality number 4588.
Colours/ColourCertain lead-free red and yellow colours may discolour when exposed to chlorine- containing
stability:
atmosphere.
Leaded colours may become discoloured when exposed to sulphide-containing atmosphere.
Like other epoxy coatings in white/whitish colour a yellowing may take place in cases of
application under unfavourable weather conditions, especially sudden drops in temperature during
drying and initial cure and/or lack of ventilation.
Weathering/service The natural tendency of epoxy coatings to chalk in outdoor exposure and to become more
temperatures:
sensitive to mechanical damage and chemical exposure at elevated temperatures is also
reflected in this product.
Film thicknesses/
May be specified in another film thickness than indicated depending on purpose and area of use.
thinning:
This will alter spreading rate and may influence drying time and recoating interval. Normal range
dry is 125-200 micron/5-8 mils. May be specified in lower film thickness for which purpose
additional thinning is required, please see separate APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS.
Avoid application of excessive film thicknesses.
As supplied
275
Page 2 of 3
Note:
ISSUED BY:
Page 3 of 3
Application
Application Instructions
Instructions
For product description refer to product data sheet
Surface preparation:
Page 1 of 6
HEMPEL
HEMPEL
Application
Instructions
Application Instructions
HEMPADUR MASTIC 45880/45881 being a high solids and a relatively high viscosity
material, may require special measures to be taken at application.
Recommended airless spray equipment:
Pump ratio:
Pump output:
min. 45:1
12 litres/minute (theoretical)
Input pressure:
Spray hoses:
Regular surfaces:
Nozzle size:.021" through .023"
Fan angle: 60.
After finishing the application, clean the equipment immediately with THINNER 08450 or
HEMPELS TOOL CLEANER 99610.
Note: Increasing hose diameter may increase paint flow, thereby improving the spray
fan. If longer hoses are necessary it may be necessary to raise the pump ratio to 60:1,
maintaining the high output capacity of the pump.
Alternatively up to approx. 5% THINNER 08450 may be added, but thinning must be
done with care as the anti-sagging properties are drastically reduced by overthinning.
Airless spray data are indicative and subject to adjustment.
Induction time:
Page 2 of 6
Application Instructions
At application with hand tools, brush, but especially by roller the natural tendency to a
more uneven paint film obtained by these methods, is to be counteracted by more
coats applied. If at all possible each coat is to be applied across the preceding one - in
general follow good painting practise.
On poorly prepared surfaces it is always recommended to apply the first coat by brush.
Extra thinning will facilitate the penetration of the paint material, but will also require an
extra layer to be applied.
Please note that the thixotropic nature of HEMPADUR MASTIC 45880/45881 may give
a rather "wavy" surface of the paint just after application. This smoothens at drying, but
can make it necessary to let the wet film readings be of a higher value than indicated.
In many cases the wet film thickness, reading should be 25-50 micron/1-2 mils higher
than calculated. As the wavy surface becomes more smooth during drying these extra
wet film thickness readings will not cause a higher paint consumption than otherwise
stipulated.
Film thickness/thinning:
Pot life:
When measured under standard conditions the pot life is 1 hour at 20C/68F for
HEMPADUR MASTIC 45880 respectively 1 hours at 30C/86F for HEMPADUR
MASTIC 45881. However, for a 20 litres/5 US gallons mix, and used under warm
climate conditions, the heat developed by the chemical reaction between BASE and
CURING AGENT may make the corresponding practical pot life shorter.
Therefore: At high temperatures, use the paint immediately after mixing irrespective of
equipment.
Attached:
Page 3 of 6
Application Instructions
Drying time and recoating interval vary with film thickness, temperature and later
exposure conditions:
HEMPADUR MASTIC 45880 in a dry film thickness of 100-150 micron/4-6 mils:
Surface temperature:
-5C/23F
3 days
2 months
12 hours
14 days
4 hours
7 days
3 hours
5 days
2 hours
3 days
5 hours
7 hours
8 hours
4 hours
5 hours
6 hours
3 hours
4 hours
5 hours
Atmospheric, medium
Atmospheric, severe
15 hours
15 hours
5 hours
5 hours
4 hours
4 hours
3 hours
3 hours
12 hours
18 hours
5 hours
7 hours
4 hours
5 hours
3 hours
4 hours
3 days
3 days
45 hours
45 hours
N/R
N/R
N/R
N/R
-5C/23F
6 days
2 months
18 hours
14 days
6 hours
7 days
5 hours
5 days
4 hours
3 days
21 hours
30 hours
36 hours
7 hours
10 hours
12 hours
5 hours
8 hours
9 hours
4 hours
6 hours
7 hours
Atmospheric, medium
Atmospheric, severe
21 hours
21 hours
7 hours
7 hours
5 hours
5 hours
4 hours
4 hours
21 hours
30 hours
7 hours
10 hours
5 hours
8 hours
4 hours
6 hours
5 days
5 days
63 hours
63 hours
N/R
N/R
N/R
N/R
Notes:
Avoid sudden drops in (substrate) temperatures during drying/initial curing. It is especially important that the
substrate temperature does not drop significantly before application of the acrylic or polyurethane finish and
that proper ventilation is maintained.
If faster handling or recoating at lower temperatures is required, HEMPADUR 45143 may be used.
In case of low temperatures, it is recommended that HEMPADUR MASTIC 45880 has been given a proper
induction time before application. Under such conditions, consider paint temperature equal to substrate
temperature and follow the rules given on page 2.
Page 4 of 6
Application Instructions
-5C/23F
40C/104F
Extended*
Extended*
23 days
Extended*
Extended*
15 days
Extended*
Extended*
Extended*
Extended*
9 hours
9 hours
6 hours
6 hours
12 hours
12 hours
Atmospheric, medium
N/R
N/R
9 days
3 days
2 days
36 hours
1 days
1 day
Atmospheric, severe
N/R
N/R
4 days
18 hours
1. Depending on actual local conditions, extended maximum recoating intervals may apply.
Please contact Hempel for further advice.
Notes:
Avoid sudden drops in (substrate) temperatures during drying/initial curing.
If faster handling is required at low temperatures, HEMPADUR 45143 may be used.
20C/68F
4 hours
7 days
30C/86F 40C/104F
3 hours
5 days
2 hours
3 days
5 hours
7 hours
8 hours
4 hours
6 hours
6 hours
3 hours
4 hours
5 hours
20C/68F
6 hours
7 days
30C/86F 40C/104F
5 hours
5 days
4 hours
3 days
7 hours
10 hours
12 hours
6 hours
8 hours
10 hours
4 hours
6 hours
8 hours
20C/68F
30C/86F 40C/104F
Extended*
Extended*
1 months
Extended*
Extended*
23 days
Extended*
Extended*
15 days
Extended*
Extended*
Extended*
Extended*
Extended*
Extended*
12 hours
9 hours
6 hours
3 days
1 days
2 days
1 day
1 day
12 hours
Page 5 of 6
Application Instructions
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
ISSUED BY:
Page 6 of 6
Application Instructions
Product Data
HEMPATEX HI-BUILD 46330
Description:
Recommended use:
Service temperatures:
Certificates/Approvals:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Dry to touch:
V.O.C.:
Grey/11480 - Red/50630
Flat
42 1
5.3 m/litre - 80 micron
211 sq.ft./US gallon - 3.2 mils
32C/90F
1.3 kg/litre - 10.8 lbs/US gallon
8 (approx.) hours at 20C/68F
515 g/litre - 4.3 lbs/US gallon
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Application method:
Thinner (max.vol.):
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Airless spray
Air spray
Brush (touch-up)
08080 (5%)
08080 (15%)
08080 (5%)
.021"-.023"
150 bar/2200 psi
(Airless spray data are indicative and subject to adjustment)
THINNER 08080
80 micron/3.2 mils (See REMARKS overleaf)
175 micron/7 mils
8 hours (20C/68F) (See REMARKS overleaf)
None (See REMARKS overleaf)
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
New steel: Abrasive blasting to Sa 2. For temporary protection, if required, use suitable
shopprimer. All damage of shopprimer and contamination from storage and fabrication should be
thoroughly cleaned prior to final painting. For repair and touch-up use HEMPATEX HI-BUILD 46330.
Maintenance: Remove oil and grease, etc. with suitable detergent. Remove salt and other
contaminants by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning. Remove all rust and loose material by
abrasive blasting or power tool cleaning. Dust off residues. Touch up to full film thickness.
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
PRECEDING
COAT:
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
REMARKS:
VOC - EU directive
2004/42/EC:
VOC:
As supplied
15 vol. % thinning Limit phase I, 2007
VOC in g/l
510
560
600
For VOC of other shades, please refer to Safety Data Sheet.
Service
temperatures:
Film thicknesses:
Recoating:
Note:
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPATEX HI-BUILD 46370
Description:
HEMPATEX HI-BUILD 46370 is a physically drying high build paint with optimum colour
retention. Based on acrylic resin and chlorinated plasticizer. Resistant to salt water,
splashes of aliphatic hydrocarbons, animal and vegetable oils.
Recommended use:
1.
2.
Service temperatures:
Certificates/Approvals:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade Nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Surface dry:
Dry to touch:
V.O.C.:
White/10000*
Semi-flat
40 1
4.7 m/litre - 85 micron
189 sq.ft./US gallon - 3.4 mils
25C/77F
1.2 kg/litre - 10.0 lbs/US gallon
(approx) hour at 20C/68F (ISO 1517)
4 (approx) hours at 20C/68F
535 g/litre - 4.5 lbs/US gallon
*Concerning other shades, reference is made to HEMPEL'S CONTAINER COLOUR CARD.
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Application method:
Thinner (max. vol.):
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Airless spray
Air spray
Brush
08080 (20%)
08080 (30%)
08080 (5%)
For on-line container production thinning according to specification
.017"-.021"
150 bar/2200 psi
(Airless spray data are indicative and subject to adjustment)
THINNER 08080
85 micron/3.4 mils (See REMARKS overleaf)
200 micron/8 mils
4 hours (20C/68F) (See REMARKS overleaf)
None (See REMARKS overleaf)
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
Repair and Maintenance: Remove oil and grease etc. with suitable detergent. Remove salt and
other contaminants by high pressure fresh water cleaning. Followed by:
For steel: Remove all rust and loose material by abrasive blasting or power tool cleaning. Dust off
residues. Touch up bare spots with e.g. suitable primer followed by HEMPATEX HI-BUILD 46370 to
full film thickness.
For other metals, concrete: Reference is made to the corresponding painting specification and to
the Product Data Sheet for the primer/sealer.
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
PRECEDING
COAT:
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
REMARKS:
VOC - EU directive
2004/42/EC:
VOC:
Colours:
Service
temperatures:
Film thicknesses:
Recoating:
As supplied
26 vol. % thinning Limit phase I, 2007 Limit phase II, 2010
VOC in g/l
535
600
600
500
For VOC of other shades, please refer to Safety Data Sheet.
Certain lead-free red and yellow colours may discolour when exposed to chlorine- containing
atmosphere.
Leaded colours may become discoloured when exposed to sulphide-containing atmosphere.
To obtain full opacity, an extra coat may be necessary, especially for certain lead-free colours in eg
red, orange, yellow and green.
As HEMPATEX HI-BUILD 46370 is a thermoplastic product, prolonged mechanical exposure at
temperatures above approx. 40C/104F may cause film indentation. When temperature drops
below, mechanical strength is recovered.
May be specified in another film thickness than indicated depending on purpose and area of use.
This will alter spreading rate and may influence drying time and recoat interval. Normal range is 75100 microns/3-4 mils. A series of maintenance jobs may result in build up of a too high total film
thickness which may cause blister formation due to "entrapped" solvents. As each coat may also
retain solvents, it is generally recommended not to apply HEMPATEX HI-BUILD 46370 in excessive
film thickness.
In case of multicoat application, drying time and minimum recoat interval are influenced by the
actual film thickness and number of coats applied. Reference is made to the corresponding
painting specification.
No maximum recoating interval, but before recoating after exposure in contaminated environment,
clean the surface thoroughly by high pressure fresh water hosing and allow to dry.
Note:
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPATEX HI-BUILD 46410
Description:
HEMPATEX HI-BUILD 46410 is physically drying high build paint with good colour
retention as a flat finish. Based on acrylic resin and non-chlorinated plasticizer.
Contains zinc phosphate. Resistant to salt water, splashes of aliphatic hydrocarbons,
animal and vegetable oils.
Recommended use:
1.
2.
3.
Service temperatures:
Certificates/Approvals:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Surface dry:
Dry to touch:
V.O.C.:
Grey/11480* - Red/50630*
Flat
42 1
4.2 m/litre - 100 micron
168 sq.ft./US gallon - 4 mils
24C/75F
1.2 kg/litre - 10.0 lbs/US gallon
1 (approx.) hrs at 20C/68F (ISO 1517)
4 (approx.) hours at 20C/68F
515 g/litre - 4.3 lbs/US gallon
*Other shades according to assortment list.
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Application method:
Thinner (max. vol.):
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Airless spray
Air spray
Brush/Roller
08080 (5%)
08080 (15%)
08080 (5%)
.017"-.021"
175 bar/2500 psi
(Airless spray data are indicative and subject to adjustment)
THINNER 08080
100 micron/4 mils (See REMARKS overleaf)
225 micron/9 mils
When dry (See REMARKS overleaf)
None (See REMARKS overleaf)
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
New steel: Remove oil and grease etc. with suitable detergent. Remove salt and other
contaminants by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning. Abrasive blasting to Sa 2. For temporary
protection, if required, use suitable shopprimer. All damage of shopprimer and contamination from
storage and fabrication should be thoroughly cleaned prior to final painting. For repair and touch-up
use HEMPATEX HI-BUILD 46410.
Repair and maintenance: Remove oil and grease etc. with suitable detergent. Remove salt and
other contaminants by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning.
Remove all rust and loose material by abrasive blasting or power tool cleaning. Dust off residues.
Touch up bare spots with HEMPATEX HI-BUILD 46410 to full film thickness.
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
PRECEDING
COAT:
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
REMARKS:
VOC - EU directive
2004/42/EC:
VOC:
Colours:
Service
temperatures:
Film thicknesses:
Deck coating:
Recoating:
As supplied
15 vol. % thinning Limit phase I, 2007
VOC in g/l
530
580
600
For VOC of other shades, please refer to Safety Data Sheet.
Certain lead-free red and yellow colours may discolour when exposed to sulphide and chlorinecontaining atmosphere.
To obtain full opacity, an extra coat may be necessary, especially for certain lead-free colours in eg
red, orange, yellow and green.
As HEMPATEX HI-BUILD 46410 is a thermoplastic product, prolonged, mechanical exposure at
temperatures above approx. 40C/104F may cause film indentation. When temperature drops
below, mechanical strength is recovered.
May be specified in another film thickness than indicated depending on purpose and area of use.
This will alter spreading rate and may influence drying time and recoating interval. Normal range is
75-125 micron/3-5 mils. To obtain an even dry film thickness (of 125 micron), application in two
passes (wet-in-wet) is recommended. If applied by roller, e.g. as deck coating, usual dry film
thickness is approx. 50 microns per coat. A series of maintenance jobs may result in build up of a
too high total film thickness which may cause blister formation due to "entrapped" solvents. As
each coat may also retain solvents, it is generally recommended not to apply HEMPATEX HI-BUILD
46410 in excessive film thickness.
If a skid-proof surface is desired, sprinkle HEMPEL'S ANTI-SLINT 67500 evenly on the first coat of
HEMPATEX HI-BUILD 46410 while still wet (consumption approx. 2.5 kg/5.5 lbs to 25 m /270
sq.ft.). When the paint is dry, sweep up surplus grit and apply a second coat of HEMPATEX HIBUILD 46410. Antiskid properties can also be obtained by mixing 1.0 kg of HEMPEL'S ANTISLIP
BEADS 67420 into 20 litre of HEMPATEX HI-BUILD 46410.
For multicoat application minimum recoating interval is influenced by the actual film thickness and
number of coats applied. Reference is made to the corresponding painting specification.
No maximum recoating interval, but before recoating after exposure in contaminated environment,
clean the surface thoroughly by high pressure fresh water hosing and allow drying.
Note:
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPATEX HI-BUILD 46820
Description:
HEMPATEX HI-BUILD 46820 is based on acrylic resin, physically drying. Optimum colour
retention. Resistant to salt water, splashes of aliphatic hydrocarbons, animal and
vegetable oils.
Recommended use:
1.
Service temperatures:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Dry to touch:
V.O.C.:
Light alu./19000
Semi-flat
31 1
3.9 m/litre - 80 micron
155 sq.ft/US gallon - 3.2 mils
25C/77F
1.0 kg/litre - 8.4 lbs/US gallon
3-4 hours at 20C/68F
600 g/litre - 5.0 lbs/US gallon
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Application method:
Thinner (max. vol.):
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min.:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Airless spray
Air spray
Brush (touch up)
08080 (5%)
08080 (20%)
08080 (5%)
.017"-.021" (See REMARKS overleaf)
175 bar/2500 psi (See REMARKS overleaf)
(Airless spray data are indicative and subject to adjustment)
THINNER 08080
80 microns/3.2 mils (See REMARKS overleaf)
250 microns/10 mils
When dry (See REMARKS overleaf)
None (See REMARKS overleaf)
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
Remove oil and grease, etc. with suitable detergent. Remove salt and other contaminants by (high
pressure) fresh water cleaning. Remove all rust and loose material by abrasive blasting or power
tool cleaning. Dust off residues. Prime/touch up with suitable primer followed by HEMPATEX
46820 to full film thickness.
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
The surface must be completely clean and dry, its temperature must be above the dew point to
avoid condensation. In confined spaces provide adequate ventilation during application and drying.
PRECEDING
COAT:
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
REMARKS:
Service
temperatures:
Application:
Film thicknesses:
Recoating:
Note:
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPADUR 47140
BASE 47149 with CURING AGENT 98140
Description:
Recommended use:
Service temperatures:
Certificates/Approvals:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Dry to touch:
Fully cured:
V.O.C.:
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Mixing ratio for 47140:
Application method:
Thinner (max. vol.):
Pot life:
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
HEMPADUR 47140
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
Apply only on a dry and clean surface with a temperature above the dew point to avoid
condensation. Use only when application and curing can proceed at temperatures above
0C/32F.
The temperature of the paint itself should be 15-25C/59-77F to secure proper application
properties.
In confined spaces provide adequate ventilation during application and drying.
PRECEDING
COAT:
It is important that the surface is completely clean to ensure the adhesion. Any oil, grease, etc. to
be removed by suitable detergent.
Spray metallisation, HEMPADUR ZINC 17360, HEMPELS GALVOSIL 15700, HEMPELS GALVOSIL
1571A or according to specification.
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
REMARKS:
VOC - EU directive
2004/42/EC:
VOC:
As supplied
5 vol. % thinning
Limit phase I, 2007
VOC in g/l
302
330
550
For VOC of other shades, please refer to Safety Data Sheet.
Weathering/
service
temperatures:
Film thicknesses:
The natural tendency of epoxy coatings to chalk in outdoor exposure and to become more
sensitive to mechanical damage and chemical exposure at elevated temperatures is also
reflected in this product.
May be specified in another film thickness than indicated depending on purpose and area of use.
This will alter spreading rate and may influence drying time and recoating interval. Normal range
dry is 80-150 micron/3.2-6 mils.
Irregular surfaces:
Special care should be taken in relation to irregular surfaces (welding seams, undercuts etc.) as
application with an excessive film thickness - typically being more than 400 micron/16 mils per
coat may result in cracking especially on such areas.
Thinner:
Type and amount of thinner depend on application conditions, - method, temperature, ventilation
and substrate. HEMPELS THINNER 08450 is normally recommended. HEMPELS THINNER 08700
can be used alternatively depending on the local conditions.
Application onto zinc It is recommended to apply HEMPADUR 47140 by using a "mist-coat" procedure. A thin, undiluted
metallised and zinc spray-coat is applied (the mist coat) and after a few minutes, a second coat is applied in the full
silicate primed
silicate painted specified film thickness.
surfaces:
Depending on actual conditions of application, such as temperature, porosity of substrate,
method of spray, a sealer coat (thinned up to 30%) can be applied as an alternative method to
reduce popping, followed by application of the full coat.
Note:
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPADUR 47200
BASE 47209 with CURING AGENT 97100
Description:
Recommended use:
Service temperatures:
Certificates/Approvals:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Surface dry:
Dry to touch:
Fully cured:
V.O.C.:
Grey/13610 - Red/50630
Flat
63 1
6.3 m/litre - 100 micron
253 sq.ft./US gallon - 4 mils
30C/86F
1.6 kg/litre - 11.6 lbs/US gallon
15 minutes at 20C/68F (ISO 1517)
1 hour at 20C/68F
7 days at 20C/68F
355 g/litre - 3.0 lbs/US gallon
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1..
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Mixing ratio for 47200:
Application method:
Thinner (max. vol.):
Pot life:
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
HEMPADUR 47200
SURFACE
PREPARATION:
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
PRECEDING
COAT:
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
REMARKS:
VOC - EU directive
2004/42/EC:
VOC:
Weathering/Service
temperatures:
Film thicknesses:
Recoating:
New steel (dry conditions): Abrasive blasting to minimum Sa 2 according to ISO 8501-1:2007.
For temporary protection, if required, use suitable shopprimer. All damage of shopprimer and
contamination from storage and fabrication should be thoroughly cleaned prior to final painting.
For repair and touch-up use HEMPADUR 47200.
Maintenance: Remove oil and grease, etc. with suitable detergent. Remove salt and other
contaminants by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning. Remove all rust and loose material by wet
or dry abrasive blasting or power tool cleaning. Feather edges to sound and intact areas. After wet
abrasive blasting hose down the surface with fresh water and allow to dry. Touch up bare spots to
full film thickness.
Use only where application and curing can proceed at temperatures above -10C/32F. At the
freezing point and below be aware of the risk of ice on the surface, which will hinder the adhesion.
The temperature of the paint itself should be 15C/60F or above to secure proper application
properties.
In order to obtain the best possible spray properties, mix the components thoroughly and allow
the mixture to pre-react for 10 - 15 minutes before use (Induction time).
In confined spaces provide adequate ventilation during application and drying.
None, or according to specification.
HEMPADUR, HEMPATHANE, or as per specification.
As supplied 15 vol. % thinning Limit phase I, 2007 Limit phase II, 2010
VOC in g/l
355
425
550
500
For VOC of other shades, please refer to Safety Data Sheet.
The natural tendency of epoxy coatings to chalk in outdoor exposure and to become more
sensitive to mechanical damage and chemical exposure at elevated temperatures is also
reflected in this product.
May be specified in another film thickness than indicated depending on purpose and area of use.
This will alter spreading rate and may influence drying time and recoating interval. Normal range is
75-200 micron/3-8 mils.
Recoating intervals related to later conditions of exposure (100 micron/4 mils dry):
Maximum
Independent of filmthickness
Note:
ISSUED BY:
Surface temperature
20C/68F
Atmospheric
Recoated with
Medium
Severe
HEMPADUR
HEMPATHANE
None
None
None
5 days
If the maximum recoating interval is exceeded, whatever the subsequent coat, roughening of the
surface is necessary to ensure optimum intercoat adhesion or in the case of recoating with
coatings other than HEMPADUR, apply a (thin) additional coat of HEMPADUR 47200 within the
above directions for recoating.
A completely clean surface is mandatory to ensure intercoat adhesion, especially in the case of
long recoating intervals. Any dirt, oil and grease have to be removed with eg suitable detergent
followed by high pressure fresh water cleaning. Salts to be removed by fresh water hosing.
Any degraded surface layer, as a result of a long exposure period, must be removed as well.
Water jetting may be relevant to remove any degraded surface layer and may also replace the
above-mentioned cleaning methods when properly executed. Consult HEMPEL for specific advice if
in doubt.
To check whether the quality of the surface cleaning is adequate, a test patch may be relevant.
HEMPADUR 47200 is for professional use only.
HEMPEL A/S - 4720013610CR001
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPADUR FIBRE 47601/
HEMPADUR FIBRE 47603
47601: BASE 47609 with CURING AGENT 97330
47603: BASE 47609 with CURING AGENT 98420
Description:
HEMPADUR FIBRE 47601/47603 is a two-component, high-build, polyamide adductcured epoxy paint which cures to a hard and tough abrasion resistant anticorrosive
coating with improved crack resistance. Reinforced with inorganic fibres.
Recommended use:
Features:
Service temperatures:
Certificates/Approvals:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Version; mixed product:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Dry to touch:
Fully cured:
V.O.C.:
47601
Grey/12170*
Semi-flat
70 1
4.7 m/litre - 150 micron
187 sq.ft./US gallon - 6 mils
32C/90F
1.4 kg/litre - 11.7 lbs/US gallon
7 hours (app.) at 20C/68F
7 days at 20C/68F
305 g/litre - 2.5 lbs/US gallon
* See REMARKS overleaf.
47603
Grey/12170*
Semi-flat
70 1
4.7 m/litre - 150 micron
187sq.ft./US gallon - 6 mils
32C/90F
1.4 kg/litre - 11.7 lbs/US gallon
16 hours (app.) at 5C/41F
20 days at 5C/41F
305 g/litre - 2.5 lbs/US gallon
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Mixing ratio:
Application method:
Thinner (max.vol.):
Pot life:
Induction time:
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
47601
47603
Base 47609 : Curing agent 97330
Base 47609 : Curing agent 98420
4 : 1 parts by volume
4 : 1 parts by volume
Airless spray
Brush
Airless spray
Brush
08450 (5%)
08450 (5%)
08450 (5%)
08450 (5%)
2 hours (20C/68F)
2 hours (20C/68F)
See REMARKS overleaf
.021"-.025"
250 bar/3600 psi
(Airless spray data are indicative and subject to adjustment)
HEMPELS TOOL CLEANER 99610
150 micron/6 mils (See REMARKS overleaf)
225 micron/9 mils
See separate APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS
See separate APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
New steel: When used selfprimed surface preparation as to specification. When being an integral
part in heavy duty systems abrasive blasting to Sa 2. Reference is made to separate
APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS.
Ballast tanks: For PSPC type approved coating, consult separate APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS BALLAST TANKS for HEMPADUR FIBRE 47601/47603.
Stainless steel: (Ballast tanks in chemical carriers) to be abrasive blasted to a uniform, sharp,
dense profile, ISO Comparator Medium (G), corresponding to Rz minimum 50 micron. Any salts,
grease, oil, etc. to be removed before abrasive blasting is commenced.
Repair: Remove oil and grease, etc. with suitable detergent. Remove salt and other contaminants
by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning. Clean damaged areas thoroughly by power tool cleaning to
St 3 (minor areas) or by abrasive blasting to min. Sa 2, preferably to Sa 2. Improved surface
preparation will improve the performance of HEMPADUR FIBRE 47601/47603.
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
Apply only on a dry and clean surface with a temperature above the dew point to avoid
condensation.
Use only where application and curing can proceed at temperatures above -10C/14F (curing
agent 98420) and 0C/32F (curing agent 97330). The temperature of the paint itself should be
above 15C/59F for proper application.
In confined spaces provide adequate ventilation during application and drying.
PRECEDING
COAT:
REMARKS:
Weathering/
service
temperatures:
Application
equipment:
Film thicknesses:
Curing agent:
The natural tendency of epoxy coatings to chalk in outdoor exposure and to become more
sensitive to mechanical damage and chemical exposure at elevated temperatures is also
reflected in this product.
A reversible nozzle is recommended.
Filter: Surge tank filter and tip filter should be removed.
May be specified in another film thickness than indicated depending on purpose and area of use.
This will alter spreading rate and may influence drying time and recoating interval. Normal range
dry is 125-200 micron/5-8 mils.
Other shades are available according to assortment list. The aluminium pigmented version, shade
no. 19530, reddish grey, is designed for primer-coat application, holds a lower volume solids
(65%) and a slightly higher VOC (335 g/litre - 2.8 lbs/US gallon) than the other shades.
The aluminium pigmented version, shade no. 19530 contains approximately 9.5% aluminium on
weight in the dry film.
To facilitate proper application properties it is recommended to allow the thoroughly mixed BASE
and CURING AGENT to pre-react before application. In case two-component spray-equipment is
used, paint material is to be heated. Consult separate APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS.
Curing agent 98420 is hazy. This is intended and has no negative influence on the performance.
Note:
ISSUED BY:
Shades:
Mixing/
induction time:
Page 2 of 2
Application
Application Instructions
Instructions
For product description refer to product data sheet
Surface preparation:
New steel: When used selfprimed surface preparation as to specification. When being
an integral part in heavy duty systems abrasive blasting to Sa 2.
New steel, ballast tanks and similar areas: Abrasive blasting to Sa 2. For temporary
protection, if required, use a suitable shopprimer. All damage of shopprimer and
contamination from storage and fabrication should be thoroughly cleaned prior to final
painting - preferably by abrasive blasting. For repair and touch-up, use HEMPADUR
47601/47603.
Stainless steel: (Ballast tanks in chemical carriers) to be abrasive blasted to a uniform,
sharp, dense profile, ISO Comparator Medium (G), corresponding to Rz minimum 50
micron. Any salts, grease, oil, etc. to be removed before abrasive blasting is
commenced.
Repair: Remove oil and grease, etc. with suitable detergent. Remove salt and other
contaminants by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning. Clean damaged areas thoroughly
by power tool cleaning to St 3 (minor areas) or by abrasive blasting to min. Sa 2,
preferably to Sa 2. Improved surface preparation will improve the performance of
HEMPADUR FIBRE 47601/47603.
Application equipment:
HEMPADUR FIBRE 47601/47603 being a high viscosity material may require special
measures to be taken at application.
Recommended airless spray equipment:
Pump ratio:
Pump output:
Input pressure:
Spray hoses:
Filter:
Nozzle size:
Fan angle:
min 45:1
12 litres/minute (theoretical)
min. 6 bar/90 psi
max. 100 metres/300 feet, internal diameter
max. 30 metres/100 feet, 3/8" internal diameter
max. 6 metres/20 feet, 1/4" internal diameter
Should be removed
.021"-.025
60-80.
Page 1 of 5
HEMPEL
HEMPEL
Application
Instructions
Application Instructions
First coat on steel substrates: HEMPADUR FIBRE 47601/3 in shade 19530 (Reddish grey) is recommended as first
coat when the product is applied directly to steel substrates - independent of method of
surface preparation.
Pot life/mixing/
induction time
(both curing agents):
When measured under standard conditions the pot life is 3 hours at 15C/59F and 2
hours at 20C/68F. However, for a 20 litres/5 US gallons mix, the heat developed by
the chemical reaction between BASE and CURING AGENT may make the corresponding
practical pot life shorter.
a.
Mix the entire content of corresponding base and curing agent packing. If it is
necessary to mix smaller portions, this must be done properly by either weighing
base and curing agent in the prescribed weight ratio: 86 parts by weight of base
and 14 parts by weight of curing agent or by volume: 4.0 parts by volume base and
1.0 parts by volume curing agent.
b.
Stir the mixed paint thoroughly by means of a clean mechanical mixer until a
homogeneous mixture is obtained.
c.
Use all mixed paint before the pot life is exceeded. The pot life depends on the
temperature of the paint as shown in table below (valid for a 20 litres can):
15C/59F1)
20C/68F
25C/77F
30C/86F2)
3 hours
2 hours
1 hours
1 hour
At 15C/59F and below, the viscosity can be too high for airless spray application.
Temperatures above 30C/86F should preferably be avoided.
Induction time:
At steel temperatures below 5C/41F the paint may advantageously be prereacted 1020 minutes before spray application (longer pre-reaction time at lower temperatures).
When two-component spray equipment is used, heating may be relevant to obtain a
proper spray fan and a uniform and smooth paint film. This can either be done by
preheating the two-component paint or by using a flow-heater on the pressure side. As
an indication, a paint temperature of approx 40C/104F will be relevant, but has to be
adjusted according to the actual conditions.
Page 2 of 5
Application Instructions
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
ISSUED BY:
Attached:
To check whether the quality of the surface cleaning is adequate, a test patch may be
relevant.
Page 3 of 5
Application Instructions
0C/32F
10C/50F
20C/68F
30C/86F
40C/104F
Drying time
Curing time
32 hours
28 days
14 hours
14 days
7 hours
7 days
5 hours
3 days
3 hours
2 days
Initial curing
20 days
10 days
5 days
2 days
1 days
Recoating:
-10C/14F
0C/32F
10C/50F
20C/68F
30C/86F
Drying time
Curing time
45 hours
56 days
23 hours
28 days
10 hours
14 days
5 hours
7 days
4 hours
3 days
Initial curing
40 days
20 days
10 days
5 days
2 days
10C/50
20C/68F
30C/86F
12 hours
12 hours
6 hours
6 hours
24 hours
24 hours
12 hours
14 hours
16 hours
6 hours
7 hours
8 hours
4 hours
5 hours
5 hours
3 days
1 days
36 hours
18 hours
6 days
3 days
None
None
90 days
None
None
30 days
None
None
15 days
20 days
6 days
Not relevant
10 days
3 days
Not relevant
5 days
36 hours
Not relevant
Page 4 of 5
Application Instructions
-10C/14F
0C/32F
10C/50F
20C/68F
Not relevant
Not relevant
Not relevant
Not relevant
16 hours
16 hours
8 hours
8 hours
36 hours
45 hours
54 hours
18 hours
23 hours
27 hours
8 hours
10 hours
12 hours
4 hours
5 hours
6 hours
Not relevant
Not relevant
Not relevant
Not relevant
6 days
3 days
3 days
1 days
None
None
(90 days)
None
None
90 days
None
None
60 days
None
None
30 days
20 days
6 days
Not relevant
10 days
3 days
Not relevant
90 days
30 days
Not relevant
45 days
15 days
Not relevant
Workshop application:
For Workshops managing strict consumption control and equipped with proper
ventilation, minimum recoat interval may be reduced for HEMPADUR FIBRE 47603:
(125 micron/5 mils dry film thickness of HEMPADUR FIBRE 47603)
Surface temperature
10C/50F
20C/68F
30C/86F
4 hours
4 hours
2 hours
2 hours
1 hours
1 hours
Page 5 of 5
Application Instructions
Application Instructions
BALLAST TANKS
Application Instructions
The steel shall preferably be Rust Grade A or B according to ISO 8501-1:2007. The use
of steel with Rust Grade C requires more tight inspection of surface profile after blasting as well as of possible salt contamination. Rust grade D is not should not be used
for ballast tanks.
The steel surface shall be prepared so that the coating achieves an even distribution at
the specified nominal dry film thickness of 320 micron and has an adequate adhesion
by removing sharp edges, grinding weld beads and removing weld spatter and any other
surface contamination. PSPC makes reference to ISO 8501-3: Preparation of steel
substrates before application of paints and related products - Visual assessment of surface cleanliness.
For optimum performance the following is recommended: All welding seams shall be
partially dressed to remove irregular profiles.
Surface pores, pits and craters shall be sufficiently open to allow penetration of the
paint.
Sharp edges shall be treated to a rounded radius of minimum 2 mm, subjected to a
three-pass grinding or treated with an equivalent process that produces an edge profile
that results in a dry film thickness retention equivalent to or better than that of three
pass grinding. Sharp edge means all edges except natural rounded/rolled edges of sections or profiled steel bars.
Visible roll overs/laminations shall be removed.
The surface shall be free of all welding spatter.
Abrasive blasting/
abrasive sweep blasting:
The coating system shall only be applied on steel primed with a pre-qualified zinc containing inhibitor free zinc silicate shopprimer according to PSPC, Table 1.2.1-3. Steel
shopprimed with a shopprimer not pre-qualified must be abrasive blast cleaned to Sa 2
removing at least 70% of intact shopprimer, while steel, which has not been
shopprimed must be blasted to Sa 2.
Before blasting any deposits of grease or oil must be removed from the steel surface
using a suitable detergent followed by fresh water hosing. Minor spots of oil/grease
may be cleaned with thinner and clean rags - avoid smearing out the contamination.
Possible alkali weld deposits, chemicals used for testing of welds, soap residues from
the pressure testing must be removed by fresh water hosing.
The shopprimer must have been checked randomly for excessive film thickness. Areas
detected to have film thicknesses above approx 40 micron/1.6 mils (as measured directly on the shopprimed surface with equipment calibrated on smooth steel) are to be
blasted to Sa 2 removing at least 70% of the shopprimer.
Welds as well as shopprimed areas with damage, burn marks and rust must be blasted
to Sa 2.
Surfaces with zinc salts, deposits of black iron oxides from plasma cutting, markings
and similar foreign matters shall be cleaned by light abrasive sweep blasting.
Page 1 of 5
HEMPEL
Application Instructions
Application Instructions
BALLAST
BALLAST TANKS
TANKS
Application Instructions
HEMPADUR 17630
FIBRE 47601/47603
Welds coated with a temporary (shop)primer after welding must be cleaned by hard
abrasive sweeping, preferably abrasive blasting.
Spot-checks for possible salt contamination of the surface must be executed after secondary surface preparation. The upper water soluble salts limit is 50 mg/m sodium
chloride equivalents when measured according to ISO 8502-9:1998. To limit salt contamination from abrasives it is recommended to use abrasives showing a water-soluble
contaminant level equivalent to less than 25 mS/m according to ISO 11127-6:1993.
When blasting, the importance of working systematically must be stressed. Poorly
blasted areas covered with dust are very difficult to locate during the blast inspection
made after the rough cleaning.
In the case of full or partial abrasive blast cleaning, the surface profile must be 40-75
micron/1.6-3.0 mils approximately equivalent to Rugotest No. 3, BN9-BN10 or KeaneTator Comparator, 3.0 G/S or to ISO 8503-1, grade Medium (G).
Dust must be removed just before application of the paint to a dust quantity rating 1
for dust size class 3, 4 or 5. Lower dust size classes shall be removed from the
surface if visible without magnification.
Note: If any doubt exists about the quality of the primary surface preparation (before
shoppriming), the substrate must be re-blasted in situ as defined above.
Block assembly zones: Overlap zones must be treated with great care. Damage caused
by possible over-blasting must be avoided, paint edges must be feathered and consecutive layers of paint coatings given larger and larger overlaps. Roughening must be carried out when the maximum recoating interval is exceeded (when sand papering, use
free-cut paper, grain size 80).
Furthermore, these areas may be either masked off with tape - to keep them as narrow
as possible. Application of a thin zinc epoxy primer coat on these areas after secondary
surface preparation at block stage is acceptable if removed before the application of
HEMPADUR FIBRE 47601/47603.
Secondary surface preparation of block assembly zones is preferably abrasive spotblasting. However, mechanical cleaning to St 3 may be acceptable if zones are narrow
and an extra coat of HEMPADUR FIBRE 47601/47603 is applied to these areas. The
procedure of masking off with tape or using the zinc epoxy primer as described above
may advantageously be used in case of mechanical cleaning.
Stainless steel: (Ballast tanks of chemical carriers) To be abrasive blast cleaned to a
uniform, sharp, dense, profile (Rugotest No. 3, BN9-10, ISO Comparator Medium (G),
Keane-Tator Comparator 2.0 G/S corresponding to Rz minimum 50 micron). Any salts,
grease, oil etc. shall be removed before abrasive blasting is commenced. Surface
preparation and paint application to be carried out concurrently with treatment of surrounding carbon steel.
Application equipment:
HEMPADUR FIBRE 47601/47603, being a high viscosity material, may require special
measures to be taken at application.
Recommended airless spray equipment:
Pump ratio:
Pump output:
Input pressure:
Spray hoses:
Issued:
2007
Issued: September
December 2007
Filter:
min 45:1
12 litres/minute (theoretical)
min. 6 bar/90 psi
max. 100 metres/300 feet, internal diameter
max. 30 metres/100 feet, 3/8" internal diameter
max. 6 metres/20 feet, 1/4" internal diameter
should be removed
Nozzle size:
Fan angle:
.021"-.025
60-80.
Page
Page 22 of
of 55
Application Instructions
Application Instructions
BALLAST
BALLAST TANKS
TANKS
Application Instructions
HEMPADUR 17630
FIBRE 47601/47603
PSPC requires the application of minimum two spray applied coatings and minimum two
stripe coats.
Spray application: A continuous, pinhole-free paint film must be obtained at application
of each spray applied coat. An application technique which will ensure good film formation on all surfaces must be adopted. It is very important to use nozzles of the correct
size, not too large, and to have a proper, uniform distance of the spray gun to the surface, 30-50 cm should be aimed at. Furthermore, great care must be taken to cover
edges, openings, rear sides of stiffeners etc. even though these areas also must be
stripe coated. To obtain good and steady atomising, the viscosity of the paint must be
suitable and the spray equipment must be sufficient in output pressure and capacity. At
high working temperatures, use of extra thinner may be necessary to avoid dust spray.
The paint layer must be applied homogeneously and as close to the specification as
possible. Care shall be taken to avoid exaggerated film thicknesses. Wet film thickness
shall be regularly checked during the application.
The finished coating must appear as a homogeneous film with a smooth surface and
irregularities such as dust, dry spray, abrasives, should be remedied.
Stripe coating: The required two stripe coats must each be applied as a coherent film
showing good film formation and no visible defects such as pores or un-wetted areas.
The application method must ensure that all areas which require stripe coating are
properly stripe coated by alternative application methods which include brush or roller.
Application by airless spray requires the use of relatively small, narrow-angled nozzles.
PSPC accepts that the second stripe coat, by way of welded seams only, may be reduced in scope where it is proven that the nominal dry film thickness (NDFT) can be met
by the coats applied. The first stripe coating should preferably be applied after first full
coat to avoid contamination of the steel substrate.
Pot life/mixing/
induction time:
Issued:
2007
Issued: September
December 2007
When measured under standard conditions the pot life is 3 hours at 15C/59F and 2
hours at 20C/68F. However, for a 20 litres/5 US gallons mix, the heat developed by
the chemical reaction between BASE and CURING AGENT may make the corresponding
practical pot life shorter.
a.
Mix the entire content of corresponding base and curing agent packing. If it is
necessary to mix smaller portions, this must be done properly by either weighing
base and curing agent in the prescribed weight ratio: 86 parts by weight of base
and 14 parts by weight of curing agent or by volume: 4.0 parts by volume base and
1.0 parts by volume curing agent.
b.
Stir the mixed paint thoroughly by means of a clean mechanical mixer until a
homogeneous mixture is obtained.
c.
Use all mixed paint before the pot life is exceeded. The pot life depends on the
temperature of the paint as shown in table below (valid for a 20 litres can):
Page
Page 33 of
of 55
Application Instructions
Application Instructions
BALLAST
BALLAST TANKS
TANKS
Application Instructions
HEMPADUR 17630
FIBRE 47601/47603
15C/59F1)
20C/68F
25C/77F
30C/86F2)
3 hours
2 hours
1 hours
1 hour
Pot life
1)
2)
At 15C/59F and below, the viscosity can be too high for airless spray application.
Temperatures above 30C/86F should preferably be avoided.
Induction time:
At steel temperatures below 5C/41F the paint may advantageously be prereacted 1020 minutes before spray application (longer prereaction time at lower steel temperatures).
Two-component spray equipment: Heating may be required to obtain a proper spray fan
and a uniform and smooth paint film. This can either be done by preheating the twocomponent paint or by using a flow-heater on the pressure side. As an indication, a
paint temperature of approx 40C/104F will be relevant, but has to be adjusted according to the actual conditions.
Dry film thickness:
PSPC requires that the nominal dry film thickness (NDFT) shall be 320 micron and
achieved by minimum two spray coats and two stripe coats. The dry film thickness distribution shall be evaluated according to the 90/10 rule.
Dry film thickness (DFT)
DFT
micron/mils
Remark
Minimum DFT
per coat
90/3.5
2,000/80
The maximum DFT is valid for isolated spots less than 1% of the total surface
area per tank. The stated maximum DFT is for guidance and should be kept as
close to the specified nominal DFT as possible. Frequent control of wet film
thickness during application is recommended
Maximum DFT
(complete coating system)
Physical data
versus temperature:
0C/32F
10C/50F
20C/68F
30C/86F
40C/104F
Drying time
Walk-on time
Curing time
32 hours
32 hours
28 days
14 hours
14 hours
14 days
7 hours
7 hours
7 days
5 hours
5 hours
3 days
3 hours
3 hours
2 days
Initial curing*
20 days
10 days
5 days
2 days
1 days
-10C/14F
0C/32F
10C/50F
20C/68F
30C/86F
Drying time
Walk-on time
Curing time
45 hours
45 hours
56 days
23 hours
23 hours
28 days
10 hours
10 hours
14 days
5 hours
5 hours
7 days
4 hours
4 hours
3 days
Initial curing*
40 days
20 days
10 days
5 days
2 days
* When the state "initial curing" has been reached, the coating may exceptionally be exposed
to ballast water provided it has been applied within the specified limits of film thicknesses
and that all painted areas have been subject to thorough ventilation.
Recoating:
Issued:
2007
Issued: September
December 2007
Page
Page 44 of
of 55
Application Instructions
Application Instructions
BALLAST
BALLAST TANKS
TANKS
Application Instructions
HEMPADUR 17630
FIBRE 47601/47603
20C/68F
30 days*
To check whether the quality of the surface cleaning is adequate, a test patch may be
relevant.
8.2 Repair process
Safety:
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
ISSUED BY:
Page
Page 55 of
of 55
Application Instructions
Product Data
HEMPADUR UNIQ 47741/
HEMPADUR UNIQ 47743
Summertime application: 47741: BASE 47745 with CURING AGENT 98741
Wintertime application: 47743: BASE 47747 with CURING AGENT 98743
Description:
Recommended use:
Features:
Service temperatures:
Certificates/Approvals:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Version; mixed product:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Dry to touch:
Fully cured:
V.O.C.:
47741
Grey/12170 - Red/50630 *
Semi-gloss
80 1
5.3 m/litre - 150 micron
214 sq.ft./US gallon - 6 mils
29C/84F
1.6 kg/litre - 13.4 lbs/US gallon
6 hours at 20C/68F
7 days at 20C/68F
220 g/litre - 1.8 lbs/US gallon
* See REMARKS overleaf
47743
Grey/12170 - Red/50630 *
Semi-gloss
80 1
5.3 m/litre - 150 micron
214 sq.ft./US gallon - 6 mils
31C/88F
1.6 kg/litre - 13.4 lbs/US gallon
10-12 hours at 5C/41F
21 days at 5C/41F
215 g/litre - 1.8 lbs/US gallon
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Mixing ratio:
Application method:
Thinner:
Pot life:
Nozzle orifice and pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
47741
Base 47745 : Curing agent 98741
3 : 1 by volume
Airless spray
08450
1 hour (20C/68F)
See overleaf.
HEMPELS TOOL CLEANER 99610
150 micron/6 mils
200 micron/8 mils
6 hours (20C/68F)
As per separate painting specification
47743
Base 47747 : Curing agent 98743
3 : 1 by volume
Airless spray
08450
11/4 hour (5C/41F)
See overleaf.
HEMPELS TOOL CLEANER 99610
150 micron/6 mils
200 micron/8 mils
12 hours (5C/41F)
As per separate painting specification
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
Page 1 of 3
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
New steel:
Exterior hull, bulk cargo holds and similar areas: Abrasive blasting to Sa 2. For temporary
protection, if required, use a suitable shopprimer. Damage of shopprimer and contamination from
storage and fabrication should be thoroughly cleaned prior to final painting. . Welds, rusty spots,
etc. to be abrasive spot-blasted. Intact shopprimer to be abrasive sweep-blasted (or equivalent
roughening).
For areas not later to be subject to aggressive exposure surface preparation to be as per normal
shipyard procedure.
Ballast tanks: For PSPC type approved coating, consult separate APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS BALLAST TANKS for HEMPADUR UNIQ 47741.
Stainless steel: (Ballast tanks in chemical carriers) to be abrasive blasted to a uniform, sharp,
dense profile, ISO Comparator Medium (G), corresponding to Rz minimum 50 micron.
Any salts, grease, oil, etc. to be removed before abrasive blasting is commenced.
Repair: Remove oil and grease, etc. with suitable detergent. Remove salt and other contaminants
by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning. Clean damaged areas thoroughly by power tool cleaning to
St 3 (minor areas) or by abrasive blasting to min. Sa 2, preferably to Sa 2. Improved surface
preparation will improve the performance of HEMPADUR UNIQ 47741/47743.
Reference is further made to separate Application Instructions.
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
Use only where application and curing can proceed at temperatures above -10C/14F for
HEMPADUR UNIQ 47743 and above 10C/50F for HEMPADUR UNIQ 47741. A temperature of
the paint itself above 15C/59F facilitates proper application.
Apply only on a dry and clean surface with a temperature above the dew point to avoid
condensation. Relative humidity max. 85%.
In confined spaces provide adequate ventilation during application and drying.
PRECEDING COAT:
SUBSEQUENT COAT: None, or HEMPADUR or HEMPATHANE paints as per specification, depending on area of use.
REMARKS:
Weathering/
service
temperatures:
Airless application,
nozzle orifice and
pressure:
Spray equipment:
Colour of curing
agent:
Film thicknesses:
Shades:
The natural tendency of epoxy coatings to chalk in outdoor exposure and to become more
sensitive to mechanical damage and chemical exposure at elevated temperatures is also
reflected in this product.
Optimum result with undiluted paint material is obtained with an output pressure of
250 bar/3600 psi and nozzle orifices of 0.021-0.023. Bigger nozzle-sizes are possible, but
depends on the skill of the painter, sufficient output pressure and material-flow.
Furthermore up to 5% thinner may be needed.
It is recommended to use heavy duty airless spray equipment with a pump transmission rate of
60:1 (approximately), and a theoretical output of min. 12 litres per minute (at 60 cycles per
minute). Longer spray hoses and/or bigger spray nozzles will require higher capacity of the spray
equipment to maintain a proper spray fan atomisation.
The curing agent 98743 has a tendency to become darker at storage. This has no influence on
performance, but may influence the shade of the mixed product.
May be specified in another film thickness than indicated depending on purpose and area of use.
This will alter spreading rate and may influence drying time and recoating interval. Normal range
dry is 125-200 micron/5-8 mils.
Undiluted, absolute minimum for closed film formation is 100 micron dry film thickness. For the
upper end the paint material has sufficient safety in its application window to allow for a 250
micron specification provided a skilled application work.
Other shades are available according to assortment list. The aluminium pigmented version, shade
no. 59690, red alu, is designed for primer-coat application, holds a lower volume solids (72%) and
a slightly higher VOC (270 g/litre - 2.3 lbs/US gallon) than the other shades.
The aluminium pigmented version, shade no. 59690 contains approximately 8.8% aluminium on
weight in the dry film.
Page 2 of 3
When changing between summer- and winter-version, drying time and recoating intervals will
change as described separately.
Note:
ISSUED BY:
Page 3 of 3
Application
Application Instructions
Instructions
For product description refer to product data sheet
Surface preparation:
The specific type and degree of surface preparation depends on type and condition of
the actual substrate and on desired performance. The better the surface preparation
the better the performance, but it will not always be economic feasible to go for the
highest degree within a given type of surface preparation.
Ballast tanks,
surface preparation:
Before blasting any deposits of grease or oil must be removed from the steel surface
with a suitable detergent followed by fresh water hosing. Minor spots of oil/grease may
be cleaned with thinner and clean rags - avoid smearing out the contamination. Possible
alkali weld deposits, chemicals used for testing of welds, soap residues from the
pressure testing must be removed by fresh water hosing.
Newbuilding/new steelwork: To obtain full performance of the ballast tank coating,
welds, burns, damaged and rusty shopprimer must be abrasive blast cleaned to Sa 2.
Minor areas mechanically cleaned to St 3.
If welds have previously been coated with a (shop)primer just after welding this
(shop)primer must be removed by abrasive blasting in order to obtain optimum
performance.
Page 1 of 4
HEMPEL
HEMPEL
Application
Instructions
Application Instructions
HEMPADUR UNIQ 47741/47743, being a high viscosity material, may require special
measures to be taken at application.
Recommended airless spray equipment:
Pump ratio:
Pump output:
Input pressure:
Spray hoses:
Filter:
Regular surfaces:
Nozzle size:
Fan angle:
Ballast tanks
.021"-.023
60-80
Page 2 of 4
Application Instructions
First coat on steel substrates: HEMPADUR UNIQ 47741/3 in shade 59690 (Red alu) is recommended as first coat
when the product is applied directly to steel substrates - independent of method of
surface preparation.
Pot life/mixing/
induction time:
(both curing agents):
When measured under standard conditions the pot life is 2 hours at 15C/59F and 1
hour at 20C/68F. However, for a 20 litres/5 US gallons mix, the heat developed by
the chemical reaction between BASE and CURING AGENT may make the corresponding
practical pot life shorter.
a.
Mix the entire content of corresponding base and curing agent packings. If it is
necessary to mix smaller portions, this must be done properly by volume: 3.0
parts of base and 1.0 part of curing agent.
b.
Stir the mixed paint thoroughly by means of a clean mechanical mixer until a
homogeneous mixture is obtained.
c.
Use all mixed paint before the pot life is exceeded. The pot life depends on the
temperature of the paint as shown in table below (valid for a 20 litres can):
5C/41F
10C/50F
20C/68F
30C/86F1)
N.A.
1 1/4
1 hour
1 hour
1 hour
( hour)
( hour)
N.A.
Induction time:
At Steel temperatures below 5C/41F the paint may advantageously be prereacted 10
minutes before spray application (longer prereaction time at lower steel temperatures).
When twin-feed two-component spray equipment is used, heating may be relevant to
obtain a proper spray fan and a uniform and smooth paint film. This can either be done
by preheating the two-component paint or by using a flow-heater on the pressure side.
As an indication, a paint temperature of approx 40C/104F will be relevant, but has to
be adjusted according to the actual conditions.
Page 3 of 4
Application Instructions
10C/50F
20C/68F
30C/86F
Drying time
Curing time*
15 hours
18 days
6 hours
7 days
3 hours
3 days
Initial curing*
13 days
5 days
2 days
-10C/14F
0C/32F
10C/50F
Drying time
Curing time*
36 hours
63 days
18 hours
32 days
8 hours
14 days
Initial curing*
60 days
29 days
10 days
Recoating:
47743
Minimum
Surface temp.
Maximum
Minimum
20C/68F
Recoated with
Atmospheric
Medium
Severe
Atmospheric
Immer-
Maximum
5C/41F
Medium Severe
sion *
Atmospheric
Immer-
Medium
Severe
sion *
HEMPADUR
4 hours
5 hours
6 hours
None
HEMPATHANE Topcoat
4 hours
5 hours
N/R
10 days 3 days
None
Atmospheric
Immer-
Medium Severe
sion *
Immersion *
30 days
8 hours
N/R
8 hours
10 hours N/R
None
30 days 9 days
60 days
N/R
* and heavy wear - eg bulk cargo holds and fender areas. If such areas are to be topcoated with HEMPATHANE,
same max as for atmospheric/severe apply.
The long maximum recoating interval for HEMPADUR will be reduced if the coating is
more than just scarcely exposed to direct sunshine before recoating.
If the interval is exceeded, roughening of surface is necessary to ensure intercoat
adhesion.
Safety:
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
ISSUED BY:
Page 4 of 4
Application Instructions
Application Instructions
BALLAST TANKS
Application Instructions
Scope:
The steel shall preferably be Rust Grade A or B according to ISO 8501-1:2007. The use
of steel with Rust Grade C requires more tight inspection of surface profile after blasting as well as of possible salt contamination. Rust grade D is not should not be used
for ballast tanks.
The steel surface shall be prepared so that the coating achieves an even distribution at
the specified nominal dry film thickness of 320 micron and has an adequate adhesion
by removing sharp edges, grinding weld beads and removing weld spatter and any other
surface contamination. PSPC makes reference to ISO 8501-3: Preparation of steel
substrates before application of paints and related products - Visual assessment of surface cleanliness.
For optimum performance the following is recommended: All welding seams shall be
partially dressed to remove irregular profiles.
Surface pores, pits and craters shall be sufficiently open to allow penetration of the
paint.
Sharp edges shall be treated to a rounded radius of minimum 2 mm, subjected to a
three-pass grinding or treated with an equivalent process that produces an edge profile
that results in a dry film thickness retention equivalent to or better than that of three
pass grinding. Sharp edge means all edges except natural rounded/rolled edges of sections or profiled steel bars.
Visible roll overs/laminations shall be removed.
The surface shall be free of all welding spatter.
Abrasive blasting/
abrasive sweep blasting:
The coating system shall only be applied on steel primed with a pre-qualified zinc containing inhibitor free zinc silicate shopprimer according to PSPC, Table 1.2.1-3. Steel
shopprimed with a shopprimer not pre-qualified must be abrasive blast cleaned to Sa 2
removing at least 70% of intact shopprimer, while steel, which has not been
shopprimed must be blasted to Sa 2.
Before blasting any deposits of grease or oil must be removed from the steel surface
using a suitable detergent followed by fresh water hosing. Minor spots of oil/grease
may be cleaned with thinner and clean rags - avoid smearing out the contamination.
Possible alkali weld deposits, chemicals used for testing of welds, soap residues from
the pressure testing must be removed by fresh water hosing.
The shopprimer must have been checked randomly for excessive film thickness. Areas
detected to have film thicknesses above approx 40 micron/1.6 mils (as measured directly on the shopprimed surface with equipment calibrated on smooth steel) are to be
blasted to Sa 2 removing at least 70% of the shopprimer.
Welds as well as shopprimed areas with damage, burn marks and rust must be blasted
to Sa 2.
Surfaces with zinc salts, deposits of black iron oxides from plasma cutting, markings
and similar foreign matters shall be cleaned by light abrasive sweep blasting.
Page 1 of 5
HEMPEL
Application Instructions
Application Instructions
BALLAST
BALLAST TANKS
TANKS
Application Instructions
HEMPADUR 17630
UNIQ 47741
Welds coated with a temporary (shop)primer after welding must be cleaned by hard
abrasive sweeping, preferably abrasive blasting.
Spot-checks for possible salt contamination of the surface must be executed after secondary surface preparation. The upper water soluble salts limit is 50 mg/m sodium
chloride equivalents when measured according to ISO 8502-9:1998. To limit salt contamination from abrasives it is recommended to use abrasives showing a water-soluble
contaminant level equivalent to less than 25 mS/m according to ISO 11127-6:1993.
When blasting, the importance of working systematically must be stressed. Poorly
blasted areas covered with dust are very difficult to locate during the blast inspection
made after the rough cleaning.
In the case of full or partial abrasive blast cleaning, the surface profile must be 40-75
micron/1.6-3.0 mils approximately equivalent to Rugotest No. 3, BN9-BN10 or KeaneTator Comparator, 3.0 G/S or to ISO 8503-1, grade Medium (G).
Dust must be removed just before application of the paint to a dust quantity rating 1
for dust size class 3, 4 or 5. Lower dust size classes shall be removed from the
surface if visible without magnification.
Note: If any doubt exists about the quality of the primary surface preparation (before
shoppriming), the substrate must be re-blasted in situ as defined above.
Block assembly zones: Overlap zones must be treated with great care. Damage caused
by possible over-blasting must be avoided, paint edges must be feathered and consecutive layers of paint coatings given larger and larger overlaps. Roughening must be carried out when the maximum recoating interval is exceeded (when sand papering, use
free-cut paper, grain size 80).
Furthermore, these areas may be either masked off with tape - to keep them as narrow
as possible. Application of a thin zinc epoxy primer coat on these areas after secondary
surface preparation at block stage is acceptable if removed before the application of
HEMPADUR UNIQ 47741.
Secondary surface preparation of block assembly zones is preferably abrasive spotblasting. However, mechanical cleaning to St 3 may be acceptable if zones are narrow
and an extra coat of HEMPADUR UNIQ 47741 is applied to these areas. The procedure
of masking off with tape or using the zinc epoxy primer as described above may advantageously be used in case of mechanical cleaning.
Stainless steel: (Ballast tanks of chemical carriers) To be abrasive blast cleaned to a
uniform, sharp, dense, profile (Rugotest No. 3, BN9-10, ISO Comparator Medium (G),
Keane-Tator Comparator 2.0 G/S corresponding to Rz minimum 50 micron). Any salts,
grease, oil etc. shall be removed before abrasive blasting is commenced. Surface
preparation and paint application to be carried out concurrently with treatment of surrounding carbon steel.
Application equipment:
HEMPADUR UNIQ 47741, being a high viscosity material, may require special measures
to be taken at application.
Recommended airless spray equipment:
Pump ratio:
Pump output:
Input pressure:
Spray hoses:
Issued:
2007
Issued: September
December 2007
Filter:
min 45:1
12 litres/minute (theoretical)
min. 6 bar/90 psi
max. 100 metres/300 feet, internal diameter
max. 30 metres/100 feet, 3/8" internal diameter
max. 6 metres/20 feet, 1/4" internal diameter
60 mesh
Nozzle size:
Fan angle:
.021"-.023
60-80.
Page
Page 22 of
of 55
Application Instructions
Application Instructions
BALLAST
BALLAST TANKS
TANKS
Application Instructions
HEMPADUR 17630
UNIQ 47741
PSPC requires the application of minimum two spray applied coatings and minimum two
stripe coats.
Spray application: A continuous, pinhole-free paint film must be obtained at application
of each spray applied coat. An application technique which will ensure good film formation on all surfaces must be adopted. It is very important to use nozzles of the correct
size, not too large, and to have a proper, uniform distance of the spray gun to the surface, 30-50 cm should be aimed at. Furthermore, great care must be taken to cover
edges, openings, rear sides of stiffeners etc. even though these areas also must be
stripe coated. To obtain good and steady atomising, the viscosity of the paint must be
suitable and the spray equipment must be sufficient in output pressure and capacity. At
high working temperatures, use of extra thinner may be necessary to avoid dust spray.
The paint layer must be applied homogeneously and as close to the specification as
possible. Care shall be taken to avoid exaggerated film thicknesses. Wet film thickness
shall be regularly checked during the application.
The finished coating must appear as a homogeneous film with a smooth surface and
irregularities such as dust, dry spray, abrasives, should be remedied.
Stripe coating: The required two stripe coats must each be applied as a coherent film
showing good film formation and no visible defects such as pores or un-wetted areas.
The application method must ensure that all areas which require stripe coating are
properly stripe coated by alternative application methods which include brush or roller.
Application by airless spray requires the use of relatively small, narrow-angled nozzles.
PSPC accepts that the second stripe coat, by way of welded seams only, may be reduced in scope where it is proven that the nominal dry film thickness (NDFT) can be met
by the coats applied. The first stripe coating should preferably be applied after first full
coat to avoid contamination of the steel substrate.
Pot life/mixing/
induction time:
Issued:
2007
Issued: September
December 2007
When measured under standard conditions the pot life is 3 hours at 15C/59F and 2
hours at 20C/68F. However, for a 20 litres/5 US gallons mix, the heat developed by
the chemical reaction between BASE and CURING AGENT may make the corresponding
practical pot life shorter.
a.
Mix the entire content of corresponding base and curing agent packing. If it is
necessary to mix smaller portions, this must be done properly by either weighing
base and curing agent in the prescribed weight ratio: 86 parts by weight of base
and 14 parts by weight of curing agent or by volume: 4.0 parts by volume base and
1.0 parts by volume curing agent.
b.
Stir the mixed paint thoroughly by means of a clean mechanical mixer until a
homogeneous mixture is obtained.
Page
Page 33 of
of 55
Application Instructions
Application Instructions
BALLAST
BALLAST TANKS
TANKS
Application Instructions
HEMPADUR 17630
UNIQ 47741
c.
Use all mixed paint before the pot life is exceeded. The pot life depends on the
temperature of the paint as shown in table below (valid for a 20 litres can):
10C/50F
20C/68F
30C/86F2)
Pot life
1 hours
1 hour
( hour)
1)
Induction time:
At steel temperatures below 5C/41F the paint may advantageously be prereacted 10
minutes before spray application (longer prereaction time at lower steel temperatures).
When twin-feed two-component spray equipment is used, heating may be relevant to
obtain a proper spray fan and a uniform and smooth paint film. This can either be done
by preheating the two-component paint or by using a flow-heater on the pressure side.
As an indication, a paint temperature of approx 40C/104F will be relevant, but has to
be adjusted according to the actual conditions.
Dry film thickness:
PSPC requires that the nominal dry film thickness (NDFT) shall be 320 micron and
achieved by minimum two spray coats and two stripe coats. The dry film thickness distribution shall be evaluated according to the 90/10 rule.
Dry film thickness (DFT)
DFT
micron/mils
Remark
Minimum DFT
per coat
90/3.5
2,000/80
The maximum DFT is valid for isolated spots less than 1% of the total surface
area per tank. The stated maximum DFT is for guidance and should be kept as
close to the specified nominal DFT as possible. Frequent control of wet film
thickness during application is recommended
Maximum DFT
(complete coating system)
Physical data
versus temperature:
10C/50F
20C/68F
30C/86F
40C/104F
Drying time
Walk-on time
Curing time
14 hours
14 hours
18 days
7 hours
7 hours
7 days
5 hours
5 hours
3 days
2 hours
2 hours
2 days
Initial curing*
13 days
5 days
2 days
30 hours
* When the state "initial curing" has been reached, the coating may exceptionally be exposed
to ballast water provided it has been applied within the specified limits of film thicknesses
and that all painted areas have been subject to thorough ventilation.
Recoating:
10C/50F
Minimum
20C/68F 30C/86F
40C/104F 10C/50F
Maximum
20C/68F 30C/86F
40C/104F
16 hours
7 hours
2 hours
30 days*
9 days*
3 hours
75 days*
15 days*
Depending on actual local conditions, extended maximum recoating intervals may apply. Please contact
HEMPEL for further advice.
** Stripe coat can be applied when it is possible to walk on the surface without damage to the coating.
Issued:
2007
Issued: September
December 2007
Page
Page 44 of
of 55
Application Instructions
Application Instructions
BALLAST
BALLAST TANKS
TANKS
Application Instructions
HEMPADUR 17630
UNIQ 47741
Any degraded surface layer, as a result of a long exposure period, must be removed
as well. Water jetting may be relevant to remove any degraded surface layer and may
also replace the above-mentioned cleaning methods when properly executed. Consult HEMPEL for specific advice if in doubt.
To check whether the quality of the surface cleaning is adequate, a test patch may be
relevant.
8.2 Repair process
Safety:
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
ISSUED BY:
Page
Page 55 of
of 55
Application Instructions
Product Data
HEMUCRYL 48130
Description:
Recommended use:
Service temperatures:
Certificates/Approvals:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Surface dry:
Dry to touch:
Shelf life:
V.O.C.:
Grey/12170 - Red/50630*
Semi-flat
48 1
4.0 m/litre - 120 micron
160 sq.ft/US gallon - 4.8 mils
> 93C/199F
1.1 kg/litre - 9.2 lbs/US gallon
1 (approx.) hr at 20C/68F (ISO 1517)
2 (approx.) hours at 20C/68F
(See REMARKS overleaf)
1 year at 20C/68F
25 g/litre - 0.2 lbs/US gallon
*Other shades according to assortment list.
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Application method:
Thinner (max.vol):
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Airless spray
Brush (touch-up)
Fresh water (5%)
Fresh water (5%)
015"-.019" (see REMARKS overleaf)
130 bar/1900 psi
(Airless spray data are indicative and subject to adjustment)
Fresh water (see APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS)
120 micron/4.8 mils (see REMARKS overleaf)
250 micron/10 mils
3 hours (20C/68F)
None (see REMARKS overleaf)
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
HEMUCRYL 48130
SURFACE
PREPARATION:
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
PRECEDING COAT:
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
REMARKS:
VOC - EU directive
2004/42/EC:
VOC:
Film thicknesses:
Application:
Recoating:
Other REMARKS:
As supplied
5 vol. % thinning
Limit phase I, 2007
VOC in g/l
25
25
140
For VOC of other shades, please refer to Safety Data Sheet.
May be specified in another film thickness than indicated. Normal range is 100-125 micron/4-5
mils dry film thickness. This will alter spreading rate and may influence drying time and recoat
interval.
For proper film formation the recommended nozzle sizes should be used.
If application is done by roller/brush, apply liberally. Use brushes with synthetic fibres. Rollers
should either be mohair or felt.
No maximum recoat interval, but after prolonged exposure to polluted atmosphere remove
accumulated contamination by high pressure fresh water cleaning and allow to dry.
See separate APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS for HEMPELS HEMUCRYL product range.
HEMUCRYL 48130 is for professional use only.
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Surface preparation,
primers:
New steel: Remove oil and grease, etc. with suitable detergent. Remove salt and
other contaminants by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning. Abrasive blasting to
minimum Sa 2. For temporary protection, if required, use suitable shopprimer. All
damaged shopprimer and contamination from storage and fabrication should be
thoroughly cleaned prior to final painting. For repair and touch-up use the specified
HEMUCRYL primer type.
Repair: Remove oil and grease, etc. with suitable detergent. Remove salt and other
contaminants by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning. Remove rust and loose paint by
abrasive blasting or power tool cleaning to St 3 before recoating. Touch up bare spots
with the specified HEMUCRYL primer type.
Aluminium: Very thorough degreasing, followed by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning
to remove all salts and other contamination. Any anodizing must be completely
removed. Thorough sand papering or abrasive sweeping with mineral abrasives is
recommended. Cast aluminium is recommended to be abrasive swept to a uniform,
evenly grey appearance.
Stainless steel: Very thorough degreasing with alkaline degreaser, ie HEMPEL'S LIGHT
CLEANER 99350, followed by fresh water hosing to remove all contamination.
Hot-dipped galvanized steel: Wet rubbing/grinding with ammonia water 1:20 followed
by fresh water hosing. In the case this method is not feasible, the procedure as
described for stainless steel may be used.
Zinc silicate coated surfaces: Remove oil and grease, etc, with suitable detergent.
Remove salt and other contaminants by high pressure fresh water cleaning. After
exposure to high humidity, zinc salts ("white rust") must be removed carefully by (high
pressure) fresh water cleaning - if necessary combined with scrubbing with stiff nylon
brushes. Consult the APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS for the relevant GALVOSIL product.
Note:
Among the HEMUCRYL primer types, HEMUCRYL TI-COAT 18200 is designed to be
used as the first coat on aluminium, hot-dipped galvanized steel, stainless steel and
on zinc silicate coated surfaces.
Surface preparation,
topcoats:
Preceding coats should be sound and tightly adhering. Remove oil and grease with
suitable detergent. Remove salts and other contaminants by (high pressure) fresh
water cleaning. Remove rust and loose material by abrasive blasting or power tool
cleaning. Dust off residues. Touch up to full system before recoating with specified
HEMUCRYL topcoat type.
Concrete: Any oil, grease and other contaminants should be removed by eg volatilizing
by flame cleaning or treatment with suitable detergent, the latter in the following way:
1)
2)
Remove loose material eg by stiff brushes or blasting, high pressure jetting or flame
cleaning followed by fresh water hosing depending on circumstances. Three last
mentioned methods are also able to remove scum layer if necessary. After surface
preparation the surface should feel solid and hard. Remove dust. Saturate surface with
suitable sealer, eg micro dispersed acrylic type or by the HEMUCRYL topcoat diluted
15-20% with water.
Page 1 of 2
Application Instructions
Use only where application can proceed at temperatures above 5C/41F, preferably
above 10C/50F. Apply on a clean and dry surface with a temperature above the dew
point to avoid condensation.
Relative humidity: During application above 60%, preferably 75-90%, to avoid dry
spray. If RH is below 60%, special thinner may be added in order to reduce dry spray.
During drying below 80%, preferably between 40-60%. (Contact HEMPEL for further
advice). Good ventilation during application and drying is necessary. Especially during
drying it is of utmost importance that sufficient ventilation is covering all parts of the
surfaces painted. Ventilation requirements to remove water vapours liberated during
application and drying are app. 75 m/litre of the paint at 20C/68F. (Relative
humidity of the air supply 40%).
REMARKS:
Good painting practice:
"Edge effect":
The (last applied) paint layer must dry for at least 6 hours at 20C/68F - 40-60%
RH, 12 hours at 10C/50F - 40-60% RH before exposure to temperatures below
5C/41F and/or condensation/water exposure.
Avoid outdoor application in seasons with low night temperatures, frost and frost in
combination with condensation or rain.
Shelf life/storage:
Cleaning of tools:
Tools must be cleaned immediately with lukewarm soap water and/or fresh water
followed by thoroughly rinsing to remove residues of detergent.
Dried remains of paint can be removed with HEMPEL'S TOOL CLEANER 99610.
Safety:
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
Note:
Any deviations from the above of a particular HEMUCRYL will be stated in the product
data sheet for this paint.
ISSUED BY:
HEMPEL A/S
Page 2 of 2
Application Instructions
Product Data
HEMPEL'S SILVIUM 51570
Description:
Recommended use:
As a finishing coat on steel and woodwork exterior and interior in mild to moderately
corrosive environment where an aluminium surface or light reflection is desired, and/or
for moderately hot surface.
Service temperatures:
Certificates/Approvals:
Complies with Section 175.300 of Food Additive Regulations (in respect of carriage of
dry foodstuffs) of the Code of Federal Regulations as found by review of the U.S. Food
and Drug Administration.
HEMPELS SILVIUM 51570 has been tested for non-contamination of grain cargo at the
Newcastle Occupational Health, Great Britain.
Approved as a low flame spread material by Danish, French, Spanish and Singaporean
authorities according to IMO resolution MSC 61 (67).
Has a French, Spanish, Singaporean and Malaysian EC-type Examination Certificate.
Complies with EU Directive 2004/42/EC, subcategory i.
Please see REMARKS overleaf.
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Dry to touch:
V.O.C.:
Aluminium/19000
Glossy (See REMARKS overleaf)
38 1
15.2 m/litre - 25 micron
610 sq.ft./US gallon - 1 mil
38C/100F
1.0 kg/litre - 8.3 lbs/US gallon
5 (approx.) hours at 20C/68F
505 g/litre - 4.2 lbs/US gallon
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Application method:
Thinner (max. vol.):
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness. dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Airless spray
Air spray
Brush/Roller
Do not dilute (See REMARKS overleaf)
.017"
100 bar/1500 psi
(Airless spray data are indicative and subject to adjustment)
THINNER 08080
25 micron/1 mil
75 micron/3 mils
8 hours (20C/68F)
None
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
Sound and intact areas primed with eg HEMPALIN or other suitable alkyd primers (temperature
range: see PRECEDING COAT below) can be recoated directly after all contamination from storage
and fabrication has been thoroughly removed. For other areas remove all rust and loose material
by power tool cleaning to St 3 or abrasive blasting to Sa 2.
Maintenance: Remove oil and grease etc. with suitable detergent.
Remove salt and other contaminants by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning. Remove all rust and
loose material by abrasive blasting or power tool cleaning.
Dust off residues. Touch up with recommended primer.
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
PRECEDING
COAT:
Preceding coat:
Below 120C/248F
120-200C/248-390F
HEMPALIN PRIMERS
Self primed
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
REMARKS:
VOC - EU directive
2004/42/EC:
VOC:
Application:
Finish:
Colour:
None.
As supplied
0 vol. % thinning
Limit phase I, 2007
VOC in g/l
505
505
600
For VOC of other shades, please refer to Safety Data Sheet.
Certificates have been issued under the former quality number 5157.
Spray application is recommended.
For brush application use a flat brush not more than 10 cm/4" wide. Do not dilute. After the paint
has been laid on, it should be distributed with light strokes and in one direction only. If the paint is
worked too much with brush or roller, it will become streaky and greyish and loose its lustre. The
effect is cosmetic only and has no influence on the protective properties.
At high temperatures HEMPEL'S SILVIUM 51570 will become greyish and loose its lustre.
This effect is cosmetic only and has no influence on the protective properties.
At high temperatures HEMPEL'S SILVIUM 51570 will show a tendency to yellow.
This effect is cosmetic only and has no influence on the protective properties.
Note:
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPALIN ENAMEL 52140
Description:
HEMPALIN ENAMEL 52140 is a glossy alkyd enamel which forms a weather resistant
coating. It is flexible and resistant to salt water and spillage of mineral oil and other
aliphatic hydrocarbons.
Recommended use:
As a general purpose finishing coat in alkyd systems on exterior and interior steel and
woodwork in mildly to moderately corrosive environment.
As a finishing coat in engine rooms including tank tops, main engines and auxiliary
machinery.
Service temperatures:
Certificates/Approvals:
Approved as a low flame spread material by Danish, French, Spanish and Singaporean
authorities according to IMO resolution MSC 61 (67).
Has a Danish, French, Spanish, Singaporean, Malaysian and Indonesian EC-type
Examination Certificate.
Complies with EU Directive 2004/42/EC, subcategory i.
Please see REMARKS overleaf.
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Surface dry:
Dry to touch:
V.O.C.:
White/10000*
Glossy
46 1
15.3 m/litre - 30 micron
615 sq.ft./US gallon - 1.2 mils
38C/100F
1.1 kg/litre - 9.2 lbs/US gallon
2 (approx) hrs at 20C/68F (ISO 1517)
6-8 hours at 20C/68F
430 g/litre - 3.6 lbs/US gallon
Black/19990*
Glossy
43 1
14.3 m/litre - 30 micron
575 sq.ft./US gallon - 1.2 mils
38C/100F
0.9 kg/litre - 7.5 lbs/US gallon
2 (approx) hrs at 20C/68F (ISO 1517)
6-8 hours at 20C/68F
455 g/litre - 3.8 lbs/US gallon
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Application method:
Thinner (max. vol.):
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Airless spray
Air spray
Brush/Roller
08230 (5%)
08230 (15%)
08230 (5%)
overleaf)
.018"
150 bar/2200 psi
(Airless spray data are indicative and subject to adjustment)
THINNER 08230
30 micron/1.2 mils
75 micron/3 mils
8 hours (20C/68F)
See REMARKS overleaf
(See REMARKS
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
PREDEDING
COAT:
HEMPALIN PRIMER 12050, HEMPALIN PRIMER HI-BUILD 13200, HEMPALIN UNDERCOAT 42460
according to specification.
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
None.
REMARKS:
VOC - EU directive
2004/42/EC:
VOC:
As supplied
15 vol. % thinning Limit phase I, 2007
VOC in g/l
460
500
600
For VOC of other shades, please refer to Safety Data Sheet.
Certificates have been issued under the former quality number 5214.
Colours:
Film thicknesses:
Thinning:
Recoating:
Certain lead-free red and yellow colours may discolour when exposed to chlorine- containing
atmosphere.
Leaded colours may become discoloured when exposed to sulphide-containing atmosphere.
To obtain full opacity, an extra coat may be necessary, especially for certain lead-free colours in eg
red, orange, yellow and green.
May be specified in other film thicknesses than indicated depending on purpose and area of use.
This will alter spreading rate and may influence drying time and recoat interval. Normal range 3040 micron/1.2-1.6 mils.
THINNER 08080 may be used for spray application, however, with a certain risk of wrinkling of the
preceding fresh coat of HEMPALIN.
Recoat intervals related to later conditions of exposure:
(30 micron/1.2 mils dry film thickness of HEMPALIN ENAMEL 52140)
Minimum
Maximum
Surface temperature
20C/68F
20C/68F
Recoated with
(quality numbers only)
Atmospheric
Atmospheric
52140
Mild
Medium
Mild
Medium
8 hours
8 hours
None
5 days
If the maximum recoat interval is exceeded, roughening of the surface is recommended to ensure
intercoat adhesion.
Before recoating after exposure in contaminated environment, clean the surface thoroughly by (high
pressure) fresh water hosing and allow drying.
Note:
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPALIN ENAMEL HI-BUILD 52220
Description:
HEMPALIN ENAMEL HI-BUILD 52220 is an alkyd paint, which can be applied in high film
thickness by airless spray.
Recommended use:
Service temperatures:
Certificates/Approvals:
Approved as a low flame spread material by Danish, French, Spanish and Singaporean
authorities according to IMO resolution MSC 61 (67).
Has a Danish, French, Spanish, Singaporean, Malaysian and Indonesian EC-type
Examination Certificate.
Complies with EU Directive 2004/42/EC, subcategory i.
Please see REMARKS overleaf.
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Surface dry:
Dry to touch:
V.O.C.:
White/10000
Glossy
47 1
7.8 m/litre - 60 micron
314 sq.ft/US gallon - 2.4 mils
38C/100F
1.1 kg/litre - 9.2 lbs/US gallon
2 (approx) hours at 20C/68F (ISO 1517)
6-8 hours at 20C/68F
435 g/litre - 3.6 lbs/US gallon
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Application method:
Thinner (max.vol.):
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Airless spray
Brush (touch up)
08230 (5%)
08230 (5%)
.021"-.023"
200 bar/2900 psi
(Airless spray data are indicative and subject to adjustment)
THINNER 08080
60 micron/2.4 mils (See REMARKS overleaf)
125 micron/5 mils
See REMARKS overleaf
See REMARKS overleaf
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
PRECEDING
COAT:
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
None.
REMARKS:
VOC - EU directive
2004/42/EC:
VOC:
As supplied
5 vol. % thinning
Limit phase I, 2007
VOC in g/l
435
460
600
For VOC of other shades, please refer to Safety Data Sheet.
Certificate has been issued under the former quality number 5222.
Recoating:
Maximum
Surface temperature
20C/68F
20C/68F
Recoated with
(quality number only)
Atmospheric
Atmospheric
52220
Mild
Medium
Mild
Medium
12 hours
16 hours
None
5 days
If the maximum recoat interval is exceeded, roughening of the surface is recommended to ensure
intercoat adhesion.
Before recoating after exposure in contaminated environment, clean surface thoroughly by (high
pressure) fresh water hosing and allow drying.
May be specified in another film thickness than indicated depending on purpose and area of use.
This will alter spreading rate and may influence drying time and recoat interval.
Do not expose liquid paint to temperatures above 40C/104F neither during storage nor in
connection with application.
Note:
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPALIN DANREX 52360
Description:
HEMPALIN DANREX 52360 is a versatile, alkyd-based, economy paint with fairly good
penetration into rough and porous substrate.
Harmless to grain cargo.
Recommended use:
1.
2.
As a self-primed paint system on interior steel and woodwork, e.g. in dry cargo
holds and other dry areas such as engine rooms, including tank tops, main engine
and auxiliary machinery.
As a primer for alkyd-based paint systems in mild environment.
Service temperatures:
Certificates/Approvals:
Approved as a low flame spread material by Danish, French, Spanish and Singaporean
authorities according to IMO resolution MSC 61 (67).
Has a Danish, French, Spanish, Singaporean, Malaysian and Indonesian EC-type
Examination Certificate.
Tested for non-contamination of grain cargo at the Newcastle Occupational Health,
Great Britain.
Complies with Section 175.300 of Food Additive Regulations (in respect of carriage of
dry foodstuffs) of the Code of U.S. Federal Regulations (FDA).
Please see REMARKS overleaf.
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos.:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Dry to touch:
V.O.C.:
Grey/10670 - Red/50610
Semi-gloss
56 1
14.0 m/litre - 40 micron
561 sq.ft./US gallon - 1.6 mils
38C/100F
1.3 kg/litre - 10.8 lbs/US gallon
6-8 hours at 20C/68F
360 g/litre - 3.0 lbs/US gallon
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Application methods:
Thinner (max. vol.):
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Airless spray
Air spray
Brush/Roller
08230 (5%)
08230 (15%)
08230 (5%)
.018"-.021"
150 bar/2200 psi
(Airless spray data are indicative and subject to adjustment)
THINNER 08230
40 micron/1.6 mils
75 micron/3 mils
8 hours (20C/68F)
None (See REMARKS overleaf)
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
New steel: Abrasive blasting to minimum Sa 2. For temporary protection, if required, use suitable
shopprimer. All damage of shopprimer and contamination from storage and fabrication should be
thoroughly cleaned prior to final painting. For repair and touch-up use HEMPALIN DANREX 52360.
Maintenance: Remove oil and grease, etc. with suitable detergent. Remove salt and other
contaminants by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning. Remove all rust and loose material by
abrasive blasting or power tool cleaning. Dust off residues. Touch up to full film thickness.
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
PRECEDING
COAT:
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
REMARKS:
Note:
Certificates have been issued under the former quality number 5236.
Before recoating after exposure in contaminated environment, clean surface thoroughly by (high
pressure) fresh water hosing and allow to dry.
THINNER 08080 may be used for spray application, however, with a certain risk of wrinkling of a
preceding fresh HEMPALIN coat.
HEMPALIN DANREX 52360 is for professional use only.
ISSUED BY:
Thinning:
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPALIN DECKPAINT 53240
Description:
Recommended use:
As a general purpose finishing coat, interior and exterior, on steel decks, stairways,
catwalks, etc., in mildly to moderately corrosive environment.
Service temperatures:
Certificates/Approvals:
Approved as a low flame spread material by Danish, French, Spanish and Singaporean
authorities according to IMO resolution MSC 61 (67).
Has a Danish, French, Spanish, Singaporean, Malaysian and Indonesian EC-type
Examination Certificate.
Please see REMARKS overleaf.
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Dry to touch:
V.O.C.:
Green/40640
Semi-gloss
42 1
14.0 m/litre - 30 micron
561 sq.ft./US gallon - 1.2 mils
28C/82F
1.1 kg/litre - 9.2 lbs/US gallon
1 (approx.) hour at 20C/68F
495 g/litre - 4.1 lbs/US gallon
Red/50630
Semi-gloss
41 1
13.7 m/litre - 30 micron
548 sq.ft./US gallon - 1.2 mils
28C/82F
1.1 kg/litre - 9.2 lbs/US gallon
1 (approx.) hour at 20C/68F
490 g/litre - 4.1 lbs/US gallon
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Application method:
Thinner (max. vol.):
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Airless spray
Air spray
Brush
08080 (5%)
08080 (15%)
08080 (5%)
.018"-.021"
150 bar/2200 psi
(Airless spray data are indicative and subject to adjustment)
THINNER 08080
30 micron/1.2 mils
75 micron/3 mils
2 hours (20C/68F) (See REMARKS overleaf)
4 hours (20C/68F) (See REMARKS overleaf)
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
PRECEDING
COAT:
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
None.
REMARKS:
Recoating:
Note:
Certificates have been issued under the former quality number 5324.
Recoating should take place when the first coat is dry and within 4 hours. If this interval is
exceeded, do not recoat until after two weeks. No maximum interval for adhesion.
Before recoating after exposure in contaminated environment, clean surface thoroughly by (high
pressure) fresh water cleaning and allow to dry.
If a skid-proof surface is desired, sprinkle HEMPELS ANTI-SLINT 67500 evenly over the first coat
of HEMPALIN DECKPAINT 53240 while still wet. (Consumption: approximately 7.5 kg 67500 to 20
litres of paint). When the paint is dry, sweep up surplus grit and apply a second coat of HEMPALIN
DECKPAINT 53240.
Anti-skid properties can also be attained by mixing 1.0 kg of HEMPEL'S ANTI-SLIP BEADS 67420
into 20 litre of HEMPALIN DECKPAINT 53240.
HEMPALIN DECKPAINT 53240 is for professional use only.
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPAQUICK ENAMEL 53840
Description:
HEMPAQUICK ENAMEL 53840 is a quick drying alkyd enamel with good gloss and
colour retention.
Recommended use:
Service temperatures:
Certificates/Approvals:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Surface dry:
Dry to touch:
V.O.C.:
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Application method:
Thinner (max.vol.):
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min.:
Recoat interval, max.:
Safety:
Airless spray
Airspray
08080 (5%)
08080 (15%)
.011"-.015
150 bar/2200 psi
(Airless spray data are indicative and subject to confirmation)
HEMPELS THINNER 08080
40 micron/1.6 mils
100 micron/4 mils
2 hours (20C/68F)
None
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
The surface must be completely clean and dry and its temperature above the dew point to avoid
condensation. In confined spaces provide adequate ventilation.
PRECEDING
COAT:
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
None.
REMARKS:
VOC - EU directive
2004/42/EC:
VOC:
As supplied
15 vol. % thinning Limit phase I, 2007
VOC in g/l
555
600
600
For VOC of other shades, please refer to Safety Data Sheet.
Colours:
Certain lead-free red and yellow colours may discolour when exposed to sulphide and chlorinecontaining atmosphere.
Recoating:
Before recoating after exposure in contaminated environment, clean the surface thoroughly by high
pressure fresh water hosing and allow to dry.
Note:
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPAXANE CLASSIC 55000
BASE 55009 with CURING AGENT 98000
Description:
Recommended use:
As an isocyanate free glossy decorative and protective, high build finishing coat for new
steel structures in severely corrosive atmospheric environment.
Minimum temperature for curing is 0C/32F.
Service temperatures:
Certificates/Approvals:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific Gravity:
Dry to touch:
Fully cured:
V.O.C.:
Grey/17380*
High-gloss
85 1
6.8 m/litre - 125 micron
273 sq.ft./US gallon - 5 mils
45C/95F
1.4 kg/litre - 11.7 lbs/US gallon
6 hours at 20C/68F
7 days at 20C/68F
195 g/litre - 1.6 lbs/US gallon
*Other shades according to assortment list.
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved
formulas. They are subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard
deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Mixing ratio for 55000:
Application method:
Thinner (max.vol.):
Pot life:
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
The surface must be completely clean and dry at the time of application, and its temperature
must be above the dew point to avoid condensation. Minimum temperature for curing is
0C/32F, minimum relative humidity 30%. In confined spaces provide adequate ventilation during
application and drying.
Reference is made to separate application instructions.
PRECEDING
COAT:
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
None.
REMARKS:
VOC - EU directive
2004/42/EC:
VOC:
Colours:
Service
temperatures:
Film thicknesses:
Recoating on
HEMPADUR:
As supplied
10 vol. % thinning Limit phase I, 2007 Limit phase II, 2010
VOC in g/l
225
290
550
500
For VOC of other shades, please refer to Safety Data Sheet.
Certain lead-free red and yellow colours may discolour when exposed to chlorine- containing
atmosphere.
Leaded colours may become discoloured when exposed to sulphide-containing atmosphere.
At service temperature above 100C/212F, slight discoloration may be expected
May be specified in another film thickness than indicated depending on purpose and area of use.
This will alter spreading rate and may influence drying time and recoating interval. Normal range is
100 - 125 micron/4 -5 mils.
If the product is specified in lower film thickness, more thinning will be needed for proper film
formation during spray application - additionally the colour in the preceding coat should be
considered to reduce contrast.
Recoat intervals related to later conditions of exposure:
(150 micron/6 mils dry film thickness of HEMPAXANE CLASSIC 55000):
Minimum
Maximum
Surface temperature
20C/68F
20C/68F
Recoated with
(quality numbers only)
Atmospheric
Atmospheric
55000
Thinner:
Exposure
to humidity:
Recoating:
Application onto
zinc silicate:
ISSUED BY:
Mild
Medium
Severe
Mild
Medium
Severe
6 hours
6 hours
7 hours
30 days
30 days
30 days
Page 2 of 2
Application
Application Instructions
Instructions
For product description refer to product data sheet
Surface preparation:
Page 1 of 3
HEMPEL
HEMPEL
Application
Instructions
Application Instructions
HEMPAXANE CLASSIC 55000 being a high solids and a relatively high viscosity material
based on special binder chemistry, may require special measures to be taken at
application.
Spray application:
Please note that the thixotropic nature of HEMPAXANE CLASSIC 55000 may give a
rather "wavy" surface of the paint just after application. This smoothens at drying, but
can make it necessary to let the wet film readings be of a higher value than indicated.
In many cases the wet film thickness, reading should be 25 micron/1 mil higher than
calculated. As the wavy surface becomes smoother during drying these extra wet films
thickness readings will not cause a higher paint consumption than otherwise stipulated.
Film thickness/thinning:
Brush application:
Use a brush with natural bristles - maintain a wet edge. By application with brush, a
more uneven paint film is obtained; this can be counteracted by the application of more
coats and thinning.
Roller application:
HEMPAXANE CLASSIC 55000 can be applied directly onto a fully cured zinc-silicate
(GALVOSIL) coating. Zinc-silicate coatings are porous and the porosity depends on the
actual application of the zinc-silicate, the film thickness and the state of aging. Popping
and bubbles may develop when the zinc-silicate is over-coated depending on the
porosity and application method. The following methods have been used successfully in
order to minimize/eliminate the popping and bubbling:
Flash coat procedure: Provided the paint temperature is above approximately
20C/68F: A thin, undiluted coat is applied (the flash coat) and after a few minutes, a
second coat is applied in the full specified film thickness. If the paint temperature is
below 20C/68F, thinning (max 15% THINNER 08080) may be required. The flash coat
is not intended to form a closed uniform film.
Sealer coat procedure: HEMPAXANE CLASSIC 55000 is diluted 100 % with THINNER
08080 and a very thin coat is applied (the sealer coat) - the sealer coat should provide
a blotchy non-uniform appearance. One or two passes of the sealer coat should be
applied - depending on the actual condition of the GALVOSIL surface. After approx. 1
hour (20C/68F) a second coat (undiluted) is applied in the full specified film
thickness.
The actual condition of the zinc-silicate may vary from case to case and it may be
necessary to try both methods to get the optimal result.
Page 2 of 3
Application Instructions
Drying time and recoating interval vary with humidity and temperature:
HEMPAXANE CLASSIC 55000 in a dry film thickness of 100-125 micron/4-5 mils:
Surface temperature:
12 hours
1 month
8 hours
14 days
6 hours
7 days
3 hours
5 days
2 hours
3 days
8 hours
6hours
3 hours
2 hours
60 days
30 days
15 days
7 days
Safety:
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
ISSUED BY:
Page 3 of 3
Application Instructions
Product Data
HEMPAXANE LIGHT 55030
BASE 55039 with CURING AGENT 98000
Description:
Recommended use:
As an isocyanate free glossy decorative and protective finishing coat for new steel
structures in severely corrosive atmospheric environment.
Minimum temperature for curing is 0C/32F.
Service temperatures:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific Gravity:
Dry to touch:
Fully cured:
V.O.C.:
Grey/17380*
High-gloss
82 1
10.9 m/litre - 75 micron
438 sq.ft./US gallon - 3 mils
41C/106F
1.3 kg/litre - 10.8 lbs/US gallon
5 hours at 20C/68F
7 days at 20C/68F
225 g/litre - 1.9 lbs/US gallon
*Other shades according to assortment list.
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Mixing ratio for 55030:
Application method:
Thinner (max.vol.):
Pot life:
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
The surface must be completely clean and dry at the time of application, and its temperature
must be above the dew point to avoid condensation. Minimum temperature for curing is
0C/32F, minimum relative humidity 30%. In confined spaces provide adequate ventilation during
application and drying.
PRECEDING
COAT:
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
None.
REMARKS:
Colours:
Certain lead-free red and yellow colours may discolour when exposed to chlorine- containing
atmosphere.
Leaded colours may become discoloured when exposed to sulphide-containing atmosphere.
To obtain full opacity, an extra coat may be necessary, especially for certain lead-free colours in eg
red, orange, yellow and green.
Minimum
Maximum
Surface temperature
20C/68F
20C/68F
Recoated with
(quality numbers only)
Atmospheric
Atmospheric
55030
Service
temperatures:
Film thicknesses:
Thinner:
Exposure
to humidity:
Recoating:
Mild
Medium
Severe
Mild
Medium
Severe
6 hours
6 hours
7 hours
30 days
30 days
30 days
Notes:
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPATHANE ENAMEL 55100
BASE 55109 with CURING AGENT 95370
Description:
Recommended use:
Service temperatures:
Certificates/Approvals:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific Gravity:
Surface dry:
Dry to touch:
Fully cured:
V.O.C.:
White/10000*
High-gloss
52 1
14.9 m/litre - 35 micron
596 sq.ft./US gallon - 1.4 mil
35C/95F
1.3 kg/litre - 10.8 lbs/US gallon
2 (approx.) hrs at 20C/68F (ISO 1517)
4-5 hours at 20C/68F
7 days at 20C/68F
440 g/litre - 3.7 lbs/US gallon
*Other shades according to assortment list.
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Mixing ratio for 55100:
Application method:
Thinner (max.vol.):
Pot life:
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Brush
08080 (5%)
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
Page 1 of 3
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
The surface must be completely clean and dry at the time of application, and its temperature
must be above the dew point to avoid condensation. Minimum temperature for curing is
-10C/14F.
At the freezing point and below, be aware of the risk of ice on the surface which will hinder the
adhesion. Light rain, high humidity and/or condensation during application and the following 16
hours (20C/68F) may adversely affect the film formation. The humidity of plywood/hardwood
should not exceed 16% w/w.
In confined spaces provide adequate ventilation during application and drying.
PRECEDING COAT:
Service
temperatures:
Film thicknesses:
Thinning:
Recoating and
drying/curing time:
As supplied
20 vol. % thinning Limit phase I, 2007
VOC in g/l
495
550
550
For VOC of other shades, please refer to Safety Data Sheet.
Certain lead-free red and yellow colours may discolour when exposed to chlorine- containing
atmosphere. Leaded colours may become discoloured when exposed to sulphide-containing
atmosphere. To obtain full opacity, an extra coat may be necessary, especially for certain lead-free
colours in eg red, orange, yellow and green.
At service temperatures above 100C/212F, slight discoloration may be expected.
May be specified in another film thickness than indicated depending on purpose and area of use.
This will alter spreading rate and may influence drying time and recoating interval. Normal range is
20-40 micron/0.8 -1.6 mils.
The type and amount of thinner depend on application conditions, application method,
temperature, ventilation, and substrate. THINNER 0808 is recommended in general. THINNER
08510 may be used alternatively depending on local conditions.
Airless spray: 15-20% thinning is recommended. Under extreme conditions more than 25% may be
necessary to obtain satisfactory film formation.
Conventional air spray: Dilute to a viscosity of 17-20 s/DIN 4 (approx 35% by volume). Use lowest
possible air pressure and a small nozzle.
For both kinds of spray application the best result is obtained by applying a mist coat of
HEMPATHANE ENAMEL 55100 at first, and then 2-15 minutes later apply to full film thickness
giving a uniform film formation. Do not exaggerate the film thickness.
Physical data versus temperatures (35 micron/1.4 mil dry film thickness - sufficient ventilation):
Surface temperature
-10C/14F 0C/32F
Min
Max*
10C/50F
20C/68F
30C/86F
45 hours
20 hours
9 hours
5 hours
3 hours
(7 days)
(2 months)
3 days
32 days
32 hours
14 days
16 hours
7 days
12 hours
5 days
3 days
1 day
16 hours
8 hours
6 hours
3 months
2 months
*The maximum recoating intervals apply to surfaces exposed to very severe conditions of periodical immersion,
heavy condensation, great variations in temperatures, chemical attack and/or abrasion during service life of
the coating system. Under other conditions no maximum recoating interval. A completely clean surface is
anyhow mandatory to ensure intercoat adhesion, especially at long recoating intervals. Any dirt, oil, and
grease has to be removed. e.g. with suitable detergent. Salts to be removed by fresh water hosing. To
check an adequate quality of the surface cleaning a test patch is recommended before actual recoating.
If the maximum recoating interval is exceeded, roughening of the surface is necessary to ensure
intercoat adhesion. In the case of recoating with other paint materials maximum will be 1-3 days
(20C/68F) depending on type.
Page 2 of 3
CURING AGENT 95370 is sensitive to moisture. Store in a dry place and keep the can tightly
closed until use. Open curing agent cans with caution as overpressure might exist. Even small
traces of water in the mixed paint will reduce the pot-life and result in film defects.
HEMPATHANE ENAMEL 55100 is for professional use only.
ISSUED BY:
Page 3 of 3
Product Data
HEMPATHANE TOPCOAT 55210
BASE 55219 with CURING AGENT 95370
Description:
Recommended use:
Service temperatures:
Certificates/Approvals:
Approved as a low flame spread material by Danish, French, Spanish and Singaporean
authorities according to IMO resolution MSC 61 (67).
Has a Danish, French, Spanish, Singaporean, Malaysian and Indonesian EC-type
Examination Certificate.
Complies with EU Directive 2004/42/EC, subcategory j.
Please see REMARKS overleaf.
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Surface dry:
Dry to touch:
Fully cured:
V.O.C.:
White/10000 - Blue/30840*
Semi-gloss
51 1
10.2 m/litre - 50 micron
409 sq.ft./US gallon - 2 mils
33C/92F
1.2 kg/litre - 10.0 lbs/US gallon
2 (approx.) hrs at 20C/68F (ISO 1517)
8 (approx.) hours at 20C/68F
7 days at 20C/68F
450 g/litre - 3.7 lbs/US gallon
*Other shades according to assortment list.
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Mixing ratio for 55210:
Application method:
Thinner (max. vol.):
Pot life:
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
The surface must be completely clean and dry at the time of application, and its temperature
must be above the dew point to avoid condensation. Minimum temperature for curing is
-10C/14F. At the freezing point and below, be aware of the risk of ice on the surface which will
hinder the adhesion. High humidity and/or condensation during application and the following 10
hours (20C/68F) may adversely affect the film formation.
In confined spaces provide adequate ventilation during application and drying.
PRECEDING COAT: HEMPADUR 45141/45143, HEMPADUR MASTIC 45880/45881 or according to specification.
SUBSEQUENT COAT: None.
REMARKS:
VOC - EU directive
As supplied
15 vol. % thinning Limit phase I, 2007 Limit phase II, 2010
2004/42/EC:
VOC in g/l
465
515
550
500
VOC:
For VOC of other shades, please refer to Safety Data Sheet.
Certificate has been issued under the former quality number 5521.
Colours:
Certain lead-free red and yellow colours may discolour when exposed to chlorine- containing
atmosphere.
Leaded colours may become discoloured when exposed to sulphide-containing atmosphere.
To obtain full opacity, an extra coat may be necessary, especially for certain lead-free colours in eg
red, orange, yellow and green.
Service
At service temperatures above 100C/212F, HEMPATHANE TOPCOAT 55210 will become more
temperatures:
soft. Furthermore, discolouration may occur.
Film thicknesses:
May be specified in another film thickness than indicated depending on purpose and area of use.
This will alter spreading rate and may influence drying time and recoating interval. Normal range is
40-75 micron/1.6-3 mils.
Thinning:
The type and amount of thinner depend on application conditions, application method,
temperature, ventilation, and substrate. THINNER 08080 is recommended in general. THINNER
08510 may be used alternatively depending on local conditions.
Airless spray: 5-15% thinning is recommended. Under extreme conditions up to more than 20%
may be necessary to obtain satisfactory film formation.
The best result is obtained by applying a mist coat of HEMPATHANE TOPCOAT 55210 at first, and
then 2-15 minutes later apply to full film thickness giving a uniform film formation. Do not
exaggerate the film thickness.
Electrostatic spray: 10% thinning with specified thinner is recommended. Please contact HEMPEL for further advice.
Recoating and
drying/curing time:
-10C/14F
0C/32F
10C/50F
20C/68F
30C/86F
3 days
36 hours
16 hours
8 hours
6 hours
(3 days)
45 hours
20 hours
10 hours
8 hours
(2 months)
32 days
14 days
7 days
5 days
Min
3 days
45 hours
20 hours
10 hours
8 hours
Max
None
None
None
None
None
Recoating interval,
recoating 55210 with 55210
*Faster drying and curing may be obtained by using an "accelerator" - consult HEMPEL for further advice.
Notes:
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPELS OXIDUR 55850
BASE 55859 with CURING AGENT 97550
Description:
Recommended use:
Service temperatures:
Certificates/Approvals:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Surface dry:
Dry to touch:
Fully cured:
V.O.C.:
White/10000*
Glossy
65 1
10.8 m/litre - 60 micron
434 sq.ft./US gallon - 2.4 mils
39C/102F
1.5 kg/litre
12.5 lbs/US gallon
3 (approx.) hours at 20C/68F (ISO 1517)
8-10 hours at 20C/68F
7 days at 20C/68F
335 g/litre - 2.8 lbs/US gallon
*Other shades according to assortment list.
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1..
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Mixing ratio for 55850:
Application method:
Thinner (max.vol.):
Pot life:
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
SURFACE
PREPARATION:
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
Use only where application and curing can proceed at temperatures above 10C/50F. The
temperature of the surface and that of the paint itself must also be above this limit.
Apply only on a dry and completely clean surface with a temperature above the dew point to avoid
condensation.
In confined spaces provide adequate ventilation during application and drying.
PRECEDING
COAT:
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
None.
REMARKS:
VOC - EU directive
2004/42/EC:
VOC:
Service
temperatures:
Colours:
Stripe coating:
Film thicknesses:
Recoating:
As supplied
15 vol. % thinning Limit phase I, 2007
VOC in g/l
345
410
550
For VOC of other shades, please refer to Safety Data Sheet.
At service temperatures above 90C/176F, HEMPELS OXIDUR 55850 will become more
soft. Furthermore, discoloration may occur.
Certain lead-free red and yellow colours may discolour when exposed to chlorine- containing
atmosphere.
Leaded colours may become discoloured when exposed to sulphide-containing atmosphere.
When specified as a one coat Direct to Metal-system follow Good Painting Practise and apply
stripe coating before the spray application on areas difficult to cover properly by spray application.
May be specified in another film thickness than indicated depending on purpose and area of use.
This will alter spreading rate and may influence drying time and recoat interval. Normal range is 50100 micron/2.0-4.0 mils.
Maximum recoat interval related to later conditions of exposure:
Steel temperature
20C/68F
Atmospheric
Recoated with
(quality number only)
55850
Mild
None
Medium
None
Severe
3 months
Gloss:
A completely clean surface is anyhow mandatory to ensure intercoat adhesion, especially at long
recoat intervals. Any dirt, oil and grease has to be removed, e.g. with suitable detergent. Salts to
be removed by fresh water hosing. To determine whether the quality of the surface cleaning is
adequate, a test patch may be relevant. However, such a test is not the final proof of long-term
durability, but if the result is doubtful, repeated cleaning will be relevant
A slight tendency to chalk in outdoor exposure does not detract from the protective properties.
Note:
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPATHANE TOPCOAT 55910
BASE 55919 with CURING AGENT 97050
Description:
Recommended use:
Service temperatures:
Certificates/Approvals:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Surface dry:
Dry to touch:
Fully cured:
V.O.C.:
White/10000
Glossy
65 1
6.5 m/litre - 100 micron
261 sq.ft./US gallon - 4 mils
31C/88F
1.5 kg/litre - 12.5 lbs/US gallon
3 (approx.) hours at 20C/68F (ISO 1517)
5 (approx.) hours at 20C/68F
7 days at 20C/68F
335 g/litre - 2.8 lbs/US gallon
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Mixing ratio for 55910:
Application method:
Thinner (max.vol.):
Pot life:
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
The surface must be completely clean and dry at the time of application, and its temperature
must be above the dew point to avoid condensation. Minimum temperature for curing is 10C/14F.
At the freezing point and below, be aware of the risk of ice on the surface which will hinder the
adhesion. High humidity and/or condensation during application and the following 24 hours
(20C/68F) may adversely affect the film formation.
In confined spaces provide adequate ventilation during application and drying.
PRECEDING
COAT:
According to specification.
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
None.
REMARKS:
VOC - EU directive
2004/42/EC:
VOC:
Service
temperatures:
Colours:
Stripe coating:
Film thicknesses:
Recoat interval:
Notes:
As supplied
5 vol. % thinning
Limit phase I, 2007
VOC in g/l
335
360
550
For VOC of other shades, please refer to Safety Data Sheet.
At service temperatures above 100C/212F, HEMPATHANE TOPCOAT 55910 will become more
soft. Furthermore, discolouration may occur.
Certain lead-free red and yellow colours may discolour when exposed to chlorine- containing
atmosphere.
Leaded colours may become discoloured when exposed to sulphide-containing atmosphere.
To obtain full opacity, an extra coat may be necessary, especially for certain lead-free colours in eg
red, orange, yellow and green.
When specified as a one coat Direct to Metal-system 100 micron/4 mils must be applied.
In addition follow Good Painting Practise and apply stripe coating before the spray application on
areas difficult to cover properly by spray application.
May be specified in another film thickness than indicated depending on purpose and area of use.
Normal range dry is minimum 50 micron/2 mils (diluted) and minimum 75 micron/3 mils
(undiluted), maximum 125 micron/5 mils. This will alter spreading rate and may influence drying
time and recoat interval.
Maximum recoating interval: A completely clean surface is mandatory to ensure intercoat
adhesion, especially at long recoat intervals. Any dirt, oil, and grease has to be removed. e.g.
with suitable detergent followed by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning. Salts to be removed by
fresh water hosing.
To check an adequate quality of the surface cleaning a test patch is recommended before actual
recoating.
CURING AGENT 97050 is sensitive to moisture. Store in a dry place and keep the can tightly
closed until use. Open curing agent cans with caution as overpressure might exist. Even small
traces of water in the mixed paint will reduce the pot life and result in film defects.
HEMPATHANE TOPCOAT 55910 is for professional use only.
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPATEX ENAMEL 56360
Description:
HEMPATEX ENAMEL 56360 is a finishing coat based on acrylic resin and nonchlorinated plasticizer for optimum gloss and colour retention. Physically drying.
Resistant to salt water, splashes of aliphatic hydrocarbons and animal and vegetable
oils.
Recommended use:
Service temperatures:
Certificates/Approvals:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Surface dry:
Dry to touch:
V.O.C.:
Black/19990*
Semi-gloss
31 1
8.9 m/litre - 35 micron
355 sq.ft./US gallon - 1.4 mils
25C/77F
1.0 kg/litre - 8.3 lbs/US gallon
1 (approx.) hr at 20C/68F (ISO 1517)
3-4 hours at 20C/68F
615 g/litre - 5.1 lbs/US gallon
Orange/50040*
Semi-gloss
33 1
9.4 m/litre - 35 micron
378 sq.ft./US gallon - 1.4 mils
25C/77F
1.0 kg/litre - 8.3 lbs/US gallon
1 (approx.) hr at 20C/68F (ISO 1517)
3-4 hours at 20C/68F
595 g/litre - 4.9 lbs/US gallon
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Application method:
Thinner (max. vol.):
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Airless spray
Air spray
Brush/Roller
08080 (5%)
08080 (15%)
08080 (5%)
.017"
150 bar/2200 psi
(Airless spray data are indicative and subject to adjustment)
THINNER 08080
35 micron/1.4 mils
100 micron/4 mils
4 hours (20C/68F)
None (See REMARKS overleaf)
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
As dictated by normal good painting practice. Dry and clean surface at a temperature above the
dew point.
In confined spaces provide adequate ventilation during application and drying.
PRECEDING
COAT:
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
None.
REMARKS:
Colours:
Note:
Certificate has been issued under the former quality number 5636.
Certain lead-free red and yellow colours may discolour when exposed to chlorine- containing
atmosphere.
Leaded colours may become discoloured when exposed to sulphide-containing atmosphere.
To obtain full opacity, an extra coat may be necessary, especially for certain lead-free colours in eg
red, orange, yellow and green.
As HEMPATEX ENAMEL 56360 is a thermoplastic product, prolonged direct contact at
temperatures
above approx. 40C/104F may cause film indentation. When the temperature drops below, the
mechanical strength is recovered.
A series of maintenance jobs may result in build up of a too high total film thickness which may
cause blister formation due to "entrapped" solvents. As each coat may also retain solvents, it is
generally recommended not to apply HEMPATEX ENAMEL 56360 in excessive film thickness.
Before recoating after exposure in contaminated environment, clean the surface thoroughly by high
pressure fresh water hosing and allow to dry.
Overlapping with certain other paints may cause cracking. Refer to Remarks of relevant Painting
Specification.
If a skid-proof surface is desired, sprinkle HEMPEL'S ANTI-SLINT 67500 evenly on the first coat of
HEMPATEX ENAMEL 56360 while still wet (consumption approx. 2.5 kg/5.5 lbs to 25 m/270
sq.ft.). When the paint is dry, sweep up surplus grit and apply a second coat of HEMPATEX
ENAMEL 56360. Antiskid properties can also be obtained by mixing 1.0 kg of HEMPEL'S ANTISLIP
BEADS 67420 into 20 litres of HEMPATEX ENAMEL 56360.
HEMPATEX ENAMEL 56360 is for professional use only.
ISSUED BY:
Service
temperatures:
Film thicknesses:
Recoating:
Skid-proof
surfaces:
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPEL'S HI-VEE 56540
Description:
HEMPEL'S HI-VEE 56540 is a non-hiding, but strongly day-light reflecting acrylic paint
with fluorescent pigments which give intense colour impression and high visibility (HIVEE). It has no effect in darkness, and it needs HEMPEL'S HI-VEE LACQUER 06520 on
top in order to improve the light fastness.
Recommended use:
For life-saving equipment and for warning purposes such as protruding or moving
objects, etc.
Service temperatures:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shades nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Dry to touch:
V.O.C.:
Orange/50180*
Semi-gloss
44 1
11.0 m/litre - 40 micron
441 sq.ft./US gallon - 1.6 mils
38C/100F
1.0 kg/litre - 8.3 lbs/US gallon
1-2 hours at 20C/68F
450 g/litre - 3.7 lbs/US gallon
*Other shades according to assortment list.
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Application method:
Thinner (max. vol.):
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Airless spray
Air spray
Brush
08230 (5%)
08230 (15%)
08230 (5%)
.015"-.018"
150 bar/2200 psi
(Airless spray data are indicative and subject to adjustment)
THINNER 08230
40 micron/1.6 mils
100 micron/4 mils
2 hours (20C/68F)
None
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
PRECEDING
COAT:
White, preferably flat HEMPATEX paint or according to specification. HEMPEL'S HI-VEE 56540 is
applied on a white surface in order to obtain optimum light reflection.
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
HEMPEL'S HI-VEE LACQUER 06520, which contains ultra-violet radiation absorbing filter.
REMARKS:
Note:
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPELS SILICONE TOPCOAT 56900
Description:
Recommended use:
For long-term protection of hot pipelines, exhaust pipes, smoke stacks and other hot
surfaces up to 200C/392F. In corrosive environment see PRECEDING COAT overleaf.
Service temperatures:
Certificates/Approvals:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Surface dry:
Dry to touch:
V.O.C.:
White/10000
Semi-flat (See REMARKS overleaf)
58 1
23.2 m/litre - 25 micron
946 sq.ft./US gallon - 1.0 mil
25C/77F
1.5 kg/litre - 12.5 lbs/US gallon
1 (approx.) hr at 20C/68F (ISO 1517)
2-4 hours at 20C/68F
375 g/litre - 3.1 lbs/US gallon
Black/19990
Semi-flat (See REMARKS overleaf)
55 1
22.0 m/litre - 25 micron
882 sq.ft./US gallon - 1.0 mil
25C/77F
1.2 kg/litre - 10.0 lbs/US gallon
1 (approx.) hr at 20C/68F (ISO 1517)
2-4 hours at 20C/68F
405 g/litre - 3.4 lbs/US gallon
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved
formulas. They are subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard
deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Application method:
Thinner (max.vol.):
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min.:
Recoat interval, max.:
Safety:
Airless spray
Air spray
Brush
08080 (25%)
08080 (40%)
08080 (25%) (See REMARKS overleaf)
.017"
125 bar/1800 psi
(Airless spray data are indicative and subject to adjustment)
THINNER 08080
25 micron/1 mil (See REMARKS overleaf)
50 micron/2 mils
24 hours (20C/68F) (See REMARKS overleaf)
See REMARKS overleaf
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
Remove oil and grease etc. thoroughly with suitable detergent. Remove salts and other
contaminants by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning.
Abrasive blasting to Sa 2. If shopprimer is required, only zinc silicate type is recommended.
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
Clean and dry surface with a temperature above the dew point to avoid condensation. In confined
spaces provide adequate ventilation during application and drying.
PRECEDING
COAT:
Can be used directly on blast-cleaned steel. For maximum corrosion protection, a primer coat of
one of the following paints is recommended (40 micron/1.6 mil dry film thicknesses):
HEMPELS SILICONE ZINC 16900 or HEMPELS GALVOSIL 15700.
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
None.
REMARKS:
VOC - EU directive
2004/42/EC:
VOC:
As supplied
40 vol. % thinning Limit phase I, 2007
VOC in g/l
405
545
600
For VOC of other shades, please refer to Safety Data Sheet.
Gloss:
Thermoplasticity:
Film thicknesses:
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPELS SILICONE ALUMINIUM 56910
Description:
Recommended use:
For long-term protection of hot pipelines, exhaust pipes, smoke stacks and other hot
surfaces. In corrosive environment see PRECEDING COAT overleaf.
Service temperatures:
Certificates/Approvals:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Surface dry:
Dry to touch:
V.O.C.:
Aluminium/19000
Semi-flat (See REMARKS overleaf)
35 1
14.0 m/litre - 25 micron
561 sq.ft./US gallon - 1.0 mil
25C/77F
1.1 kg/litre - 9.2 lbs/US gallon
1 (approx.) hour at 20C/68F (ISO 1517)
2-4 hours at 20C/68F
585 g/litre - 4.9 lbs/US gallon
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Application method:
Thinner (max.vol.):
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Airless spray
Air spray
Brush
08080 (5%)
08080 (15%)
08080 (5%) (See REMARKS overleaf)
.017"
125 bar/1800 psi
(Airless spray data are indicative and subject to adjustment)
THINNER 08080
25 micron/1 mil (See REMARKS overleaf)
75 micron/3 mils
24 hours (20C/68F) (See REMARKS overleaf)
See REMARKS overleaf
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
Remove oil and grease etc. thoroughly with suitable detergent. Remove salts and other
contaminants by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning.
Abrasive blasting to Sa 2.
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
Clean and dry surface with a temperature above the dew point to avoid condensation. In confined
spaces provide adequate ventilation during application and drying.
PRECEDING
COAT:
Can be used directly on blast-cleaned steel. For maximum corrosion protection, a primer coat of
one of the following paints is recommended (40 micron/1.6 mil dry film thicknesses):
HEMPELS SILICONE ZINC 16900 or HEMPELS GALVOSIL 15700.
This will lower the heat resistance; reference is made to the product data sheets for the mentioned
primers.
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
None.
REMARKS:
VOC - EU directive
2004/42/EC:
VOC in g/l
As supplied
585
5 vol. % thinning
595
Gloss:
Thermo plasticity:
Film thicknesses:
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPELS SILICONE ACRYLIC 56940
Description:
Recommended use:
For long-term protection of hot pipelines, exhaust pipes, smoke stacks and other hot
surfaces up to 200C/390F, resist short time exposure up to 300C/572F. When
heated to above 200C/390F for longer periods a certain discolouration may occur,
which do not affect the protective properties of the product. In corrosive environment
see PRECEDING COAT overleaf.
Service temperatures:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos.:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Surface dry:
Dry to touch:
V.O.C.:
Aluminium/19000*
Semi-flat (see REMARKS overleaf)
29 1
11.6 m/litre - 25 micron
465 sq.ft./US gallon - 1.0 mil
25C/77F
1.1 kg/litre - 9.2 lbs/US gallon
(approx.) hr at 20C/68F (ISO 1517)
1-2 hours at 20C/68F
600 g/litre - 5.0 lbs/US gallon
*Other shades according to assortment list.
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Application method:
Thinner (max.vol.):
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Airless spray
Air spray
Brush
08080 (15%)
08080 (25%)
08080 (15%)
(See REMARKS overleaf)
.017"
125 bar/1800 psi
(Airless spray data are indicative and subject to adjustment)
THINNER 08080
25 micron/1 mil (see REMARKS overleaf)
50-100 micron/2-4 mils (depending on colour)
See REMARKS overleaf
See REMARKS overleaf
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
Remove oil and grease etc. thoroughly with suitable detergent. Remove salts and other
contaminants by high pressure fresh water cleaning.
Abrasive blasting to Sa 2, SSPC-SP-10. If shopprimer is required, only zinc silicate type is
recommended.
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
Clean and dry surface with a temperature above dew point to avoid condensation. In confined
spaces provide adequate ventilation during application and drying.
PRECEDING
COAT:
Can be used directly on blast-cleaned steel. For maximum corrosion protection, a primer coat of
one of the following paints is recommended (40 micron/1.6 mil dry film thicknesses):
HEMPELS SILICONE ZINC 16900 or HEMPELS GALVOSIL 15700.
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
None.
REMARKS:
Gloss:
Thermo plasticity:
Film thicknesses:
Note:
ISSUED BY:
High temperature
service:
First exposure
to heat:
Curing:
Recoating:
Zinc silicate
primer:
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMUCRYL ENAMEL HI-BUILD 58030
Description:
Recommended use:
Service temperatures:
Certificates/Approvals:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Surface dry:
Dry to touch:
V.O.C.:
White/10000*
Glossy
44 1
5.9 m/litre - 75 micron
235 sq.ft/US gallon - 3 mils
> 93C/199F
1.2 kg/litre - 10.0 lbs/US gallon
(approx.) hour at 20C/68F (ISO 1517)
1 (approx.) hour at 20C/68F (See REMARKS overleaf)
5 g/litre - 0.0 lbs/US gallon
*Other shades according to assortment list.
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Application method:
Thinner (max.vol):
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Airless spray
Brush (touch-up)
Fresh water (5%)
HEMUCRYL BRUSH AGENT 99810 (3-8%)
015"-.019" (See APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS)
130 bar/1900 psi
(Airless spray data are indicative and subject to adjustment)
Fresh water (See APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS)
75 micron/3 mils (See REMARKS overleaf)
175 micron/7 mils
2 hours (20C/68F)
None (See REMARKS overleaf)
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
PRECEDING
COAT:
REMARKS:
VOC - EU directive
2004/42/EC:
VOC:
Colours:
Film thicknesses:
Application:
Recoating:
Other REMARKS:
As supplied
8 vol. % thinning
Limit phase I, 2007
VOC in g/l
5
10
140
For VOC of other shades, please refer to Safety Data Sheet.
Certificates have been issued under the former quality number 5803.
Certain lead-free red and yellow colours may discolour when exposed to chlorine-containing
atmosphere.
Leaded colours may become discoloured when exposed to sulphide-containing atmosphere.
To obtain full opacity, an extra coat may be necessary, especially for certain lead-free colours in eg
red, orange, yellow and green.
May be specified in another film thickness than indicated. This will alter spreading rate and may
influence drying time and recoating interval. Normal range is 50-100 micron/2-4 mils dry film
thickness. When used in 50 micron dry film thickness, 3-5% thinning will be necessary to secure
proper film formation. Beware of overthinning, which may cause formation of fisheyes.
For proper film formation the recommended nozzle sizes should be used.
If application is done by roller/brush, apply liberally. Use brushes with synthetic fibres. Rollers
should either be mohair or felt.
For brush application, add 3-8% by volume of HEMUCRYL BRUSH AGENT 99810.
No maximum recoating interval, but after prolonged exposure to polluted atmosphere remove
accumulated contamination by high pressure fresh water cleaning and allow to dry.
See separate HEMUCRYL APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS.
HEMUCRYL ENAMEL HI-BUILD 58030 is for professional use only.
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Surface preparation,
primers:
New steel: Remove oil and grease, etc. with suitable detergent. Remove salt and
other contaminants by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning. Abrasive blasting to
minimum Sa 2. For temporary protection, if required, use suitable shopprimer. All
damaged shopprimer and contamination from storage and fabrication should be
thoroughly cleaned prior to final painting. For repair and touch-up use the specified
HEMUCRYL primer type.
Repair: Remove oil and grease, etc. with suitable detergent. Remove salt and other
contaminants by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning. Remove rust and loose paint by
abrasive blasting or power tool cleaning to St 3 before recoating. Touch up bare spots
with the specified HEMUCRYL primer type.
Aluminium: Very thorough degreasing, followed by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning
to remove all salts and other contamination. Any anodizing must be completely
removed. Thorough sand papering or abrasive sweeping with mineral abrasives is
recommended. Cast aluminium is recommended to be abrasive swept to a uniform,
evenly grey appearance.
Stainless steel: Very thorough degreasing with alkaline degreaser, ie HEMPEL'S LIGHT
CLEANER 99350, followed by fresh water hosing to remove all contamination.
Hot-dipped galvanized steel: Wet rubbing/grinding with ammonia water 1:20 followed
by fresh water hosing. In the case this method is not feasible, the procedure as
described for stainless steel may be used.
Zinc silicate coated surfaces: Remove oil and grease, etc, with suitable detergent.
Remove salt and other contaminants by high pressure fresh water cleaning. After
exposure to high humidity, zinc salts ("white rust") must be removed carefully by (high
pressure) fresh water cleaning - if necessary combined with scrubbing with stiff nylon
brushes. Consult the APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS for the relevant GALVOSIL product.
Note:
Among the HEMUCRYL primer types, HEMUCRYL TI-COAT 18200 is designed to be
used as the first coat on aluminium, hot-dipped galvanized steel, stainless steel and
on zinc silicate coated surfaces.
Surface preparation,
topcoats:
Preceding coats should be sound and tightly adhering. Remove oil and grease with
suitable detergent. Remove salts and other contaminants by (high pressure) fresh
water cleaning. Remove rust and loose material by abrasive blasting or power tool
cleaning. Dust off residues. Touch up to full system before recoating with specified
HEMUCRYL topcoat type.
Concrete: Any oil, grease and other contaminants should be removed by eg volatilizing
by flame cleaning or treatment with suitable detergent, the latter in the following way:
1)
2)
Remove loose material eg by stiff brushes or blasting, high pressure jetting or flame
cleaning followed by fresh water hosing depending on circumstances. Three last
mentioned methods are also able to remove scum layer if necessary. After surface
preparation the surface should feel solid and hard. Remove dust. Saturate surface with
suitable sealer, eg micro dispersed acrylic type or by the HEMUCRYL topcoat diluted
15-20% with water.
Page 1 of 2
Application Instructions
Use only where application can proceed at temperatures above 5C/41F, preferably
above 10C/50F. Apply on a clean and dry surface with a temperature above the dew
point to avoid condensation.
Relative humidity: During application above 60%, preferably 75-90%, to avoid dry
spray. If RH is below 60%, special thinner may be added in order to reduce dry spray.
During drying below 80%, preferably between 40-60%. (Contact HEMPEL for further
advice). Good ventilation during application and drying is necessary. Especially during
drying it is of utmost importance that sufficient ventilation is covering all parts of the
surfaces painted. Ventilation requirements to remove water vapours liberated during
application and drying are app. 75 m/litre of the paint at 20C/68F. (Relative
humidity of the air supply 40%).
REMARKS:
Good painting practice:
"Edge effect":
The (last applied) paint layer must dry for at least 6 hours at 20C/68F - 40-60%
RH, 12 hours at 10C/50F - 40-60% RH before exposure to temperatures below
5C/41F and/or condensation/water exposure.
Avoid outdoor application in seasons with low night temperatures, frost and frost in
combination with condensation or rain.
Shelf life/storage:
Cleaning of tools:
Tools must be cleaned immediately with lukewarm soap water and/or fresh water
followed by thoroughly rinsing to remove residues of detergent.
Dried remains of paint can be removed with HEMPEL'S TOOL CLEANER 99610.
Safety:
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
Note:
Any deviations from the above of a particular HEMUCRYL will be stated in the product
data sheet for this paint.
ISSUED BY:
HEMPEL A/S
Page 2 of 2
Application Instructions
Product Data
HEMUCRYL ENAMEL 58040
Description:
Recommended use:
As a glossy and hard topcoat in water-borne paint systems, interior and exterior, in
moderately to severely atmospheric corrosive environment.
Suited for workshop application where fast handling is essential.
Service temperatures:
Certificates/Approvals:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Surface dry:
Dry to touch:
V.O.C.:
White/10000
Glossy
36 1
6.0 m/litre - 60 micron
241 sq.ft/US gallon - 2.4 mils
> 93C/199F
1.2 kg/litre - 10.0 lbs/US gallon
(approx.) hour at 20C/68F (ISO 1517)
1 (approx.) hour at 20C/68F (See REMARKS overleaf)
40 g/litre - 0.3 lbs/US gallon
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved
formulas. They are subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard
deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Application method:
Thinner (max.vol):
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Airless spray
Brush (touch-up)
Fresh water (5%)
HEMUCRYL BRUSH AGENT 99810 (3-8%)
015"-.019" (See REMARKS overleaf)
130 bar/1900 psi
(Airless spray data are indicative and subject to adjustment)
Fresh water (See REMARKS overleaf)
60 micron/2.4 mils (See REMARKS overleaf)
175 micron/7 mils
2 hours (20C/68F)
None (See REMARKS overleaf)
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
PRECEDING
COAT:
REMARKS:
VOC - EU directive
2004/42/EC:
VOC:
Viscosity:
Film thicknesses:
Application:
Recoating:
Other REMARKS:
As supplied
8 vol. % thinning
Limit phase I, 2007
VOC in g/l
40
45
140
For VOC of other shades, please refer to Safety Data Sheet.
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Surface preparation,
primers:
New steel: Remove oil and grease, etc. with suitable detergent. Remove salt and
other contaminants by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning. Abrasive blasting to
minimum Sa 2. For temporary protection, if required, use suitable shopprimer. All
damaged shopprimer and contamination from storage and fabrication should be
thoroughly cleaned prior to final painting. For repair and touch-up use the specified
HEMUCRYL primer type.
Repair: Remove oil and grease, etc. with suitable detergent. Remove salt and other
contaminants by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning. Remove rust and loose paint by
abrasive blasting or power tool cleaning to St 3 before recoating. Touch up bare spots
with the specified HEMUCRYL primer type.
Aluminium: Very thorough degreasing, followed by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning
to remove all salts and other contamination. Any anodizing must be completely
removed. Thorough sand papering or abrasive sweeping with mineral abrasives is
recommended. Cast aluminium is recommended to be abrasive swept to a uniform,
evenly grey appearance.
Stainless steel: Very thorough degreasing with alkaline degreaser, ie HEMPEL'S LIGHT
CLEANER 99350, followed by fresh water hosing to remove all contamination.
Hot-dipped galvanized steel: Wet rubbing/grinding with ammonia water 1:20 followed
by fresh water hosing. In the case this method is not feasible, the procedure as
described for stainless steel may be used.
Zinc silicate coated surfaces: Remove oil and grease, etc, with suitable detergent.
Remove salt and other contaminants by high pressure fresh water cleaning. After
exposure to high humidity, zinc salts ("white rust") must be removed carefully by (high
pressure) fresh water cleaning - if necessary combined with scrubbing with stiff nylon
brushes. Consult the APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS for the relevant GALVOSIL product.
Note:
Among the HEMUCRYL primer types, HEMUCRYL TI-COAT 18200 is designed to be
used as the first coat on aluminium, hot-dipped galvanized steel, stainless steel and
on zinc silicate coated surfaces.
Surface preparation,
topcoats:
Preceding coats should be sound and tightly adhering. Remove oil and grease with
suitable detergent. Remove salts and other contaminants by (high pressure) fresh
water cleaning. Remove rust and loose material by abrasive blasting or power tool
cleaning. Dust off residues. Touch up to full system before recoating with specified
HEMUCRYL topcoat type.
Concrete: Any oil, grease and other contaminants should be removed by eg volatilizing
by flame cleaning or treatment with suitable detergent, the latter in the following way:
1)
2)
Remove loose material eg by stiff brushes or blasting, high pressure jetting or flame
cleaning followed by fresh water hosing depending on circumstances. Three last
mentioned methods are also able to remove scum layer if necessary. After surface
preparation the surface should feel solid and hard. Remove dust. Saturate surface with
suitable sealer, eg micro dispersed acrylic type or by the HEMUCRYL topcoat diluted
15-20% with water.
Page 1 of 2
Application Instructions
Use only where application can proceed at temperatures above 5C/41F, preferably
above 10C/50F. Apply on a clean and dry surface with a temperature above the dew
point to avoid condensation.
Relative humidity: During application above 60%, preferably 75-90%, to avoid dry
spray. If RH is below 60%, special thinner may be added in order to reduce dry spray.
During drying below 80%, preferably between 40-60%. (Contact HEMPEL for further
advice). Good ventilation during application and drying is necessary. Especially during
drying it is of utmost importance that sufficient ventilation is covering all parts of the
surfaces painted. Ventilation requirements to remove water vapours liberated during
application and drying are app. 75 m/litre of the paint at 20C/68F. (Relative
humidity of the air supply 40%).
REMARKS:
Good painting practice:
"Edge effect":
The (last applied) paint layer must dry for at least 6 hours at 20C/68F - 40-60%
RH, 12 hours at 10C/50F - 40-60% RH before exposure to temperatures below
5C/41F and/or condensation/water exposure.
Avoid outdoor application in seasons with low night temperatures, frost and frost in
combination with condensation or rain.
Shelf life/storage:
Cleaning of tools:
Tools must be cleaned immediately with lukewarm soap water and/or fresh water
followed by thoroughly rinsing to remove residues of detergent.
Dried remains of paint can be removed with HEMPEL'S TOOL CLEANER 99610.
Safety:
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
Note:
Any deviations from the above of a particular HEMUCRYL will be stated in the product
data sheet for this paint.
ISSUED BY:
HEMPEL A/S
Page 2 of 2
Application Instructions
Product Data
HEMUCRYL TOPCOAT HI-BUILD 58230
Description:
Recommended use:
Service temperatures:
Certificates/Approvals:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Dry to touch:
V.O.C.
White/10000*
Semi-flat
42 1
5.6 m/litre - 75 micron
225 sq.ft/US gallon - 3 mils
> 93C/199F
1.2 kg/litre - 10.0 lbs/US gallon
1 (approx.) hour at 20C/68F (See REMARKS overleaf)
2 g/litre - 0.0 lbs/US gallon
*Other shades according to assortment list.
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Application method:
Thinner (max.vol):
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Airless spray
Brush (touch-up)
Fresh water (5%)
HEMUCRYL BRUSH AGENT 99810 (3-8%)
015"-.019" (See APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS)
130 bar/1900 psi
(Airless spray data are indicative and subject to adjustment)
Fresh water (See APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS)
75 micron/3 mils (See REMARKS overleaf)
175 micron/7 mils
2 hours (20C/68F)
None (See REMARKS overleaf)
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
PRECEDING
COAT:
REMARKS:
VOC - EU directive
2004/42/EC:
VOC:
Colours:
Film thicknesses:
Application:
Recoating:
Other REMARRKS:
As supplied
8 vol. % thinning
Limit phase I, 2007
VOC in g/l
5
5
140
For VOC of other shades, please refer to Safety Data Sheet.
Certain lead-free red and yellow colours may discolour when exposed to chlorine- containing
atmosphere.
Leaded colours may become discoloured when exposed to sulphide-containing atmosphere.
May be specified in another film thickness than indicated. This will alter spreading rate and may
influence drying time and recoating interval. Normal range dry is 50-100 micron/2-4 mils dry film
thickness. When used in 50 micron dry film thickness, 3-5% thinning will be necessary to secure
proper film formation.
For proper film formation the recommended nozzle sizes should be used.
If application is done by brush/roller, apply liberally. Use brushes with synthetic fibres. Rollers
should either be mohair or felt.
For brush/roller application, add 3-8% by volume of HEMUCRYL BRUSH AGENT 99810.
No maximum recoating interval, but after prolonged exposure to polluted atmosphere remove
accumulated contamination by high pressure fresh water cleaning and allow to dry.
See separate HEMUCRYL APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS.
HEMUCRYL TOPCOAT HI-BUILD 58230 is for professional use only.
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Surface preparation,
primers:
New steel: Remove oil and grease, etc. with suitable detergent. Remove salt and
other contaminants by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning. Abrasive blasting to
minimum Sa 2. For temporary protection, if required, use suitable shopprimer. All
damaged shopprimer and contamination from storage and fabrication should be
thoroughly cleaned prior to final painting. For repair and touch-up use the specified
HEMUCRYL primer type.
Repair: Remove oil and grease, etc. with suitable detergent. Remove salt and other
contaminants by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning. Remove rust and loose paint by
abrasive blasting or power tool cleaning to St 3 before recoating. Touch up bare spots
with the specified HEMUCRYL primer type.
Aluminium: Very thorough degreasing, followed by (high pressure) fresh water cleaning
to remove all salts and other contamination. Any anodizing must be completely
removed. Thorough sand papering or abrasive sweeping with mineral abrasives is
recommended. Cast aluminium is recommended to be abrasive swept to a uniform,
evenly grey appearance.
Stainless steel: Very thorough degreasing with alkaline degreaser, ie HEMPEL'S LIGHT
CLEANER 99350, followed by fresh water hosing to remove all contamination.
Hot-dipped galvanized steel: Wet rubbing/grinding with ammonia water 1:20 followed
by fresh water hosing. In the case this method is not feasible, the procedure as
described for stainless steel may be used.
Zinc silicate coated surfaces: Remove oil and grease, etc, with suitable detergent.
Remove salt and other contaminants by high pressure fresh water cleaning. After
exposure to high humidity, zinc salts ("white rust") must be removed carefully by (high
pressure) fresh water cleaning - if necessary combined with scrubbing with stiff nylon
brushes. Consult the APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS for the relevant GALVOSIL product.
Note:
Among the HEMUCRYL primer types, HEMUCRYL TI-COAT 18200 is designed to be
used as the first coat on aluminium, hot-dipped galvanized steel, stainless steel and
on zinc silicate coated surfaces.
Surface preparation,
topcoats:
Preceding coats should be sound and tightly adhering. Remove oil and grease with
suitable detergent. Remove salts and other contaminants by (high pressure) fresh
water cleaning. Remove rust and loose material by abrasive blasting or power tool
cleaning. Dust off residues. Touch up to full system before recoating with specified
HEMUCRYL topcoat type.
Concrete: Any oil, grease and other contaminants should be removed by eg volatilizing
by flame cleaning or treatment with suitable detergent, the latter in the following way:
1)
2)
Remove loose material eg by stiff brushes or blasting, high pressure jetting or flame
cleaning followed by fresh water hosing depending on circumstances. Three last
mentioned methods are also able to remove scum layer if necessary. After surface
preparation the surface should feel solid and hard. Remove dust. Saturate surface with
suitable sealer, eg micro dispersed acrylic type or by the HEMUCRYL topcoat diluted
15-20% with water.
Page 1 of 2
Application Instructions
Use only where application can proceed at temperatures above 5C/41F, preferably
above 10C/50F. Apply on a clean and dry surface with a temperature above the dew
point to avoid condensation.
Relative humidity: During application above 60%, preferably 75-90%, to avoid dry
spray. If RH is below 60%, special thinner may be added in order to reduce dry spray.
During drying below 80%, preferably between 40-60%. (Contact HEMPEL for further
advice). Good ventilation during application and drying is necessary. Especially during
drying it is of utmost importance that sufficient ventilation is covering all parts of the
surfaces painted. Ventilation requirements to remove water vapours liberated during
application and drying are app. 75 m/litre of the paint at 20C/68F. (Relative
humidity of the air supply 40%).
REMARKS:
Good painting practice:
"Edge effect":
The (last applied) paint layer must dry for at least 6 hours at 20C/68F - 40-60%
RH, 12 hours at 10C/50F - 40-60% RH before exposure to temperatures below
5C/41F and/or condensation/water exposure.
Avoid outdoor application in seasons with low night temperatures, frost and frost in
combination with condensation or rain.
Shelf life/storage:
Cleaning of tools:
Tools must be cleaned immediately with lukewarm soap water and/or fresh water
followed by thoroughly rinsing to remove residues of detergent.
Dried remains of paint can be removed with HEMPEL'S TOOL CLEANER 99610.
Safety:
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
Note:
Any deviations from the above of a particular HEMUCRYL will be stated in the product
data sheet for this paint.
ISSUED BY:
HEMPEL A/S
Page 2 of 2
Application Instructions
Product Data
1/1
HEMPELS ANTI-SLIP BEADS 67420 are hollow, aluminium silicate spheres (glass
pearls) of diameters between 5 and 300 micron.
Recommended use:
To obtain anti-skid properties on decks and other areas where a skid-proof surface is
required. To be mixed with the paint before application.
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colour:
Specific gravity:
Particle shape:
Off-white/greyish
0.7 kg/litre (approx.)
Spherical
Remarks:
Note:
Safety:
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
ISSUED BY:
HEMPEL A/S
Page 1 of 1
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
Product Data
HEMPELS ANTI-SLINT 67500
Description:
HEMPELS ANTI-SLINT 67500 is flame dried silica sand of which the average particle
size is approximately 0.5 millimetres.
Recommended use:
To obtain anti-skid properties on decks and other areas where a skid-proof surface is
required.
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colour:
Specific gravity:
Particle shape:
Greyish
2.7 (approx.) kg/litre
Grit
Remarks:
Being heavy and rather coarse HEMPELS ANTI-SLINT 67500 should not be stirred into
the paint before its application. For such purpose use HEMPEL'S ANTI-SLIP BEADS
67420.
HEMPELS ANTI-SLINT 67500 should be sprinkled evenly on the surface immediately
upon application of the penultimate coat of the paint system while the paint is still wet.
Consumption approximately 2.5 kg/5.5 lbs of HEMPELS ANTI-SLINT 67500 to 25
sq.m/ 270 sq.feet.
When the paint is dry, sweep up surplus grit and apply the final coat.
HEMPELS ANTI-SLINT 67500 should be kept dry and clean.
Do not mix contaminated sweepings with new supplies.
Note:
Safety:
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
ISSUED BY:
HEMPEL A/S
Page 1 of 1
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
Product Data
HEMPASIL HELIX 77000
BASE 77009 - HEMPASIL CROSSLINKER 97080
FOULING RELEASE COATING
Description:
HEMPASIL HELIX 77000 is a biocide free, two-component, high solids fouling release
coating based on silicone. HEMPASIL HELIX 77000 provides a smooth, low surface
energy, hydrophobic surface with special surface release properties whereby fouling
settlement is minimised. The coating may foul under static conditions (idle periods).
This product does not contain organotin compounds acting as biocides and complies
with the International Convention on the Control of Harmful Antifouling Systems on
Ships as adopted by IMO October 2001 (IMO document AFS/CONF/26).
Recommended use:
HEMPASIL HELIX 77000 is designed specially for application on propellers and rudders.
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colour/Shade nos.:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Dry to touch:
Fully cured:
V.O.C.:
Shelf life:
Grey/15150 - Black/19990
Glossy
71 1
4.7 m/litre - 150 micron
190 sq.ft./US gallon - 6 mils
28C/82F
1.0 kg/litre - 8.3 lbs/US gallon
3 hours at 20C/68F
7 days at 20C/68F
270 g/litre - 2.3 lbs/US gallon
1 years (25C/77F) from time of production. Depending on storage conditions,
mechanical stirring may be necessary before usage.
If the shelf life is exceeded please contact HEMPEL for further advice.
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Mixing ratio for 77000
Application method:
Thinner (max. vol.):
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Pot life:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
Use only where application can proceed at temperatures above 5C. The temperature of the
surface and that of the paint itself must also be above this limit. Apply only on a surface with a
temperature above the dew point to avoid condensation. Relative humidity of the air between min.
30% and max. 85%.
The surface should be clean and dry.
The special application properties do furthermore necessitate extra consideration as to possible
windy weather. The on-site representative from Hempel is to be consulted.
In confined spaces provide adequate ventilation during application and drying.
PRECEDING
COAT:
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
None.
REMARKS:
It is of the utmost importance that thorough protection and cleaning procedures are followed
before and after application respectively. It is advisable to apply HEMPASIL SYSTEM after all other
exterior painting is complete. This is to avoid silicone contamination of other painted surfaces.
Before application cover all surfaces surrounding the areas to be applied with plastic sheeting to
avoid overspray. After application clean all equipment very thoroughly. See below.
Application method: A well executed spray application is necessary. This paint material has special application
properties and it is recommended first to make a small-scale application to get familiar with the
properties.
Thinning:
Not recommended. In exceptional cases use THINNER 08080 (max. 5 vol%).
Recommended
One coat normally recommended.
number of coats:
Cleaning of tools:
Very thorough cleaning with THINNER 08080 is necessary.
DISPOSE OF CLEANING SOLVENTS AFTER USE. DO NOT RE-USE SOLVENTS AFTER CLEANING.
Detailed
instructions:
Will be available in connection with separate painting specifications.
Undocking:
Minimum 24 hours (20C/68F). At temperatures below 15C/59F minimum 48 hours.
Storage of cans:
Must be stored under absolutely dry conditions, protect against seeping humidity.
Note:
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPASIL 77100
BASE 77109 - HEMPASIL CROSSLINKER 97080
FOULING RELEASE COATING
Description:
HEMPASIL 77100 is a copper free, biocide free, two-component, silicone fouling release
coating with a high solids content. The product is based on silicone and cures after
addition of HEMPASIL CROSSLINKER 97080.
It provides a smooth, low surface energy, hydrophobic surface with special surface
release properties whereby fouling settlement is minimised. The surface properties
facilitate self cleaning and provide easy clean characteristics. The coating may
accumulate some fouling under static conditions (idle periods).
This product does not contain organotin compounds acting as biocides and complies
with the International Convention on the Control of Harmful Antifouling Systems on
Ships as adopted by IMO October 2001 (IMO document AFS/CONF/26).
Recommended use:
As a fouling release coating for High Speed Craft (HSC), powerful commercial and
military vessels (such as fast ferries, patrol and coast guard vessels, high speed
monohulls, wave piercers, hydrofoils etc.) with service speeds in excess of 25 knots
and with medium to high activity.
HEMPASIL 77100 will typically be used in cases where a full new F/R system is to be
applied or for recoating of existing F/R system.
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colour/Shade nos.:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Dry to touch:
Fully cured:
V.O.C.:
Shelf life:
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Mixing ratio for 77100
Application method:
Thinner (max. vol.):
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Pot life:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
HEMPASIL 77100
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
Use only where application can proceed at temperatures above 5C. The temperature of the
surface and that of the paint itself must also be above this limit. Apply only on a surface with a
temperature above the dew point to avoid condensation. Relative humidity of the air between min.
30% and max. 85%.
The surface should be clean and dry.
The special application properties do furthermore necessitate extra consideration as to possible
windy weather. The on-site representative from Hempel is to be consulted.
In confined spaces provide adequate ventilation during application and drying.
PRECEDING
COAT:
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
None.
REMARKS:
It is of the utmost importance that thorough protection and cleaning procedures are followed
before and after application respectively. It is advisable to apply HEMPASIL SYSTEM after all other
exterior painting is complete. This is to avoid silicone contamination of other painted surfaces.
Before application cover all surfaces surrounding the areas to be applied with plastic sheeting to
avoid overspray. After application clean all equipment very thoroughly. See below.
Application method: A well executed spray application is necessary. This paint material has special application
properties and it is recommended first to make a small-scale application to get familiar with the
properties.
Thinning:
Not recommended. In exceptional cases use THINNER 08080 (max. 5 vol%).
Recommended
One coat normally recommended.
number of coats:
Cleaning of tools:
Very thorough cleaning with THINNER 08080 is necessary.
DISPOSE OF CLEANING SOLVENTS AFTER USE. DO NOT RE-USE SOLVENTS AFTER CLEANING.
Detailed
instructions:
Will be available in connection with separate painting specifications.
Undocking:
Minimum 24 hours (20C/68F). At temperatures below 15C/59F minimum 48 hours.
Storage of cans:
Must be stored under absolutely dry conditions, protect against seeping humidity.
Note:
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPASIL 77500
BASE 77509 - HEMPASIL CROSSLINKER 97080
FOULING RELEASE COATING
Description:
HEMPASIL 77500 is a biocide free, two-component, silicone fouling release coating with
a high solids content. The product is based on silicone and cures after addition of
HEMPASIL CROSSLINKER 97080.
It provides a smooth, low surface energy, hydrophobic surface with special surface
release properties whereby fouling settlement is minimised. The coating may foul under
static conditions (idle periods).
This product does not contain organotin compounds acting as biocides and complies
with the International Convention on the Control of Harmful Antifouling Systems on
Ships as adopted by IMO October 2001 (IMO document AFS/CONF/26).
Recommended use:
As a fouling release coating for deep sea, high activity scheduled vessels with service
speed in the 15-30-knot range, eg container vessels, ferries, cruise liners, LNG/LPG
carriers, vehicle carriers etc.
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colour/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Dry to touch:
Fully cured:
V.O.C.:
Shelf life:
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Mixing ratio for 77500
Application method:
Thinner (max.vol.):
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Pot life:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
HEMPASIL 77500
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
Use only where application can proceed at temperatures above 5C. The temperature of the
surface and that of the paint itself must also be above this limit. Apply only on a surface with a
temperature above the dew point to avoid condensation. Relative humidity of the air between min.
30% and max. 85%.
The surface should be clean and dry.
The special application properties do furthermore necessitate extra consideration as to possible
windy weather. The on-site representative from Hempel is to be consulted.
In confined spaces provide adequate ventilation during application and drying.
PRECEDING
COAT:
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
None.
REMARKS:
It is of the utmost importance that thorough protection and cleaning procedures are followed
before and after application respectively. It is advisable to apply HEMPASIL SYSTEM after all other
exterior painting is complete. This is to avoid silicone contamination of other painted surfaces.
Before application cover all surfaces surrounding the areas to be applied with plastic sheeting to
avoid overspray. After application clean all equipment very thoroughly. See below.
Application method: A well executed spray application is necessary. This paint material has special application
properties and it is recommended first to make a small-scale application to get familiar with the
properties.
Thinning:
Not recommended. In exceptional cases use THINNER 08080 (max 5 vol%).
Recommended
One coat normally recommended.
number of coats:
Cleaning of tools:
Very thorough cleaning with THINNER 08080 is necessary.
DISPOSE OF CLEANING SOLVENTS AFTER USE. DO NOT RE-USE SOLVENTS AFTER CLEANING.
Detailed
instructions:
Will be available in connection with separate painting specifications.
Undocking:
Minimum 24 hours (20C/68F). At temperatures below 15C/59F minimum 48 hours.
Storage of cans:
Must be stored under absolutely dry conditions, protect against seeping humidity.
Note:
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPELS ANTIFOULING GLOBIC NCT 8190M
Description:
Recommended use:
As an antifouling for bottom and boottop on vessels operating in coastal trade at low to
medium speeds and low to medium activity.
Aluminium hulls: see REMARKS overleaf.
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos.:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Dry to touch:
V.O.C.:
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Application method:
Thinner (max. vol.):
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval:
Safety:
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
Existing old self-polishing or ablative antifouling: Remove possible oil and grease etc. with
suitable detergent, followed by high pressure fresh water cleaning for a thorough removal of any
possible weak structure of leached antifouling.
Allow the surface to dry before coating.
Sealer: Whether to use a sealer coat/tiecoat or not depends on the type and condition of the
existing antifouling.
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
The surface must be completely clean and dry at the time of application and its temperature
must be above the dew point to avoid condensation. In confined spaces such as sea chests and
stagnant air under large flat bottoms provide adequate ventilation during application and drying.
PRECEDING
COAT:
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
REMARKS:
This product contains heavy particles. Stir well before use. By providing a constantly active surface
during its lifetime, this antifouling is gradually sacrificed in the process.
The GLOBICs are never tinted and as the high load of cuprous oxide influences the shade a
certain variation from batch to batch is allowable. Exposure to humid weather shortly after
application is likely to cause discolouration. This is a surface phenomenon only and has no
influence on performance nor recoatability.
May be specified on aluminium hulls provided an efficient anticorrosive system in minimum 2
coats of 150 micron/6 mils each has been applied. The anticorrosive system must stay intact
during service in order to avoid corrosion of the aluminium caused by the cuprous oxide content
of GLOBIC.
Standard airless heavy-duty spray equipment:
Pump ratio:
min 45:1 (see Note below)
Pump output:
min 12 litres/minute (theoretical)
Spray hoses:
max 15 metres/50 feet, 3/8" internal diameter
max 3 metres/10 feet, 1/4" internal diameter
Note: If longer spray hoses are necessary, up to 50 metres/150 feet hose (" internal diameter)
can be added. The pump ratio must be raised to 60:1 or more, however, the high output capacity
of the pump must be maintained.
A reversible nozzle is recommended.
Filter: Surge tank filter and tip filter should be removed.
Range and control of dry film thickness: 80 micron/3.2 mils to 150 micron/6 mils. Indicated film
thickness will vary according to specification. This will alter spreading rate and may influence
drying time. In case of multi-coat application, drying time and minimum recoat interval will be
influenced by the number of coats and by the thickness of each coat applied - reference is made
to the corresponding painting specification. Keep thinning to a minimum to ensure that correct film
thickness is obtained. The proper way of governing the film thickness is to sub-divide the areas to
be painted and calculate the amount of paint to be applied on each sub-divided area. The exact
amount of paint calculated must be applied evenly on the area. For further information, please
consult the corresponding painting specification.
As per specification depending on existing hull condition, trading pattern, and intended service life.
No maximum recoat interval, but after prolonged exposure to polluted atmosphere, remove
accumulated contamination by high pressure fresh water cleaning and allow to dry before applying
next coat. As for other physically drying paints the final hardness will be obtained a few days after
application of the last coat. Precautions must be made taking this into account during e.g. out
docking.
Minimum undocking time depends on number of coats applied, film thickness, the prevailing
temperature and the subsequent exposure/service conditions. For further information, please
consult the corresponding painting specification. Maximum undocking time depends on the
atmospheric conditions (UV radiation, temperature, degree of atmospheric pollution, etc.).
Exposure to the atmosphere in up to 6 months normally presents no problems but extraordinary
contamination may call for a freshwater high pressure hosing - contact Hempel.
Colour:
Aluminium hulls:
Application
equipment:
Film thicknesses:
Recommended
number of coats:
Undocking:
Note:
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPELS ANTIFOULING GLOBIC NCT 8190N
Description:
Recommended use:
As an antifouling for bottom and boottop on vessels operating in coastal trade at low to
medium speeds and low to medium activity.
HEMPELS ANTIFOULING GLOBIC NCT 8190N is especially developed for new-buildings.
Aluminium hulls: see REMARKS overleaf.
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos.:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Dry to touch:
V.O.C.:
Red/58000 - Brown/62900
Flat
55 1
5.5 m/litre - 100 micron
221 sq.ft./US gallon - 4 mils
27C/81F
1.9 kg/litre - 15.9 lbs/US gallon
4-5 hours at 20C/68F
410 g/litre - 3.4 lbs/US gallon
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Application method:
Thinner (max. vol.):
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval:
Safety:
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
The surface must be completely clean and dry at the time of application and its temperature
must be above the dew point to avoid condensation. In confined spaces such as sea chests and
stagnant air under large flat bottoms provide adequate ventilation during application and drying.
PRECEDING
COAT:
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
REMARKS:
This product contains heavy particles. Stir well before use. By providing a constantly active surface
during its lifetime, this antifouling is gradually sacrificed in the process.
The GLOBICs are never tinted and as the high load of cuprous oxide influences the shade a
certain variation from batch to batch is allowable. Exposure to humid weather shortly after
application is likely to cause discolouration. This is a surface phenomenon only and has no
influence on performance nor recoatability.
May be specified on aluminium hulls provided an efficient anticorrosive system in minimum 2
coats of 150 micron/6 mils each has been applied. The anticorrosive system must stay intact
during service in order to avoid corrosion of the aluminium caused by the cuprous oxide content
of GLOBIC.
Standard airless heavy-duty spray equipment:
Pump ratio:
min 45:1 (see Note below)
Pump output:
min 12 litres/minute (theoretical)
Spray hoses:
max 15 metres/50 feet, 3/8" internal diameter
max 3 metres/10 feet, 1/4" internal diameter
Note: If longer spray hoses are necessary, up to 50 metres/150 feet hose (" internal diameter)
can be added. The pump ratio must be raised to 60:1 or more, however, the high output capacity
of the pump must be maintained.
A reversible nozzle is recommended.
Filter: Surge tank filter and tip filter should be removed.
Range and control of dry film thickness: 80 micron/3.2 mils to 150 micron/6 mils. Indicated film
thickness will vary according to specification. This will alter spreading rate and may influence
drying time. In case of multi-coat application, drying time and minimum recoat interval will be
influenced by the number of coats and by the thickness of each coat applied - reference is made
to the corresponding painting specification. Keep thinning to a minimum to ensure that correct film
thickness is obtained. The proper way of governing the film thickness is to sub-divide the areas to
be painted and calculate the amount of paint to be applied on each sub-divided area. The exact
amount of paint calculated must be applied evenly on the area. For further information, please
consult the corresponding painting specification.
As per specification depending on existing hull condition, trading pattern and intended service life.
No maximum recoat interval, but after prolonged exposure to polluted atmosphere, remove
accumulated contamination by high pressure fresh water cleaning and allow to dry before applying
next coat. As for other physically drying paints the final hardness will be obtained a few days after
application of the last coat. Precautions must be made taking this into account during e.g. out
docking.
Minimum undocking time depends on number of coats applied, film thickness, the prevailing
temperature and the subsequent exposure/service conditions. For further information, please
consult the corresponding painting specification. Maximum undocking time depends on the
atmospheric conditions (UV radiation, temperature, degree of atmospheric pollution, etc.).
Exposure to the atmosphere in up to 6 months normally presents no problems but extraordinary
contamination may call for a freshwater high pressure hosing - contact Hempel.
Colour:
Aluminium hulls:
Application
equipment:
Film thicknesses:
Recommended
number of coats:
Undocking:
Note:
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPELS ANTIFOULING GLOBIC NCT 8195M
Description:
Recommended use:
As an antifouling for bottom and boottop on vessels operating in deep sea trade at
medium to high speed and high activity with short idle periods.
Aluminium hulls: see REMARKS overleaf.
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Dry to touch:
V.O.C.:
Brown/62900 - Red/58000
Flat
52 1
5.2 m/litre - 100 micron
209 sq.ft./US gallon - 4 mils
27C/81F
1.8 kg/litre - 15.0 lbs/US gallon
4-5 hours at 20C/68F
450 g/litre - 3.8 lbs/US gallon
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Application method:
Thinner (max. vol.):
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval:
Safety:
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
Existing old self-polishing or ablative antifouling: Remove possible oil and grease etc. with
suitable detergent, followed by high pressure fresh water cleaning for a thorough removal of any
possible weak structure of leached antifouling.
Allow the surface to dry before coating.
Sealer: Whether to use a sealer coat/tie-coat or not depends on the type and condition of the
existing antifouling.
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
The surface must be completely clean and dry at the time of application and its temperature must
be above the dew point to avoid condensation. In confined spaces such as sea chests and
stagnant air under large flat bottoms provide adequate ventilation during application and drying.
PRECEDING
COAT:
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
REMARKS:
This product contains heavy particles. Stir well before use. By providing a constantly active surface
during its lifetime, this antifouling is gradually sacrificed in the process.
The GLOBICs are never tinted and as the high load of cuprous oxide influences the shade a
certain variation from batch to batch is allowable. Exposure to humid weather shortly after
application may cause discolouration. This is a surface phenomenon only and has no influence on
performance nor recoatability.
May be specified on aluminium hulls provided an efficient anticorrosive system in minimum 2
coats of 150 micron/6 mils each has been applied. The anticorrosive system must stay intact
during service in order to avoid corrosion of the aluminium caused by the cuprous oxide content
of GLOBIC.
Standard airless heavy-duty spray equipment:
Pump ratio:
min 45:1 (see Note below)
Pump output:
min 12 litres/minute (theoretical)
Spray hoses:
max 15 metres/50 feet, 3/8" internal diameter
max 3 metres/10 feet, 1/4" internal diameter
Note: If longer spray hoses are necessary, up to 50 metres/150 feet hose (" internal diameter)
can be added. The pump ratio must be raised to 60:1 or more, however, the high output capacity
of the pump must be maintained.
A reversible nozzle is recommended.
Filter: Surge tank filter and tip filter should be removed.
Range and control of dry film thickness: 80 micron/3.2 mils to 150 micron/6 mils. Indicated film
thickness will vary according to specification. This will alter spreading rate and may influence
drying time. In case of multi-coat application, drying time and minimum recoat interval will be
influenced by the number of coats and by the thickness of each coat applied - reference is made
to the corresponding painting specification. Keep thinning to a minimum to ensure that correct film
thickness is obtained. The proper way of governing the film thickness is to sub-divide the areas to
be painted and calculate the amount of paint to be applied on each sub-divided area. The exact
amount of paint calculated must be applied evenly on the area. For further information, please
consult the corresponding painting specification.
As per specification depending on existing hull condition, trading pattern, and intended service life.
No maximum recoat interval, but after prolonged exposure to polluted atmosphere, remove
accumulated contamination by high pressure fresh water cleaning and allow to dry before applying
next coat. As for other physically drying paints the final hardness will be obtained a few days after
application of the last coat. Precautions must be made taking this into account during e.g. out
docking.
Minimum undocking time depends on number of coats applied, film thickness, the prevailing
temperature and the subsequent exposure/service conditions. For further information, please
consult the corresponding painting specification. Maximum undocking time depends on the
atmospheric conditions (UV radiation, temperature, degree of atmospheric pollution, etc.).
Exposure to the atmosphere in up to 6 months normally presents no problems but extraordinary
contamination may call for a freshwater high pressure hosing - contact Hempel.
Colour:
Aluminium hulls:
Application
equipment:
Film thicknesses:
Recommended
number of coats:
Undocking:
Note:
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPELS ANTIFOULING GLOBIC NCT 8195N
Description:
Recommended use:
As an antifouling for bottom and boottop on vessels operating in deep sea trade at
medium to high speed and high activity with short idle periods.
HEMPELS ANTIFOULING GLOBIC NCT 8195N is especially developed for new-buildings.
Aluminium hulls: see REMARKS overleaf.
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Dry to touch:
V.O.C.:
Brown/62900 - Red/58000
Flat
55 1
5.5 m/litre - 100 micron
221 sq.ft./US gallon - 4 mils
27C/81F
1.9 kg/litre - 15.8 lbs/US gallon
4-5 hours at 20C/68F
410 g/litre - 3.4 lbs/US gallon
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Application method:
Thinner (max. vol.):
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval:
Safety:
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
The surface must be completely clean and dry at the time of application and its temperature must
be above the dew point to avoid condensation. In confined spaces such as sea chests and
stagnant air under large flat bottoms provide adequate ventilation during application and drying.
PRECEDING
COAT:
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
REMARKS:
This product contains heavy particles. Stir well before use. By providing a constantly active surface
during its lifetime, this antifouling is gradually sacrificed in the process.
The GLOBICs are never tinted and as the high load of cuprous oxide influences the shade a
certain variation from batch to batch is allowable. Exposure to humid weather shortly after
application may cause discolouration. This is a surface phenomenon only and has no influence on
performance nor recoatability.
May be specified on aluminium hulls provided an efficient anticorrosive system in minimum 2
coats of 150 micron/6 mils each has been applied. The anticorrosive system must stay intact
during service in order to avoid corrosion of the aluminium caused by the cuprous oxide content
of GLOBIC.
Standard airless heavy-duty spray equipment:
Pump ratio:
min 45:1 (see Note below)
Pump output:
min 12 litres/minute (theoretical)
Spray hoses:
max 15 metres/50 feet, 3/8" internal diameter
max 3 metres/10 feet, 1/4" internal diameter
Note: If longer spray hoses are necessary, up to 50 metres/150 feet hose (" internal diameter)
can be added. The pump ratio must be raised to 60:1 or more, however, the high output capacity
of the pump must be maintained.
A reversible nozzle is recommended.
Filter: Surge tank filter and tip filter should be removed.
Range and control of dry film thickness: 80 micron/3.2 mils to 150 micron/6 mils. Indicated film
thickness will vary according to specification. This will alter spreading rate and may influence
drying time. In case of multi-coat application, drying time and minimum recoat interval will be
influenced by the number of coats and by the thickness of each coat applied - reference is made
to the corresponding painting specification. Keep thinning to a minimum to ensure that correct film
thickness is obtained. The proper way of governing the film thickness is to sub-divide the areas to
be painted and calculate the amount of paint to be applied on each sub-divided area. The exact
amount of paint calculated must be applied evenly on the area. For further information, please
consult the corresponding painting specification.
As per specification depending on existing hull condition, trading pattern, and intended service life.
No maximum recoat interval, but after prolonged exposure to polluted atmosphere, remove
accumulated contamination by high pressure fresh water cleaning and allow to dry before applying
next coat. As for other physically drying paints the final hardness will be obtained a few days after
application of the last coat. Precautions must be made taking this into account during e.g. out
docking.
Minimum undocking time depends on number of coats applied, film thickness, the prevailing
temperature and the subsequent exposure/service conditions. For further information, please
consult the corresponding painting specification. Maximum undocking time depends on the
atmospheric conditions (UV radiation, temperature, degree of atmospheric pollution, etc.).
Exposure to the atmosphere in up to 6 months normally presents no problems but extraordinary
contamination may call for a freshwater high pressure hosing - contact Hempel.
Colour:
Aluminium hulls:
Application
equipment:
Film thicknesses:
Recommended
number of coats:
Undocking:
Note:
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPELS ANTIFOULING GLOBIC SAP 81970
Description:
HEMPELS ANTIFOULING GLOBIC SAP 81970 is a high solid, self-smoothening and selfpolishing antifouling. Polishing is based on an ion exchange, resulting in a hydrolysable
activated layer. An inorganic fibre reinforcement of the silylated acrylate copolymer
ensures effective polishing control and mechanical strength. A powerful bioactive
mixture and its self-renewing effect makes it suitable for protection on deep-sea
vessels. The system provides a certain control of roughness.
This product does not contain organotin compounds acting as biocides and complies
with the International Convention on the Control of Harmful Antifouling Systems on
Ships as adopted by IMO October 2001 (IMO document AFS/CONF/26).
Recommended use:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Dry to touch:
V.O.C.:
Shelf life:
Brown/60600 - Red/51110
Flat
57 1
5.7 m/litre - 100 micron
229 sq.ft./US gallon - 4 mils
24C/75F
1.9 kg/litre - 15.9 lbs/US gallon
2 hours at 20C/68F
415 g/litre - 3.5 lbs/US gallon
2 years (25C/77F) from time of production. Depending on storage conditions,
mechanical stirring may be necessary before usage.
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Application method:
Thinner (max. vol.):
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval:
Safety:
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
Redocking:
Aluminium hulls:
Application
equipment:
Film thicknesses:
Recommended
number of coats:
Undocking:
This product contains heavy particles. Stir well before use. By providing a constantly active surface
during its lifetime, this antifouling is gradually sacrificed in the process.
The GLOBICs are never tinted and as the high load of cuprous oxide influences the shade a
certain variation from batch to batch is allowable. Exposure to humid weather shortly after
application is likely to cause discolouration. This is a surface phenomenon only and has no
influence on performance nor recoatability.
At redocking, HEMPEL'S ANTIFOULING GLOBIC SAP 81970 can be recoated after thorough
cleaning and removal of any poorly adhering surface layer on the antifouling.
Reference is made to SURFACE PREPARATION above. If recoated with other types of antifouling,
other surface preparation methods may be required - contact HEMPEL.
May be specified on aluminium hulls provided an efficient anticorrosive system in minimum 2
coats of 150 micron/6 mils each has been applied. The anticorrosive system must stay intact
during service in order to avoid corrosion of the aluminium caused by the cuprous oxide content
of GLOBIC.
Standard airless heavy-duty spray equipment:
Pump ratio:
min 45:1 (see Note below)
Pump output:
min 12 litres/minute (theoretical)
Spray hoses:
max 15 metres/50 feet, 3/8" internal diameter
max 3 metres/10 feet, 1/4" internal diameter
Note: If longer spray hoses are necessary, up to 50 metres/150 feet hose (" internal diameter)
can be added. The pump ratio must be raised to 60:1 or more, however, the high output capacity
of the pump must be maintained.
A reversible nozzle is recommended.
Filter: Surge tank filter and tip filter should be removed.
Range and control of dry film thickness: 80 micron/3.2 mils to 150 micron/6 mils. Indicated film
thickness will vary according to specification. This will alter spreading rate and may influence
drying time. In case of multi-coat application, drying time and minimum recoat interval will be
influenced by the number of coats and by the thickness of each coat applied - reference is made
to the corresponding painting specification. Keep thinning to a minimum to ensure that correct film
thickness is obtained. The proper way of governing the film thickness is to sub-divide the areas to
be painted and calculate the amount of paint to be applied on each sub-divided area. The exact
amount of paint calculated must be applied evenly on the area. For further information, please
consult the corresponding painting specification.
As per specification depending on existing hull condition, trading pattern, and intended service
life.
No maximum recoat interval, but after prolonged exposure to polluted atmosphere, remove
accumulated contamination by high pressure fresh water cleaning and allow to dry before applying
next coat. As for other physically drying paints the final hardness will be obtained a few days after
application of the last coat. Precautions must be made taking this into account during e.g. out
docking.
Minimum undocking time depends on number of coats applied, film thickness, the prevailing
temperature and the subsequent exposure/service conditions. For further information, please
consult the corresponding painting specification. Maximum undocking time depends on the
atmospheric conditions (UV radiation, temperature, degree of atmospheric pollution, etc.).
Exposure to the atmosphere in up to 6 months normally presents no problems but extraordinary
contamination may call for a freshwater high pressure hosing - contact Hempel.
Note:
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPELS ANTIFOULING OCEANIC 8490K
Description:
HEMPELS ANTIFOULING OCEANIC 8490K is a high solids, self-smoothening and selfpolishing antifouling. Polishing is based on an ion exchange, resulting in a hydrolysable
activated layer. An inorganic fibre reinforcement of the resin matrix ensures effective
polishing control and mechanical strength. A powerful bioactive mixture and its selfrenewing effect makes it suitable for protection on vessels trading in coastal waters.
The system provides a certain control of roughness.
This product does not contain organotin compounds acting as biocides and complies
with the International Convention on the Control of Harmful Antifouling Systems on
Ships as adopted by IMO October 2001 (IMO document AFS/CONF/26).
Recommended use:
As an cost effective antifouling for bottom and boottop on vessels operating in coastal
trade at low to medium speeds and low to medium activity and with dry-docking interval
of up to 36 months on vertical sides and up to 60 months on flat bottom.
Aluminium hulls: see REMARKS overleaf.
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Dry to touch:
V.O.C.:
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Application method:
Thinner (max. vol.):
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval:
Safety:
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPELS ANTIFOULING OCEANIC 8495K
Description:
Recommended use:
As an cost effective tin-free antifouling for bottom and boottop on deep-sea going
vessels operating at medium to high speed and high activity with short idle periods, and
with dry-docking interval of up to 36 months on vertical sides and up to 60 months on
flat bottom.
Aluminium hulls: see REMARKS overleaf.
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Dry to touch:
V.O.C.:
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Application method:
Thinner (max. vol.):
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval:
Safety:
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
1/2
Description:
Recommended use:
As a one-coat system for internal coating of gas pipes designed for carrying of dry,
sweet gas. The coating is designed to reduce the drag resistance in the pipeline by
making the pipewalls smoother.
Service temperatures:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Surface dry:
Dry to touch:
Fully cured:
V.O.C.:
Reddish brown/50890
Semi-gloss
42 1
7.0 m/litre - 60 micron
281 sq.ft./US gallon - 2.4 mils
30C/86F
1.1 kg/litre
9.2 lbs/US gallon
3/4 (approx.) hour at 20C/68F (ISO 1517)
5-6 hours at 20C/68F
7 days at 20C/68F
530 g/litre - 4.4 lbs/US gallon
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Mixing ratio for 85442:
Application method:
Thinner (max.vol.):
Pot life:
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
2/2
Remove oil and grease thoroughly with suitable detergent. Remove salt and other contaminants
by high pressure fresh water cleaning.
Abrasive blasting to Sa 2 , SSPC-SP-10 with a surface profile corresponding to Rugotest No. 3,
BN9a, Keane-Tator Comparator, 2.0 G/S or ISO Comparator, FINE (G).
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
The surface must be completely dry and clean with a temperature above the dew point to avoid
condensation. The minimum temperature and the temperature of the paint itself should be above
10C/50F. The best result is obtained at 15-25C/59-77F. Maximum steel temperature approx.
45C/113F. Relative humidity max. 85%. In confined spaces provide adequate ventilation.
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
REMARKS:
Recoating:
Recoating will normally not apply. In exceptional cases in connection with touch-up of too low dry
film thickness, recoating is acceptable provided sufficient ventilation has been provided during
drying.
Minimum recoat interval is 8 hours at 20C/68F. No maximum recoating interval for the
intended use of HEMPEL'S GAS PIPE COATING 85442 but the surface must be completely clean
and dry.
Note:
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPADUR 85531
BASE 85539 with CURING AGENT 97531
Description:
Recommended use:
Service temperatures:
Maximum:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos.:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Surface dry:
Dry to touch:
Fully cured:
V.O.C.:
Red/50890
Glossy
84 1
2.4 m/litre - 350 microns
96 sq.ft./US gallon - 14 mils
14C/57F
1.7 kg/litre - 14.2 lbs/US gallon
2 hours at 20C/68F
6 hours at 20C/68F
7 days at 20C/68F
170 g/litre - 1.4 lbs/US gallon
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Mixing ratio for 85531:
Application method:
Thinner (max.vol.):
Pot life:
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
HEMPADUR 85531
SURFACE
PREPARATION:
Abrasive blasting to Sa 2, (ISO 8501-1:2007), with a surface profile equivalent to Rugotest No.
3 BN 10, Keane-Tator Comparator 3.0 G/S or ISO Comparator, rough Medium (G).
Remove any oil, grease and other contaminants by detergent and salts by high fresh water hosing
prior to abrasive blasting.
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
The surface must be completely dry and clean with a temperature above the dew point to avoid
condensation. Use only when application and curing can proceed at temperatures above
5C/41F. The temperature of the paint itself should be above 15C/59F. The best result is
obtained at 20-30C/68-86F.
In confined spaces, provide adequate ventilation. In pipelines blow hot dry air through the pipeline
immediately after application to remove solvent fumes and speed up drying process.
PRECEDING
COAT:
None.
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
REMARKS:
Recoating:
The indicated recoat intervals will normally only apply in connection with touch-up of too low dry
film thicknesses.
If the maximum recoat interval is exceeded, roughening of the surface is necessary to ensure
adhesion.
Note:
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPADUR 85671
BASE 85675 with CURING AGENT 97371
Description:
Recommended use:
As an interior lining in tanks, pipelines etc. for hot water, brine, crude oil, etc.
For coating of potable water tanks.
As a primer coat in specific painting systems.
Service temperatures:
Certificates/Approvals:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Surface dry:
Dry to touch:
Fully cured:
V.O.C.:
Shelf life:
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Mixing ratio for 85671:
Application method:
Thinner (max.vol.):
Pot life:
Induction time:
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
HEMPADUR 85671
SURFACE
PREPARATION:
For optimum performance abrasive blasting to very near white metal Sa 2-3, with a surface
profile corresponding to Rugotest No. 3, BN10, Keane-Tator Comparator 3.0 G/S, or ISO
Comparator Rough Medium (G).
APPLICATION
Use only where application and curing can proceed at temperatures above 10C/50F. The
CONDITIONS:
temperature of the paint itself must be above 15C/59F, best results are obtained at 1723C/62-73F. Relative humidity max. 80%, preferably 40-60%. Apply on a dry and clean surface
with a temperature above the dew point to avoid condensation. Furthermore, reference is made to
special APPLICATION INSTRUCTIONS.
Provide adequate ventilation during application and drying in confined spaces.
PRECEDING COAT: None.
SUBSEQUENT COAT: None.
REMARKS:
High temperature
May be used under insulation, pipes and the like in one or two-coat systems. Dry film thicknesses
service:
should not exceed 300 micron/12 mils. However, at temperatures above 200C/392F, max
260C/500F, it is recommended to apply max 125 micron/5 mils.
The coating should be cured for at least 7 days at 20C/68F before exposure to high
temperatures. The coating will discolour at high service temperatures.
Film thicknesses:
The minimum total dry film thickness for the system is normally 300 microns/12 mils. May be
specified in other film thicknesses than indicated depending on purpose and area of use. This will
alter spreading rate, influence drying time and minimum recoating intervals. The specification may
read up to 125 micron/5 mils dry film thickness per coat, exceptionally 150 micron/6 mils.
Pot life:
As per Aramco's requirements, gel time is above 8 hours at a can temperature of 23C/73F and
above 2 hours at a can temperature of 40C/164F. For optimum spray application properties, the
mixture should be used within 2 hours at 20C/68F.
Recoating
Minimum:
intervals:
Non-potable water service: 36 hours (20C/68F) between the first and second coat, 24 hours
(20C/68F) between the second and third coat.
Potable water service: 3 days (20C/68F) between coats.
The approval from Folkehelseinstituttet, Norway will apply provided a minimum recoat interval of 6
days (20C/68F).
Maximum: 21 days (20C/68F).
If the maximum recoating interval is exceeded, roughening of the surface is necessary to ensure
intercoat adhesion.
The coating is to be applied in a dry film thickness as near as possible to the specified 100
Notes to
application and
micron/4 mils (or higher if specified).
recoating:
Film formation of each coat has to be of good quality, free from defects such as pinholes and
without any dry spray.
Drying and curing conditions have to be according to APPLICATION CONDITIONS until full
curing has been obtained.
No kind of surface contamination must exist except loose dust, abrasives, loose dry-spray,
which is possible to remove by vacuum cleaning before overcoating.
The surface MUST be completely clean before overcoating.
The coating must only be (exceptionally) exposed to strong, direct sunlight (ultraviolet light) in
short periods.
The coating is to be checked carefully and should have no patchy, whitish, and/or greasy
formation, which can hinder adhesion of the subsequent coat.
Note: Exudation of the curing agent causes the mentioned patchy, whitish, and/or greasy
formation, which will take place if HEMPADUR 85671 is applied at low temperatures without
proper induction time and/or if the coating is exposed to water (rain, condensation) during drying
and curing.
Mixing:
The thoroughly mixed BASE and CURING AGENT must be prereacted before application (15
minutes at 20C/68F). Keep thinning at an absolute minimum. Do not dilute the components
separately - only the mixture.
Disclaimer:
Any reference to a company standard or specification in this Technical Product Data sheet shall
not be construed as a recommendation by that company to purchase.
Note:
HEMPADUR 85671 is for professional use only.
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Application
Application Instructions
Instructions
For product description refer to product data sheet
HEMPADUR 85671
BASE 85675 with CURING AGENT 97371
Scope:
Steel work:
Surface preparation:
Prior to abrasive blast cleaning of the steel, remove oil, grease, salts and other
contamination with a suitable detergent followed by high pressure fresh water hosing.
Alkali deposits on new welding seams as well as soap traces from pressure testing of
tanks to be removed by fresh water and scrubbing with stiff brushes.
Control for absence of contamination according to separate guidelines.
On repair jobs, a rough blasting to remove all loosely adhering materials may be
required before degreasing/washing is carried out.
Old steel: Even after a very thorough cleaning, pits may typically contain contamination
in the form of remnants of chemicals/water soluble salts. For this reason, repeated
detergent washing plus abrasive blasting may be necessary. After the first blasting, a
very thorough vacuum cleaning is carried out in order to see if any "chemical bleeding"
occurs as well as controls for water soluble salts (reference is made to separate
instructions) are made. Special care should be taken in evaluating pitted areas - ask for
special guidelines.
For optimum performance, gritblast to very near white metal, Sa 2-3, ISO 85011:2007. In practice this requirement is to be understood as white metal Sa 3 at the
moment of abrasive blasting, but allows a slight reduction at the moment of paint
application.
The resulting surface profile must be equivalent to Rugotest No. 3, min. BN 10, KeaneTator Surface Comparator, G/S min. 3.0 or ISO 8503/1 rough MEDIUM (G).
Use steel grit, aluminium silicate, or similar sharp edged abrasives of a good quality
free of foreign matters, soft particles, and the like. Control for absence of
contamination according to separate guidelines.
Page 1 of 7
HEMPEL
HEMPEL
Application
Instructions
Application Instructions
HEMPADUR 85671
In case steel grit is used this must furthermore be controlled so that a proper grain size
distribution is maintained.
Steel grit with particle sizes of 0.2-1.2 mm or aluminium silicate of 0.4-1.8 mm will
usually create the desired surface profile when the air pressure measured at the nozzle
is 6-7 bar/85 -100 psi.
The compressed air must be dry and clean. The compressor must be fitted with suitable
oil and water traps.
When the abrasive blasting is completed, remove residual grit and dust by vacuum
cleaning. Abrasive particles not removed by vacuum cleaning are to be removed by
brushing with clean brushes followed by vacuum cleaning.
The importance of systematic working must be stressed when blasting. Poorly blasted
areas covered with dust are very difficult to locate during the blast inspection made
after the rough cleaning.
Shopprimed and previously painted surfaces: All shopprimer or existing coating
materials to be completely removed. Avoid the use of zinc shopprimer whenever
possible.
However, if the steel is shopprimed with zinc, it is very important that all zinc is
removed by abrasive blast cleaning. Separate check procedures will be necessary to
demonstrate the effectiveness of removal. More blast cleaning may be deemed
necessary! Use of a red zinc shopprimer will facilitate the visual check of the blast
cleaning and is considered necessary in order to obtain an acceptable surface
preparation.
Note: Degree of steelwork finish and surface preparation are more detailed described
in HEMPELs Technical Standard for Tank Coating Work.
Application equipment:
Min. 45:1
.018"-.021"
200 bar (2900 psi)
To avoid excessive loss of pressure in long hoses, hoses with an
internal diameter of up to 0.5" can be used
If required: max. 10% of THINNER 08450. Additional thinning may be required at higher
temperatures to counteract dry-spray. However, never use more thinner than required to
avoid possible risk of solvent entrapment. Thinner only to be added to the mixed paint.
Spraying properties are influenced by the induction time (premix time). Too much
"thixotropy" will disappear after a certain reaction of the mixed components.
Cleaning of equipment:
The whole equipment to be cleaned thoroughly with HEMPELS TOOL CLEANER 99610
after use.
a.
Mix the entire content of corresponding base and curing agent packings. If it is
necessary to mix smaller portions, this must only be done by weighing base and
curing agent in the prescribed weight ratio: 158 parts by weight of base and 11.4
parts by weight of curing agent or by volume 8.8 parts by volume base and 1.2
parts by volume curing agent.
b.
Stir the mixed paint thoroughly by means of a clean mechanical mixer until a
homogeneous mixture is obtained.
Page 2 of 7
Application Instructions
HEMPADUR 85671
c.
Allow the mixed paint to prereact before application, see table below.
d.
Use all mixed paint before the pot life is exceeded. The pot life depends on the
paints temperature as shown in table below (valid for a 20 litres can):
20C/68F
25C/77F
(30C/86F2))
(25 minutes)
15 minutes
10 minutes
(5 minutes)
Induction time
(1 hours)
2 hours
3 hours
(4 hours)
Spray application within
1)
Below 15C/59F the viscosity can be too high for airless spray application.
2)
Temperatures at 30C/86F and above should be avoided due to a risk of dry-spray.
Application procedure:
The first full coat is usually applied immediately after vacuum cleaning.
First stripe coat to follow afterwards.
Film-build/continuity: With this tank coating intended for aggressive service, it is of
special importance that a continuous, pinhole-free paint film is obtained at application
of each coat. An application technique which will ensure good film formation and no dryspray on all surfaces must be adopted.
It is very important to use nozzles of the correct size, ie not too big. Select small
nozzles for spray application of complicated structures, while bigger nozzles may be
used for regular surfaces.
A proper, uniform distance of the spray gun to the surface, 30-50 cm, should be aimed
at. To obtain good and steady atomizing, the viscosity of the paint must be suitable and
the spray equipment must be sufficient in output pressure and capacity. At high working
temperatures, use of extra thinner may be necessary to avoid dry-spray.
The paint layer must be applied homogenously and as close to the specification as
possible. The consumption of paint must be controlled and heavy layers must be
avoided because of the risk of sags and cracks and solvent retention.
Furthermore, great care must be taken to cover edges, openings, rear sides of
stiffeners etc. Thus, on these areas a stripe coat will usually be necessary.
The finished coating must appear as a homogeneous film with a smooth surface and
irregularities such as dust, dry spray, abrasives, must be remedied.
Note: In case of old, pit corroded steel; application of a diluted, extra first coat is
recommended to obtain better "penetration" in the fine pits. For this purpose, it is
relevant to dilute 5-10%. Application by brush is recommended and film thickness so
low that the surface is "saturated" only.
Stripe coating:
All places difficult to cover properly by spray application should be stripe coated twice
by brushing immediately before the spray application. First stripe coat is applied after
the first full coat and second stripe coat after second full coat.
The second stripe coat with brush can be replaced with spray application with a small
narrow nozzle, but still air slots and similar and possible undercuts (welds) and the like
will require brush application.
Film thicknesses:
The final dry film thickness of the three coat system must be between 300-600 micron
(max. 450 micron below 15C)/12-24 mils (max. 18 mils below 59F).
Corresponding to 100 micron/4 mils dry film thickness, the wet film thickness must be
150-175 micron/6-7 mils and must be measured regularly.
Normally up to 200 micron/8 mils per coat may be accepted for 100 micron/4 mils
specifications, but at temperatures below 15C/59F, it is important not to exceed a
dry film thickness of 150 micron/6 mils in any area.
Page 3 of 7
Application Instructions
HEMPADUR 85671
Microclimate:
The actual climate conditions at the substrate during application:
The minimum surface temperature until full cure is 10C/50F.
To ensure an all-over steel temperature of minimum 10C/50F, special attention
should be paid to possible "cold bridges" eg stiffeners on deck.
In case of steel temperatures lower than 10C/50F there is a severe risk of
incomplete curing, resulting in a too open film with reduced chemical resistance.
When the outside temperature is lower than 10C/50F, it is therefore recommended to
use insulation mats on deck and in addition to aim at a general steel temperature of
15C/59F to minimise the risk of too low steel temperatures.
Furthermore, the steel temperature should be kept reasonably constant - within the
range of 3C/5F is recommended. Any changes of the outside temperature should
therefore be carefully monitored and heating equipment calibrated accordingly.
The maximum surface temperature should preferably be below approximately
30C/86F. In a warm climate it is recommended to carry out application during night
time. Application at higher temperatures is possible, but extra care must be taken to
avoid poor film formation and excessive spray-dust.
The steel temperature must be above the dew point. As a rule of thumb a steel
temperature which is 3C/5F above the dew point can be considered safe.
The relative humidity should preferably be 40-60%, maximum 80%. In confined spaces,
supply an adequate amount of fresh air during application and drying to assist the
evaporation of solvent.
Drying and curing,
ventilation:
In a dry film thickness of 100 micron/4 mils, with a steel temperature of 20C/68F, a
relative air humidity of maximum 80% and adequate ventilation, HEMPADUR 85671 will
be dry to touch after 4-6 hours. Under these drying conditions, the paint film will accept
light traffic after approximately 16 hours.
Correct film formation depends on an adequate ventilation during drying.
A good guideline for tank coating work is to ventilate to a calculated 10% of LEL during
application and until the coating is dry.
One litre undiluted HEMPADUR 85671 gives off in total 81 litres solvent vapour until it
is completely dry.
The lower explosive limit, LEL, is 1.0%.
To reach a common safety requirement of 10% LEL, the theoretical ventilation
requirement is 81 m per litre paint.
Because solvent vapours are heavier than atmospheric air, effective ventilation requires
forced ventilation with exhaust from the lowest part of the tank.
During the following period until full curing a few air shifts per hour will suffice. Take
actions to avoid "pockets" of stagnant air.
Please contact HEMPEL for further advice.
Actual safety precautions may require stronger ventilation.
Curing time:
Page 4 of 7
14 days
10 days
8 days
7 days
6 days
4 days
Application Instructions
HEMPADUR 85671
Post curing:
The chemical resistance of the coating can be extended by post curing, which must
take place within the first year in service.
Post curing is accomplished by carrying a hot cargo of mineral lube oil, vegetable oil or
animal oil at minimum 50C/122F. The curing time is 8 days at 50C/122F and 4
days at 60C/140F.
Post curing of double-hull tankers may also be accomplished by using tank cleaning
machines to spray hot, clean fresh water to achieve a minimum steel temperature of
60C/140F and maximum 80C/176F. The curing time is 16 hours at 60C/140F
and 3 hours at 80C/176F. All adjacent ballast tanks must be empty and all
adjacent cargo tanks must be either empty or carrying a liquid cargo of minimum
40C/104F.
Contact HEMPEL for detailed advice about post curing.
Recoating intervals:
Provided observance of the above stated ventilation and relative humidity for the
following recoating intervals in relation to the (steel) temperature are valid:
Steel temperature
Minimum,
non-potable water service
10C/50F* 15C/59F
20C/68F
25C/77F
30C/86F
35C/95F
90 hours
60 hours
36 hours
24 hours
18 hours
14 hours
60 hours
40 hours
24 hours
16 hours
12 hours
9 hours
7 days
5 days
3 days
2 days
36 hours
30 hours
11 days
14 days
16 days
21 days
34 days
47 days
Maximum
* Absolute minimum temperature recommended.
** The approval from Folkehelseinstituttet, Norway will apply provided a minimum recoat interval of 6 days
(20C/68F).
The maximum relative humidity before and between the coats should not exceed 80%
and the steel temperature should always be above the dew point, in practice minimum
3C/5F above the dew point.
Conditions for
paint application work:
Dry spray is not acceptable as this will reduce the protective characteristics of the
paint and make later tank cleaning difficult. Dry spray can be avoided by using adequate
stagings, spraying equipment and methods.
Hold spray gun at a right angle to and about 30 cm/1 foot from surface making even
parallel passes at a rate to produce the specified wet film thickness as per
specification.
Avoid dry spray (overspray creating excessive paint mist), e.g. by using a smaller fan
angle, and the lowest possible pressure. A small fan angle should also be used, if
spray application is used, for "stripe coating" of for instance reverse sides of stiffeners.
Each layer must be applied homogeneously, must be free from pinholes and other
defects and as near above the specification of 100 micron/4 mils dry film thickness, as
possible. The consumption of paint must be controlled, and heavy layers must be
avoided because of the risk of saggings, cracks and solvent retention.
Surface irregularities such as dry spray, saggings, exaggerated thickness or embedded
dust or abrasives will have to be remedied.
If a sandpapering between layers, for instance on the bottom, is needed, great care
must be taken to avoid damaging of otherwise intact surfaces. When using mechanical
means only lightweight equipment should be used, orbital sander is recommended. Yet,
avoid sandpapering on top of welds or irregularities or near to vertical surfaces.
The finished coating must appear as a homogeneous surface without pores, runners or
pollution of any kind.
Page 5 of 7
Application Instructions
HEMPADUR 85671
Control of
dry film thicknesses:
For the standard specification following applies to the dry film thickness:
The minimum dry film thickness is 300 micron/12 mils, maximum recommended
thickness is 600 micron/24 mils (below 15C/59F: 450 micron/18 mils). The
minimum dry film thickness is evaluated according to the "80-20" rule, ie no more than
20% of the total number of individual measurements must be lower than the minimum
dry film thickness, and the lowest individual measurement must be at least 80% of
minimum dry film thickness, ie 240 micron/9.6 mils. The maximum dry film thickness
can also be evaluated according to the "80-20" rule.
Dry film thickness control must not be carried out within the first 24 hours after
application of final coat (20C, sufficient ventilation). The measurement must be carried
out using an electromagnetic dry film thickness gauge calibrated with shims placed on a
smooth steel substrate.
Do not use the tank or pipeline before the coating is properly cured. Reference is made
to curing time on page 5.
Being a solvent-borne paint HEMPADUR 85671 does contain traces of solvents after full
curing. These solvents will leach out into the surrounding media during service. In order
to keep the concentrations below acceptable levels the following conditioning procedure
is recommended for HEMPADUR 85671 in contact with potable water:
When cured for 1 month (20C/68F), but before taking the tank into use for potable
water, fill twice with water at 60C/140F each time for a period of no less than 24
hours and finally flush with fresh water.
For tanks larger the 100.000 litres/26.000 US gallons flush the surface with fresh
water (min. 15C/59F) for two days. Then wash the tank thoroughly with soap water,
followed by brushing with water or steam cleaning.
On vessels adjacent tanks must be empty during the conditioning.
Repairs:
Page 6 of 7
Application Instructions
HEMPADUR 85671
Safety:
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
ISSUED BY:
Page 7 of 7
Application Instructions
Product Data
HEMPELS ANTIFOULING OLYMPIC 86900
Description:
Recommended use:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Dry to touch:
V.O.C.:
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Application method:
Thinner (max. vol.):
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
Existing organotin copolymer based self-polishing antifouling: Remove possible oil and grease
etc. with suitable detergent, followed by careful high pressure fresh water cleaning. Ensure that
any possible leached surface layer is removed effectively.
Allow the surface to dry before recoating.
Sealer: Whether to use a sealer coat or not depends on the type and condition of the existing
antifouling.
APPLICATION
The surface must be completely clean and dry at the time of application and its temperature
CONDITIONS:
must be above the dew point to avoid condensation. In confined spaces such as sea chests and
stagnant air under large flat bottoms provide adequate ventilation during application and drying.
PRECEDING COAT: HEMPATEX HI-BUILD 46330, HEMPADUR 45182 or according to specification.
SUBSEQUENT COAT: None.
REMARKS:
This product contains heavy particles. Stir well before use. By providing a constantly active surface
during its lifetime, this antifouling is gradually sacrificed in the process.
Colour:
ANTIFOULING OLYMPIC is never tinted and as the high load of cuprous oxide influences the shade
a certain variation from batch to batch is allowable. Exposure to humid weather shortly after
application is likely to cause discolouration. This is a surface phenomenon only and has no
influence on performance nor recoatability.
The final colour will appear after exposure to saltwater. This has no influence on the antifouling
performance. Brown 60700 changes to greyish in direct contact with sea water.
Redocking:
At redocking, HEMPEL'S ANTIFOULING OLYMPIC 86900 can be recoated after thorough
cleaning and removal of any poorly adhering surface layer on the antifouling.
Reference is made to SURFACE PREPARATION above. If recoated with other types of antifouling,
other surface preparation methods may be required - contact HEMPEL.
Aluminium hulls:
May be specified on aluminium hulls provided an efficient anticorrosive system in minimum 2
coats of 150 micron/6 mils each has been applied. The anticorrosive system must stay intact
during service in order to avoid corrosion of the aluminium caused by the cuprous oxide content
of OLYMPIC.
Application
Standard airless heavy-duty spray equipment:
equipment:
Pump ratio:
min 45:1 (see Note below)
Pump output:
min 12 litres/minute (theoretical)
Spray hoses:
max 15 metres/50 feet, 3/8" internal diameter
max 3 metres/10 feet, 1/4" internal diameter
Note: If longer spray hoses are necessary, up to 50 metres/150 feet hose (" internal diameter)
can be added. The pump ratio must be raised to 60:1 or more, however, the high output capacity
of the pump must be maintained.
A reversible nozzle is recommended.
Filter: Surge tank filter and tip filter should be removed.
Filmthicknesses:
Range and control of dry film thickness: 80 micron/3.2 mils to 150 micron/6 mils. Indicated film
thickness will vary according to specification. This will alter spreading rate and may influence
drying time. In case of multi-coat application, drying time and minimum recoat interval will be
influenced by the number of coats and by the thickness of each coat applied - reference is made
to the corresponding painting specification. Keep thinning to a minimum to ensure that correct film
thickness is obtained. The proper way of governing the film thickness is to sub-divide the areas to
be painted and calculate the amount of paint to be applied on each sub-divided area. The exact
amount of paint calculated must be applied evenly on the area. For further information, please
consult the corresponding painting specification.
Recommended
As per specification depending on existing hull condition, trading pattern, and intended service
number of coats:
life.
No maximum recoat interval, but after prolonged exposure to polluted atmosphere, remove
accumulated contamination by high pressure fresh water cleaning and allow to dry before applying
next coat.
Undocking:
Minimum undocking time depends on number of coats applied, film thickness, the prevailing
temperature and the subsequent exposure/service conditions. For further information, please
consult the corresponding painting specification. Maximum undocking time depends on the
atmospheric conditions (UV radiation, temperature, degree of atmospheric pollution, etc.).
Exposure to the atmosphere in up to 6 months normally presents no problems but extraordinary
contamination may call for a freshwater high pressure hosing - contact Hempel.
Note:
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPELS ANTIFOULING OLYMPIC 86950
Description:
Recommended use:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Dry to touch:
V.O.C.:
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Application method:
Thinner (max. vol.):
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
Existing organotin copolymer based self-polishing antifouling: Remove possible oil and grease
etc. with suitable detergent, followed by careful high pressure fresh water cleaning. Ensure that
any possible leached surface layer is removed effectively.
Allow the surface to dry before recoating.
Sealer: Whether to use a sealer coat or not depends on the type and condition of the existing
antifouling.
APPLICATION
The surface must be completely clean and dry at the time of application and its temperature
CONDITIONS:
must be above the dew point to avoid condensation. In confined spaces such as sea chests and
stagnant air under large flat bottoms provide adequate ventilation during application and drying.
PRECEDING COAT: HEMPATEX HI-BUILD 46330, HEMPADUR 45182 or according to specification.
SUBSEQUENT COAT: None.
REMARKS:
This product contains heavy particles. Stir well before use. By providing a constantly active surface
during its lifetime, this antifouling is gradually sacrificed in the process.
Colour:
ANTIFOULING OLYMPIC is never tinted and as the high load of cuprous oxide influences the shade
a certain variation from batch to batch is allowable. Exposure to humid weather shortly after
application is likely to cause discolouration. This is a surface phenomenon only and has no
influence on performance nor recoatability.
The final colour will appear after exposure to saltwater. This has no influence on the antifouling
performance. Brown 60700 changes to greyish in direct contact with seawater.
Redocking:
At redocking, HEMPEL'S ANTIFOULING OLYMPIC 86950 can be recoated after thorough
cleaning and removal of any poorly adhering surface layer on the antifouling.
Reference is made to SURFACE PREPARATION above. If recoated with other types of antifouling,
other surface preparation methods may be required - contact HEMPEL.
Aluminium hulls:
May be specified on aluminium hulls provided an efficient anticorrosive system in minimum 2
coats of 150 micron/6 mils each has been applied. The anticorrosive system must stay intact
during service in order to avoid corrosion of the aluminium caused by the cuprous oxide content
of OLYMPIC.
Application
Standard airless heavy-duty spray equipment:
equipment:
Pump ratio:
min 45:1 (see Note below)
Pump output:
min 12 litres/minute (theoretical)
Spray hoses:
max 15 metres/50 feet, 3/8" internal diameter
max 3 metres/10 feet, 1/4" internal diameter
Note: If longer spray hoses are necessary, up to 50 metres/150 feet hose (" internal diameter)
can be added. The pump ratio must be raised to 60:1 or more, however, the high output capacity
of the pump must be maintained.
A reversible nozzle is recommended.
Filter: Surge tank filter and tip filter should be removed.
Film thicknesses:
Range and control of dry film thickness: 80 micron/3.2 mils to 150 micron/6 mils. Indicated film
thickness will vary according to specification. This will alter spreading rate and may influence
drying time. In case of multi-coat application, drying time and minimum recoat interval will be
influenced by the number of coats and by the thickness of each coat applied - reference is made
to the corresponding painting specification. Keep thinning to a minimum to ensure that correct film
thickness is obtained. The proper way of governing the film thickness is to sub-divide the areas to
be painted and calculate the amount of paint to be applied on each sub-divided area. The exact
amount of paint calculated must be applied evenly on the area. For further information, please
consult the corresponding painting specification.
Recommended
As per specification depending on existing hull condition, trading pattern, and intended service
number of coats:
life.
No maximum recoat interval, but after prolonged exposure to polluted atmosphere, remove
accumulated contamination by high pressure fresh water cleaning and allow to dry before applying
next coat.
Undocking:
Minimum undocking time depends on number of coats applied, film thickness, the prevailing
temperature and the subsequent exposure/service conditions. For further information, please
consult the corresponding painting specification. Maximum undocking time depends on the
atmospheric conditions (UV radiation, temperature, degree of atmospheric pollution, etc.).
Exposure to the atmosphere in up to 6 months normally presents no problems but extraordinary
contamination may call for a freshwater high pressure hosing - contact Hempel.
Note:
HEMPEL'S ANTIFOULING OLYMPIC 86950 is for professional use only.
ISSUED BY:
HEMPEL A/S - 8695051110CR005
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPADUR 87540
BASE 87549 with CURING AGENT 97740
Description:
Recommended use:
1.
2.
The product complies with Aramco Engineering Standard APCS 113. (See REMARKS
overleaf).
Service temperature:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Solids content:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Dry to touch:
Dry to backfilling:
V.O.C.:
Red/50700
Glossy
100%
1.6 m/litre - 625 micron
64 sq.ft./US gallon - 25 mils
> 66C/151F
1.8 kg/litre - 15.0 lbs/US gallon
45 minutes at 25C/77F - 15 minutes at 50C/122F
3 hours at 25C/77F
10 g/litre - 0.1 lbs/US gallon
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances. Further reference is made to "Explanatory Notes" in the HEMPEL book.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Mixing ratio 87540:
Application method:
Thinner (max. vol):
Pot life:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
HEMPADUR 87540
SURFACE
PREPARATION:
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
Use only where application and curing can proceed at temperatures above 10C/50F. Apply only
on a clean and dry surface with a temperature above the dew point to avoid condensation. The
maximum temperature of the substrate should not be more than approx 100C/210F. The paint
temperature should not exceed 80C/176F. Relative humidity max. 85%.
PRECEDING
COAT:
None
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
None.
REMARKS:
Film thicknesses:
Substrate
temperature, film
forming properties:
Recoating:
May be specified in another film thickness than indicated. This will alter spreading rate and may
influence drying time and overcoating interval.
Irrespective of substrate temperature, make sure that the paint material is applied in a uniform
film free of pinholes, dry-spray or other irregularities.
The indicated overcoating interval will normally only apply in connection with touch-up of too low dry
film thickness.
If the maximum overcoating interval is exceeded, roughening of the surface is necessary to ensure
adhesion.
Disclaimer:
Any reference to a company standard or specification in this Technical Product Data sheet shall
not be construed as a recommendation by that company to purchase.
Note:
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Application
Application Instructions
Instructions
For product description refer to product data sheet
HEMPADUR 87540
BASE 87549 with CURING AGENT 97740
Scope:
Surface preparation:
When used as a heavy duty coating for rehabilitation of old buried pipelines:
Abrasive grit blasting to minimum Sa 2. Recommended surface profile is Rz 75-100
micron/3-4 mils, corresponding to Rugotest No. 3, BN10, Keane-Tator Comparator,
minimum 3.0 G/S, or ISO Comparator, Medium (G). Oil and grease must be removed
with suitable detergent, salts and other contaminants by (high pressure) fresh water
cleaning prior to blasting. After blasting clean the surface carefully from abrasives and
dust.
Severely pitted areas may call for further water washing at a pressure of min. 300
bar/4350 psi and repeated abrasive blasting.
When used as a heavy duty coating for factory application of pipe fittings and pipe
bends:
Oil and grease to be removed by suitable detergent, salts and other contaminants by
high pressure fresh water hosing prior to blasting. Abrasive grit blasting to Sa 2.
Recommended surface profile is Rz 75-100 micron/3-4 mils, corresponding to Rugotest
No. 3, BN 10 or ISO Comparator, Medium (G).
Application equipment:
HEMPADUR 87540, being a solvent free, high viscosity material, requires special
measures to be taken during application. Spray application can only be carried out with
dual feed hot airless equipment with proportioning pump adjusted to mixing ratio 2:1.
Heated storage tanks with agitators, material feed pumps, fluid heaters, solvent
flushing pump, one mixer manifold assembly and one mixer tube are required. Other
spray systems may be used. Please consult HEMPEL for more details.
Supply hose: min. 3/8preferably insulated and heated
max. length 25 metres
Spray hose: 1/4
max. length 3 metres
Nozzle size: .024 - .031, reversible
Procedure:
Storage: It is recommended to store the paint under heated conditions the last 1-2 days
before taken into use, preferably at 40C/104F, which will ease emptying the cans into
the mixer tanks.
Maximum storage temperature for both base 87549 and curing agent 97740, 40C/
104F.
Start-up: Transfer the two components base 87549 and curing agent 97740 into two
storage tanks.
Heating of the base material 87549 and curing agent 97740 is required to reduce the
viscosity. The optimum spray temperature is around 55-60C/131-140F (at the nozzle).
Circulate the material until the output pressure of the three main pump cylinders is
identical - between 160-200 bar/2175-2900 psi and the material temperature is
typically 55-60C/131-140F maximum 80C/176F. This is valid for both base and
curing agent. When this has been achieved, the material is ready for spraying.
Recirculation should be stopped.
If some or all of the cylinders show too low pressure and no leaks are visible, it may
indicate that the viscosity of the material is too high. In this case, further heating of the
base is required.
Page 1 of 3
HEMPEL
HEMPEL
Application
Instructions
Application Instructions
HEMPADUR 87540
Please note that the output pressure of the two supply pumps should always be lower
than that of the proportioning pump cylinders. Maximum recommended output pressure
of supply pumps is 10 bar/140 psi.
Before application, the mixing ratio should be checked (on heated product). Close the
valve to the re-circulation hoses. Measure the volumetric material flow of the two
components separately at the outlets just after the dosing cylinders.
Base : curing agent:
2 : 1 by volume
b)
c)
Be sure that the flush pump system is on stand-by under full pressure at all
times.
d)
Have the necessary tools ready for immediate disconnection of spray hose from
static mixer if spraying has been discontinued for more than one minute.
The best distance between spray gun and substrate to be coated is approximately 30
cm/1 ft.
It is recommended to do at least three passes (depending on the size of the nozzle)
wet-in-wet in order to build up a pinhole-free paint film in the specified film thickness.
Applied wet film thickness should be checked by using a wet film gauge (comb). It is
recommended to coat flat steel panels and check the wet film thickness on these, prior
to start the coating of the object itself.
When coating long sections of pipelines, the whole section planned for coating, should
be coated without making breaks, and if necessary by using replacement teams.
Control:
a)
As an extra check of correct mixing ratios, evaluate the dry to touch time. If
longer than indicated this may indicate insufficient or incorrect mixing.
b)
All three main pump cylinders must show same or almost same output pressure.
Especially their movements following charging and discharging of the pistons
must be synchronous and within the same order of magnitude.
Drying/curing:
Steel temperature
25C/77F
Dry to touch
45 minutes
15 minutes
3 hours
30 minutes
Cleaning of equipment:
50C/122F
60C/140F
3 minutes
Page 2 of 3
Application Instructions
HEMPADUR 87540
CLEANER 99610 or HEMPELS THINNER 08450. Keep flushing until the cleaner looks
clear and clean.
After all the material has been removed from pump and hoses, the surge valve should
be flushed and the suction pipes cleaned.
Topcoating:
Damaged areas:
Coating damaged during testing for continuity of paint film or damaged through handling
may be ground down to bare steel and repaired with HEMPADUR 87540 or HEMPELS
MULTI-MIL 35430.
Safety:
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
ISSUED BY:
Page 3 of 3
Application Instructions
Product Data
HEMPELS HS GAS PIPE COATING 87633
BASE 87638 with CURING AGENT 97693
Description:
Recommended use:
As a one-coat system for internal coating of gas pipes designed for carrying of dry,
sweet gas. The coating is designed to reduce the drag resistance in the pipeline by
making the pipe walls smoother.
Service temperatures:
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Finish:
Volume solids, %:
Theoretical spreading rate:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
Dry to touch:
Fully cured:
V.O.C.:
Reddish brown/50890
Semi-gloss
69 1
11.5 m/litre - 60 micron
461 sq.ft./US gallon - 2.4 mils
25C/77F
1.3 kg/litre - 10.9 lbs/US gallon
8 hours at 20C/68F
7 days at 20C/68F
325 g/litre - 2.7 lbs/US gallon
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
APPLICATION DETAILS:
Mixing ratio for 87633:
Application method:
Thinner (max.vol.):
Pot life:
Nozzle orifice:
Nozzle pressure:
Cleaning of tools:
Indicated film thickness, dry:
Indicated film thickness, wet:
Recoat interval, min:
Recoat interval, max:
Safety:
Page 1 of 2
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
Remove oil and grease thoroughly with suitable detergent. Remove salt and other contaminants
by high pressure fresh water cleaning.
Abrasive blasting to Sa 2 with a surface profile corresponding to Rugotest No. 3, BN9a, KeaneTator Comparator, 2.0 G/S, 2S, or ISO Comparator, FINE (G).
APPLICATION
CONDITIONS:
The surface must be completely dry and clean with a temperature above the dew point to avoid
condensation. The minimum temperature and the temperature of the paint itself should be above
10C/50F. The best result is obtained at 15-25C/59-77F. Maximum steel temperature approx.
45C/113F. Relative humidity max. 85%. In confined spaces provide adequate ventilation.
SUBSEQUENT
COAT:
REMARKS:
Recoating:
Recoating will normally only apply in connection with touch-up of too low dry film thickness.
Thinner:
Note:
ISSUED BY:
Page 2 of 2
Product Data
HEMPELS TOOL CLEANER 99610
Description:
HEMPELS TOOL CLEANER 99610 is a blend of strong solvents for cleaning of tools
that have been used for mixing or application of two-component epoxy products.
It has better cleaning properties than epoxy thinners.
Does not contain chlorinated solvent.
Recommended use:
For cleaning of brushes, paint rollers, spray equipment, and other tools which have
been used for mixing or application of HEMPADUR products.
Do not use as thinner for any paint.
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade Nos:
Volume solids:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
V.O.C.:
Transparent/00000
0%
28C/82F
0.9 kg/litre
7.5 lbs/US gallon
715 g/litre - 6.0 lbs/US gallon
Remarks:
Cleaning should take place as soon as possible after use of the tools.
Spray equipment does not require rinsing or flushing after use of HEMPELS TOOL
CLEANER 99610.
Do not use on cloth, linoleum, plexiglass, plastics, asphalt floors, and similar.
Do not use it for cleaning of equipment before and after application of polyurethanes
(HEMPATHANEs).
Note:
Safety:
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
ISSUED BY:
Page 1 of 1
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
Product Data
HEMUCRYL THINNER 99800
Description:
Recommended use:
For dilution of water-borne acrylic paints when low relative humidity is causing an
unacceptable level of dry spraying. Can be added up to 50%* by volume to slow down
the drying time without reduction of the maximum possible dry film thickness.
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Volume solids, %:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
V.O.C.:
Transparent/00000
0,9
> 93C/199F
1.0 kg/litre - 8.3 lbs/US gallon
0 g/litre - 0 lbs/US gallon
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
Remarks:
Increase wet
Film thickness %
10
20
30
40
50
Minimum recoating
interval (75 micron dry)
2 hours
2 hours
2 hours
3 hours
3 hours
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
ISSUED BY:
Page 1 of 1
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
Product Data
HEMUCRYL BRUSH AGENT 99810
Description:
Recommended use:
Addition of HEMUCRYL BRUSH AGENT to a water-borne acrylic paint will increase the
high shear viscosity of the paint thereby making it more suitable for application by brush
or roller. Eg relevant for touch-up work.
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colours/Shade nos:
Volume solids, %:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
V.O.C.:
Transparent/00000
81
> 93C/199F
1.0 kg/litre - 8.3 lbs/US gallon
0 g/litre - 0 lbs/US gallon
The physical constants stated are nominal data according to the HEMPEL Group's approved formulas. They are
subject to normal manufacturing tolerances and where stated, being standard deviation according to ISO 3534-1.
Remarks:
Note:
Safety:
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
ISSUED BY:
Page 1 of 1
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet
Product Data
HEMPELS SILICONE CLEANER 99850
Description:
Recommended use:
As a cleaning fluid for the HEMPASIL range of products. For removal of silicone
contamination on all substrates except for aluminium (see REMARK below) to be
recoated, e.g. vessels already coated with HEMPASIL or vessels to be coated with a
new coat of HEMPASIL.
Availability:
PHYSICAL CONSTANTS:
Colour/Shade nos:
Active matter:
Flash point:
Specific gravity:
pH value:
V.O.C.:
Application method:
Can be applied by brush, roller, or spray at low pressure. To be applied undiluted, left to
work for some time (see separate instructions) and then removed by fresh water
washing.
Remarks:
Shake HEMPELS SILICONE CLEANER 99850 before use to lower the viscosity.
Do not use on aluminium substrates.
Do not expose to frost.
Safety:
Handle with care. Before and during use, observe all safety labels on packaging and
paint containers, consult HEMPEL Material Safety Data Sheets and follow all local or
national safety regulations. Avoid inhalation, avoid contact with skin and eyes, and do
not swallow. Take precautions against possible risks of fire or explosions as well as
protection of the environment. Apply only in well ventilated areas.
Note:
ISSUED BY:
Page 1 of 1
HEMPEL
Product Data Sheet